IDT82V2108 [IDT]

T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER; T1 / E1 / J1八进制成帧器
IDT82V2108
型号: IDT82V2108
厂家: INTEGRATED DEVICE TECHNOLOGY    INTEGRATED DEVICE TECHNOLOGY
描述:

T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER
T1 / E1 / J1八进制成帧器

文件: 总272页 (文件大小:1168K)
中文:  中文翻译
下载:  下载PDF数据表文档文件
T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
IDT82V2108  
PRELIMINARY  
FEATURES  
APPLICATIONS  
Octal Framer supporting T1, E1 and J1 Formats  
High density internet E1 or T1 / J1 interface for routers, multiplex-  
ers, switches and digital modems.  
Provides programmable system interface to support Mitelâ ST-  
bus, AT&Tâ CHI and MVIP bus, supporting data rates of 1.544 /  
2.048 / 8.192Mb/s; up to four links can be byte interleaved on one  
system bus without external logic  
Frame relay switches and access devices (FRADS)  
SONET / SDH add drop multiplexers  
Digital private branch exchanges (PBX)  
Provides up to three internal floating HDLC controllers for each  
framer to support ISDN PRI and V5.X interface. Each HDLC con-  
tains 128-byte deep FIFOs in both the receive and transmit direc-  
tions  
Provides jitter attenuation performance exceeding the requirements  
set by the associated standards for both Rx and Tx path  
Provides payload, line and digital loop-backs  
Channel service units (CSU) and data service units (DSU)  
Channel banks and multiplexers  
Digital access and cross-connect systems (DACS)  
STANDARDS  
E1 MODE:  
ITU-T: G.704, G.706, G.732, G.802, G.737, G.738, G.739, G.742,  
G.823, G.964, G.965, I.431, O.151, O.152, O.153;  
ETSI: ETS 300 011, ETS 300 233, ETS 324-1, ETS 347-1, TBR 4,  
TBR 12, TBR 13;  
Provides a floating Pseudo Random Bit Sequence / repetitive pat-  
tern generator/detector, which can be assigned to any one of eight  
framers, the pattern may be inserted / detected in an unframed or  
Nx64K or Nx56K (T1 only) basis  
GO - MVIP  
Provides signaling insertion / extraction for CCS / CAS and RBS  
signaling system  
Provides programmable codes insertion, data / sign inversion and  
digital milliwatt code insertion on a per channel / timeslot basis  
Supports automatic / manual alarming transmit and integration  
T1/J1 MODE:  
ANSI: T1.107, T1.231, T1.403, T1.408;  
TR: TSY-000147, TSY-000191, NWT-000303, TSY-000312, TSY-000-  
499;  
AT&T: TR 54016, TR 62411  
TTC: JT-G 703, JT-G 704, JT-G706, JT-G 1431  
Provides performance monitor to counter CRC error, framing bit er-  
ror, far end block CRC error (E1), out of frame event (T1/J1) and  
change of frame alignment event (T1/J1)  
Provides programmable In-band Loop-back Code transmitter/re-  
ceiver, Bit Oriented Message generator / detector  
Supports polled or interrupt driven processing for all events  
Supports multiplexed or non-multiplexed address/data bus MPU in-  
terface for configuration, control and status monitoring  
JTAG boundary scan meets IEEE 1149.1  
Low power 3.3V CMOS technology with 5V tolerant inputs  
Operating industrial temperature range: -40°C to +85°C  
Package available: 128 pin PQFP  
144 pin PBGA  
TheIDTlogoisaregisteredtrademarkofIntegratedDeviceTechnology, Inc.  
JANUARY 2003  
INDUSTRIAL TEMPERATURE RANGES  
1
ã
2001 Integrated Device Technology, Inc.  
DSC-6039/3  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
bit or any arbitrary channels in ESF mode. The signaling insertion, idle  
code substitution, data insertion, data inversion and test pattern  
generation or detection are also supported on a per-channel basis.  
In T1/J1 mode, the data stream of 1.544M bit/s can be converted to/  
from the data stream of 2.048M bit/s on the system side by software  
configuration. In addition, any four of the eight framers can be  
multiplexed or de-multiplexed to or from one of the two 8.192M bit/s  
buses.  
DESCRIPTION  
The IDT82V2108 is a flexible feature-rich octal T1/E1/J1 Framer.  
Controlled by the software, the IDT82V2108 can be globally configured  
as an Octal E1 or T1/J1 Framer. When E1 or T1/J1 has been set glo-  
bally, the operation mode of each of the eight framers can be  
configured independently. The configuration is performed through a par-  
allel Multiplexed/Non-Multiplexed microprocessor interface.  
The IDT82V2108 realizes frame synchronization, frame generating,  
signaling extraction and insertion, alarm and test signals generation  
and detection in a single chip. It also integrates up to three HDLC re-  
ceivers and HDLC transmitters for each of the eight framers.  
In E1 Mode, the receive path of each framer can be configured to  
frame to Basic Frame, CRC Multi-Frame and Signaling Multi-Frame.  
The framing can also be bypassed (unframed mode). It detects and  
indicates the event of out of Basic Frame Sync, out of CRC Multi-  
Frame, out of Signaling Multi-Frame, the Remote Alarm Indication  
signal and the Remote Signaling Multi-Frame Alarm Indication signal. It  
also monitors the Red and AIS alarms. Basic Frame Alignment Signal  
errors, Far End Block Errors (FEBE) and CRC errors are counted. Up  
to three HDLC links are provided to extract the HDLC message on  
TS16, the Sa National bits and/or any arbitrary timeslot. An Elastic  
Store Buffer that optionally supports slip buffering and adaptation to  
backplane timing is provided. In E1 receive path, signaling debounce,  
signaling freezing, idle code substitution, digital milliwatt code insertion,  
trunk conditioning, data inversion and pattern generation or detection  
are also supported on a per-timeslot basis.  
In E1 mode, the transmit path of each framer can be configured to  
generate Basic Frame, CRC Multi-Frame and Signaling Multi-Frame.  
The framing can also be disabled (unframed mode). It can also transmit  
Remote Alarm Indication signal, the Remote Signaling Multi-Frame  
Alarm Indication signal, AIS signal and FEBE. Up to three HDLC links  
are provided to insert the HDLC message on TS16, the Sa National bits  
and/or any arbitrary timeslot. The signaling insertion, idle code  
substitution, data insertion, data inversion and test pattern generation  
or detection are also supported on a per-timeslot basis.  
In E1 mode, any four of the eight framers can be multiplexed or de-  
multiplexed to or from one of the two 8.192M bit/s buses.  
In T1/J1 mode, the receive path of each framer can be configured to  
frame to Super Frame (SF) or Extended Super Frame (ESF) formats.  
The framing can also be bypassed (unframed mode). It detects and  
indicates the out of SF/ESF sync event, the Yellow, Red and AIS  
alarms. It also detects the presence of inband loopback codes, bit  
oriented message. Frame Alignment Signal errors, CRC-6 errors, out of  
SF/ESF events and Frame Alignment position changes are counted. Up  
to two HDLC links are provides to extract the HDLC message on the F-  
bit or any arbitrary channels in ESF mode. An Elastic Store Buffer that  
optionally supports controlled slip and adaptation to backplane timing is  
provided. In T1/J1 receive path, signaling debounce, signaling freezing,  
idle code substitution, digital milliwatt code insertion, idle code insertion,  
data inversion and pattern generation or detection are also supported  
on a per-channel basis.  
In T1/J1 mode, the transmit path of each framer can be configured  
to generates SF or ESF. The framing can also be disabled (unframed  
mode). It can also transmit Yellow signal and AIS signal. Inband  
loopback codes and bit oriented message can also be transmitted. Up  
to two HDLC links are provided to insert the HDLC message on the F-  
2
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
FUNCTIONAL BLOCK DIAGRAM  
One of the Eight Framers  
TSCCKA  
Transmit  
Clock  
TSCCKB/  
MTSCCKB  
TSCFS/  
MTSCFS  
Transmit  
System  
Interface  
TSFSn/  
TSSIGn  
MTSSIG[1:2]  
MTSD[1:2]  
Transmit  
Payload  
Control  
Frame Generator  
Transmit  
Jitter  
Attenuator  
LTCKn  
LTDn  
TSDn  
Inband  
Loopback  
Code  
Generator  
(T1/J1 only)  
Bit-Oriented  
Message  
Transmitter  
(T1/J1 only)  
HDLC  
Transmitter  
#1  
#3  
#2 (E1  
only)  
Digital  
Loopback  
Payload  
Loopback  
PRBS  
Generator  
/Detector  
Bit-Oriented  
Message  
Receiver  
Inband  
Loopback  
Code Detector  
(T1/J1 only)  
XCK  
(T1/J1 only)  
Alarm  
Detector  
(T1/J1 only)  
#3  
#2 (E1  
only)  
HDLC  
Receiver #1  
Line  
Loopback  
MRSD[1:2]  
RSDn  
Receive  
CAS/RBS  
Buffer  
Receive  
Payload  
Control  
RSCKn/  
RSSIGn  
MRSSIG[1:2]  
MRSFS[1:2]  
Frame Processor  
LRCKn  
LRDn  
Receive  
System  
Interface  
Receive  
Jitter  
Attenuator  
RSFSn  
Performance  
Monitor  
RSCCK/  
MRSCCK  
Elastic  
Store  
Buffer  
RSCFS/  
MRSCFS  
BIAS  
VDDIO  
VDDC  
GNDIO  
GNDC  
Micro-Processor  
Interface  
IEEE1149.1  
JTAG  
3
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
CONTENTS  
1 PIN ASSIGNMENTS ............................................................................................................................................13  
1.1 128 PIN PQFP PACKAGE (TOP VIEW) .................................................................................................................................................. 13  
1.2 144 PIN PBGAPACKAGE (BOTTOM VIEW) .......................................................................................................................................... 14  
2 PIN DESCRIPTION ..............................................................................................................................................15  
3 FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION ..............................................................................................................................21  
3.1 T1 / E1 / J1 MODE SELECTION ............................................................................................................................................................. 21  
3.2 FRAME PROCESSOR (FRMP) ............................................................................................................................................................... 21  
3.2.1 E1 Mode......................................................................................................................................................................................... 21  
3.2.2 T1/J1 Mode .................................................................................................................................................................................... 26  
3.3 PERFORMANCE MONITOR (PMON) ..................................................................................................................................................... 28  
3.3.1 E1 Mode......................................................................................................................................................................................... 28  
3.3.2 T1/J1 Mode .................................................................................................................................................................................... 28  
3.4 ALARM DETECTOR (ALMD) - T1 / J1 ONLY .......................................................................................................................................... 28  
3.5 HDLC RECEIVER (RHDLC) ................................................................................................................................................................... 29  
3.5.1 E1 Mode......................................................................................................................................................................................... 29  
3.5.2 T1 / J1 Mode .................................................................................................................................................................................. 30  
3.6 BIT-ORIENTED MESSAGE RECEIVER (RBOM) - T1 / J1 ONLY............................................................................................................. 30  
3.7 INBAND LOOPBACK CODE DETECTOR (IBCD) - T1 / J1 ONLY ........................................................................................................... 31  
3.8 ELASTIC STORE BUFFER (ELSB) ........................................................................................................................................................ 31  
3.8.1 E1 Mode......................................................................................................................................................................................... 31  
3.8.2 T1 / J1 Mode .................................................................................................................................................................................. 31  
3.9 RECEIVE CAS/RBS BUFFER (RCRB) ................................................................................................................................................... 31  
3.9.1 E1 Mode......................................................................................................................................................................................... 31  
3.9.2 T1 / J1 Mode .................................................................................................................................................................................. 33  
3.10 RECEIVE PAYLOAD CONTROL (RPLC) .............................................................................................................................................. 33  
3.10.1 E1 Mode ....................................................................................................................................................................................... 33  
3.10.2 T1 / J1 Mode ................................................................................................................................................................................ 34  
3.11 RECEIVE SYSTEM INTERFACE (RESI) ............................................................................................................................................... 35  
3.11.1 E1 Mode ....................................................................................................................................................................................... 35  
3.11.1.1 Receive Clock Slave Mode .................................................................................................................................................... 36  
3.11.1.1.1 Receive Clock Slave RSCK Reference Mode ........................................................................................................ 36  
3.11.1.1.2 Receive Clock Slave External Signaling Mode ...................................................................................................... 38  
3.11.1.2 Receive Clock Master Mode ................................................................................................................................................... 39  
3.11.1.2.1 Receive Clock Master Full E1 Mode ..................................................................................................................... 39  
3.11.1.2.2 Receive Clock Master Fractional E1 (with F-bit) Mode ........................................................................................... 41  
3.11.1.3 Receive Multiplexed Mode ..................................................................................................................................................... 41  
3.11.1.4 Parity Check & Polarity Fix ..................................................................................................................................................... 43  
3.11.1.5 Offset .................................................................................................................................................................................... 44  
3.11.1.6 Output On RSDn/MRSD & RSSIGn/MRSSIG ......................................................................................................................... 44  
4
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
3.11.2 T1 / J1 Mode ................................................................................................................................................................................ 47  
3.11.2.1 Receive Clock Slave Mode .................................................................................................................................................... 47  
3.11.2.1.1 Receive Clock Slave RSCK Reference Mode ........................................................................................................ 48  
3.11.2.1.2 Receive Clock Slave External Signaling Mode ...................................................................................................... 50  
3.11.2.2 Receive Clock Master Mode ................................................................................................................................................... 50  
3.11.2.2.1 Receive Clock Master Full T1/J1 Mode ................................................................................................................. 52  
3.11.2.2.2 Receive Clock Master Fractional T1/J1 Mode ....................................................................................................... 52  
3.11.2.3 Receive Multiplexed Mode ..................................................................................................................................................... 52  
3.11.2.4 Parity Check .......................................................................................................................................................................... 53  
3.11.2.5 Offset .................................................................................................................................................................................... 55  
3.11.2.6 Output On RSDn/MRSD & RSSIGn/MRSSIG ......................................................................................................................... 55  
3.12 PRBS GENERATOR / DETECTOR (PRGD) .......................................................................................................................................... 56  
3.12.1 E1 Mode ....................................................................................................................................................................................... 56  
3.12.2 T1 / J1 Mode ................................................................................................................................................................................ 57  
3.13 TRANSMIT SYSTEM INTERFACE (TRSI) ............................................................................................................................................. 57  
3.13.1 E1 Mode ....................................................................................................................................................................................... 57  
3.13.1.1 Transmit Clock Slave Mode ................................................................................................................................................... 58  
3.13.1.1.1 Transmit Clock Slave TSFS Enable Mode ........................................................................................................... 58  
3.13.1.1.2 Transmit Clock Slave External Signaling Mode ................................................................................................... 60  
3.13.1.2 Transmit Clock Master Mode .................................................................................................................................................. 61  
3.13.1.3 Transmit Multiplexed Mode .................................................................................................................................................... 61  
3.13.1.4 Parity Check .......................................................................................................................................................................... 63  
3.13.1.5 Offset .................................................................................................................................................................................... 65  
3.13.2 T1 / J1 Mode ................................................................................................................................................................................ 68  
3.13.2.1 Transmit Clock Slave Mode ................................................................................................................................................... 68  
3.13.2.1.1 Transmit Clock Slave TSFS Enable Mode ........................................................................................................... 69  
3.13.2.1.2 Transmit Clock Slave External Signaling Mode ................................................................................................... 71  
3.13.2.2 Transmit Clock Master Mode .................................................................................................................................................. 72  
3.13.2.3 Transmit Multiplexed Mode .................................................................................................................................................... 72  
3.13.2.4 Parity Check .......................................................................................................................................................................... 75  
3.13.2.5 Offset .................................................................................................................................................................................... 75  
3.14 TRANSMIT PAYLOAD CONTROL (TPLC) ............................................................................................................................................ 76  
3.14.1 E1 Mode ....................................................................................................................................................................................... 76  
3.14.2 T1 / J1 Mode ................................................................................................................................................................................ 76  
3.15 FRAME GENERATOR (FRMG) ............................................................................................................................................................. 77  
3.15.1 E1 Mode ....................................................................................................................................................................................... 77  
3.15.2 T1 / J1 Mode ................................................................................................................................................................................ 78  
3.16 HDLC TRANSMITTER (THDLC) ........................................................................................................................................................... 79  
3.16.1 E1 Mode ....................................................................................................................................................................................... 79  
3.16.2 T1 / J1 Mode ................................................................................................................................................................................ 79  
3.17 BIT-ORIENTED MESSAGE TRANSMITTER (TBOM) - T1 / J1 ONLY .................................................................................................... 80  
3.18 INBAND LOOPBACK CODE GENERATOR (IBCG) - T1 / J1 ONLY ...................................................................................................... 80  
5
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
3.19 JITTERATTENUATOR (RJAT/TJAT) .................................................................................................................................................... 80  
3.19.1 E1 Mode ...................................................................................................................................................................................... 80  
3.19.2 T1 / J1 Mode ................................................................................................................................................................................ 83  
3.20 TRANSMIT CLOCK .............................................................................................................................................................................. 85  
3.20.1 E1 Mode ...................................................................................................................................................................................... 85  
3.20.2 T1 / J1 Mode ................................................................................................................................................................................ 85  
3.21 LINE INTERFACE ................................................................................................................................................................................ 85  
3.21.1 E1 Mode ...................................................................................................................................................................................... 85  
3.21.2 T1 / J1 Mode ................................................................................................................................................................................ 85  
3.22 INTERRUPT SUMMARY ...................................................................................................................................................................... 86  
3.22.1 E1 Mode ...................................................................................................................................................................................... 86  
3.22.2 T1 / J1 Mode ................................................................................................................................................................................ 86  
3.23 LOOPBACK MODE .............................................................................................................................................................................. 86  
3.23.1 Line Loopback ............................................................................................................................................................................ 86  
3.23.2 Digital Loopback ......................................................................................................................................................................... 86  
3.23.3 Payload Loopback ...................................................................................................................................................................... 86  
3.24 CLOCK MONITOR ............................................................................................................................................................................... 86  
4 OPERATION .......................................................................................................................................................90  
4.1 E1 MODE ............................................................................................................................................................................................... 90  
4.1.1 Default Setting .............................................................................................................................................................................. 90  
4.1.2 Various Operation Modes Configuration ...................................................................................................................................... 90  
4.1.3 Operation Example ....................................................................................................................................................................... 95  
4.1.3.1 Using The HDLC Receiver ....................................................................................................................................................... 95  
4.1.3.2 Using The HDLC Transmitter ................................................................................................................................................... 95  
4.1.3.3 Using The PRBS Generator / Detector ..................................................................................................................................... 99  
4.1.3.4 Using Payload Control and Receive CAS/RBS Buffer ..............................................................................................................104  
4.1.3.5 Using TJAT / Timing Option ....................................................................................................................................................104  
4.2 T1/J1 MODE .........................................................................................................................................................................................105  
4.2.1 Default Setting .............................................................................................................................................................................105  
4.2.2 OPERATION IN J1 MODE .............................................................................................................................................................105  
4.2.3 Various Operation Modes Configuration .....................................................................................................................................105  
4.2.4 Operation Example ......................................................................................................................................................................110  
4.2.4.1 Using The HDLC Receiver ...................................................................................................................................................... 110  
4.2.4.2 Using The HDLC Transmitter .................................................................................................................................................. 112  
4.2.4.3 Using The PRBS Generator / Detector .................................................................................................................................... 114  
4.2.4.4 Using Payload Control and Receive CAS/RBS Buffer .............................................................................................................. 118  
4.2.4.5 Using TJAT / Timing Option .................................................................................................................................................... 118  
5 PROGRAMMING INFORMATION ....................................................................................................................... 119  
5.1 REGISTER MAP ...................................................................................................................................................................................119  
6
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
5.1.1 E1 Mode Register Map ................................................................................................................................................................ 120  
5.1.2 T1 / J1 Mode Register Map ......................................................................................................................................................... 123  
5.2 REGISTER DESCRIPTION .................................................................................................................................................................. 126  
5.2.1 E1 Mode ...................................................................................................................................................................................... 126  
5.2.2 T1 / J1 Mode ................................................................................................................................................................................ 198  
6 IEEE STD 1149.1 JTAG TEST ACCESS PORT ................................................................................................... 259  
6.1 JTAG INSTRUCTIONSAND INSTRUCTION REGISTER (IR) ............................................................................................................... 261  
6.2 JTAG DATAREGISTER ....................................................................................................................................................................... 261  
6.2.1 Device Identification Register (IDR) ........................................................................................................................................... 261  
6.2.2 Bypass Register (BYR) ............................................................................................................................................................... 261  
6.2.3 Boundary Scan Register (BSR) .................................................................................................................................................. 261  
6.3 TESTACCESS PORT CONTROLLER ................................................................................................................................................. 261  
7 PHYSICAL AND ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS .............................................................................................. 265  
7.1 ABSOLUTE MAXIMUM RATINGS ........................................................................................................................................................ 265  
7.2 OPERATING CONDITIONS .................................................................................................................................................................. 265  
7.3 D.C. CHARACTERISTICS .................................................................................................................................................................... 265  
7.4 CLOCK RESET TIMING ....................................................................................................................................................................... 266  
7.4.1 Clock Parameters E1 Configuration ........................................................................................................................................... 266  
7.4.2 Clock Parameters T1/J1 Configuration ...................................................................................................................................... 266  
7.5 MICROPROCESSOR READACCESS TIMING .................................................................................................................................... 267  
7.6 MICROPROCESSOR WRITEACCESS TIMING ................................................................................................................................... 268  
7.7 I/O TIMING CHARACTERISTICS ......................................................................................................................................................... 269  
7.7.1 Transmit System Interface Timing .............................................................................................................................................. 269  
7.7.2 Receive System Interface Timing ............................................................................................................................................... 270  
7.7.3 Receive & Transmit Line Timing ................................................................................................................................................. 271  
7.7.3.1 Receive Line Interface Timing ............................................................................................................................................... 271  
7.7.3.2 Transmit Line Interface Timing ............................................................................................................................................... 271  
7
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
LIST OF FIGURES  
Figure-1. E1FrameSearchingProcess ........................................................................................................................................................... 22  
Figure-2.BasicFrameSearchingProcess ...................................................................................................................................................... 23  
Figure-3. HDLCPacket .................................................................................................................................................................................... 29  
Figure-4.TS16ArrangementinSignalingMulti-Frame ................................................................................................................................... 32  
Figure-5.SignalingOutputinE1Mode ........................................................................................................................................................... 32  
Figure - 6. Signaling Output in T1 / J1 Mode ..................................................................................................................................................... 32  
Figure-7. ReceiveClockSlaveRSCKReferenceMode ................................................................................................................................... 36  
Figure-8.E1ReceiveClockSlaveRSCKReferenceMode-FunctionalTimingExample1 ............................................................................ 37  
Figure-9.E1ReceiveClockSlaveRSCKReferenceMode-FunctionalTimingExample2 ............................................................................ 37  
Figure-10.ReceiveClockSlaveExternalSignalingMode .............................................................................................................................. 38  
Figure-11.E1ReceiveClockSlaveExternalSignalingMode-FunctionalTimingExample1 ........................................................................ 38  
Figure-12.E1ReceiveClockSlaveExternalSignalingMode-FunctionalTimingExample2 ....................................................................... 39  
Figure-13. ReceiveClockMasterFullE1orT1/J1Mode ................................................................................................................................. 40  
Figure-14.E1ReceiveClockMasterFullE1Mode-FunctionalTimingExample ........................................................................................... 40  
Figure-15.ReceiveClockMasterFractionalE1orT1/J1Mode ....................................................................................................................... 41  
Figure-16.E1ReceiveClockMasterFractionalE1Mode-FunctionalTimingExample ................................................................................ 42  
Figure-17.ReceiveMultiplexedMode ............................................................................................................................................................. 43  
Figure-18.E1ReceiveMultiplexedMode-FunctionalTimingExample1 ...................................................................................................... 43  
Figure-19.E1ReceiveMultiplexedMode-FunctionalTimingExample2 ...................................................................................................... 44  
Figure - 20. Receive Bit Offset - Between RSCFS & RSDn ................................................................................................................................ 46  
Figure - 21. Receive Bit Offset - Between RSFSn & RSDn ................................................................................................................................ 46  
Figure-22.T1/J1ToE1FormatConversion ..................................................................................................................................................... 48  
Figure-23.T1/J1ReceiveClockSlaveRSCKReferenceMode-FunctionalTimingExample1 ..................................................................... 48  
Figure-24.T1/J1ReceiveClockSlaveRSCKReferenceMode-FunctionalTimingExample2 ..................................................................... 49  
Figure-25.T1/J1ReceiveClockSlaveRSCKReferenceMode-FunctionalTimingExample3 ..................................................................... 49  
Figure-26.T1/J1ReceiveClockSlaveExternalSignalingMode-FunctionalTimingExample1 ................................................................... 50  
Figure-27.T1/J1ReceiveClockSlaveExternalSignalingMode-FunctionalTimingExample2 ................................................................... 51  
Figure-28.T1/J1ReceiveClockSlaveExternalSignalingMode-FunctionalTimingExample3 ................................................................... 51  
Figure-29.T1/J1ReceiveClockMasterFullT1/J1Mode-FunctionalTimingExample.................................................................................. 52  
Figure-30.T1/J1ReceiveClockMasterFractionalT1/J1Mode-FunctionalTimingExample ....................................................................... 53  
Figure-31.T1/J1ReceiveMultiplexedMode-FunctionalTimingExample1 .................................................................................................. 54  
Figure-32.T1/J1ReceiveMultiplexedMode-FunctionalTimingExample2 .................................................................................................. 54  
Figure-33. ReceiveBitOffsetinT1/J1Mode ................................................................................................................................................... 55  
Figure-34. PRBSPatternGenerator ................................................................................................................................................................ 56  
Figure-35.TransmitClockSlaveTSFSEnableMode ...................................................................................................................................... 58  
Figure-36.E1TransmitClockSlaveTSFSEnableMode-FunctionalTimingExample1 ............................................................................... 59  
Figure-37.E1TransmitClockSlaveTSFSEnableMode-FunctionalTimingExample2 ............................................................................... 59  
Figure-38.TransmitClockSlaveExternalSignalingMode ............................................................................................................................. 60  
8
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Figure-39.E1TransmitClockSlaveExternalSignalingMode-FunctionalTimingExample1 ...................................................................... 60  
Figure-40.E1TransmitClockSlaveExternalSignalingMode-FunctionalTimingExample2 ...................................................................... 61  
Figure-41.TransmitClockMasterMode .......................................................................................................................................................... 61  
Figure-42.E1TransmitClockMasterMode-FunctionalTimingExample ..................................................................................................... 62  
Figure-43.TransmitMultiplexedMode ............................................................................................................................................................ 63  
Figure-44.E1TransmitMultiplexedMode-FunctionalTimingExample1 ..................................................................................................... 64  
Figure-45.E1TransmitMultiplexedMode-FunctionalTimingExample2 ..................................................................................................... 64  
Figure - 46. Transmit Bit Offset in E1 Mode - 1 ................................................................................................................................................. 65  
Figure - 47. Transmit Bit Offset in E1 Mode - 2 ................................................................................................................................................. 66  
Figure - 48. Transmit Bit Offset in E1 Mode - 3 ................................................................................................................................................. 66  
Figure - 49. Transmit Bit Offset in E1 Mode - 4 ................................................................................................................................................. 67  
Figure - 50. Transmit Bit Offset in E1 Mode - 5 ................................................................................................................................................. 67  
Figure-51.E1ToT1/J1FormatConversion ..................................................................................................................................................... 69  
Figure-52.T1/J1TransmitClockSlaveTSFSEnableMode-FunctionalTimingExample1 .......................................................................... 69  
Figure-53.T1/J1TransmitClockSlaveTSFSEnableMode-FunctionalTimingExample2 .......................................................................... 70  
Figure-54.T1/J1TransmitClockSlaveTSFSEnableMode-FunctionalTimingExample3 .......................................................................... 70  
Figure-55.T1/J1TransmitClockSlaveExternalSignalingMode-FunctionalTimingExample1 ................................................................. 71  
Figure-56.T1/J1TransmitClockSlaveExternalSignalingMode-FunctionalTimingExample2 ................................................................. 71  
Figure-57.T1/J1TransmitClockSlaveExternalSignalingMode-FunctionalTimingExample3 ................................................................. 72  
Figure-58.T1/J1TransmitClockMasterMode-FunctionalTimingExample ................................................................................................. 73  
Figure-59.T1/J1TransmitMultiplexedMode-FunctionalTimingExample1 ................................................................................................ 74  
Figure-60.T1/J1TransmitMultiplexedMode-FunctionalTimingExample2 ................................................................................................ 74  
Figure - 61. Transmit Bit Offset in T1/J1 Mode - 1 ............................................................................................................................................. 75  
Figure - 62. Transmit Bit Offset in T1/J1 Mode - 2 ............................................................................................................................................. 75  
Figure - 63. E1 Mode Jitter Tolerance (N1 = N2 = 2fH) ....................................................................................................................................... 82  
Figure - 64. E1 Mode Jitter Transfer (N1 = N2 = 2fH) ......................................................................................................................................... 82  
Figure - 65. T1/J1 Mode Jitter Tolerance (N1 = N2 = 2fH) .................................................................................................................................. 84  
Figure - 66. T1/J1 Mode Jitter Transfer (N1 = N2 = 2fH) .................................................................................................................................... 84  
Figure-67.TransmitClockSelect .................................................................................................................................................................... 85  
Figure-68.LineLoopback ................................................................................................................................................................................ 87  
Figure-69.DigitalLoopback ............................................................................................................................................................................ 88  
Figure-70.PayloadLoopback .......................................................................................................................................................................... 89  
Figure-71. InterruptServiceinE1ModeHDLCReceiver ................................................................................................................................ 96  
Figure-72. WritingDatatoE1ModeTHDLCFIFO ............................................................................................................................................ 97  
Figure-73. InterruptServiceinE1ModeHDLCTransmitter ............................................................................................................................ 98  
Figure-74. PollingModeinE1ModeHDLCTransmitter .................................................................................................................................. 99  
Figure-75.WritingSequenceofIndirectRegisterinE1Mode ...................................................................................................................... 104  
Figure-76. ReadingSequenceofIndirectRegisterinE1Mode .................................................................................................................... 104  
Figure-77.InterruptServiceinT1/J1ModeHDLCReceiver ........................................................................................................................... 111  
Figure-78. WritingDatatoT1/J1ModeTHDLCFIFO ......................................................................................................................................112  
9
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Figure-79.InterruptServiceinT1/J1ModeHDLCTransmitter ......................................................................................................................113  
Figure-80.PollingModeinT1/J1ModeHDLCTransmitter ............................................................................................................................114  
Figure-81.WritingSequenceofIndirectRegisterinT1/J1Mode ...................................................................................................................118  
Figure-82.ReadingSequenceofIndirectRegisterinT1/J1Mode .................................................................................................................118  
Figure-83.JTAGArchitecture ........................................................................................................................................................................ 259  
Figure-84. JTAGStateDiagram ..................................................................................................................................................................... 264  
Figure-85.ReadAccessTiming ..................................................................................................................................................................... 267  
Figure-86.WriteAccessTiming ..................................................................................................................................................................... 268  
Figure-87.TransmitInterfaceTiming(TransmitSystemCommonClock#B) ............................................................................................... 269  
Figure-88.TransmitInterfaceTiming(LineTransmitClock) ......................................................................................................................... 269  
Figure-89.ReceiveInterfaceTiming(ReceiveSystemCommonClock) ...................................................................................................... 270  
Figure-90.ReceiveInterfaceTiming(ReceiveSystemClock) ...................................................................................................................... 270  
Figure-91.ReceiveLineInterfaceTiming ..................................................................................................................................................... 271  
Figure-92.TransmitLineInterfaceTiming .................................................................................................................................................... 271  
10  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
LIST OF TABLES  
Table - 1. The Structure Of TS0 ......................................................................................................................................................................... 23  
Table - 2. Interrupt Sources In The E1 Frame Processor .................................................................................................................................. 25  
Table - 3. The Structure Of SF Format ............................................................................................................................................................... 26  
Table - 4. The Structure Of ESF Format ............................................................................................................................................................ 27  
Table - 5. Interrupt Sources In The T1 / J1 Frame Processor ............................................................................................................................ 27  
Table - 6. Basic Frame Alignment Pattern Error Counter .................................................................................................................................. 28  
Table - 7. Alarm Summary in ALMD ................................................................................................................................................................... 29  
Table - 8. A-Law Digital Milliwatt Pattern ........................................................................................................................................................... 34  
Table - 9. u-Law Digital Milliwatt Pattern ........................................................................................................................................................... 34  
Table - 10. E1 Mode Receive System Interface in Different Operation Modes .................................................................................................. 35  
Table - 11. Operation Mode Selection in E1 Receive Path ................................................................................................................................ 35  
Table - 12. Active Edge Selection of RSCCK (in E1 Receive Clock Slave RSCK Reference Mode) .................................................................. 36  
Table - 13. Active Edge Selection of RSCCK (in E1 Receive Clock Slave External Signaling Mode) ............................................................... 38  
Table - 14. Active Edge Selection of RSCK (in E1 Receive Clock Master Mode) .............................................................................................. 39  
Table - 15. Active Edge Selection of MRSCCK (in E1 Receive Multiplexed Mode) ........................................................................................... 41  
Table - 16. Offset in Different Operation Modes ................................................................................................................................................ 45  
Table - 17. Receive System Interface Bit Offset (FPMODE [b5, E1-011H] = 0) .................................................................................................. 45  
Table - 18. Receive System Interface Bit Offset (FPMODE [b5, E1-011H] = 1) .................................................................................................. 45  
Table - 19. Bit Offset Between RSFSn and RSDn When the BRXSMFP and the ALTIFP (b2, b0, E1-011H) are Both Set To Logical 1 ............. 45  
Table - 20. T1/J1 Mode Receive System Interface in Different Operation Modes ............................................................................................. 47  
Table - 21. Operation Mode Selection in T1/J1 Receive Path ........................................................................................................................... 47  
Table - 22. Active Edge Selection of RSCCK (in T1/J1 Receive Clock Slave RSCK Reference Mode) ............................................................. 48  
Table - 23. Active Edge Selection of RSCCK (in T1/J1 Receive Clock Slave External Signaling Mode) ........................................................... 50  
Table - 24. Active Edge Selection of MRSCCK (in T1/J1 Receive Multiplexed Mode) ....................................................................................... 52  
Table - 25. Receive System Interface Bit Offset ................................................................................................................................................ 55  
Table - 26. E1 Mode Transmit System Interface in Different Operation Modes ................................................................................................ 58  
Table - 27. Operation Mode Selection in E1 Transmit Path ............................................................................................................................... 58  
Table - 28. Active Edge Selection of TSCCKB (in E1 Transmit Clock Slave TSFS Enable Mode) ..................................................................... 60  
Table - 29. Active Edge Selection of TSCCKB (in E1 Transmit Clock Slave External Signaling Mode) ............................................................ 60  
Table - 30. Active Edge Selection of MTSCCKB (in E1 Transmit Multiplexed Mode) ........................................................................................ 63  
Table - 31. Transmit System Interface Bit Offset (CHI [b3, E1-01CH] = 1, CMS [b2, E1-018H] = 0) ................................................................... 65  
Table - 32. Transmit System Interface Bit Offset (CHI [b3, E1-01CH] = 1, CMS [b2, E1-018H] = 1) ................................................................... 65  
Table - 33. T1/J1 Mode Transmit System Interface in Different Operation Modes ............................................................................................ 68  
Table - 34. Operation Mode Selection in T1/J1 Transmit Path .......................................................................................................................... 68  
Table - 35. Active Edge Selection of TSCCKB (in T1/J1 Transmit Clock Slave TSFS Enable Mode) ................................................................ 69  
Table - 36. Remote Alarm Indication .................................................................................................................................................................. 77  
Table - 37. Content in International Bits (when the INDIS [b1, E1-040H] is logic 0) .......................................................................................... 78  
Table - 38. Interrupt Summary ........................................................................................................................................................................... 78  
11  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Table - 39. Default Setting in Receive Path ....................................................................................................................................................... 90  
Table - 40. Default Setting in Transmit Path ...................................................................................................................................................... 90  
Table - 41. Various Operation Modes in Receive Path for Reference ............................................................................................................... 91  
Table - 42. Various Operation Modes in Transmit Path for Reference .............................................................................................................. 93  
Table - 43. Example for Using HDLC Receiver .................................................................................................................................................. 95  
Table - 44. Example for Using HDLC Transmitter .............................................................................................................................................. 97  
Table - 45. Test Pattern .................................................................................................................................................................................... 100  
Table - 46. The Setting of PRGD ...................................................................................................................................................................... 101  
Table - 47. Initializtion of TPLC ........................................................................................................................................................................ 101  
Table - 48. Initializtion of RPLC ....................................................................................................................................................................... 103  
Table - 49. Error Insertion ................................................................................................................................................................................ 103  
Table - 50. Default Setting in Receive Path ..................................................................................................................................................... 105  
Table - 51. Default Setting in Transmit Path .................................................................................................................................................... 105  
Table - 52. Various Operation Modes in Receive Path for Reference ............................................................................................................. 106  
Table - 53. Various Operation Modes in Transmit Path for Reference ............................................................................................................ 108  
Table - 54 . Example for Using HDLC Receiver ................................................................................................................................................110  
Table - 55. Example for Using HDLC Transmitter .............................................................................................................................................112  
Table - 56. Test Pattern .....................................................................................................................................................................................115  
Table - 57. The Setting of PRGD .......................................................................................................................................................................116  
Table - 58. Initializtion of TPLC .........................................................................................................................................................................116  
Table - 59. Initializtion of RPLC ........................................................................................................................................................................117  
Table - 60. Error Insertion .................................................................................................................................................................................118  
Table - 61. T1/E1 Mode Selection Register .......................................................................................................................................................119  
Table - 62a. E1 Mode Register Map - Direct Register ...................................................................................................................................... 120  
Table - 62b. E1 Mode Register Map - Indirect Register ................................................................................................................................... 123  
Table - 63a. T1/J1 Mode Register Map - Direct Register .................................................................................................................................. 123  
Table - 63b. T1/J1 Mode Register Map - Indirect Register ............................................................................................................................... 125  
Table - 64. IR Code ........................................................................................................................................................................................... 260  
Table - 65. IDR .................................................................................................................................................................................................. 261  
Table - 66. Boundary Scan Sequence and the I/O Pad Cell Type .................................................................................................................... 261  
Table - 67. TAP Controller State Description ................................................................................................................................................... 263  
12  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
1
PIN ASSIGNMENTS  
1.1 128 PIN PQFP PACKAGE (TOP VIEW)  
LRD[1]  
LRCK[1]  
LRD[2]  
LRCK[2]  
LRD[3]  
LRCK[3]  
LRD[4]  
LRCK[4]  
LTD[1]  
LTCK[1]  
LTD[2]  
LTCK[2]  
LTD[3]  
LTCK[3]  
LTD[4]  
LTCK[4]  
BIAS  
VDDIO[0]  
GNDIO[0]  
VDDC[0]  
GNDC[0]  
LTD[5]  
LTCK[5]  
LTD[6]  
LTCK[6]  
LTD[7]  
LTCK[7]  
LTD[8]  
LTCK[8]  
GNDIO[3]  
LRD[5]  
LRCK[5]  
LRD[6]  
LRCK[6]  
LRD[7]  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
102  
101  
100  
99  
98  
97  
96  
95  
94  
93  
92  
91  
90  
89  
88  
87  
86  
85  
84  
83  
82  
81  
80  
79  
78  
77  
76  
75  
74  
73  
72  
71  
70  
69  
68  
67  
66  
65  
TSFS[6]/TSSIG[6]  
TSD[7]  
TSFS[7]/TSSIG[7]  
TSD[8]  
TSFS[8]/TSSIG[8]  
RSD[1]/MRSD[1]  
RSCK[1]/RSSIG[1]/MRSSIG[1]  
RSFS[1]/MRSFS[1]  
RSD[2]/MRSD[2]  
GNDC[3]  
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
25  
26  
27  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
36  
37  
38  
VDDC[3]  
RSCK[2]/RSSIG[2]/MRSSIG[2]  
RSFS[2]/MRSFS[2]  
RSD[3]  
RSCK[3]/RSSIG[3]  
RSFS[3]  
GNDC[2]  
VDDC[2]  
RSD[4]  
RSCK[4]/RSSIG[4]  
RSFS[4]  
RSD[5]  
RSCK[5]/RSSIG[5]  
RSFS[5]  
RSD[6]  
RSCK[6]/RSSIG[6]  
RSFS[6]  
GNDIO[2]  
VDDIO[2]  
RSD[7]  
RSCK[7]/RSSIG[7]  
RSFS[7]  
RSD[8]  
RSCK[8]/RSSIG[8]  
RSFS[8]  
RD  
WR  
LRCK[7]  
LRD[8]  
LRCK[8]  
CS  
13  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
1.2 144 PIN PBGA PACKAGE (BOTTOM VIEW)  
12  
11  
10  
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
TSFS[1]/  
TSSIG[1]/  
MTSSIG[1]  
TSFS[4]/  
TSSIG[4]  
RSCCK/  
MRSCCK  
TSD[7]  
TSD[6]  
GNDC[4]  
TSD[3]  
VDDC[3]  
TSCCKA  
TCK  
LRD[1]  
LRD[3]  
A
B
C
D
E
F
A
B
C
D
E
F
TSFS[2]/  
TSSIG[2]/  
MTSSIG[2]  
RSD[1]/  
MRSD[1]  
TSFS[6]/  
TSSIG[6]  
TSD[1]/  
MTSD[1]  
RSCFS/  
MRSCFS MTSCCKB  
TSCCKB/  
TSD[8]  
TSD[5]  
XCK  
TMS  
LRD[2]  
LRCK[3]  
LTD[1]  
LRD[4]  
LTCK[1]  
LTCK[2]  
LTD[4]  
RSCK[1]/  
RSSIG[1]/  
MRSSIG[1]  
RSD[2]/  
MRSD[2]  
TSFS[8]/  
TSSIG[8]  
TSFS[7]/  
TSSIG[7]  
TSFS[3]/  
TSSIG[3]  
TSCFS/  
TDO  
VDDC[4]  
GNDC[3]  
LRCK[1]  
LRCK[2]  
LTD[2]  
MTSCFS  
RSCK[2]/  
RSSIG[2]/  
MRSSIG[2]  
RSFS[2]/  
MRSFS[2]  
RSFS[1]/  
MRSFS[1] TSSIG[5]  
TSFS[5]/  
TSD[2]/  
MTSD[2]  
VDDIO[3]  
RSD[3]  
GNDC[2]  
RSD[6]  
TESTSE  
RSFS[8]  
WR  
TSD[4]  
TRST  
TDI  
RSCK[3]/  
RSSIG[3]  
RSFS[3]  
VDDC[2]  
GNDIO[3]  
RSD[5]  
VDDC[5]  
VDDC[9]  
GNDC[5]  
VDDC[6]  
VDDC[7]  
VDDC[8]  
LRCK[4]  
LTD[3]  
BIAS  
LTCK[4]  
RSD[4]  
RSFS[4]  
RSFS[5]  
RSFS[6]  
VDDIO[2]  
RSFS[7]  
VDDC[10] VDDC[11] VDDC[12]  
LTCK[3]  
LTD[5]  
GNDIO[0] VDDIO[0]  
RSCK[4]/  
RSSIG[4]  
RSCK[6]/  
RSSIG[6]  
GNDC[6]  
GNDC[7]  
GNDC[8]  
GNDC[0]  
LTCK[5]  
LTD[7]  
VDDC[0]  
LTD[6]  
G
H
J
G
H
J
RSCK[5]/  
RSSIG[5]  
RSCK[7]/  
RSSIG[7]  
GNDC[9] GNDC[10] GNDC[11] GNDC[12]  
LTCK[8]  
LRD[5]  
LRCK[7]  
D[0]  
LTCK[6]  
LTD[8]  
RSD[7]  
RSD[8]  
RD  
A[9]  
A[6]  
A[4]  
A[7]  
A[3]  
A[1]  
VDDIO[1]  
A[0]  
D[4]  
D[5]  
INT  
D[2]  
D[7]  
LTCK[7]  
GNDIO[1]  
LRD[6]  
LRCK[6]  
LRCK[8]  
LRCK[5]  
LRD[7]  
K
L
K
L
A[10]  
ALE  
VDDC[1]  
RSCK[8]/  
RSSIG[8]  
CS  
A[8]  
A[5]  
A[2]  
GNDC[1]  
GNDIO[2]  
D[6]  
D[3]  
D[1]  
RST  
LRD[8]  
M
M
12  
11  
10  
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
14  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
2
PIN DESCRIPTION  
Pin No.  
PQFP PBGA  
Name  
Type  
Description  
Line and System Interface  
LRD[1:8]: Line Receive Data for Framer 1 ~ 8  
These pins receive the data stream from line interface units or from a higher demultiplex  
interface. Data on these pins are sampled on the active edge of the corresponding  
LRCKn.  
LRD[1]  
LRD[2]  
LRD[3]  
LRD[4]  
LRD[5]  
LRD[6]  
LRD[7]  
LRD[8]  
LRCK[1]  
LRCK[2]  
LRCK[3]  
LRCK[4]  
LRCK[5]  
LRCK[6]  
LRCK[7]  
LRCK[8]  
Input  
1
3
5
A2  
B2  
A1  
B1  
J4  
7
31  
33  
35  
37  
2
4
6
8
32  
34  
36  
38  
96  
L1  
L2  
M1  
C3  
D3  
C2  
E4  
K2  
K3  
K4  
L3  
Input  
LRCK[1:8]: Line Receive Clock for Framer 1 ~ 8  
These pins receive externally recovered line clock (2.048 or 1.544 MHz). The clock is  
used to sample the data on the corresponding LRDn.  
RSCK[1]/RSSIG[1]/  
MRSSIG[1]  
RSCK[2]/RSSIG[2]/  
MRSSIG[2]  
RSCK[3]/RSSIG[3]  
RSCK[4]/RSSIG[4]  
RSCK[5]/RSSIG[5]  
RSCK[6]/RSSIG[6]  
RSCK[7]/RSSIG[7]  
RSCK[8]/RSSIG[8]  
Output  
C11  
RSCK[1:8]: Receive Side System Clock for Framer 1 ~ 8  
In Receive Clock Master Full E1 or T1/J1 mode, the clock is a smoothed version of the  
corresponding 2.048 or 1.544 MHz Line Receive Clock (LRCK). The RSCKn is pulsed for  
each bit in the 256-bit or 193-bit frame. The corresponding RSFSn and RSDn pins are  
updated on the active edge of the RSCKn.  
In Receive Clock Master Nx64K mode, the clock is a gapped version of the associated  
smoothed LRCKn. The pulse number of the RSCKn in each frame is controllable from 0 to  
255 or from 0 to 192 on a per-timeslot/channel basis. The corresponding RSFSn and  
RSDn pins are updated on the active edge of the RSCKn.  
91  
D12  
88  
83  
80  
77  
72  
69  
E12  
G11  
H11  
G9  
H9  
M12  
In Receive Clock Slave RSCK Reference mode, the RSCKn can be selected to be either  
a 2.048/1.544 MHz jitter attenuated version of the corresponding LRCKn or an 8KHz clock  
divided down from the smoothed line clock LRCKn.  
RSSIG[1:8]: Receive Side System Signaling for Framer 1 ~ 8  
In Receive Clock Slave External Signaling mode, the extracted signaling is output on  
these pins. The signal on these pins is timeslot/channel-aligned with the data output on  
the corresponding RSDn pin and is updated on the active edge of the RSCCK. The  
extracted signaling is located in the lower nibble (b5 ~ b8). In E1 mode, the extracted  
signaling repeats during the entire Signaling Multi-Frame for the same timeslot. In T1/J1  
mode, the extracted signaling repeats during the entire SF/ESF for the same channel.  
MRSSIG[1:2]: Multiplexed Receive Side System Signaling  
When the multiplexed bus structure is configured, the extracted signaling data from the  
selected framers are multiplexed on these pins using a byte-interleaved multiplexing  
scheme. The data on the MRSSIG[1:2] are updated on the active edge of the MRSCCK.  
RSD[1:8]: Receive Side System Data for Framer 1 ~ 8  
The processed data stream is output on these pins.  
In Receive Clock Master mode, the RSDn is updated on the active edge of the  
corresponding RSCKn.  
RSD[1]/MRSD[1]  
RSD[2]/MRSD[2]  
RSD[3]  
Output  
97  
94  
89  
84  
81  
78  
73  
70  
B12  
C12  
E10  
F12  
F9  
G10  
J11  
K11  
RSD[4]  
RSD[5]  
RSD[6]  
RSD[7]  
In Receive Clock Slave mode, the RSDn is updated on the active edge of the RSCCK.  
MRSD[1:2]: Multiplexed Receive Side System Data  
RSD[8]  
When the multiplexed bus structure is configured, the processed data stream from the  
selected framers is multiplexed on these pins using the byte-interleaved multiplexing  
scheme. The data on the MRSD[1:2] are updated on the active edge of the MRSCCK.  
15  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
PIN DESCRIPTION (CONTINUED)  
Pin No.  
PQFP PBGA  
Name  
Type  
Description  
RSFS[1]/MRSFS[1] Output  
RSFS[2]/MRSFS[2]  
RSFS[3]  
95  
90  
87  
82  
79  
76  
71  
68  
D9  
D11  
E11  
G12  
H12  
J12  
RSFS[1:8]: Receive Side System Frame Pulse for Framer 1 ~ 8  
In E1 mode, RSFSn can be configured to indicate the beginning of Basic Frame, or  
CRC Multi-Frame or/and Signaling Multi-Frame for data stream on RSDn. When  
configured for the Basic Frame, RSFSn will pulse high/low during the first bit of each  
Basic Frame. When configured for CRC Multi-Frame, RSFSn will pulse during the first  
bit of the first frame of the CRC Multi-Frame. When configured for the Signaling Multi-  
Frame, RSFSn will pulse during the first bit of the first frame of the Signaling Multi-  
Frame. When configured to indicate both Signaling and CRC Multi-Frame, RSFSn will  
go high/low on the first bit of the first frame of the Signaling Multi-Frame and go the  
opposite after the first bit of the first frame of the CRC Multi-Frame.  
RSFS[4]  
RSFS[5]  
RSFS[6]  
RSFS[7]  
L12  
J10  
RSFS[8]  
In T1/J1 mode, RSFSn can be configured to indicate each F-bit, or the first F-bit of  
every 12-frame SF / every 24-frame ESF. RSFSn pulses during the above F-bit.  
In both E1 and T1/J1 mode, when Receive Clock Master mode is active, the RSFSn is  
updated on the active edge of the corresponding RSCKn. When Receive Clock Slave  
mode is active, the RSFSn is updated on the active edge of the RSCCK.  
MRSFS[1:2]: Multiplexed Receive Side System Frame Pulse  
When the multiplexed bus structure is configured, the signals on these pins indicate the  
beginning of a multiplexed frame. The MRSFS[1:2] are updated on the active edge of  
the MRSCCK.  
RSCCK/MRSCCK  
Input  
120  
A5  
RSCCK: Receive Side System Common Clock  
RSCCK is used only in Receive Clock Slave mode. In E1 mode, it is a 2.048 or 4.096  
MHz clock. In T1 mode, it is a 1.544 or 2.048 or 4.096 MHz clock. In Receive Clock  
Slave RSCK Reference mode, the RSDn and the RSFSn are updated and the RSCFS  
is sampled on the active edge of the RSCCK. In Receive Clock Slave External  
Signaling mode, the RSDn, the RSFSn and the RSSIGn are updated and the RSCFS is  
sampled on the active edge of the RSCCK.  
MRSCCK: Multiplexed Receive Side System Common Clock  
When the multiplexed bus structure is configured, MRSCCK is an 8.192 or 16.384 MHz  
clock for the receive system multiplexed bus. The MRSCFS is sampled and the  
MRSD[1:2], the MRSFS[1:2] and the MRSSIG[1:2] are updated on the active edge of  
the MRSCCK.  
RSCFS/MRSCFS  
Input  
119  
B5  
RSCFS: Receive Side System Common Frame Pulse  
In Receive Clock Slave mode, RSCFS can be selected as a frame alignment reference.  
It is asserted on the request of each Basic Frame or each Multi-Frame in E1 mode, or it  
is asserted on the request of F-bit in T1/J1 mode. The RSCFS is sampled on the active  
edge of the RSCCK.  
MRSCFS: Multiplexed Receive Side System Common Frame Pulse  
When the multiplexed bus structure is configured, the signal on this pin aligns the  
multiplexed frame to the backplane timing. The MRSCFS is sampled on the active  
edge of the MRSCCK.  
16  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
PIN DESCRIPTION (CONTINUED)  
Pin No.  
Name  
Type  
Description  
PQFP PBGA  
TSD[1]/MTSD[1]  
TSD[2]/MTSD[2]  
TSD[3]  
Input  
115  
113  
111  
109  
105  
103  
101  
99  
B7  
D6  
A8  
D7  
B9  
A11  
A12  
B11  
TSD[1:8]: Transmit Side System Data for Framer 1 ~ 8  
The data streams from the system backplane are input on these pins.  
In Transmit Clock Master mode, the TSDn is sampled on the active edge of the  
corresponding LTCKn.  
TSD[4]  
TSD[5]  
TSD[6]  
TSD[7]  
In Transmit Clock Slave mode, the TSDn is sampled on the active edge of the TSCCKB.  
MTSD[1:2]: Multiplexed Transmit Side System Data  
TSD[8]  
When the multiplexed bus structure is configured, the data stream from the backplane is  
carried on the multiplexed bus for the selected framers. The MTSD[1:2] are sampled on  
the active edge of the MTSCCKB.  
TSFS[1]/TSSIG[1]/  
MTSSIG[1]  
TSFS[2]/TSSIG[2]/  
MTSSIG[2]  
Output  
/Input  
114  
112  
A7  
B8  
TSFS[1:8]: Transmit Side System Frame Pulse for Framer 1 ~ 8  
In Transmit Clock Master mode, the TSFSn indicates the beginning of each Basic Frame  
in E1 mode, or indicates the F-bit of SF/ESF in T1/J1 mode. The TSFSn is updated on the  
active edge of the corresponding LTCKn.  
TSFS[3]/TSSIG[3]  
TSFS[4]/TSSIG[4]  
TSFS[5]/TSSIG[5]  
TSFS[6]/TSSIG[6]  
TSFS[7]/TSSIG[7]  
TSFS[8]/TSSIG[8]  
110  
106  
104  
102  
100  
98  
C7  
A10  
D8  
B10  
C9  
In Transmit Clock Slave TSFS Enabled mode, the TSFSn indicates the beginning of each  
Basic Frame in E1 mode, or indicates the F-bit of SF/ESF in T1/J1 mode. The TSFSn is  
updated on the active edge of the TSCCKB.  
TSSIG[1:8]: Transmit Side System Signaling for Framer 1 ~ 8  
C10  
In Transmit Clock Slave External Signaling mode, these are the TSSIG inputs. The  
signaling is located in the lower nibble (b5 ~ b8) and sampled on the active edge of the  
TSCCKB. In E1 mode, the signaling repeats during the entire Signaling Multi-Frame for the  
same timeslot. In T1/J1 mode, the signaling repeats during the entire SF/ESF for the same  
channel.  
MTSSIG[1:2]: Multiplexed Transmit Side System Signaling  
When the multiplexed bus structure is configured, the signaling on the bus is organized in  
a byte-interleaved scheme for the selected framers. The MTSSIG[1:2] are sampled on the  
active edge of the MTSCCKB.  
TSCCKA  
Input  
Input  
123  
122  
A4  
B4  
TSCCKA: Transmit Side System Common Clock A  
TSCCKA is one of the reference clocks for the transmit jitter attenuator DPLL. TSCCKA  
can be configured to input the clock as:  
1. 16.384MHz clock;  
2. Line rate: 2.048MHz (for E1) or 1.544MHz (for T1);  
3. Nx8KHz (N is from 1 to 256) so long as TSCCKA is a jitter-free clock.  
The IDT82V2108 can be configured to ignore the TSCCKA and utilize LRCK and TSCCKB  
instead. The TSCCKA is replaced by LRCK if line loopback is enabled.  
TSCCKB: Transmit Side System Common Clock B  
TSCCKB/  
MTSCCKB  
In E1 mode, the TSCCKB is a 2.048 or 4.096 MHz clock. In T1/J1 mode, the TSCCKB is a  
1.544 or 2.048 or 4.096 MHz clock.  
In Transmit Clock Slave TSFS mode, the TSDn and TSCFS are sampled and the TSFSn  
is updated on the active edge of the TSCCKB. In Transmit Clock Slave External Signaling  
mode, the TSDn, TSSIGn and TSCFS are sampled on the active edge of the TSCCKB.  
MTSCCKB: Multiplexed Transmit Side System Common Clock B  
When the multiplexed bus structure is configured, MTSCCKB is an 8.192 or 16.384 MHz  
reference clock for the transmit system multiplexed bus. The MTSCFS, the MTSD[1:2] and  
the MTSSIG[1:2] are sampled on the active edge of the MTSCCKB.  
17  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
PIN DESCRIPTION (CONTINUED)  
Pin No.  
PQFP PBGA  
Name  
Type  
Description  
TSCFS/  
Input  
121  
C5  
TSCFS: Transmit Side System Common Frame Pulse  
MTSCFS  
In Transmit Clock Slave mode, TSCFS is used to frame align all the framers to the system  
backplane. In E1 mode, the pulse can be configured to indicate the first bit of a Basic Frame,  
CRC Multi-Frame / Signaling Multi-Frame. In T1/J1 mode, the pulse can be configured to  
indicate the first bit of SF/ESF. The width of the pulse must be at least 1 TSCCKB cycle wide.  
The TSCFS is sampled on the active edge of the TSCCKB.  
MTSCFS: Multiplexed Transmit Side System Common Frame Pulse  
When the multiplexed bus structure is configured, MTSCFS is used to frame align the  
multiplexed frames to the system backplane. The MTSCFS is sampled on the active edge of  
the MTSCCKB.  
LTD[1]  
LTD[2]  
LTD[3]  
LTD[4]  
LTD[5]  
LTD[6]  
LTD[7]  
LTD[8]  
LTCK[1]  
LTCK[2]  
LTCK[3]  
LTCK[4]  
LTCK[5]  
LTCK[6]  
LTCK[7]  
LTCK[8]  
XCK  
Output  
Output  
Input  
9
11  
13  
15  
22  
24  
26  
28  
10  
12  
14  
16  
23  
25  
27  
29  
117  
D2  
E3  
F4  
E1  
G3  
H1  
J2  
LTD[1:8]: Line Transmit Data for Framer 1 ~ 8  
These pins output the data stream to line interface units or a higher multiplex interface.  
The data on the LTDn is updated on the active edge of the corresponding LTCKn.  
J3  
C1  
D1  
F3  
E2  
H2  
H3  
J1  
LTCKn: Line Transmit Clock for Framer 1 ~ 8  
It is a nominal E1 (2.048MHz) or T1/J1 (1.544MHz) clock. The LTCK can be derived from  
TSCCKA, TSCCKB, LRCK or XCK. On the active edge of the LTCKn, the corresponding LTDn  
is updated.  
H4  
B6  
XCK: Crystal Clock  
The clock frequency equals 49.152MHz + 50 ppm 50% duty cycle for E1 and 37.056MHz + 32  
ppm 50% duty cycle for T1/J1.  
Microprocessor Interface  
Input  
Input  
39  
65  
M2  
RST  
RST  
CS  
: Reset (Active Low)  
RST  
A low signal for at least 100ns on this pin can reset the device anytime. The  
trigger input with weak pull-up.  
is a Schmitt-  
M11  
CS  
: Chip Select (Active Low)  
This pin must be asserted low to enable the microprocessor interface. The signal must be  
asserted high at least once after power up to clear the internal test modes. A transition from  
high to low must occur on this pin for each Read/Write operation and cannot return to high until  
the operation is over.  
Output  
Input  
40  
J5  
INT  
: Open-Drain Interrupt Signal (Active Low)  
This pin will keep low until all the active unmasked interrupt are acknowledged at their sources.  
A[10:0]: Address Bus  
The signals on these pins select the register for the microprocessor to access.  
INT  
A[0]  
A[1]  
A[2]  
A[3]  
A[4]  
A[5]  
A[6]  
A[7]  
A[8]  
A[9]  
A[10]  
54  
55  
56  
57  
58  
59  
60  
61  
62  
63  
64  
K7  
L8  
M8  
K8  
L9  
M9  
K9  
J8  
M10  
J9  
L10  
18  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
PIN DESCRIPTION (CONTINUED)  
Pin No.  
Name  
Type  
Description  
PQFP  
PBGA  
D[0]  
D[1]  
D[2]  
D[3]  
D[4]  
D[5]  
D[6]  
D[7]  
I/O  
41  
42  
43  
44  
45  
46  
47  
48  
L4  
M3  
K5  
M4  
J6  
K6  
D[7:0]: Bi-directional Data Bus  
Signals on these pins are the data for Read/Write operation.  
M5  
L5  
Input  
Input  
Input  
67  
L11  
RD  
RD  
WR  
ALE  
: Read Strobe (Active Low)  
A low signal on this pin enables a read operation on the selected register.  
WR  
66  
53  
K10  
L7  
: Write Strobe (Active Low)  
A low signal on this pin enables a write operation on the selected register.  
ALE: Address Latch Enable  
In non-multiplexed address/data bus, the ALE is connected to High.  
It is internally pulled-up.  
JTAG Signals (per IEEE 1149.1)  
TRST  
Input  
125  
D5  
: Test Reset (Active Low)  
A low signal on this pin will reset the JTAG test port anytime. This pin is a Schmitt-triggered  
TRST  
RST  
input with an internal pull-up resistor. It must be connected to the  
JTAG is not used.  
pin or ground when  
TMS  
TCK  
Input  
Input  
128  
126  
B3  
A3  
TMS: Test Mode Select  
The signal on this pin controls the JTAG test performance and is clocked into the device on  
the rising edge of the TCK. This pin has an internal pull-up resistor.  
TCK: Test Clock  
The clock for the JTAG test is input on this pin. The TDI and the TMS are clocked into the  
device on the rising edge of the TCK and the TDO is clocked out of the device on the falling  
edge of the TCK.  
TDI  
Input  
127  
124  
D4  
C4  
TDI: Test Input  
The test data are input on this pin. It is sampled on the rising edge of the TCK. This pin has an  
internal pull-up resistor.  
TDO: Test Output  
TDO  
Tri-State  
The test data are output on this pin. It is sampled on the falling edge of the TCK. This pin is in  
tri-state mode, except during the process of scanning of the data.  
Supplies and Grounds  
BIAS  
Power  
Power  
17  
G4  
BIAS: +5V Bias  
This pin enables +5V tolerance on the inputs. When +5V tolerance inputs are required, the  
BIAS must be connected to a well-decoupled +5V rail. When +3V input is required, the BIAS  
must be connected to a well-decoupled +3.3V DC supply.  
During power up, the power should be applied to the BIAS pin before any of VDDC/VDDIO  
pins is powered.  
VDDIO[0]  
VDDIO[1]  
VDDIO[2]  
VDDIO[3]  
18  
49  
74  
F1  
J7  
K12  
D10  
VDDIO[3:0]:  
These pins must be connected to a common, well-decoupled +3.3V DC supply together with  
the core power pins VDDC[4:0] externally.  
107  
19  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
PIN DESCRIPTION (CONTINUED)  
Pin No.  
Name  
Type  
Description  
PQFP  
20  
51  
PBGA  
G1  
L6  
VDDC[0]  
VDDC[1]  
VDDC[2]  
VDDC[3]  
VDDC[4]  
VDDC[5:12]  
Power  
VDDC[4:0]:  
These pins must be connected to a common, well-decoupled +3.3V DC supply together with  
85  
92  
116  
-
F11  
A6  
C8  
the pad ring power pins VDDIO[3:0] externally.  
The VDDC[5:12] are extra power pins for PBGA.  
E8,  
E7,  
E6,  
E5,  
F8,  
F7,  
F6,  
F5  
GNDIO[0]  
GNDIO[1]  
GNDIO[2]  
GNDIO[3]  
GNDC[0]  
GNDC[1]  
GNDC[2]  
GNDC[3]  
GNDC[4]  
GNDC[5:12]  
Ground  
Ground  
19  
50  
75  
30  
21  
52  
86  
93  
118  
-
F2  
K1  
GNDIO[3:0]:  
These pins must be connected to a common ground together with the core ground pins  
GNDC[4:0].  
M6  
E9  
G2  
M7  
F10  
C6  
GNDC[4:0]:  
These pins must be connected to a common ground together with the pad ring ground pins  
GNDIO[3:0].  
The GNDC[5:12] are extra ground pins for PBGA.  
A9  
G8,  
G7,  
G6,  
G5,  
H8,  
H7,  
H6,  
H5  
TESTSE  
Input  
108  
H10  
This pin is connected to ground for normal operation and reserved for testing.  
Notes:  
1. All outputs have 4mA drive capability except for the D[7:0], the LTCK[1:8] and the RSCK[1:8] pins which have 6mA drive capability.  
2. All input and bi-directional pins present minimum capacitive loading.  
20  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
condition has persisted for at least 100 ms, an AIS Alarm is declared.  
The Frame Processor can also declare a Red Alarm if the out-of-frame  
condition has persisted for at least 100 ms.  
An interrupt output is provided to indicate status changes and the  
occurrence of some events. The interrupts may be generated every  
Basic Frame, CRC Sub Multi-Frame, CRC Multi-Frame or Signaling  
Multi-Frame.  
3
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION  
3.1 T1 / E1 / J1 MODE SELECTION  
The IDT82V2108 can be configured as a duplex eight ports E1  
framer, or a duplex eight ports T1 framer, or a duplex eight ports J1  
framer. When the TMODE (b0, 400H)* is set to 0, the device is in E1  
mode. When the TMODE (b0, 400H) is set to 1, the device is in T1/J1  
mode (default mode). In T1/J1 mode, when the JYEL (b3, T1/J1-020H)  
and the J1_YEL (b5, T1/J1-02CH) are both set to 0, the receive path of  
the corresponding framer is in T1 mode; when the JYEL (b3, T1/J1-  
020H) and the J1_YEL (b5, T1/J1-02CH) are both set to 1, the receive  
path of the corresponding framer is in J1 mode; when the J1_CRC (b6,  
T1/J1-044H) and the J1_YEL (b5, T1/J1-044H) are both set to 0, the  
transmit path of the corresponding framer is in T1 mode; when the  
J1_CRC (b6, T1/J1-044H) and the J1_YEL (b5, T1/J1-044H) are both  
set to 1, the transmit path of the corresponding framer is in J1 mode.  
The Frame Processor can also be bypassed to receive unframed  
data.  
Basic Frame  
The algorithm of searching for the E1 Basic Frame alignment pattern  
(as shown in Figure - 2) meets the ITU-T Recommendation G.706 4.1.2  
and 4.2.  
Generally, it is performed by detecting a successive FAS/NFAS/FAS  
sequence. If STEP 2 is not met, a new search will start after the follow-  
ing frame is skipped. If STEP 3 is not met, a new search will start imme-  
diately in the next frame. Once the Basic Frame alignment pattern is de-  
tected in the received PCM data stream, the Basic Frame synchroniza-  
tion is found and the OOFV (b6, E1-036H) will be set to logic 0 for indi-  
cation. Then, this block goes on monitoring the received data stream. If  
the received Basic Frame alignment signal does not meet its pattern, it  
will be indicated by setting the FERI (b2, E1-034H). The criteria of out of  
Basic Frame synchronization are selected by the BIT2C (b6, E1-031H).  
If one of the conditions that set in the BIT2C (b6, E1-031H) is met, the  
search process will restart when the REFRDIS (b0, E1-030H) is 0. Ex-  
cessive CRC errors will also lead to re-searching for the Basic Frame  
(refer to “CRC Multi-Frame” for details).  
3.2 FRAME PROCESSOR (FRMP)  
The Frame Processor of each framer operates independently.  
3.2.1  
E1 MODE  
In E1 mode, the Frame Processor searches for Basic Frame  
synchronization, CRC Multi-frame synchronization, and Channel  
Associated Signaling (CAS) Multi-frame synchronization in the received  
data stream. Figure - 1 shows the searching process.  
Once the frame is synchronized, the Frame Processor keeps on  
monitoring the received data stream. If there are any framing bit errors,  
CAS Multi-Frame alignment pattern errors, CRC Multi-Frame alignment  
pattern errors or CRC errors, the Frame Processor will indicate these  
errors. The status of loss of frame, loss of Signaling Multi-Frame and  
loss of CRC Multi-Frame can also be detected and declared based on  
user-selectable criteria. The reframe operation can be initiated by  
excessive CRC errors, or the CRC Multi-Frame alignment is not found  
within 400ms. A software reset can also make the Frame Processor  
reframe.  
However, the Basic Frame synchronization can also be forced to re-  
search for a new Basic Frame any time when there is a transition from 0  
to 1 on the REFR (b2, E1-030H).  
CRC Multi-Frame  
The CRC Multi-Frame is provided to enhance the ability of verifying  
the data stream. The structure of TS0 of CRC Multi-Frame is illustrated  
in Table - 1:  
The Frame Processor can extract the data stream in TS16, and  
output the extracted data on a separate pin. The Frame Processor also  
extracts the contents of the International bits (from both the FAS and the  
NFAS frames), the National bits and the Extra bits (from TS16 in the  
frame 0 of the Signaling Multi-Frame), and stores these data in registers.  
The CRC Sub Multi-Frame alignment 4 bit codeword in the National bit  
positions Sa4 to Sa8 can also be extracted and stored in registers, and  
updated every CRC Sub Multi-Frame.  
The Framer Processor identifies the Remote Alarm bit (bit 3 of TS0 of  
NFAS frames) and Remote Signaling Multi-Frame Alarm (bit 6 of TS16  
of the frame 0 of the Signaling Multi-Frame). The “de-bounced” Remote  
Alarm and Remote Signaling Multi-Frame Alarm can be indicated if the  
corresponding bit has been a certain logic for consecutive 2 or 3 times.  
The AIS (Alarm Indication Signal) can also be detected, and if the AIS  
A CRC Multi-Frame consists of 16 continuous Basic Frames (No. 0 –  
15) which are numbered from a Basic Frame with FAS. Each CRC Multi-  
Frame can be divided into two Sub Multi-Frames (SMF I & SMF II).  
The first bit of TS0 of each frame is called International (Si) bit. The  
Si bit in each even frame is the CRC bit. Thus, there are C1, C2, C3, C4  
in each SMF. The C1 is the most significant bit, while the C4 is the least  
significant bit. The Si bit in the first six odd frames is the CRC Multi-  
Frame alignment pattern. Its pattern is ‘001011’. The Si bit in the Frame  
13 and the Frame 15 are E1 and E2 bits. The E bits’ value can indicate  
the Far End Block Errors (FEBE).  
After the Basic Frame has been synchronized, the Frame Processor  
initiates an 8 and 400ms timer to check the CRC Multi-Frame alignment  
signal if the CRCEN (b7, E1-030H) is 1. The CRC Multi-Frame synchro-  
nization is declared with a logic 0 in the OOCMFV (b4, E1-036H) only if  
at least two CRC Multi-Frame alignment patterns are found within 8ms,  
with the interval time of each pattern being a multiple of 2ms. Then if the  
received CRC Multi-Frame alignment signal does not meet its pattern, it  
will be indicated by the CMFERI (b0, E1-034H). The Frame Processor  
calculates the data in the SMF(N) per the algorithm in the G.704 and the  
G.706 to get a four-bit remainder, then compares the four-bit remainder  
with the C1, C2, C3, C4 in the next SMF. If there is a difference between  
Note:  
* The contents in the brackets indicate the position of this bit and the address of  
the register. If more than one register contains the same bit, the address is only  
for the first register, the addresses of the remaining registers are listed together  
with the first register in the Register Description paragraph.  
21  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Out of sync.  
OOFV=1,OOCMFV=1,  
OOSMFV=1,  
OOOFV=0,RAI=1,Ei=0  
search for Basic Fframe alignment patten  
(refer to Basic Frame)  
find FAS in  
th  
N frame  
No (N=N+1)  
Yes  
3 consecutive FAS or NFAS  
errors (criteria selected by the  
BIT2C) or manually re-frame  
find NFAS in  
(N+1)th frame  
No (skip one  
frame, N=N+3)  
Yes  
find FAS in  
th  
(N+2) frame  
Yes  
No (N=N+3)  
Basic Frame sync. acquired  
OOFV=0, RAI=0, Ei=0  
Start to check FAS errors  
> 914  
CRC  
errors in  
one  
search for CRC Multi-Frame  
alignment pattern if CRCEN =  
1 (refer to CRC Multi-Frame)  
search for Signaling Multi-Frame  
alignment if CASDIS = 1 (refer to  
Signaling Multi-Frame)  
second  
Start 8ms and  
400ms timer  
find Signaling  
Multi-Frame alignment  
pattern  
No  
Yes  
find 2 CRC Multi-Frame  
alignment patterns within 8ms, with the  
interval time of each pattern being a  
multiple of 2ms  
Signaling  
Multi-Frame sync.  
acquired  
Lock the Sync. Position  
Start Offline Frame  
search OOOFV=1  
No, and  
8ms  
expired  
Yes  
find FAS in  
th  
check for out  
of Signaling Multi-Frame  
Sync conditions which criteria  
are set in the SMFASC  
& TS16C  
n frame  
No (n = n+1)  
CRC Multi-Frame sync.  
acquired; Start CRC and  
E-bits processing;  
Yes  
find NFAS in  
th  
(n+1) frame  
No (skip one  
OOCMFV=0, OOFV=0 CRC  
to CRC interworking  
frame, n=n+3)  
Yes  
Yes  
No  
find FAS in  
th  
(n+2) frame  
No (n=n+3)  
Yes  
Basic Frame sync. acquired  
OOOFV=0  
Start 8ms timer  
No, and  
8ms  
expired  
No, and 400ms  
expired with  
basic frame sync.  
C2NCIWV=1  
CRC to non-CRC  
interworking  
find 2 CRC Multi-Frame  
alignment patterns within 8ms, with the  
interval time of each pattern being a  
multiple of 2ms  
Stop CRC processing  
E-bits set to logic 0  
Yes  
Figure - 1. E1 Frame Searching Process  
22  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
them, bit errors exist in SMF(N) and a CRC error is counted. The  
CRCERR[9:0] (b7~0, E1-039H & b1~0, E1-03AH) are used to indicate  
the CRC error numbers and are updated every second. Once the  
CRCERR[9:0] (b7~0, E1-039H & b1~0, E1-03AH) are updated, a logic 1  
will be set in the NEWDATA (b6, E1-03AH) for indication. If the  
CRCERR[9:0] are over-written, the OVR (b7, E1-03AH) will be asserted.  
When more than 914 CRC errors occur in one second which is indicated  
in the EXCRCERR (b0, E1-031H, a new search for the Basic Frame  
alignment pattern will start if the REFCRCE (b1, E1-030H) is set to 1  
and the REFRDIS (b0, E1-030H) is set to 0.  
If the 2 CRC Multi-Frame alignment patterns can not be found within  
8ms with the interval time being a multiple of 2ms, an offline search for  
the Basic Frame alignment pattern will start which is indicated in the  
OOOFV (b3, E1-036H). The process is the same as shown in Figure - 2.  
This offline operation searches in parallel with the pre-found Basic  
Frame synchronization searching process. After the new Basic Frame  
synchronization is found by this offline search, the 8ms timer is restarted  
to check whether the two CRC Multi-Frame alignment patterns are found  
within 8ms, with the interval time of each pattern being a multiple of 2ms  
again. If the condition can not be met, the procedure will go on until the  
400ms timer ends. If the condition still can not be met at that time and  
the Basic Frame is still synchronized, the device declares by the  
C2NCIWV (b7, E1-036) to run under the CRC to non-CRC interworking  
process. In this process, the CRC Multi-Frame alignment pattern can still  
be searched if the C2NCIWCK (b5, E1-030H) is logic 1.  
STEP1: Search  
for 7-bit Frame Alignment  
Sequence (FAS) (X0011011)  
in the Nth frame  
No (N=N+1)  
No (skip  
one frame,  
N=N+3)  
Yes  
STEP 2: Find logic 1 in the  
th  
2nd bit of TS0 of the (N+1) frame to ensure  
that this is a non-frame alignment  
sequence (NFAS)  
Yes  
No  
(N=N+3)  
STEP 3: Search for  
the correct 7-bit FAS (X0011011)  
th  
in the TS0 in the (N+2)  
frame  
Yes  
Basic Frame  
Synchronization Found  
CAS Signaling Multi-Frame  
If the CRCEN (E1-030H) is logic 1, after the CRC Multi-Frame has  
been found, the Frame Processor starts to search for Signaling Multi-  
Frame alignment pattern when the CASDIS (E1-030H) is logic 0. If the  
CRCEN is logic 0, after the Basic Frame has been found, the Frame  
Processor starts to search for Signaling Multi-Frame alignment signal  
when the CASDIS (E1-030H) is logic 0. Refer to Figure - 1.  
Figure - 2. Basic Frame Searching Process  
The Signaling Multi-Frame alignment pattern is located in the 1 – 4  
bits of TS16 of Frame 0 of Signaling Multi-Frame. The pattern is ‘0000’.  
Once the pattern is detected, the Signaling Multi-Frame synchronization  
is acquired which is indicated with a logic 0 in the OOSMFV (b5, E1-  
Table - 1. The Structure Of TS0  
Basic Frame  
No. / Type  
0 /FAS  
1 / NFAS  
2 / FAS  
3 / NFAS  
4 / FAS  
5 / NFAS  
6 / FAS  
the Eight Bits in Timeslot 0  
SMF  
1 (Si bit)  
C1  
0
C2  
0
C3  
1
C4  
0
C1  
1
C2  
1
C3  
E1  
C4  
E2  
2
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
3
0
A
0
A
0
A
0
A
0
A
0
A
0
A
0
A
4
1
5
1
6
0
Sa6  
0
Sa6  
0
Sa6  
0
Sa6  
0
Sa6  
0
Sa6  
0
Sa6  
0
7
1
Sa7  
1
Sa7  
1
Sa7  
1
Sa7  
1
Sa7  
1
Sa7  
1
Sa7  
1
8
1
Sa8  
1
Sa8  
1
Sa8  
1
Sa8  
1
Sa8  
1
Sa8  
1
Sa8  
1
Sa4  
1
Sa5  
1
Sa4  
1
Sa5  
1
SMF I  
Sa4  
1
Sa5  
1
CRC-4  
Multi-Frame  
7 / NFAS  
8 / FAS  
Sa4  
1
Sa5  
1
9 / NFAS  
10 / FAS  
11 / NFAS  
12 / FAS  
13 / NFAS  
14 / FAS  
15 / NFAS  
Sa4  
1
Sa5  
1
Sa4  
1
Sa5  
1
SMF II  
Sa4  
1
Sa5  
1
Sa4  
Sa5  
Sa6  
Sa7  
Sa8  
23  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
036H). If the received Signaling Multi-Frame alignment signal does not  
meet its pattern, the SMFERI (b1, E1-034H) is set to logic 1. The entire  
content in TS16 of Frame 0 of Signaling Multi-Frame is ‘0000XYXX’. Y is  
for remote Signaling Multi-Frame alarm indication and X are extra bits.  
A new search of Signaling Multi-Frame alignment pattern is initiated  
when the out of the Signaling Multi-Frame criteria set in the SMFASC  
(b5, E1-031H) and the TS16C (b4, E1-031H) is met or when it is out of  
Basic Frame synchronization.  
Bits Extraction  
The Frame Processor extracts the National Bit codeword (Sa4[1:4] to  
Sa8[1:4] in the CRC Sub Multi-frame), the International bit (Si), the Na-  
tional bit (Sa), the Remote Alarm Indication bit (A), the Extra bits (X) and  
the Remote Signaling Multi-Frame Alarm Indication bit (Y).  
- National Bit Codeword  
The Frame Processor extracts one of the National Bit codeword  
(Sa4[1:4] to Sa8[1:4] in the CRC Sub Multi-frame) to the SaX[1:4] (b3~0,  
E1-03DH). Here the ‘X’ is selected from 4 to 8 by the SaSEL[2:0] (b7~5,  
E1-03BH). The SaX[1:4] (b3~0, E1-03DH) are debounced. They are up-  
dated only when two consecutive codewords are the same.  
All the above frame synchronization functions can only be executed  
when the UNF (b6, E1-000H) is logic 0.  
REDAlarm  
RED alarm is declared when the out of Basic Frame sync condition  
has persisted for 100ms. RED alarm is removed when the out of Basic  
Frame sync condition has been absent for 100ms. The RED alarm sta-  
tus is reflected in the RED (b3, E1-037H).  
The received data stream is out of Basic Frame sync when: 1) The  
Basic Frame has not been synchronized; 2) The received data stream  
meets the out of Basic Frame sync criteria set in the BIT2C (b6, E1-  
031H); 3) There are excessive CRC errors in the received data stream.  
Any one of the three conditions will be indicated by the OOFV (b6, E1-  
036H).  
- International Bit  
The International bits (Si) are extracted to the Si[1:0] (b7~6, E1-  
038H). The Si[1:0] (b7~6, E1-038H) are updated on the boundary of the  
associated FAS/NFAS frame and are not updated when out of frame is  
reported.  
- National Bit  
The National bits (Sa) are extracted to the Sa[4:8] (b4~0, E1-038H).  
The Sa[4:8] (b4~0, E1-038H) are updated on the boundary of the asso-  
ciated NFAS frame and are not updated when out of frame is reported.  
The integration of RED alarm uses the following algorithm: The algo-  
rithm monitors the occurrence of out of Basic Frame over a 4ms interval.  
A valid out of Basic Frame presence is accumulated when one or more  
out of Basic Frame indications occurred during the 4ms interval. Each  
valid out of Basic Frame presence increases one accumulation. An  
invalid out of Basic Frame presence is also accumulated when there is  
no out of Basic Frame indication occurring during the 4ms inverval. Each  
invalid out of Basic Frame indication decreases one accumulation (until  
the accumulation is zero). The RED alarm is declared when 25 valid out  
of Basic Frame presences have been accumulated. The RED alarm is  
removed when the out of Basic Frame presences reaches 0.  
- Remote Alarm Indication Bit  
The Remote Alarm Indication bit (A) is extracted to the A (b5, E1-  
038H). The A (b5, E1-038H) is updated on the boundary of the associ-  
ated NFAS frame.  
- Extra Bit  
The Extra bits (X) are extracted to the X[0:2] (b5 & b3~2, E1-03AH).  
The X[0:2] (b5 & b3~2, E1-03AH) are updated on the beginning of the  
Frame1 (next NFAS frame).  
- Remote Signaling Multi-Frame Alarm Indication Bit  
AISAlarm  
The Remote Signaling Multi-Frame Alarm Indication bit (Y) is ex-  
tracted to the Y (b4, E1-03AH). The Y (b4, E1-03AH) is updated on the  
beginning of the Frame1 (next NFAS frame).  
The AIS density criteria are selected in the AISC (b1, E1-031H). That  
is, if it is out of Basic Frame synchronization and less than 3 zeros are  
detected in a 512-bit stream, or if it is out of Basic Frame synchroniza-  
tion and less than 3 zeros are detected in each of 2 consecutive 512-bit  
streams, the status will be reported by the AISD (b5, E1-037H).  
When the above status has lasted for 100ms, AIS alarm is declared  
with a logic 1 in the AIS (b2, E1-037H). However, in unframed mode, the  
detection of AIS alarm is disabled.  
V5.2 Link  
The V5.2 link ID signal, i.e. 2 out of 3 Sa7 bits being logic 0, is de-  
tected with the indication in the V52LINKV (b0, E1-036H).  
Interrupt Sources  
24 kinds of interrupts are derived from this block as shown in Table -  
2. When there are conditions meeting the interrupt sources, the corre-  
sponding Status bit will be asserted high. When there is a transition  
(logic 1 to 0 or logic 0 to 1) on the Status bit, the corresponding Status  
Interrupt Indication bit will be set to logic 1 (If the Status bit does not ex-  
ist, the source will cause its Status Interrupt Indication bit to logic 1 di-  
rectly) and the Status Interrupt Indication bit will be cleared when it is  
read. A logic 1 in the Status Interrupt Indication bit means an interrupt  
occurred. The interrupt will be reported by the INT pin if its Status Inter-  
rupt Enable bit is logic 1.  
24  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Table - 2. Interrupt Sources In The E1 Frame Processor  
No.  
Sources  
Status Bit  
Interrupt Indication Bit Interrupt Enable Bit  
1
The received Basic Frame alignment signal does not meet its  
pattern once Basic Frame sync is achieved.  
The received CRC Multi-Frame alignment signal does not meet its  
pattern once CRC Multi-Frame sync is achieved.  
-
FERI (b2, E1-034H)  
CMFERI (b0, E1-034H)  
SMFERI (b1, E1-034H)  
FERE (b2, E1-032H)  
2
3
4
CMFERE  
(b0, E1-032H)  
SMFERE  
-
-
The received Signaling Multi-Frame alignment signal does not meet  
its pattern once Signaling Multi-Frame sync is achieved.  
The received data stream is out of Basic Frame sync, that is, when:  
1. The Basic Frame has not been synchronized; 2. The received  
data stream meets the out of Basic Frame sync criteria set in the  
BIT2C (b6, E1-031H); 3. There are excessive CRC errors in the  
received data stream.  
The received data stream is out of CRC Multi-Frame sync, that is,  
when: 1. The CRC Multi-Frame has not been synchronized; 2.  
There are excessive CRC errors in the received data stream.  
The received data stream is out of Signaling Multi-Frame sync, that  
is, when: 1. The received data stream is out of Basic Frame sync; 2.  
The received data stream meets the out of Signaling Multi-Frame  
sync criteria set in the SMFASC (b5, E1-031H) and the TS16C (b4,  
E1-031H).  
(b1, E1-032H)  
OOFV  
(b6, E1-036H)  
OOFI (b6, E1-034H)  
OOCMFI (b4, E1-034H)  
OOSMFI (b5, E1-034H)  
OOFE (b6, E1-032H)  
5
6
OOCMFV  
(b4, E1-036H)  
OOCMFE  
(b4, E1-032H)  
OOSMFV  
(b5, E1-036H)  
OOSMFE  
(b5, E1-032H)  
7
8
9
The out of Basic Frame sync condition has lasted for 100ms. (e.g.  
the condition in item No.4 has lasted for 100ms.)  
The calculated CRC remainder is not equal to the received C[1:4]  
bits.  
It is out of Basic Frame sync and less than 3 zeros are detected in a  
512-bit stream, or it is out of Basic Frame sync and less than 3  
zeros are detected in each of 2 consecutive 512-bit stream. These (b5, E1-037H)  
two criteria are selected in the AISC (b1, E1-031H).  
RED  
(b3, E1-037H)  
REDI (b3, E1-035H)  
CRCEI (b0, E1-035H)  
REDE (b3, E1-033H)  
CRCEE  
(b0, E1-033H)  
-
AISD  
AISDI (b5, E1-035H)  
AISDE (b5, E1-033H)  
10 The condition in item No.9 has lasted for 100ms.  
AIS  
(b2, E1-037H)  
RAIV  
(b7, E1-037H)  
AISI (b2, E1-035H)  
RAII (b7, E1-035H)  
FEBEI (b1, E1-035H)  
AISE (b2, E1-033H)  
RAIE (b7, E1-033H)  
11 Logic 1 is received in the A bit for a certain period. The criteria are  
defined in the RAIC (b3, E1-031H).  
12 Logic 0 is received in any of the CRC error indication (E1 or E2) bit.  
FEBEE  
-
(b1, E1-033H)  
RAICCRCE  
(b6, E1-03EH)  
CFEBEE  
13 A logic 1 is received in the A bit and a logic 0 is received in any of  
the E1 or E2 bits for 10ms.  
RAICCRCV  
(b2, E1-036H)  
CFEBEV  
RAICCRCI  
(b6, E1-03FH)  
14  
³
A logic 0 is received in any of the E1 or E2 bits on 990 occasions  
CFEBEI (b5, E1-03FH)  
RMAII (b6, E1-035H)  
C2NCIWI (b7, E1-034H)  
COFAI (b3, E1-034H)  
(b1, E1-036H)  
(b5, E1-03EH)  
per second for the latest 5 consecutive seconds.  
15 Logic 1 is received in the Y bit for 3 consecutive Signaling Multi-  
Frames.  
RMAIV  
(b6, E1-037H)  
C2NCIWV  
RMAIE (b6, E1-033H)  
16 The device is operating in the CRC to non-CRC inter working mode.  
C2NCIWE  
(b7, E1-032H)  
COFAE  
(b7, E1-036H)  
17 The position of the Basic Frame alignment pattern is changed.  
18 The device is in the procedure of the offline Basic Frame searching.  
-
(b3, E1-032H)  
OOOFV  
(b3, E1-036H)  
OOOFE  
OOOFI (b7, E1-03FH)  
IFPI (b3, E1-03FH)  
(b7, E1-03EH)  
IFPE (b3, E1-03EH)  
ICSMFPE  
19 The first bit of each Basic Frame is received.  
20 The first bit of each CRC Sub Multi-Frame is received.  
-
-
-
-
ICSMFPI (b2, E1-03FH)  
(b2, E1-03EH)  
21 The first bit of each CRC Multi-Frame is received.  
22 The first bit of each Signaling Multi-Frame is received.  
23 2 out of 3 Sa7 bits are received as logic 0.  
ICMFPE  
(b1, E1-03EH)  
ISMFPE  
(b0, E1-03EH)  
V52LINKE  
(b4, E1-03EH)  
Sa4E, Sa5E, Sa6E,  
Sa7E, Sa8E  
(b4~0, E1-03BH)  
ICMFPI (b1, E1-03FH)  
ISMFPI (b0, E1-03FH)  
V52LINKV  
(b0, E1-036H)  
V52LINKI  
(b4, E1-03FH)  
Sa4I, Sa5I, Sa6I,  
Sa7I, Sa8I  
24 There is change in the corresponding SaX[1:4] (b3~0, E1-03DH).  
-
(b4~0, E1-03CH)  
25  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
3.2.2  
T1/J1 MODE  
The pattern of the Frame Alignment Pattern is ‘001011’, which is lo-  
In T1/J1 Mode, the Frame Processor searches for the frame cated from Frame 4 in every 4th F-bit position. When the ESFFA (b5, T1/  
alignment patterns in the standard Super-Frame (SF) or in the Extended J1-020H) is set to 0, if four consecutive Frame Alignment Patterns are  
Super-Frame (ESF) framing formats. The format is selected by the ESF detected in the F-Bit in the received data stream, the ESF synchroniza-  
(b4, T1/J1-020H). The searching algorithm of T1 or J1 is selected by the tion is acquired. If the same pattern is received in the data stream other  
JYEL (b3, T1/J1-020H). The Frame Processor acquires frame alignment than in the F-bit, it is a mimic pattern. If a mimic pattern exists during the  
per ITU-T requirement.  
frame searching procedure, the synchronization will not be declared and  
When frame alignment is achieved, the Framer Processor continues the MFP (b1, T1/J1-022H) will be set to indicate the presence of a mimic  
to monitor the received data stream. If there are any of framing bit errors pattern. When the ESFFA (b5, T1/J1-020H) is set to 1, the synchroniza-  
or bit error events, the Frame Processor declares these events. The tion will be declared when 6 consecutive Frame Alignment Patterns are  
Frame Processor can also detect out-of-frame events based on received error free and the CRC-6 checksum is also error free. In this  
selectable criteria.  
condition, the existance of mimic patterns will not be considered.  
The Frame Processor can also be disabled to receive unframed data.  
A 4-frame capacity buffer is used to store the data when the Frame  
Processor is searching for SF/ESF synchronization. Once the SF/ESF is  
Super Frame (SF) Format  
The structure of T1/J1 SF format is illustrated in the Table - 3. The SF synchronized, the buffer is relinquished by the Frame Processor and the  
is made up of 12 frames. Each frame consists of a one bit overhead - F Frame Processor continues to monitor the errors. When the FAS error  
Bit and 24 8-bit channels. If two consecutive valid Frame Alignment Pat- ratio exceeds the criteria configured in the M2O[1:0] (b7~6, T1/J1-  
terns - ‘100011011100’ for T1 / ‘10001101110X’ for J1 - are received in 020H), it is out of frame.  
the F-Bit in the received data stream, the SF synchronization is ac-  
All the frame sync function can only be executed when the UNF (b6,  
quired. If the same pattern is received in the data stream other than in T1/J1-000H) is logic 0.  
the F-bit, it is a mimic pattern. If a mimic pattern exists during the frame  
The interrupt sources in this block are summarized in Table - 5.  
searching procedure, the synchronization will not be declared and the When there are conditions meeting the interrupt sources, the corre-  
MFP (b1, T1/J1-022H) will be set to indicate the presence of a mimic sponding Status bit will be asserted high. When there is a transition  
pattern.  
(logic 1 to 0 or logic 0 to 1) on the Status bit, the corresponding Status  
Interrupt Indication bit will be set to logic 1 (If the Status bit does not ex-  
ist, the source will cause its Status Interrupt Indication bit to be logic 1  
Extended Super Frame (ESF) Format  
The structure of T1/J1 ESF format is illustrated in the Table-4. The directly) and the Status Interrupt Indication bit will be cleared when it is  
ESF is made up of 24 frames. Each frame consists of a one bit over- read. A logic 1 in the Status Interrupt Indication bit indicates an interrupt  
head - F Bit and 24 8-bit channels.  
occurred. The interrupt is reported by the INT pin if its Status Interrupt  
Enable bit was set to logic 1.  
Table - 3. The Structure Of SF Format  
Frame No. In The SF  
The Bit In Each Channel  
F-Bit (Frame Alignment)  
Data Bit  
1 - 8  
1 - 8  
1 - 8  
1 - 8  
1 - 8  
1 - 7  
1 - 8  
1 - 8  
1 - 8  
1 - 8  
1 - 8  
1 - 7  
Signaling Bit  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
1
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
1
0
X
-
-
-
-
-
A (bit 8)  
-
-
-
-
10  
11  
12  
-
B (bit 8)  
X should be logic 0 in T1 FAS.  
X can be logic 0 or 1 in J1 FAS because this position is used as Yellow Alarm Indication bit.  
26  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Table - 4. The Structure Of ESF Format  
F-Bit Assignment  
The Bit In Each Channel  
Frame No. In The ESF  
FAS  
-
-
-
0
-
-
-
0
-
-
-
1
-
-
-
0
-
-
-
1
-
DL  
DL  
-
DL  
-
DL  
-
DL  
-
DL  
-
DL  
-
DL  
-
DL  
-
CRC  
-
C1  
-
-
-
C2  
-
-
-
C3  
-
-
-
C4  
-
-
-
C5  
-
-
-
C6  
-
Data Bit  
1 - 8  
1 - 8  
1 - 8  
1 - 8  
1 - 8  
1 - 7  
1 - 8  
1 - 8  
1 - 8  
1 - 8  
1 - 8  
1 - 7  
1 - 8  
1 - 8  
1 - 8  
1 - 8  
1 - 8  
1 - 7  
1 - 8  
1 - 8  
1 - 8  
1 - 8  
1 - 8  
1 - 7  
Signaling Bit  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
-
-
-
-
-
A (bit 8)  
-
-
-
-
-
B (bit 8)  
-
-
-
-
DL  
-
DL  
-
DL  
-
-
C (bit 8)  
-
-
-
-
-
-
1
DL  
-
-
-
D (bit 8)  
Table - 5. Interrupt Sources In The T1 / J1 Frame Processor  
No.  
1
Sources  
Status Bit  
MFP  
(b1, T1/J1-022H)  
Interrupt Indication Bit Interrupt Enable Bit  
The frame alignment mimic pattern is detected in the received  
data stream.  
MFPE  
MFPI (b3, T1/J1-022H)  
(b1, T1/J1-021H)  
2
3
4
5
6
The SF / ESF synchronization is found.  
INFR  
(b0, T1/J1-022H)  
INFRE  
(b0, T1/J1-021H)  
COFAE  
(b5, T1/J1-021H)  
FERE  
(b4, T1/J1-021H)  
SFEE  
(b2, T1/J1-021H)  
INFRI (b2, T1/J1-022H)  
The position of the new frame alignment pattern differs from  
the position of the previous one.  
One bit error is detected in frame alignment pattern.  
COFAI  
(b7, T1/J1-022H)  
-
-
-
.
FERI (b6, T1/J1-022H)  
SFEI (b4, T1/J1-022H)  
Two or more bit errors are detected in one frame alignment  
pattern.  
In the SF format, one bit error is detected in frame alignment  
pattern.  
BEEE  
(b3, T1/J1-021H)  
-
BEEI (b5, T1/J1-022H)  
In the ESF format, the received CRC-6 is not equal to the local  
calculated CRC-6.  
27  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
FER[8:0] (b0, T1/J1-04DH & b7~0, T1/J1-04CH) (In SF format, the us-  
age of the BEE[11:0] (b3~0, T1/J1-04BH & b7~0, T1/J1-04AH) is the  
same as that of the FER[8:0]);  
2. The out of SF synchronization event is counted. The number  
counted during the interval is reflected in the OOF[4:0] (b4~0, T1/J1-  
04EH);  
3.3 PERFORMANCE MONITOR (PMON)  
The Performance Monitor is used to count various performance  
events in the received data stream within defined intervals. The Perform-  
ance Monitor of each framer operates independently.  
3.3.1  
E1 MODE  
3. The number of changes of the frame alignment position during the  
interval is counted and is reflected in the COFA[2:0] (b2~0, T1/J1-04FH).  
In ESF format, the Performance Monitor counts four kinds of events:  
1. The block counts the CRC-6 errors which mean the local calcu-  
lated CRC-6 remainders are not equal to the received CRC-6. The  
number of the errors counted during the interval is indicated in the  
BEE[11:0] (b3~0, T1/J1-04BH & b7~0, T1/J1-04AH);  
2 ~ 4. (The same events as 1 ~ 3 in the SF format, described above.)  
These PMON Error Count registers in a framer can be updated as a  
group. The intervals are typically 1 second when the AUTOUPDATE (b0,  
T1/J1-000H) of the framer is set. They can also be updated by writing to  
any of these PMON Error Count registers. The PMON Error Count regis-  
ters of eight framers can also be updated together by writing to the Revi-  
sion / Chip ID / Global PMON Update register (T1/J1-00CH). Once the  
PMON Error Count registers are updated, the XFER (b1, T1/J1-049H)  
will be logic 1 and an interrupt can be asserted on the INT pin if the INTE  
(b2, T1/J1-049H) is logic 1.  
The PMON block counts the Basic Frame alignment pattern errors.  
The method of counting the errors is defined by the WORDERR (b5, E1-  
000H) and CNTNFAS (b4, E1-000H) as shown in Table - 6. The number  
of the Basic Frame alignment pattern errors counted during the interval  
is reflected in the FER[6:0] (b6~0, E1-069H).  
Table - 6. Basic Frame Alignment Pattern Error Counter  
WORDERR  
(b5, E1-000H)  
CNTNFAS  
(b4, E1-000H)  
One Error is Counted  
0
0
One bit error in FAS  
0
1
One bit error in FAS or a logic  
0 in bit 2 of TS0 of NFAS  
One or more than one bit error  
in a FAS  
Any bit error in a FAS and the  
2nd bit of TS0 of the following  
NFAS  
1
1
0
1
If the performance number counted in the next interval is latched in  
its PMON register without the previous one being read, the PMON Error  
Count register is over-written. Any over-writing of the four kinds of  
PMON Error Count registers will be indicated in the OVR (b0, T1/J1-  
049H).  
The PMON block counts the Far End Block Error (FEBE) which is de-  
tected in the E1 and E2 bits. The number of the FEBE counted during  
the interval is stored in the FEBE[9:0] (b1~0, E1-06BH & b7~0, E1-  
06AH).  
The block also counts the CRC errors which mean the local calcu-  
lated CRC remainders are not equal to the received CRC. The number  
of the CRC errors counted during the interval is indicated in the  
CRCE[9:0] (b1~0, E1-06DH & b7~0, E1-06CH).  
The above three kinds of PMON Error Count registers are deacti-  
vated when the framer is out of Basic Framer synchronization. The latter  
two kinds of PMON Error Count registers are also deactivated when it is  
out of CRC Multi-Frame synchronization.  
These PMON Error Count registers in a framer can be updated as a  
group. The intervals are typically 1 second when the AUTOUPDATE (b0,  
E1-000H) of the current framer is set. They can also be updated by writ-  
ing to any of these PMON Error Count registers. The PMON Error Count  
registers in eight framers can also be updated together by writing to the  
Revision / Chip ID / Global PMON Update register (E1-009H). Once the  
PMON Error Count registers are updated, the XFER (b1, E1-068H) will  
be set to logic 1 and an interrupt can be asserted on the INT pin if the  
INTE (b2, E1-068H) is logic 1.  
3.4 ALARM DETECTOR (ALMD) - T1 / J1 ONLY  
The Alarm Detector block exists in T1/J1 mode only. It detects the  
Yellow signal and the AIS (Blue Alarm) signal in SF/ESF in T1/J1 data  
stream and declares the Yellow alarm, the Red alarm and the AIS alarm.  
The T1 or J1 mode is selected by the J1_YEL (b5, T1/J1-02CH) while  
the SF or ESF format is selected by the ESF (b4, T1/J1-02CH).  
The Yellow signal is declared differently in each format:  
- In T1 SF format: The Yellow signal occupies the 2nd bit of each  
channel. When the occurence of logic 1 in this bit position is less than 16  
times (including 16 times) during a 40ms period, the Yellow signal is de-  
clared.  
- In J1 SF format: The Yellow signal occupies the F-bit of the 12th  
frame. When the occurence of logic 0 on this bit position is less than 2  
times (including 2 times) during a 40ms period, the Yellow signal is de-  
clared.  
- In T1/J1 ESF format: The Yellow signal occupies the DL of the F-bit  
(refer to Table-4). The pattern is ‘FF00’ in T1 mode and ‘FFFF’ in J1  
mode. When the AVC (b1, T1/J1-02AH) is logic 0, the Yellow signal is  
declared if 8 out of 10 successive patterns match the ‘FF00’ (in T1) or  
‘FFFF’ (in J1) on the DL bit position. When the AVC (b1, T1/J1-02AH) is  
logic 1, the Yellow signal is declared if 4 out of 5 successive patterns  
match the ‘FF00’ (in T1) or ‘FFFF’ (in J1) on the DL bit position  
Any of the above conditions will be indicated by the YELD (b1, T1/J1-  
02FH).  
If the performance number counted in the next interval is latched in  
its PMON Error Count register without the previous one being read, the  
PMON Error Count register is over-written. Any over-writing of the three  
kinds of PMON Error Count registers will be indicated in the OVR (b0,  
E1-068H).  
The AIS signal is declared when the received data are out of SF/ESF  
synchronization for 60ms and the received logic 0 is less than 127 times  
in the same period. Then the AIS signal will be indicated by the AISD  
(b0, T1/J1-02FH).  
3.3.2  
T1/J1 MODE  
In SF format, the Performance Monitor counts three kinds of events:  
1. Every one-bit error in a frame alignment pattern is counted. The  
number of the errors counted during the interval is reflected in the  
28  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
The Red signal is declared when one or more out of SF/ESF sync timeslot except TS16);  
event occurs in 40ms. Then the Red signal will be indicated by the  
REDD (b2, T1/J1-02FH).  
3. Sa-bit data link.  
All the functions of the selected HDLC Receiver block can be ena-  
The Yellow alarm, AIS alarm and Red alarm will be declared or bled only if the EN (b0, E1-048H) is set to logic 1.  
cleared when the corresponding alarm signal is present or absent for a  
certain period as summarized in Table - 7.  
A normal HDLC packet consists of the following parts as shown in  
Figure - 3:  
The Yellow alarm, AIS alarm and Red alarm are also the interrupt  
sources in the ALMD block. When the alarm occurs, the corresponding  
Interrupt Status Register (YEL, AIS or RED in b2, b0, b1 of T1/J1-02EH  
respectively) will indicate it. When there is any transition (from 0 to 1 or  
from 1 to 0) on the Interrupt Status Register, its corresponding Interrupt  
Indication Register (YELI, AISI or REDI in b5, b3, b4 of T1/J1-02EH re-  
spectively) will be logic 1. A transition on the Interrupt Indication Register  
can cause an interrupt on the INT pin if the corresponding Interrupt Ena-  
bled Register (YELE, AISE or REDE in b2, b0, b1 of T1/J1-02DH re-  
spectively) is logic 1.  
FCS  
Flag (7E)  
HDLC Data  
Flag (7E)  
one byte  
01111110  
n bytes  
one byte  
01111110  
two bytes  
n
2
(remove the stuffed zero)  
store in FIFO  
Figure - 3. HDLC Packet  
3.5 HDLC RECEIVER (RHDLC)  
The HDLC extraction is performed in this block. The HDLC Receiver  
#1, #2 and #3 in E1 mode or the HDLC Receiver #1 and #2 in T1/J1  
ESF mode of each framer operate independently.  
Every HDLC packet starts with a 7E (Hex) opening flag sequence  
and ends with the same flag. Before the closing flag sequence, two  
bytes of CRC-CCITT frame check sequences (FCS) are provided to  
check all the HDLC data. The received FCS will be compared with the  
local calculated FCS.  
3.5.1  
E1 MODE  
Three HDLC Receiver blocks (#1, #2 and #3) are employed for each  
framer to extract the HDLC link from the received data stream. Before  
selecting the HDLC link, the TXCISEL (b3, E1-00AH) should be set to 0.  
Thus, the configuration of the Link Control and Bits Select registers (ad-  
dressed from 028H to 02DH) is for RHDLC. Next, select one of the three  
HDLC Receiver blocks by selecting the appropriate bits in the  
RHDLCSEL[1:0] (b7~6, E1-00AH). The #2 and #3 blocks can also be  
disabled by setting the V52DIS (b3, E1-007H). Then the position of the  
HDLC link can be defined as follows:  
1. Set the DL_EVEN (b7, E1-028H or b7, E1-02AH or b7, E1-02CH)  
and/or the DL_ODD (b6, E1-028H or b6, E1-02AH or b6, E1-02CH) to  
select the even and/or odd frames (the even frames are FAS frames  
while the odd frames are NFAS frames);  
2. Set the DL_TS[4:0] (b4~0, E1-028H or b4~0, E1-02AH or b4~0,  
E1-02CH) to define the timeslot of the assigned frame (or to select the  
TS16_EN (b5, E1-028H) to select the TS16 of the assigned frame);  
3. Set the DL_BIT[7:0] (b7~0, E1-029H or b7~0, E1-02BH or b7~0,  
E1-02DH) to select the bits of the assigned timeslot.  
Three HDLC standards for E1 are defined and one is selected as fol-  
lows:  
1. Common Channel Signaling (CCS) data link (extract the bits in the  
TS16);  
A FIFO buffer is used to store the HDLC packet, that is, to store the  
data whose stuffed zeros have been removed and the FCS. However,  
when the address matching is enabled, the first and/or second byte  
compares with the address setting in the PA[7:0] (b7~0, E1-04CH) and  
the SA[7:0] (b7~0, E1-04DH), and only the data matching the selection  
in the MEN (b3, E1-048H) and the MM (b2, E1-048H) are stored into the  
FIFO. When address matching is disabled, all the HDLC data are stored.  
The first 7E opening flag which activates the HDLC link and the 7F (Hex)  
abort sequence which deactivates the HDLC link will also be converted  
to dummy bytes and stored into the FIFO regardless if the address is  
matching or not. These two types of flags will also assert the COLS (b5,  
E1-04AH) to indicate the HDLC link status change. The content in the  
FIFO is read in the RD[7:0] (b7~0, E1-04BH), and the status of the bytes  
will be reflected in the PBS[2:0] (b3~1, E1-04AH). Both of these regis-  
ters (RD[7:0] (b7~0, E1-04BH) and PBS[2:0] (b3~1, E1-04AH)) can not  
be accessed at a rate greater than 1/15 of the XCK rate.  
The depth of the FIFO is 128 bytes. When the FIFO is empty, the FE  
(b7, E1-04AH) will be set. If data are still written into the FIFO when the  
FIFO is already full, the FIFO will be over-written. The over-written con-  
dition will be indicated by the OVR (b6, E1-04AH) and forces the FIFO to  
be cleared.  
2. V5.1 / V5.2 D-channel and C-channels (extract the bits in any  
A logic 1 in the PKIN (b4, E1-04AH) indicates a non-abort HDLC  
Table - 7. Alarm Summary in ALMD  
Declaring  
Clearing  
YellowAlarm  
the Yellow signal is present for 425ms (± 50ms)  
the Yellow signal is absent for 425ms (± 50ms)  
the AIS signal is absent for 16.8sec (± 500ms); or the AIS signal  
is absent for 180ms if the FASTD (b4, T1/J1-02DH) is set  
AIS Alarm  
the AIS signal is present for 1.5sec (± 100ms)  
the Red signal is absent for 16.6sec (± 500ms); or the Red signal  
is absent for 120ms if the FASTD (b4, T1/J1-02DH) is set  
Red Alarm  
the Red signal is present for 2.55sec (± 40ms)  
29  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
packet was received. This bit (PKIN) is set regardless of the status of  
the FCS condition or if there are an integer or non-integer number of  
bytes stored in the FIFO.  
The HDLC packet can be forced to terminate for four reasons:  
1. The 7F abort sequence is received;  
2. More than 15 successive logic ones are received in the data  
stream;  
3. Set the TR (b1, E1-048H) to logic 1;  
4. Set the EN (b0, E1-048H) from logic 1 to logic 0 and back to logic  
1.  
two types of flags will also assert the COLS (b5, T1/J1-056H) to indicate  
the HDLC link status change. The content in the FIFO is read in the  
RD[7:0] (b7~0, T1/J1-057H), and the status of the bytes will be reflected  
in the PBS[2:0] (b3~1, T1/J1-056H). Both of the two registers can’t be  
accessed at a rate greater than 1/15 of the XCK rate.  
The depth of the FIFO is 128 bytes. When the FIFO is empty, the FE  
(b7, T1/J1-056H) will be set. If data are still written into the FIFO when  
the FIFO is already full, the FIFO will be over-written. The over-written  
condition will be indicated by the OVR (b6, T1/J1-056H) and force the  
FIFO to be cleared.  
All the above methods can deactivate the HDLC link immediately and  
the latter two means can also clean the FIFO and interrupts. A new  
search for the 7E opening flag is also initiated.  
The interrupt sources in this block are:  
1. Receiving the first 7E opening flag sequence which terminates all  
ones data and activates the HDLC link;  
A logic 1 in the PKIN (b4, T1/J1-056H) indicates a non-abort HDLC  
packet was received whether there were FCS errors or non-integer  
number if bytes errors in it or not.  
The HDLC packet can be forced to terminate by four means:  
1. The 7F abort sequence is received;  
2. More than 15 successive logic ones are received in the data  
stream;  
2. Receiving the 7E closing flag sequence;  
3. Receiving the abort sequence;  
3. Set the TR (b2, T1/J1-054H) to logic 1;  
4. Exceeding the set point of the FIFO which is defined in the  
INTC[6:0] (b6~0, E1-049);  
4. Set the EN (b1, T1/J1-054H) from logic 1 to logic 0 and back to  
logic 1.  
5. Over-writting the FIFO.  
All the above methods can deactivate the HDLC link immediately and  
the latter two methods can also clear the FIFO and interrupts. A new  
search for the 7E opening flag is also initiated.  
Any one of the interrupt sources will assert the INTR (b0, E1-04AH)  
high. Then the INT pin will be low to report the interrupt if the INTE (b7,  
E1-049H) is logic 1.  
The interrupt sources in this block are:  
1. Receiving the first 7E opening flag sequence which terminates the  
all ones data and activates the HDLC link;  
3.5.2  
T1 / J1 MODE  
In the SF format, there is no HDLC link.  
2. Receiving the 7E closing flag sequence;  
In the ESF format, two HDLC Receiver blocks (#1 and #2) are em-  
ployed for each framer to extract the HDLC link. Before selecting the  
HDLC link, the TXCISEL (b3, T1/J1-00DH) should be set to 0. Thus, the  
configuration of the Link Control and Bits Select registers (addressed  
from 070H to 071H) is for the RHDLC. Then, selected by the  
RHDLCSEL[1:0] (b7~6, T1/J1-00DH), one of the two HDLC Receiver  
blocks are accessable to the microprocessor. The HDLC#1 extracts the  
HDLC link in the DL of the F-bit (its position is shown in Table - 4). The  
HDLC#2 extracts the HDLC link from one of the channels which position  
is selected as follows:  
1. Set the DL2_EVEN (b7, T1/J1-070H) and/or the DL2_ODD (b6,  
T1/J1-070H) to select the even and/or odd frames;  
2. Set the DL2_TS[4:0] (b4~0, T1/J1-070H) to select the channel of  
the assigned frame;  
3. Set the DL2_BIT[7:0] (b7~0, T1/J1-071H) to select the bits of the  
assigned channel.  
All the functions of the selected HDLC Receiver block can be ena-  
bled only if the EN (b0, T1/J1-054H) is set to logic 1.  
3. Receiving the abort sequence;  
4. Exceeding the set point of the FIFO which is defined in the  
INTC[6:0] (b6~0, T1/J1-055H);  
5. Over-writting the FIFO.  
Any one of the interrupt sources will assert the INTR (b0, T1/J1-  
056H) high. Then the INT pin will be driven low to report the interrupt if  
the INTE (b7, T1/J1-055H) is logic 1.  
3.6 BIT-ORIENTED MESSAGE RECEIVER (RBOM) - T1  
/ J1 ONLY  
The Bit Oriented Message (BOM) can only be received in the ESF  
format in T1/J1 mode. The standard of the BOM is defined in ANSI  
T1.403 and in TR-TSY-000194. This block of each framer operates inde-  
pendently.  
The BOM pattern is ‘111111110XXXXXX0’ which occupies the DL of  
the F-bit in the ESF format (refer to Table-4). The six ‘X’s represent the  
message. The BOM is declared only when the pattern is matched and  
the received message is identical 4 out of 5 times or 8 out of 10 times.  
The identification time is selected by the AVC (b1, T1/J1-02AH). After the  
BOM is declared, the BOM is loaded into the BOC[5:0] (b5~0, T1/J1-  
02BH). However, the BOM does not include all ones code in both T1 and  
J1 mode.  
When the BOM is converted into non-BOM, the received data will be  
idle code. The pattern of the idle code is ‘FFFF’ in T1 mode and ‘FF7E’  
in J1 mode. When the received data is 4 out of 5 times or 8 out of 10  
times identical with the pattern, the idle code is declared. The identifica-  
tion time is selected by the AVC (b1, T1/J1-02AH).  
There are two interrupt sources in this block. When the BOM is de-  
clared, the BOCI (b6, T1/J1-02BH) will indicate it. When the idle code is  
declared, the IDLEI (b7, T1/J1-02BH) will indicate it. If the BOCE (b0,  
The structure of the HDLC packet is the same as it is described in  
the E1 mode (refer to Figure - 3).  
A FIFO buffer is used to store the HDLC packet, that is, to store the  
data whose stuffed zeros have been removed and the FCS. However,  
when the address matching is enabled, the first and/or second byte  
compares with the address setting in the PA[7:0] (b7~0, T1/J1-058H)  
and the SA[7:0] (b7~0, T1/J1-059H) and only the data matching the se-  
lection in the MEN (b3, T1/J1-054H) and the MM (b2, T1/J1-054H) are  
stored into the FIFO. When the address matching is disabled, the entire  
HDLC packet is stored. The first 7E opening flag which activates the  
HDLC link and the 7F abort sequence which deactivates the HDLC link  
will also be converted into dummy bytes and stored in the FIFO. These  
30  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1/J1-02AH) and IDLE (b2, T1/J1-02AH) are set to 1 respectively, the will be repeated after it is read. When the read pointer crosses the next  
corresponding condition will cause an interrupt on the INT pin.  
frame boundary, a controlled slip will occur with a logic 0 indicated in the  
SLIPD (b1, E1-059H).  
When the slip occurs, the SLIPI (b0, E1-059H) will indicate. An inter-  
rupt on the INT pin will also occur if the SLIPE (b2, E1-059H) is set to  
logic 1.  
In Receive Clock Slave mode, if it is out of Basic Frame synchroniza-  
tion, the idle code programmed in the D[7:0] (b7~0, E1-05AH) in the  
Elastic Store Buffer can be set to replace the data if the TRKEN (b1, E1-  
001H) is set to logic 1.  
In Receive Clock Master mode, the Elastic Store Buffer is bypassed  
unless the device is in the Payload Loopback diagnosis mode. (Refer to  
Payload Loopback Mode for details).  
3.7 INBAND LOOPBACK CODE DETECTOR (IBCD) -  
T1 / J1 ONLY  
The Inband Loopback Code Detector can track loopback activate/de-  
activate codes only in framed or unframed T1/J1 data stream. The  
Inband Loopback Code Detector of each framer operates independently.  
The received data stream is compared with the target activate/deacti-  
vate code whose length and the content are programmed in the  
ASEL[1:0] (b1~0, T1/J1-03CH) / DSEL[1:0] (b3~2, T1/J1-03CH) and the  
ACT[7:0] (b7~0, T1/J1-03EH) / DACT[7:0] (b7~0, T1/J1-03FH) respec-  
tively. In framed mode, the F-bit can be selected by the IBCD_IDLE (b5,  
T1/J1-000H) to compare with the target activate/deactivate code or not.  
In unframed mode, all 193 bits are compared with the target activate/de-  
activate code. Whether the received data stream matches the target ac-  
tivate or deactivate code and repeats for a 39.8ms period, the LBACP  
(b7, T1/J1-03DH) or LBDCP (b6, T1/J1-03DH) will indicate the appear-  
ance of the corresponding code. 2, 20 or 200 bit-error tolerance within  
each 39.8ms period is permitted by setting the IBCD_ERR[1:0] (b5~4,  
T1/J1-03CH). However, even if the F-bit is compared, whether it is  
matched or not, the result will not cause bit errors, that is, the compari-  
son result of the F-bit is passed over.  
When the received data stream matches the target activate/deacti-  
vate code and repeats for 5.1 sec, the LBA (b1, T1/J1-03DH) / LBD (b0,  
T1/J1-03DH) will indicate the detection of the inband loopback code. The  
code sequences detection and timing is compatible with the specifica-  
tions in T1.403, TA-TSY-000312 and TR-TSY-000303.  
The status changes of the activate or deactivate code are the inter-  
rupt sources in the IBCD block. That is, when the value in the Status  
Register (LBA [b1, T1/J1-03DH] or LBD [b0, T1/J1-03DH]) changes, its  
corresponding Interrupt Indication Register (LBAI [b3, T1/J1-03DH] or  
LBDI [b2, T1/J1-03DH]) will be logic 1. A logic 1 on the Interrupt Indica-  
tion Register will cause an interrupt on the INT pin if the corresponding  
Interrupt Enable Register (LBAE [b5, T1/J1-03DH] or LBDE [b4, T1/J1-  
03DH]) is logic 1.  
3.8.2  
T1 / J1 MODE  
In Receive Clock Slave mode, a 2-basic-frame depth Elastic Store  
Buffer is used to synchronize the incoming frames to the Receive Side  
System Common Clock derived from the RSCCK pin, and to the Re-  
ceive Side System Common Frame Pulse derived from the RSCFS pin.  
A write pointer is used to write the data to the Elastic Store Buffer, while  
a read pointer is used to read the data from the Elastic Store Buffer.  
When the average frequency of the incoming data is greater than the  
average frequency of the Receive Side System Common Clock  
(RSCCK), the write pointer will be faster than the read pointer and the  
Elastic Store Buffer will be filled. So a frame will be deleted after its prior  
frame is read. When the read pointer crosses the frame boundary, a  
controlled slip will occur with a logic 1 indicated in the SLIPD (b1, T1/J1-  
01DH).  
When the average frequency of the incoming data is less than the  
average frequency of the RSCCK, the write pointer will be slower than  
the read pointer and the Elastic Store Buffer will be empty. The frame  
will be repeated after it is read. When the read pointer crosses the next  
frame boundary, a controlled slip will occur with a logic 0 indicated in the  
SLIPD (b1, T1/J1-01DH).  
When the slip occurs, the SLIPI (b0, T1/J1-01DH) will indicate. An in-  
terrupt on the INT pin will also occur if the SLIPE (b2, T1/J1-01DH) is  
logic 1.  
In Receive Clock Slave mode, if it is out of SF/ESF sync, the idle  
code programmed in the D[7:0] (b7~0, T1/J1-01EH) in the Elastic Store  
Buffer will replace the data of all channels automatically.  
3.8 ELASTIC STORE BUFFER (ELSB)  
The Elastic Store Buffer of each framer operates independently.  
In Receive Clock Master mode, the Elastic Store Buffer is bypassed  
unless the device is in the payload loopback diagnosis mode. (Refer to  
Payload Loopback Mode for details).  
3.8.1  
E1 MODE  
In Receive Clock Slave mode, a 2-basic-frame depth Elastic Store  
Buffer is used to synchronize the incoming frames to the Receive Side  
System Common Clock derived from the RSCCK pin, and to the Re-  
ceive Side System Common Frame Pulse derived from the RSCFS pin.  
A write pointer is used to write the data to the Elastic Store Buffer, while  
a read pointer is used to read the data from the Elastic Store Buffer.  
When the average frequency of the incoming data is greater than the  
average frequency of the Receive Side System Common Clock  
(RSCCK), the write pointer will be faster than the read pointer and the  
Elastic Store Buffer will be filled. So a frame will be deleted after its prior  
frame is read. When the read pointer crosses the frame boundary, a  
controlled slip will occur with a logic 1 indicated in the SLIPD (b1, E1-  
059H).  
3.9 RECEIVE CAS/RBS BUFFER (RCRB)  
The Receive CAS/RBS Buffer of each framer operates independ-  
ently.  
3.9.1  
E1 MODE  
In the Signaling Multi-Frame synchronization condition, the signaling  
bits are located in TS16, which is Channel Associated Signaling (CAS).  
Their arrangement in TS16 is shown in Figure - 4.  
When the RSCKn/RSSIGn/MRSSIG[1:2] pins are used as the  
signaling output, i.e. in Receive Clock Slave External Signaling mode or  
in Receive Multiplex mode, the signaling codeword (ABCD) are clocked  
out in the lower nibble of the timeslot with its corresponding data serializ-  
ing on the RSDn/MRSD[1:2] pins (as shown in the Figure - 5).  
When the average frequency of the incoming data is less than the  
average frequency of the RSCCK, the write pointer will be slower than  
the read pointer and the Elastic Store Buffer will be empty. The frame  
31  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
When the COSS (b6, E1-064H) is logic 1, all the COSS[30:1] (b5~0,  
E1-064H and b7~0, E1-065H and b7~0, E1-066H and b7~0, E1-067H)  
in the Receive CAS/RBS Buffer registers will reflect the change of the  
signaling of each timeslot respectively (excluding the TS0 and TS16).  
When the COSS (b6, E1-064H) is logic 0, the Receive CAS/RBS  
Buffer indirect registers (from 01H to 5FH of RCRB indirect registers)  
can be accessed by the microprocessor. The address of the indirect reg-  
ister is specified by the A[6:0] (b6~0, E1-066H). Whether the data are  
read from or written into the specified indirect register is determined by  
the R/WB (b7, E1-066H) and the data are in the D[7:0] (b7~0, E1-067H).  
The indirect registers have a read/write cycle. Before the read/write op-  
eration is completed, the BUSY (b7, E1-065H) will be set. New opera-  
tions on the indirect registers can only be implemented when the BUSY  
(b7, E1-065H) is cleared. The read/write cycle is 490ns.  
TS16  
0
0
0
0
X
Y
X
X
F0  
Signaling Multi-Frame  
alignment pattern  
RMAI  
Extra Bits  
A
A
B
C
D
D
A
A
B
C
D
D
F1  
F2  
to TS17  
to TS1  
The indirect registers are divided into three segments: two segments  
(from 01H to 1FH & from 21H to 3FH) contain the signaling bits of each  
timeslot; another segment (from 40H to 5FH) contains the signaling  
debounce configuration of each timeslot.  
B
C
B
C
to TS18  
to TS2  
A three-Signaling-Multi-Frame capacity buffer is used for signaling  
debounce and signaling freezing.  
Signaling debounce can be set by the DEB (b0, E1-RCRB-indirect  
registers - 41~5FH) which is activated by the PCCE (b0, E1-064H). It  
updates the signaling bits only when 2 consecutive signaling of a  
timeslot are the same.  
A
B
C
D
A
B
C
D
F15  
to TS31  
to TS15  
Signaling freeze will remain the signaling automatically when it is out  
of Signaling Multi-Frame synchronization or in unframed mode.  
The signaling bits are extracted to the A, B, C, D (b3~0, E1-RCRB-  
indirect registers - 01~1FH or b3~0, E1-RCRB-indirect registers -  
21~3FH).  
Figure - 4. TS16 Arrangement in Signaling Multi-Frame  
There is a maximum 2 ms delay between the transition of the  
COSS[n] (E1-064H and E1-065H and E1-066H and E1-067H) and the  
TS31  
TS0  
TS1  
TS15  
TS16  
TS17  
TS31  
TS0  
RSDn/  
MRSD[1:2]  
12 3 4 56 78 1 23 4 56 78 1 2 34 56 78  
1 23 4 56 78 1 2 34 56 78 1 2 34 56 78  
1 2 34 56 781 2 3 45 678  
ABCD  
RSSIGn/  
MRSSIG[1:2]  
ABCD  
ABCD  
ABCD  
ABCD  
Figure - 5. Signaling Output in E1 Mode  
Channel 24  
Channel 1  
Channel 2  
Channel 24  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
Channel 1  
RSDn/  
MRSD[1:2]  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8  
F
F
RSSIGn/  
MRSSIG[1:2]  
A B C D  
A B C D  
A B C D  
A B C D  
A B C D  
F-bit or Parity  
F-bit or Parity  
Figure - 6. Signaling Output in T1 / J1 Mode  
32  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
updating of the A, B, C, D code in the corresponding indirect registers T1/J1-RCRB-indirect registers - 21~38H). To avoid this 2 ms delay, us-  
(b3~0, E1-RCRB-indirect registers - 21~3FH). To avoid this 2 ms delay, ers can read the corresponding b3~0 in the T1/J1-RCRB-indirect regis-  
users can read the corresponding b3~0 in the E1-RCRB-indirect regis- ters - (01~18H) first. If the value of these four bits are different from the  
ters - (01~1FH) first. If the value of these four bits are different from the previous A, B, C, D code, then the content of b3~0 in the T1/J1-RCRB-  
previous A, B, C, D code, then the content of b3~0 in the E1-RCRB-indi- indirect registers - (01~18H) is the updated A, B, C, D code. If the con-  
rect registers - (01~1FH) is the updated A, B, C, D code. If the content of tent of the four bits is the same as the previous A, B, C, D code, then  
the four bits is the same as the previous A, B, C, D code, then users users should read the b3~0 in the T1/J1-RCRB-indirect registers -  
should read the b3~0 in the E1-RCRB-indirect registers - (21~3FH) to (21~38H) to get the updated A, B, C, D code.  
get the updated A, B, C, D code.  
Any one of the 24-channel’s signaling change will cause an interrupt  
Any one of the 30-timeslot’s signaling change will cause an interrupt on the INT pin if the SIGE (b5, T1/J1-040H) is set.  
on the INT pin if the SIGE (b5, E1-064H) is set.  
3.10 RECEIVE PAYLOAD CONTROL (RPLC)  
3.9.2  
T1 / J1 MODE  
Different test patterns can be inserted in the received data stream or  
the received data stream can be extracted to the PRBS Generator/De-  
tector for test in this block. The Receive Payload Control of each framer  
operates independently.  
When the frame is synchronized, the signaling is located in the Bit 8  
of Frame 6 (A bit) and Frame 12 (B bit) in SF format, and is located in  
the Bit 8 of Frame 6 (A bit), Frame 12 (B bit), Frame 18 (C bit) and  
Frame 24 (D bit) in ESF format (refer to Table-3 & 4). The SF/ESF  
signaling format is selected by the ESF (b2, T1/J1-040H).  
3.10.1 E1 MODE  
When the RSCKn/RSSIGn/MRSSIG[1:2] pins are used as the  
signaling output, i.e. in Receive Clock Slave External Signaling mode or  
in Receive Multiplex mode, the signaling codeword (AB or ABCD) are  
clocked out in the lower nibble of the channel with its corresponding data  
serializing on the RSDn/MRSD[1:2] pins (as shown in the Figure - 6).  
However, in SF format, the signaling C and D are the repitition of  
signaling A and B.  
When the COSS (b6, T1/J1-040H) bit is logic 1, all the COSS[24:1]  
(b7~0, T1/J1-041H and b7~0, T1/J1-042H and b7~0, T1/J1-043H) in the  
Receive CAS/RBS Buffer registers will reflect the change of the  
signaling of each channel respectively.  
When the COSS (b6, T1/J1-040H) bit is logic 0, the Receive CAS/  
RBS Buffer indirect registers (from 01H to 58H of RCRB indirect regis-  
ters) can be accessed by the microprocessor. The address of the indi-  
rect register is specified by the A[6:0] (b6~0, T1/J1-042H). Whether the  
data are read from or written into the specified indirect register is deter-  
mined by the R/WB (b7, T1/J1-042H) and the data is in the D[7:0] (b7~0,  
T1/J1-043H). The indirect registers have a read/write cycle. Before the  
read/write operation is completed, the BUSY (b7, T1/J1-041H) will be  
set. New operations on the indirect registers can only be done when the  
BUSY (b7, T1/J1-041H) is cleared. The read/write cycle is 650ns.  
The indirect registers are devided into three segments: two segments  
(from 01H to 18H & from 21H to 38H) contain the signaling bits of each  
channel; another segment (from 41H to 58H) contains the signaling  
debounce configuration of each channel.  
A three-superframe capacity buffer is used for signaling debounce  
and signaling freezing.  
Signaling debounce can be set by the DEB (b0, T1/J1-RCRB-indirect  
registers - 41~58H) which is activated by the PCCE (b0, T1/J1-040H). It  
updates the signaling bits only when 2 consecutive SF/ESF signaling  
bits of a channel are the same.  
Signaling freeze will remain the signaling automatically when it is out  
of SF/ESF sync or in unframed mode.  
The signaling bits are extracted to the A, B, C, D (b3~0, T1/J1-  
RCRB-indirect registers - 01~18H or b3~0, T1/J1-RCRB-indirect regis-  
ters - 21~38H).  
To enable the test for the received data stream, the PCCE (b0, E1-  
05CH) must be set to activate the setting in the indirect registers (from  
20H to 7FH of RPLC indirect registers). The following methods can be  
executed for test on a per-TS basis:  
- Selected by the PRGDSEL[2:0] (b7~5, E1-00CH), the received data  
of one of the eight framers will be extracted to the PRBS Generator/De-  
tector when the RXPATGEN (b2, E1-00CH) is 0. The received data can  
be extracted in framed or unframed mode. The selection is made by the  
UNF_DET (b0, E1-00CH). In unframed mode, all the 32 timeslots are  
extracted and the per-timeslot configuration in the TEST (b7, E1-RPLC-  
indirect registers - 20~3FH) is ignored. In framed mode, the received  
data will only be extracted on the timeslot configured by the TEST (b7,  
E1-RPLC-indirect registers - 20~3FH). Refer to the section of PRBS  
GENERATOR / DETECTOR (PRGD) for details.  
- Replace the data that will be output on the RSDn/MRSD pin with the  
value in the DTRK[7:0] (b7~0, E1-RPLC-indirect registers - 40~5FH)  
when the DTRKC/NxTS (b6, E1-RPLC-indirect registers - 20~3FH) of the  
corresponding timeslot is logic 1. (When it is out of Basic Frame synchro-  
nization, the value in the DTRK[7:0] [b7~0, E1-RPLC-indirect registers -  
40~5FH] can replace the data automatically if the AUTOOOF [b1, E1-  
000H] is set. Or, when it is out of Basic Frame synchronization for  
100ms, the value in the DTRK[7:0] [b7~0, E1-RPLC-indirect registers -  
40~5FH] can replace the data automatically if the AUTORED (b2, 000H)  
is set. These two kinds of data replacements can be executed even if  
the PCCE [b0, E1-05CH] is disabled and they replace all the timeslots.)  
- Replace the data that will be output on the RSDn/MRSD pin with the  
µ-law or A-law milliwatt pattern when the DMW (b4, E1-RPLC-indirect  
register - 20~3FH) of the corresponding timeslot is logic 1. (The milliwatt  
pattern is selectable between A-law and µ-law by the DMWALAW [b3,  
E1-RPLC-indirect register - 20~3FH]. Refer to Table - 8 & Table - 9.)  
- Selected by the PRGDSEL[2:0] (b7~5, E1-00CH), the test pattern  
from the PRBS Generator/Detector will replace the received data of one  
of the eight framers when the RXPATGEN (b2, E1-00CH) is 1. The test  
pattern can replace the received data in framed or unframed mode. The  
selection is made by the UNF_GEN (b1, E1-00CH). In unframed mode,  
all 32 timeslots are replaced and the per-timeslot configuration in the  
TEST (b7, E1-RPLC-indirect registers - 20~3FH) is ignored. In framed  
mode, the received data will only replace the timeslot configured by the  
TEST (b7, E1-RPLC-indirect registers - 20~3FH). Refer to the section of  
There is a maximum 2 ms delay between the transition of the  
COSS[n] (T1/J1-041H and T1/J1-042H and T1/J1-043H) and the updat-  
ing of the A, B, C, D code in the corresponding indirect registers (b3~0,  
33  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Table - 8. A-Law Digital Milliwatt Pattern  
Table - 9. u-Law Digital Milliwatt Pattern  
Bit 0 Bit 1  
Bit 2  
Bit 3  
Bit 4  
Bit 5  
Bit 6 Bit 7  
Bit 0 Bit 1  
Bit 2  
Bit 3  
Bit 4  
Bit 5  
Bit 6  
Bit 7  
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
PRBS GENERATOR / DETECTOR (PRGD) for details.  
19~30H) when the DTRKC (b6, T1/J1-RPLC-indirect registers - 01~18H)  
- Invert the most significant bit, the even bits and/or odd bits that will of the corresponding channel is logic 1. (When it is out of SF/ESF syn-  
be output on the RSDn pin when the SIGNINV and the RINV[1:0] (b2~0, chronization, the value in the DTRK[7:0] (b7~0, T1/J1-RPLC-indirect  
E1-RPLC-indirect registers - 20~3FH) of the corresponding timeslot is registers - 19~30H) can replace the data automatically if the AUTOOOF  
set.  
(The above methods are arranged from highest to lowest in priority.)  
(b1, T1/J1-000H) is set. Or, when the RED alarm is declared, the value  
in the DTRK[7:0] (b7~0, T1/J1-RPLC-indirect registers - 19~30H) can re-  
- Replace the signaling that will be output on the RSSIGn pin with the place the data automatically if the AUTORED (b2, T1/J1-000H) is set.  
value in the A, B, C, D (b3~0, E1-RPLC-indirect registers - 61~7FH) These two kinds of data replacements can be executed even if the  
when the STRKC (b5, E1-RPLC-indirect registers - 20~3FH) of the cor- PCCE (b0, T1/J1-050H) is disabled and they replace all the channels.)  
responding timeslot allows.  
- Replace the data that will be output on the RSDn/MRSD pin with  
The data and signaling of all timeslots can be replaced with the set- the milliwatt pattern when the DMW (b5, T1/J1-RPLC-indirect register -  
ting in the DTRK[7:0] (b7~0, E1-RPLC-indirect registers - 40~5FH) and 01~18H) of the corresponding channel allows. (The milliwatt is µ-law.  
the A, B, C, D (b3~0, E1-RPLC-indirect registers - 61~7FH) respectively Refer to Table - 9.)  
when the RXMTKC (b0, E1-001H) is set. To enable this function, PCCE  
(b0, E1-05CH) must be set to 1.  
- Selected by the PRGDSEL[2:0] (b7~5, T1/J1-00FH), the test pat-  
tern from the PRBS Generator/Detector will replace the received data of  
Addressed by the A[6:0] (b6~0, E1-05EH), the data read from or writ- one of the eight framers when the RXPATGEN (b2, T1/J1-00FH) is 1.  
ten into the indirect registers are in the D[7:0] (b7~0, E1-05FH). The The test pattern can replace the received data in framed or unframed  
read or write operation is determined by the R/WB (b7, E1-05EH). The mode. The selection is made by the UNF_GEN (b1, T1/J1-00FH). In  
indirect registers have a read/write cycle. Before the read/write operation unframed mode, all the 24 channels and the F-bit are replaced and the  
is completed, the BUSY (b7, E1-05DH) will be set. New operations on per-channel configuration in the TEST (b3, T1/J1-RPLC-indirect regis-  
the indirect registers can only be implemented when the BUSY (b7, E1- ters - 01~18H) is ignored. In framed mode, the received data will only be  
05DH) is cleared. The read/write cycle is 490ns.  
replaced on the channel specified by the TEST (b3, T1/J1-RPLC-indirect  
registers - 01~18H). Fractional T1/J1 signal can also be replaced in the  
specified channel when the Nx56k_GEN (b4, T1/J1-00FH) is set. Refer  
3.10.2 T1 / J1 MODE  
To enable the test for the received data stream, the PCCE (b0, T1/ to the section of PRBS GENERATOR / DETECTOR (PRGD) for details.  
J1-050H) must be set to activate the setting in the indirect registers - Invert the most significant bit and/or the other bits in a channel that  
(from 01H to 48H). The following methods can be used for test on a per- will be output on the RSDn/MRSD pin when the SIGNINV and the IN-  
channel basis: VERT (b4 & b7, T1/J1-RPLC-indirect registers - 01~18H) of the corre-  
- Selected by the PRGDSEL[2:0] (b7~5, T1/J1-00FH), the received sponding channel are set.  
data of one of the eight framers will be extracted to the PRBS Genera-  
- Fix the signaling bit with the value in the POL (b0, T1/J1-RPLC-indi-  
tor/Detector when the RXPATGEN (b2, T1/J1-00FH) is 0. The received rect registers - 01~18H) when the FIX (b1, T1/J1-RPLC-indirect registers  
data can be extracted in framed or unframed mode. The selection is - 01~18H) of the corresponding channel is logic 1.  
made by the UNF_DET (b0, T1/J1-00FH). In unframed mode, all the 24  
channels and the F-bit are extracted and the per-channel configuration  
(The above methods are arranged from highest to lowest in priority.)  
- Replace the signaling that will be output on the RSSIGn/MRSSIG  
in the TEST (b3, T1/J1-RPLC-indirect registers - 01~18H) is ignored. In pin with the value in the A, B, C, D (b3~0, T1/J1-RPLC-indirect registers -  
framed mode, the received data will only be extracted on the channel 31~48H) when the STRKC (b7, T1/J1-RPLC-indirect registers - 31~48H)  
specified by the TEST (b3, T1/J1-RPLC-indirect registers - 01~18H). of the corresponding channel is logic 1.  
Fractional T1/J1 signal can also be extracted in the specified channel  
when the Nx56k_DET (b3, T1/J1-00FH) is set. Refer to the section of ting in the DTRK[7:0] (b7~0, T1/J1-RPLC-indirect registers - 19~30H)  
PRBS GENERATOR / DETECTOR (PRGD) for details. and the A, B, C, D (b3~0, T1/J1-RPLC-indirect registers - 31~48H) re-  
The data and signaling of all channels can be replaced with the set-  
- Replace the data that will be output on the RSDn/MRSD pin with spectively when the IMTKC (b0, T1/J1-001H) is set. To enable this func-  
the value in the DTRK[7:0] (b7~0, T1/J1-RPLC-indirect registers - tion, the PCCE (b0, T1/J1-050H) must be set to 1.  
34  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Addressed by the A[6:0] (b6~0, T1/J1-052H), the data read from or  
In the Non-multiplexed Mode, if the timing signal for clocking data on  
written into the indirect registers are in the D[7:0] (b7~0, T1/J1-053H). RSDn pin is provided by the system side and shared by all eight  
The read or write operation is determined by the R/WB (b7, T1/J1- framers, the Receive System Interface should be set in Receive Clock  
052H). Before the read/write operation is completed, the BUSY (b7, T1/ Slave mode. If the timing signal for clocking data on each RSDn pin is  
J1-051H) will be set. New operations on the indirect registers can only received from each line side, the Receive System Interface should be  
be implemented when the BUSY (b7, T1/J1-051H) is cleared. The read/ set in Receive Clock Master mode.  
write cycle is 650ns.  
In the Receive Clock Slave mode, if the multi-function pin RSCKn/  
RSSIGn is used to output a reference clock, the Receive System  
Interface is in Receive Clock Slave RSCK Reference Mode. If the  
RSCKn/RSSIGn pin is used to output the extracted signaling bits, the  
Receive System Interface is in Receive Clock Slave External Signaling  
mode.  
In the Receive Clock Master mode, if the data in all 32 timeslots in  
an E1 basic frame is clocked out by the RSCKn, the Receive System  
Interface is in Receive Clock Master Full E1 mode. If the data in only  
some of the timeslots in an E1 frame are clocked out by the RSCKn,  
then the Receive System Interface is in Receive Clock Master  
Fractional E1 (with F-bit) Mode.  
3.11 RECEIVE SYSTEM INTERFACE (RESI)  
The Receive System Interface determines how to output the received  
data to the system back-plane. The data from the eight framers can be  
aligned with each other or be output independently. The timing clocks  
and framing pulses can be provided by the system back-plane common  
to eight framers, or obtained from the far end of the individual eight fram-  
ers. The Receive System Interface supports various configurations to  
meet various requirements in different applications.  
3.11.1 E1 MODE  
Table - 10 summarizes the receive system interface in different  
operation modes. To set the receive system interface of each framer  
into various operation modes, the registers must be configured as Table  
- 11.  
In E1 mode, the Receive System Interface can be set in Non-  
multiplexed Mode or Multiplexed Mode. In Non-multiplexed Mode, the  
RSDn pin is used to output the received data from each framer at the  
bit rate of 2.048 Mb/s. While in the Multiplexed Mode, the received data  
from the eight framers are byte interleaved to form two high speed data  
streams and output on the MRSD1 and MRSD2 pins at the bit rate of  
8.192 Mb/s.  
Table - 10. E1 Mode Receive System Interface in Different Operation Modes  
Operation Mode  
Clock Slave  
Mode  
Data Pin Clock Pin  
Framing Pin  
RSCFS & RSFSn *  
RSCFS & RSFSn *  
RSFSn  
Signaling Pin Reference Clock  
Non-  
RSCK Reference  
External Signaling  
Full E1  
RSDn  
RSDn  
RSDn  
RSDn  
MRSD  
RSCCK  
RSCCK  
RSCKn  
RSCKn  
No  
RSSIGn  
No  
RSCKn  
No  
Multiplexed  
Mode  
Clock Master  
Mode  
No  
Fractional E1 (with F-bit)  
RSFSn  
No  
No  
Multiplexed Mode  
MRSCCK MRSCFS & MRSFS *  
MRSSIG  
No  
Note:  
* In Receive Clock Slave mode and Receive Multiplexed mode, there are two framing signals. In Receive Clock Slave mode, the framing pulses on  
RSCFS can be ignored for some framers by setting the FPMODE (b5, E1-011H) to 0. However, in Receive Multiplexed mode, when the FPMODE (b5,  
E1-011H) of any of the eight framers is configured as logic 1, all the others are taken as logic 1. Only when all the FPMODE (b5, E1-011H) of the eight  
framers are configured as logic 0, the frame pulses on MRSCFS can be ignored. That is, the FPMODE (b5, E1-011H) should be configured to the  
same value in Receive Multiplexed mode.  
Table - 11. Operation Mode Selection in E1 Receive Path  
RATE[1:0]  
(b1~0, E1-010H)  
RSCKSLV  
RSSIG_EN  
FRACTN[1:0]  
Operation Mode  
(b5, E1-010H) (b6, E1-001H) (b7~6, E1-010H)  
0
1
-
-
00  
10  
11  
-
Receive Clock Slave RSCK Reference  
Receive Clock Slave External Signaling  
Receive Clock Master Full E1  
1
01  
0
1
-
Receive Clock Master Fractional E1  
Receive Clock Master Fractional E1 with F-bit  
Receive Multiplexed  
11 (All the eight framers should be set)  
1
35  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
3.11.1.1 Receive Clock Slave Mode  
3.11.1.1.1  
Receive Clock Slave RSCK Reference Mode  
In the Receive Clock Slave Mode, the Receive Side System  
In this mode (refer to Figure - 7), the data on the system interface is  
Common Clock (RSCCK) is provided by the system side. It is used as a clocked by the RSCCK. The active edge of the RSCCK to sample the  
common timing clock for all eight framers. The speed of the RSCCK pulse on the RSCFS or to update the data on the RSDn and RSFSn  
can be selected by the CMS (b2, E1-010H) to be the same as the pins is determined by the following bits in the registers (refer to Table -  
received data (2.048MHz), or double of the received data (4.096 MHz). 12).  
The CMS (b2, E1-010H) of the eight framers should be set to the same  
value. If the speed of the RSCCK is double that of the received data  
stream, there will be two active edges in one bit duration. In this case,  
the RSD_RSCFS_EDGE (b5, E1-014H) determines the active edge to  
update the signal on the RSDn, RSSIGn and RSFSn pins; however, the  
pulse on the RSCFS (if exists) is always samples on its first active edge.  
In the Receive Clock Slave Mode, the Receive Side System  
Common Frame Pulse (RSCFS) is used as a common framing signal to  
align the data streams for all eight framers. The RSCFS asserts on  
each Basic Frame and its valid polarity is configured by the FPINV (b6,  
E1-011H). The framing signals on RSCFS can also be ignored by  
setting the FPMODE (b5, E1-011H) to 0.  
Table - 12. Active Edge Selection of RSCCK (in E1 Receive Clock  
Slave RSCK Reference Mode)  
Bit Determining the Active Edge of the RSCCK  
RSCFS  
FE (b3, E1-010H)  
RSFSn  
RSDn  
DE (b4, E1-010H)  
Note: If the setting of the FE (b3, E1-010H) and DE (b4, E1-010H) is  
different, the RSFSn will be one clock edge ahead of RSDn.  
The FE (b3, E1-010H) of the eight framers should be set to the same  
value to ensure the RSCFS for the eight framers is sampled on the same  
active edge.  
In the Receive Clock Slave Mode, the bit rate on the RSDn pin is  
2.048Mb/s.  
In the Receive Clock Slave Mode, the Receive Side System Frame  
Pulse (RSFSn) can be configured by the PERTS_RSFS (b3, E1-00EH)  
and REF_MRSFS (b2, E1-00EH) to output all zeros, to indicate the  
frame position or to output the same pulse as the RSCFS. When it is  
defined to indicate the frame position, it can indicate the first bit of a  
Basic Frame, Signaling Multi-frame, CRC-Multiframe, or both the  
Signaling and CRC-multiframe. This selection is made by the ROHM,  
BRXSMFP, BRXCMFP, ALTIFP (b3, b2, b1, b0, E1-011H). When the  
RSFSn is for framing pulse indication, the valid polarity of it is  
configured by the FPINV (b6, E1-011H). In this case, if the FPMODE  
(b5, E1-011H) is low, the RSFSn can only indicate the Basic Frame no  
matter what the setting in the ROHM, BRXSMFP, BRXCMFP, ALTIFP  
(b3, b2, b1, b0, E1-011H).  
Note:  
There is a special case when the CMS (b2, E1-010H) is logic 1 and  
the DE (b4, E1-010H) is equal to FE (b3, E1-010H). The  
RSD_RSCFS_EDGE (b5, E1-014H) is invalid and the signal on the RSDn  
and the RSFSn pins are updated on the first active edge of RSCCK.  
Figure - 8 & 9 show the functional timing examples. Bit 1 of each  
timeslot is the first bit to be output.  
Besides all the common functions described in the Receive Clock  
Slave mode, the special feature in this mode is that the multi-functional  
pin RSCKn/RSSIGn is used as RSCKn to output a reference clock. The  
RSCKn can be selected by the RSCKSEL (b5, E1-001H) to output a jitter  
attenuated 2.048MHz (i.e., smoothed LRCKn) or 8KHz clock (smoothed  
LRCKn divided by 256).  
The Receive Clock Slave Mode includes two sub-modes: Receive  
Clock Slave RSCK Reference Mode and Receive Clock Slave External  
Signaling Mode.  
LRD[1:8]  
RSCCK  
FIFO  
Frame  
Processor  
RSCFS *  
LRCK[1:8]  
DPLL  
Elastic  
RSD[1:8] *  
Receive  
System  
Interface  
Store  
RSFS[1:8] *  
Divider  
8kHz  
RSCK[1:8]  
RECEIVER  
Note: * RSCFS, RSD, RSFS are timed to RSCCK  
Figure - 7. Receive Clock Slave RSCK Reference Mode  
36  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
The CMS (b2, E1-010H) is logic 0, i.e., the backplane clock rate is 2.048Mbit/s.  
The DE (b4, E1-010H) is logic 0 and the FE (b3, E1-010H) is logic 0. The timeslot offset and the bit offset enable are both 0:  
RSCFS  
RSCCK  
RSFSn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
RSDn  
TS31  
TS0  
TS1  
(The RSCKn is selected by the RSCKSEL (b5, E1-001H) to output a jitter attenuated 2.048MHz (i.e., smoothed LRCKn) or 8KHz  
clock (smoothed LRCKn divided by 256).)  
Figure - 8. E1 Receive Clock Slave RSCK Reference Mode - Functional Timing Example 1  
The CMS (b2, E1-010H) is logic 1, i.e., the backplane clock rate is 4.096Mbit/s.  
The DE (b4, E1-010H) is logic 0 and the FE (b3, E1-010H) is logic 1.  
RSCFS  
RSCCK  
RSFSn  
When the RSD_RSCFS_EDGE (b5, E1-014H) is logic 1:  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
RSDn  
TS31  
TS0  
TS1  
When the RSD_RSCFS_EDGE (b5, E1-014H) is logic 0:  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
RSDn  
TS31  
TS0  
TS1  
(The RSCKn is selected by the RSCKSEL (b5, E1-001H) to output a jitter attenuated 2.048MHz (i.e., smoothed LRCKn) or 8KHz  
clock (smoothed LRCKn divided by 256).)  
Figure - 9. E1 Receive Clock Slave RSCK Reference Mode - Functional Timing Example 2  
37  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
3.11.1.1.2  
Receive Clock Slave External Signaling Mode  
Table - 13. Active Edge Selection of RSCCK (in E1 Receive Clock  
Slave External Signaling Mode)  
In this mode (refer to Figure - 10), the data on the system interface is  
clocked by the RSCCK. The active edge of the RSCCK used to sample  
the pulse on the RSCFS or to update the data on the RSDn, RSFSn and  
RSSIGn is determined by the following bits in the registers (refer to Ta-  
ble - 13).  
Figure - 11 & 12 show the functional timing examples. Bit 1 of each  
timeslot is the first bit to be output.  
Bit Determining the Active Edge of the RSCCK  
RSCFS  
FE (b3, E1-010H)  
RSFSn  
RSDn  
DE (b4, E1-010H)  
RSSIGn  
Besides all the common functions described in the Receive Clock  
Slave mode, the special feature in this mode is that the multi-functional  
pin RSCKn/RSSIGn is used as RSSIGn to output the extracted signaling  
bits. The extracted signaling bits are timeslot aligned with the data on the  
RSDn pin (refer to Figure - 5).  
In the Out of Signaling Multi-Frame condition, the output signaling  
bits ABCD on the RSSIGn pin can be forced to be all ones if the  
OOSMFAIS (b2, E1-001H) is set to 1.  
Note: If the setting of the FE (b3, E1-010H) and DE (b4, E1-010H) is  
different, the RSFSn will be one clock edge ahead of RSDn.  
The FE (b3, E1-010H) of the eight framers should be set to the same  
value to ensure the RSCFS for the eight framers is sampled on the same  
active edge.  
There is a special case when the CMS (b2, E1-010H) is logic 1 and  
the DE (b4, E1-010H) is equal to FE (b3, E1-010H). The  
RSD_RSCFS_EDGE (b5, E1-014H) is invalid and the signal on the RSDn,  
RSSIGn and RSFSn pins are updated on the first active edge of RSCCK.  
RSCCK  
RSCFS *  
LRD[1:8]  
FIFO  
RSD[1:8] *  
Frame  
Processor  
Receive  
RSFS[1:8] *  
LRCK[1:8]  
System  
DPLL  
RSSIG[1:8] *  
Elastic  
Store  
Interface  
RECEIVER  
Note: * RSCFS, RSD, RSSIG, RSFS are timed to RSCCK  
Figure - 10. Receive Clock Slave External Signaling Mode  
The CMS (b2, E1-010H) is logic 0, i.e., the bankplane rate is 2.048Mbit/s. The DE (b4, E1-010H) is logic  
1 and the FE (b3, E1-010H) is logic 0. The timeslot offset and the bit offset enable are both 0:  
RSCFS  
RSCCK  
RSFSn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
RSDn  
TS31  
A
TS0  
X
TS1  
X
RSSIGn  
X
X
X
X
B
C
D
P
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
A
B
(The 'X' represents the filled bits and has no meaning. The 'P' represents the Parity bit..)  
Figure - 11. E1 Receive Clock Slave External Signaling Mode - Functional Timing Example 1  
38  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
The CMS (b2, E1-010H) is logic 1, i.e., the bankplane rate is 4.096Mbit/s.  
The DE (b4, E1-010H) is logic 1 and the FE (b3, E1-010H) is logic 1. * The timeslot offset and the bit offset enable are both 0:  
RSCFS  
RSCCK  
RSFSn  
1
2
3
4
5
TS31  
A
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
TS0  
X
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
TS1  
X
5
6
RSDn  
X
X
X
X
B
C
D
P
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
A
B
RSSIGn  
(The 'X' represent the filled bits and has no meaning. The 'P' represents the Parity bit..)  
Note:  
* It is a special case when the CMS (b2, E1-010H) is logic 1 and the DE (b4, E1-010H) is equal to FE (b3, E1-010H). The signal on the RSDn,  
RSSIGn and RSFSn are updated on the first active edge of RSCCK.  
Figure - 12. E1 Receive Clock Slave External Signaling Mode - Functional Timing Example 2  
3.11.1.2 Receive Clock Master Mode  
Table - 14. Active Edge Selection of RSCK (in E1 Receive Clock  
In the Receive Clock Master mode, each framer uses its own clock Master Mode)  
signal on RSCKn pin and framing signal on RSFSn pin to output the  
data on each RSDn pin. As the common framing signal RSCFS is not  
used, the FPMODE bit (b5, E1-011H) must be set to 0.  
the Bit Determining the Active Edge of the RSCKn  
FE (b3, E1-010H)  
RSFSn  
In the Receive Clock Master Mode, the bit rate on the RSDn pin is  
2.048Mb/s.  
RSDn  
DE (b4, E1-010H)  
Note: If the setting in the FE (b3, E1-010H) and DE (b4, E1-010H) is  
In the Receive Clock Master Mode, the RSFSn can be configured by  
the PERTS_RSFS (b3, E1-00EH) and REF_MRSFS (b2, E1-00EH) to  
output all zeros, to indicate the frame position or to output the same  
pulse as the RSCFS. When it is defined to indicate the frame position, it  
can indicate the first bit of a Basic Frame, Signaling Multi-frame, CRC-  
Multiframe, or both the Signaling and CRC-multiframe. This selection is  
made by the ROHM, BRXSMFP, BRXCMFP, ALTIFP (b3, b2, b1, b0,  
E1-011H). When the RSFSn is used for framing pulse indication, the  
valid polarity of it is configured by the FPINV (b6, E1-011H). In this  
case, if the FPMODE (b5, E1-011H) is low, the RSFSn can only  
indicate the Basic Frame no matter what the setting in the ROHM,  
BRXSMFP, BRXCMFP, ALTIFP (b3, b2, b1, b0, E1-011H).  
different, the RSFSn will be one clock edge ahead of RSDn.  
3.11.1.2.1  
Receive Clock Master Full E1 Mode  
Besides all the common functions described in the Receive Clock  
Master mode, the special feature in this mode (refer to Figure - 13) is  
that the RSCKn is a standard 2.048MHz clock, and the data in all 32  
timeslots in a standard E1 frame is clocked out by the RSCKn.  
Figure - 14 shows the functional timing examples. Bit 1 of each  
timeslot is the first bit to be output.  
In the Receive Clock Master Mode, the data on the system interface  
is clocked by the RSCKn. The active edge of the RSCKn used to update  
the data on the RSDn and RSFSn is determined by the DE (b4, E1-  
010H) and the FE (b3, E1-010H) respectively as shown in Table - 14.  
The Receive Clock Master Mode includes two sub-modes: Receive  
Clock Master Full E1 Mode and Receive Clock Master Fractional E1  
(with F-bit) Mode.  
39  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
RSD[1:8] *  
LRD[1:8]  
Receive  
System  
Interface  
FIFO  
DPLL  
Frame  
Processor  
RSFS[1:8] *  
LRCK[1:8]  
RSCK[1:8]  
RECEIVER  
Note: * RSD, RSFS are timed to RSCK  
Figure - 13. Receive Clock Master Full E1 or T1/J1 Mode  
RSCK is 2.048M:  
RSCKn  
When the DE (b4, E1-010H) is logic 0 and the FE (b3, E1-010H) is logic 0:  
RSFSn  
RSDn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
TS31  
TS0  
TS1  
When the DE (b4, E1-010H) is logic 1 and the FE (b3, E1-010H) is logic 0:  
RSFSn  
RSDn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
TS31  
TS0  
TS1  
When the DE (b4, E1-010H) is logic 0 and the FE (b3, E1-010H) is logic 1:  
RSFSn  
RSDn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
TS31  
TS0  
TS1  
When the DE (b4, E1-010H) is logic 1 and the FE (b3, E1-010H) is logic 1:  
RSFSn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
RSDn  
TS31  
TS0  
TS1  
Figure - 14. E1 Receive Clock Master Full E1 Mode - Functional Timing Example  
40  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
3.11.1.2.2 Receive Clock Master Fractional E1 (with F-bit) Mode  
Table - 15. Active Edge Selection of MRSCCK (in E1 Receive  
Besides all the common functions described in the Receive Clock Multiplexed Mode)  
Master mode, the special feature in this mode (refer to Figure - 15) is  
that the RSCKn is a gapped 2.048MHz clock (no clock signal during the  
selected timeslot).  
Bit Determining the Active Edge of the MRSCCK  
MRSCFS  
MRSFS  
MRSD  
FE (b3, E1-010H)  
DE (b4, E1-010H)  
In the Receive Clock Master Fractional E1 mode, the RSCKn is  
gapped during those timeslots with their DTRKC/NxTS (b6, E1-RPLC-in-  
direct register - 20~3FH) in Receive Payload Control are logic 1. It  
clocks out during those timeslots with their DTRKC/NxTS_IDLE (b6, E1-  
RPLC-indirect register - 20~3FH) set to logic 0. The data in the corre-  
sponding gapped timeslot is a don’t-care. Figure - 16 shows the func-  
tional timing examples. Bit 1 of each timeslot is the first bit to be output.  
The Receive Clock Master Fractional E1 with F-bit mode supports  
ITU recommendation G.802 where an E1 clock is output as a 193-bit T1  
clock. In this mode, the RSCKn that starts from the 2nd bit of TS26 and  
ends at the last bit of the same Basic Frame are gapped, and the TS16  
is also gapped. Thus, the DTRKC/NxTS (b6, E1-RPLC-indirect register -  
20~3FH) of the timeslots of which the clock are gapped are invalid. The  
gapping of the remaining timeslots is still determined by the DTRKC/  
NxTS (b6, E1-RPLC-indirect register - 20~3FH), and the data in the cor-  
responding gapped timeslot is a don't-care.  
MRSSIG  
Note: if the setting in the FE (b3, E1-010H) and DE (b4, E1-010H) is  
different, the MRSFS will be one clock edge ahead of MRSD.  
The FE (b3, E1-010H) and DE (b4, E1-010H) of all eight framers  
should be configured to the same value.  
There is a special case when the CMS (b2, E1-010H) is logic 1 and the  
DE (b4, E1-010H) is equal to FE (b3, E1-010H). The RSD_RSCFS_EDGE  
(b5, E1-014H) is invalid and the signal on the MRSD, MRSSIG and MRSFS  
pins are updated on the first active edge of MRSCCK.  
bit rate of the received data stream (16.384 Mb/s). If the frequency of  
the RSCCK is double the bit rate of the received data stream, there will  
be two active edges in one bit time. In this case, the  
RSD_RSCFS_EDGE (b5, E1-014H) determines the active edge to  
update the signal on the MRSD, MRSSIG and MRSFS pin; however,  
the pulse on the MRSCFS (if it exists) is always samples on its first  
active edge. However, if the CMS (b2, E1-010H) or the  
RSD_RSCFS_EDGE (b5, E1-014H) of any of the eight framers is  
configured as logic 1, all the others are taken as logic 1. That is, the  
CMS (b2, E1-010H) and the RSD_RSCFS_EDGE (b5, E1-014H) of the  
eight framers should be configured to the same value in the Receive  
Multiplexed mode.  
In the Receive Multiplexed mode, the Multiplexed Receive Side  
System Common Frame Pulse (MRSCFS) is used as a common  
framing signal to align the data streams on the two multiplexed buses.  
The MRSCFS asserts on each first bit of Basic Frame of the selected  
first framer. The valid polarity of the MRSCFS is configured by the  
FPINV (b6, E1-011H). The framing signals on MRSCFS can also be  
ignored by setting the FPMODE (b5, E1-011H) to 0. The FPINV (b6, E1-  
011H) and the FPMODE (b5, E1-011H) of the eight framers should be  
set to the same value.  
3.11.1.3 Receive Multiplexed Mode  
In this mode (refer to Figure - 17), two multiplexed buses are used to  
receive the data from all eight framers. The data from up to four framers  
is byte-interleaved and output on one of the two multiplexed buses. The  
multiplexed bus is selected by the MRBS (b4, E1-001H). When the data  
from four framers are output on one multiplexed bus, the sequence of  
data is arranged by setting the timeslot offset TSOFF[6:0] (b6~0, E1-  
013H). The data from different framers on one multiplexed bus must be  
shifted by a different timeslot offset to avoid data mixing. Then the re-  
ceived data of each framer can be controlled by the MRBC (b3, E1-  
001H) to output to the selected multiplexed bus or not.  
In the Receive Multiplexed mode, the data on the system interface  
are clocked by the MRSCCK. The active edge of the MRSCCK to sam-  
ple the pulse on the MRSCFS and to update the data on the MRSD,  
MRSFS and MRSSIG are determined by the following bits in the regis-  
ters (refer to Table - 15).  
In the Receive Multiplexed mode, the Multiplexed Receive Side  
System Common Clock (MRSCCK) is provided by the system side. It is  
used as a common timing clock for all eight framers. The frequency of  
the RSCCK can be selected by the CMS (b2, E1-010H) to be the same  
as the bit rate of the received data stream (8.192Mb/s), or double the  
In the Receive Multiplexed mode, the bit rate on the MRSD pin is  
8.192Mb/s.  
In the Receive Multiplexed mode, the MRSFS can be configured by  
the PERTS_RSFS (b3, E1-00EH) and REF_MRSFS (b2, E1-00EH) to  
output all zeros, to indicate the frame position or to output the same  
RSD[1:8] *  
Receive  
LRD[1:8]  
FIFO  
RSFS[1:8] *  
Frame  
Processor  
System  
Interface  
LRCK[1:8]  
DPLL  
RSCK[1:8]  
RECEIVER  
Note: * RSD, RSFS are timed to gapped RSCK  
Figure - 15. Receive Clock Master Fractional E1 or T1/J1 Mode  
41  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
RSCK is 2.048M. In this example, RSCK is supposed to be held in an inactive state during TS0.  
When the DE (b4, E1-010H) is logic 0 and the FE (b3, E1-010H) is logic 0:  
RSCKn  
RSFSn  
RSDn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Don't Care  
1
2
3
4
5
6
TS31  
TS1  
When the DE (b4, E1-010H) is logic 1 and the FE (b3, E1-010H) is logic 0:  
RSCKn  
RSFSn  
RSDn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Don't Care  
1
2
3
4
5
6
TS31  
TS1  
When the DE (b4, E1-010H) is logic 0 and the FE (b3, E1-010H) is logic 1:  
RSCKn  
RSFSn  
RSDn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
Don't Care  
TS31  
TS1  
When the DE (b4, E1-010H) is logic 1 and the FE (b3, E1-010H) is logic 1:  
RSCKn  
RSFSn  
RSDn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Don't Care  
1
2
3
4
5
6
TS31  
TS1  
Figure - 16. E1 Receive Clock Master Fractional E1 Mode - Functional Timing Example  
42  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
The Other Four of the Framer #1~#8  
MRSCCK  
MRSCFS *  
Receive  
FIFO  
Frame  
Any Four of the Framer #1~#8  
MRSD[1:2] *  
MRSFS[1:2] *  
MRSSIG[1:2] *  
System  
Interface  
LRD[1:8]  
FIFO  
Frame  
Processor  
LRCK[1:8]  
DPLL  
Elastic  
Store  
Note: * MRSCFS, MRSD, MRSFS, MRSSIG are timed to MRSCCK  
Figure - 17. Receive Multiplexed Mode  
the output signaling ABCD on the MRSSIG pin can be forced to be all  
ones if the OOSMFAIS (b2, E1-001H) is set.  
Figure - 18 & 19 show the functional timing examples. Bit 1 of each  
timeslot is the first bit to be output.  
pulse as the MRSCFS. The PERTS_RSFS (b3, E1-00EH) and  
REF_MRSFS (b2, E1-00EH) of the eight framers should be set to the  
same value. When it is defined to indicate the frame position, it can only  
indicate the first bit of a Basic Frame of the selected first framer no  
matter what is set in the ROHM, BRXSMFP, BRXCMFP, ALTIFP (b3, b2,  
b1, b0, E1-011H). When the MRSFS is for framing pulse indication, the  
valid polarity of it is configured by the FPINV (b6, E1-011H). The FPINV  
(b6, E1-011H) of the eight framers should be set to the same value.  
In the Receive Multiplexed mode, the MRSSIG outputs extracted  
signaling. The extracted signaling bits are timeslot aligned with the data  
outputted on the MRSD. In the Out of Signaling Multi-Frame condition,  
3.11.1.4 Parity Check & Polarity Fix  
In all the above modes except for the Receive Clock Slave Fractional  
E1 (with F-bit) mode, if the RPTYE (b6, E1-012H) is logic 1, parity check  
can be conducted over the bits in the previous Basic Frame and the re-  
sult is inserted into the first bit (MSB) of TS0 on RSDn/MRSD pin. The  
even parity or odd parity is selected by the RPTYP (b7, E1-012H) and  
The CMS (b2, E1-010H) is logic 0, i.e., the bankplane rate is 8.192Mbit/s.  
The DE (b4, E1-010H) is logic 1 and the FE (b3, E1-010H) is logic 0.  
In this example, Framer1 to Framer4 are supposed to be multiplexed to one multiplexed bus.  
MRSCFS  
MRSCCK  
When the TSOFF[6:0] of Framer1 are set to 7'b0000000, the TSOFF[6:0] of Framer2 are set to 7'b0000001, the TSOFF[6:0] of Framer3 are set to 7'b0000010, the TSOFF[6:0] of Framer4 are set to 7'b0000011,  
the BOFF_EN of the four Framers are set to logic 0:  
MRSFS  
4
MRSD  
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Framer1_TS0  
Framer2_TS0  
Framer3_TS0  
Framer1_TS1  
Framer4_TS0  
X
X
X
A
B
C
X
X
X
A
B
C
X
X
X
A
B
C
X
X
X
A
B
C
X
X
X
A
B
C
C
D
X
D
X
D
X
D
X
D
X
D
MRSSIG  
(The 'X' represent the filled bits and has no meaning.)  
Figure - 18. E1 Receive Multiplexed Mode - Functional Timing Example 1  
43  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
The CMS (b2, E1-010H) is logic 1, i.e., the bankplane rate is 16.384Mbit/s.  
The DE (b4, E1-010H) is logic 0 and the FE (b3, E1-010H) is logic 0.  
In this example, Framer1 to Framer4 are supposed to be multiplexed to one multiplexed bus.  
MRSCFS  
MRSCCK  
When the TSOFF[6:0] of Framer1 are set to 7'b0000000, the TSOFF[6:0] of Framer2 are set to 7'b0000001, the TSOFF[6:0] of Framer3 are set to 7'b0000010, the TSOFF[6:0] of Framer4 are set to 7'b0000011,  
the BOFF_EN of the four Framers are set to logic 0:  
MRSFS  
MRSD  
4
3
6
7
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
5
6
7
8
1
2
4
5
8
Framer1_TS0  
Framer2_TS0  
Framer3_TS0  
Framer1_TS1  
Framer4_TS0  
MRSSIG  
X
X
X
A
B
C
X
X
X
A
B
C
X
X
X
A
B
C
X
X
X
A
B
C
X
X
X
A
B
C
C
D
X
D
X
D
X
D
X
D
X
D
(The 'X' represent the filled bits and has no meaning.)  
Figure - 19. E1 Receive Multiplexed Mode - Functional Timing Example 2  
whether the first bit of TS0 is calculated or not is determined by the 3.11.1.6 Output On RSDn/MRSD & RSSIGn/MRSSIG  
PTY_EXTD (b3, E1-012H). Alternatively this first bit of TS0 can be In all the five modes, the RSDn/MRSD and the RSSIGn/MRSSIG pin  
forced to be logic 0 or 1 by setting the value in the FIXPOL (b4, E1- can be configured by the TRI[1:0] (b1~0, E1-012H) of the corresponding  
012H), when the FIXF (b5, E1-012H) is set. The priority of the FIXF (b5, framer to be in high impedance state or to output the processed data  
E1-012H) is lower than the RPTYE (b6, E1-012H).  
stream.  
The data output on the RSDn/MRSSIG pin can also be forced to be  
all ones, and the signaling output on the RSSIGn/MRSSIG pin (if it ex-  
3.11.1.5 Offset  
In the above five modes, timeslot offset and/or bit offset can be ists) can be forced to be frozen at the current valid signaling when the  
configured. If the offset is configured, the offset between different opera- RAIS (b1, E1-007H) is set.  
tion modes is summarized in Table - 16. Bit offset is disabled when the  
CMS (b2, E1-010H) is logic 1.  
The timeslot offset is configured in the TSOFF[6:0] (b6~0, E1-013H).  
The TSOFF[6:0] (b6~0, E1-013H) give a binary representation.  
Enabled by the BOFF_EN (b3, E1-014H), the bit offset is configured  
in the BOFF[2:0] (b2~0, E1-014H). The bit offset follows the Concentra-  
tion Highway Interface (CHI) specification (refer to Table - 17 & 18).  
When the bit offset is between the RSCFS/MRSCFS and the start of the  
corresponding frame on the RSDn/MRSD, the CET (clock edge trans-  
mit) is counted from the active edge of the RSCFS/MRSCFS (refer to  
the example in Figure - 20). The pulse on the RSFSn/MRSFS and the  
signal on the RSSIGn/MRSSIG (if it exists) are aligned to the RSDn/  
MRSD. When the bit offset is between the RSFSn/MRSFS and the start  
of the corresponding frame on the RSDn/MRSD, the CET is counted  
from the active edge of the RSFSn/MRSFS (refer to the example in Fig-  
ure - 21). The signal on the RSSIGn/MRSSIG (if it exists) is aligned to  
the RSDn/MRSD.  
Note that it is a special case when the BRXSMFP and the ALTIFP  
(b2, b0, E1-011H) are both set to logical 1. In this case, there is bit off-  
set between the output on the RSFSn and RSDn. Refer to Table - 19 for  
the details.  
44  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Table - 16. Offset in Different Operation Modes  
Operation Mode  
FPMODE (b5, E1-011H)  
Offset  
The offset is between the RSCFS and the start of the corresponding frame on  
the RSDn (and RSSIGn).  
The offset is between the RSFSn and the start of the corresponding frame on  
the RSDn (and RSSIGn).  
1
0
Receive Clock Slave mode  
The offset is between the RSFSn and the start of the corresponding frame on  
the RSDn.  
The offset is between the MRSCFS and the start of the corresponding frame  
Receive Clock Master mode  
Receive Multiplexed mode  
0 (must be zero)  
1
(in any of the eight framers) on the MRSD and MRSSIG.  
The offset is between the MRSFS and the start of the corresponding frame on  
the MRSD and MRSSIG.  
0
Table - 17. Receive System Interface Bit Offset (FPMODE [b5, E1-011H] = 0)  
FE  
DE  
BOFF[2:0] (b2~0, E1-014H)  
(b3, E1-010H) (b4, E1-010H)  
000  
4
3
3
4
001  
6
5
5
6
010  
8
7
7
8
011  
10  
9
9
10  
100  
12  
11  
11  
12  
101  
14  
13  
13  
14  
110  
16  
15  
15  
16  
111  
18  
17  
17  
18  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
CET  
Table - 18. Receive System Interface Bit Offset (FPMODE [b5, E1-011H] = 1)  
FE  
DE  
BOFF[2:0] (b2~0, E1-014H)  
(b3, E1-010H) (b4, E1-010H)  
000  
2
1
1
2
001  
4
3
3
4
010  
6
5
5
6
011  
8
7
7
8
100  
10  
9
9
10  
101  
110  
111  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
12  
11  
11  
12  
14  
13  
13  
14  
16  
15  
15  
16  
CET  
Table - 19. Bit Offset Between RSFSn and RSDn When the BRXSMFP and the ALTIFP (b2, b0, E1-011H) are Both Set To Logical 1  
BOFF_EN  
(b3, E1-014H) (b5, E1-011H)  
FPMODE  
DE (b4, E1-010H) & FE (b3, E1-010H)  
Bit Offset Between the RSFSn and the RSDn  
Same  
Difference  
Same  
Difference  
Same  
1 bit offset. RSFSn is ahead.  
1.5 bit offset. RSFSn is ahead.  
1 bit offset. RSFSn is ahead.  
1.5 bit offset. RSFSn is ahead.  
0
1
X
1
0
CHI specification (Table – 17)  
Difference  
45  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
For example: when DE (b4, E1-010H) = 0, FE (b3, E1-010H) = 0  
starting edge  
(CET=0)  
1 2 3  
CET=4  
RSCFS  
RSCCK  
The bit offset is 0:  
RSDn  
2
3
4
5
6
8
2
3
4
5
6
8
2
3
4
1
7
1
7
1
TS31  
TS0  
TS2  
The bit offset is set as: BOFF_EN (b3, E1-014H) = 1, BOFF[2:0] (b2~0, E1-014H) = 000; i.e. the CET = 4:  
RSDn  
2
3
4
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
7
1
2
3
4
TS31  
TS0  
TS2  
Figure - 20. Receive Bit Offset - Between RSCFS & RSDn  
For example: when DE (b4, E1-010H) = 1, FE (b3, E1-010H) = 0  
starting edge  
1 2 CET=3  
(CET=0)  
RSFSn  
RSCCK/RSCKn  
The bit offset is 0:  
RSDn  
2
3
4
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
7
1
2
3
4
TS31  
TS0  
TS2  
The bit offset is set as: BOFF_EN (b3, E1-014H) = 1, BOFF[2:0] (b2~0, E1-014H) = 001; i.e. the CET = 3:  
RSDn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
TS31  
TS0  
TS2  
Figure - 21. Receive Bit Offset - Between RSFSn & RSDn  
46  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
3.11.2 T1 / J1 MODE  
Table - 20 summarizes the receive system interface in different  
In T1/J1 mode, the Receive System Interface can be set in Non- operating modes. To set the receive system interface of each framer  
multiplexed Mode or Multiplexed Mode. In Non-multiplexed Mode, the into various operating modes, the registers must be configured as Table  
RSDn pin is used to output the received data from each framer at the bit - 21.  
rate of 1.544 Mb/s or 2.048 Mb/s (T1/J1 mode E1 rate). While in the  
Multiplexed Mode, the received data from the eight framers are 3.11.2.1 Receive Clock Slave Mode  
converted to 2.048 Mb/s format and byte interleaved to form two high  
speed data streams and output on the MRSD1 and MRSD2 pins at the 1.544Mb/s. However, if the system clock rate is 2.048MHz, the received  
bit rate of 8.192 Mb/s. data stream (1.544 Mb/s) should be converted to the same rate as the  
In the Receive Clock Slave Mode, the bit rate on the RSDn pin is  
In the Non-multiplexed Mode, if the timing signal for clocking data system side, that is, to work in T1/J1 mode E1 rate. Thus, the  
on the RSDn pin is provided by the system side and shared by all eight RSCCK2M (b4, T1/J1-001H) and the RSCCK8M (b3, T1/J1-001H)  
framers, the Receive System Interface should be set in Receive Clock should be set to logic 1 and 0 respectiively. The conversion complies as  
Slave mode. If the timing signal for clocking data on each RSDn pin is follows: One dummy byte is inserted in the system side before 3 bytes of  
received from each line side, the Receive System Interface should be Frame N from the device are converted. This process repeats 8 times  
set in Receive Clock Master mode.  
and the conversion of Frame N of 1.544M bit/s data rate to 2.048M bit/s  
In the Receive Clock Slave mode, if the multi-function pin RSCKn/ data rate is completed. However, the F-bit of Frame N of the 1.544M bit/  
RSSIGn is used to output a reference clock, the Receive System s data rate is inserted as the 8th bit of the N of the 2.048M bit/s data rate  
Interface is in Receive Clock Slave RSCK Reference Mode. If the (refer to Figure - 22).  
RSCKn/RSSIGn pin is used to output the extracted signaling bits, the  
Receive System Interface is in Receive Clock Slave External Signaling Common Clock (RSCCK) is provided by the system side. It is used as a  
mode. common timing clock for all eight framers. The speed of the RSCCK  
In the Receive Clock Slave Mode, the Receive Side System  
The T1/J1 mode E1 rate, which means the system clock rate is can be 1.544MHz or 2.048MHz. When it is 2.048MHz, the RSCCK can  
2.048 MHz in T1/J1 mode, can only be supported in the Receive Clock be selected by the CMS (b4, T1/J1-078H) to be the same as the  
Slave mode.  
received data (2.048Mb/s), or double the received data (4.096 Mb/s).  
In the Receive Clock Master mode, if the data in all 24 channels of a The CMS (b4, T1/J1-078H) of the eight framers should be set to the  
T1/J1 basic frame is clocked out by the RSCKn signal, the Receive same value. If the speed of the RSCCK is double the received data  
System Interface is in Receive Clock Master Full T1/J1 mode. If the stream, there will be two active edges in one bit duration. In this case,  
data in only some timeslots of a T1/J1 frame is clocked out by the the RSD_RSCFS_EDGE (b5, T1/J1-078H) determines the active edge  
RSCKn, then the Receive System Interface is in Receive Clock Master to update the signal on the RSDn, RSSIGn and RSFSn pins; however,  
Fractional T1/J1 Mode.  
the pulse on the RSCFS is always sampled on its first active edge.  
Table - 20. T1/J1 Mode Receive System Interface in Different Operation Modes  
Operation Mode  
Clock Slave  
Mode  
Data Pin Clock Pin  
Framing Pin  
RSCFS/RSFSn  
RSCFS/RSFSn  
RSFSn  
Signaling Pin Reference Clock  
Non-  
RSCK Reference  
External Signaling  
Full T1/J1  
RSDn  
RSDn  
RSDn  
RSDn  
MRSD  
RSCCK  
RSCCK  
RSCKn  
No  
RSSIGn  
No  
RSCKn  
No  
Multiplexed  
Mode  
Clock Master  
Mode  
No  
Fractional T1/J1  
RSCKn  
RSFSn  
No  
No  
Multiplexed Mode  
MRSCCK  
MRSCFS/MRSFS  
MRSSIG  
No  
Table - 21. Operation Mode Selection in T1/J1 Receive Path  
RSCCK2M / RSCCK8M  
(b4, T1/J1-001H) / (b3, T1/J1-001H)  
IMODE[1:0]  
(b7~6, T1/J1-001H)  
Operation Mode  
10  
11  
01  
00  
11  
Receive Clock Slave RSCK Reference  
Receive Clock Slave External Signaling  
Receive Clock Master Full T1/J1  
Receive Clock Master Fractional T1/J1  
Receive Multiplexed  
00 / 10 *  
00  
01 (in any of the eight framers)  
Note:  
* When the RSCCK2M / RSCCK8M are ‘00’, the system clock rate is 1.544MHz.  
When the RSCCK2M / RSCCK8M are ‘10’, the system clock rate is 2.048MHz, i.e., T1/J1 mode E1 rate.  
47  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
1.544M bit/s  
2.048M bit/s  
F
CH1  
TS1  
CH2  
TS2  
CH3  
TS3  
CH4  
CH5  
TS5  
CH24  
TS31  
F
CH1  
TS0  
TS4  
TS6  
TS0  
TS1  
inserted the 8th bit  
inserted  
inserted  
the 8th bit  
Figure - 22. T1/J1 To E1 Format Conversion  
In the Receive Clock Slave Mode, the Receive Side System  
Common Frame Pulse (RSCFS) is used as a common framing signal to  
align the data stream for all eight framers. The RSCFS asserts on each  
F-bit and its valid polarity is configured by the FPINV (b6, T1/J1-078H).  
In the Receive Clock Slave Mode, the RSFSn can indicate each F-  
bit of SF/ESF, every second F-bit or the first F-bit of every 12 frames (in  
SF format) / every 24 frames (in ESF format). All the indications are  
selected by the RSFSP (b2, T1/J1-001H) and ALTIFP (b1, T1/J1-001H).  
The valid polarity of the RSFSn is configured by the FPINV (b6, T1/J1-  
078H).  
The Receive Clock Slave Mode includes two sub-modes: Receive  
Clock Slave RSCK Reference Mode and Receive Clock Slave External  
Signaling Mode. Note that if the receive system interface is configured  
to operate in T1/J1 mode E1 rate, framer 1, 3, 5, 7 must be configured  
in the same sub-mode and framer 2, 4, 6, 8 must be configured in the  
same sub-mode.  
pins is determined by the following bits in the registers (refer to Table -  
22).  
Table - 22. Active Edge Selection of RSCCK (in T1/J1 Receive Clock  
Slave RSCK Reference Mode)  
the Bit Determining the Active Edge of the RSCCK  
RSCFS  
RSFSn  
RSDn  
RSCFSFALL (b1, T1/J1-003H)  
RSCCKRISE (b0, T1/J1-003H)  
Note: The RSCFSFALL (b1, T1/J1-003H) of the eight framers should be set  
to the same value to ensure the RSCFS for the eight framers is sampled on  
the same active edge.  
It is a special case when the CMS (b4, T1/J1-078H) is logic 1 and the  
RSCFSFALL (b1, T1/J1-003H) is not equal to RSCCKRISE (b0, T1/J1-  
003H). The RSD_RSCFS_EDGE (b5, T1/J1-078H) is invalid and the signals  
on the RSDn and the RSFSn pins are updated on the first active edge of  
RSCCK.  
3.11.2.1.1  
Receive Clock Slave RSCK Reference Mode  
In this mode (refer to Figure - 7), the data on the system interface is  
clocked by the RSCCK. The active edge of the RSCCK to sample the  
data on the RSCFS pin or to update the data on the RSDn and RSFSn  
Figure - 23 to 25 show the functional timing examples. Bit 1 of each  
channel is the first bit to be output.  
The CMS (b4, T1/J1-078H) is logic 0 and the bankplane rate is 1.544Mbit/s.  
The RSCFSFALL (b1, T1/J1-003H) is logic 0 and the RSCCKRISE (b0, T1/J1-003H) is logic 0.  
The channel offset and the bit offset enable are both 0:  
RSCFS  
RSCCK  
RSFSn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
F
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
RSDn  
CH24  
CH1  
CH2  
(The RSCKn is selected by the RSCKSEL (b5, T1/J1-001H) to output a jitter attenuated 1.544MHz (i.e., smoothed LRCKn)  
or 8KHz clock (smoothed LRCKn divided by 193).)  
Figure - 23. T1/J1 Receive Clock Slave RSCK Reference Mode - Functional Timing Example 1  
48  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
The CMS (b4, T1/J1-078H) is logic 0 and the bankplane clock rate is 2.048Mbit/s.  
The RSCFSFALL (b1, T1/J1-003H) is logic 0 and the RSCCKRISE (b0, T1/J1-003H) is logic 1.  
The channel offset and the bit offset enable are both 0:  
RSCFS  
RSCCK  
RSFSn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
P
X
X
X
X
X
X
F
1
2
3
4
5
6
RSDn  
CH24  
DUMMY  
CH1  
(The 'X' represent the filled bits and has no meaning.)  
(The RSCKn is selected by the RSCKSEL (b5, T1/J1-001H) to output a jitter attenuated 1.544MHz (i.e., smoothed LRCKn)  
or 8KHz clock (smoothed LRCKn divided by 193).)  
Figure - 24. T1/J1 Receive Clock Slave RSCK Reference Mode - Functional Timing Example 2  
The CMS (b4, T1/J1-078H) is logic 1, i.e., the bankplane clock rate is 4.096Mbit/s.  
The RSCFSFALL (b1, T1/J1-003H) is logic 0 and the RSCCKRISE (b0, T1/J1-003H) is logic 1.  
When the channel offset and the bit offset enable are both 0:  
RSCFS  
RSCCK  
RSFSn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
P
X
X
X
X
X
X
F
1
2
3
4
5
6
RSDn  
CH24  
DUMMY  
CH1  
(The 'X' represents the filled bits and has no meaning.)  
(The RSCKn is selected by the RSCKSEL (b5, T1/J1-001H) to output a jitter attenuated 1.544MHz (i.e., smoothed LRCKn)  
or 8KHz clock (smoothed LRCKn divided by 193).)  
Figure - 25. T1/J1 Receive Clock Slave RSCK Reference Mode - Functional Timing Example 3  
49  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Besides all the common functions described in the Receive Clock  
Figure - 26 to 28 show the functional timing examples. Bit 1 of each  
Slave mode, the special feature in this mode is that the multi-functional channel is the first bit to be output.  
pin RSCKn/RSSIGn is used as RSCKn to output a reference clock. The  
Besides all the common functions described in the Receive Clock  
RSCKn can be selected by the RSCKSEL (b5, T1/J1-001H) to output a Slave mode, the special feature in this mode is that the multi-functional  
jitter attenuated 1.544MHz (i.e., smoothed LRCKn) or 8KHz clock pin RSCKn/RSSIGn is used as RSSIGn to output the extracted signaling  
(smoothed LRCKn divided by 193).  
bits. The extracted signaling bits are channel aligned with the data on  
the RSDn pin (refer to Figure - 6).  
3.11.2.1.2  
Receive Clock Slave External Signaling Mode  
In this mode (refer to Figure - 10), the data on the system interface is 3.11.2.2 Receive Clock Master Mode  
clocked by the RSCCK. The active edge of the RSCCK to sample the  
In the Receive Clock Master mode, each framer uses its own clock  
pulse on the RSCFS or to update the data on the RSDn, RSFSn and signal on RSCKn pin and framing signal on RSFSn pin to output the  
RSSIGn pins is determined by the following bits in the registers (refer to data on each RSDn pin.  
Table - 23).  
In the Receive Clock Master Mode, the bit rate on the RSDn pin is  
1.544Mb/s.  
In the Receive Clock Master Mode, the RSFSn can indicate each F-  
bit of SF/ESF, every second F-bit or the first F-bit of every 12 frames (in  
SF format) / every 24 frames (in ESF format). All the indications are  
selected by the RSFSP (b2, T1/J1-001H) and ALTIFP (b1, T1/J1-001H).  
The valid polarity of the RSFSn is configured by the FPINV (b6, T1/J1-  
078H).  
In the Receive Clock Master Mode, the data on the system interface  
is clocked by the RSCKn. The active edge of the RSCKn to update the  
data on the RSDn and RSFSn is determined by the RSCKRISE(b3, T1/  
J1-003H).  
Table - 23. Active Edge Selection of RSCCK (in T1/J1 Receive Clock  
Slave External Signaling Mode)  
the Bit Determining the Active Edge of the RSCCK  
RSCFS  
RSFSn  
RSDn  
RSCFSFALL (b1, T1/J1-003H)  
RSCCKRISE (b0, T1/J1-003H)  
RSSIGn  
Note: The RSCFSFALL (b1, T1/J1-003H) of the eight framers should be  
set to the same value to ensure the RSCFS for the eight framers is  
sampled on the same active edge.  
It is a special case when the CMS (b4, T1/J1-078H) is logic 1 and the  
RSCFSFALL (b1, T1/J1-003H) is not equal to RSCCKRISE (b0, T1/J1-  
003H). The RSD_RSCFS_EDGE (b5, T1/J1-078H) is invalid and the signal  
on the RSDn, RSSIGn and the RSFSn pins are updated on the first active  
edge of RSCCK.  
The Receive Clock Master Mode includes two sub-modes: Receive  
Clock Master Full T1/J1 Mode and Receive Clock Master Fractional T1/  
J1 Mode.  
The CMS (b4, T1/J1-078H) is logic 0 and the bankplane clock rate is 1.544Mbit/s.  
The RSCFSFALL (b1, T1/J1-003H) is logic 1 and the RSCCKRISE (b0, T1/J1-003H) is logic 0.  
The channel offset and the bit offset enable are both 0:  
RSCFS  
RSCCK  
RSFSn  
1
2
3
4
5
CH24  
A
6
7
8
F
X
1
2
3
4
CH1  
X
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
CH2  
X
4
5
RSDn  
RSSIGn  
X
X
X
X
B
C
D
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
A
(The 'X' represent the filled bits and has no meaning.)  
Figure - 26. T1/J1 Receive Clock Slave External Signaling Mode - Functional Timing Example 1  
50  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
The CMS (b4, T1/J1-078H) is logic 0 and the bankplane clock rate is 2.048Mbit/s.  
The RSCFSFALL (b1, T1/J1-003H) is logic 1 and the RSCCKRISE (b0, T1/J1-003H) is logic 1.  
The channel offset and the bit offset enable are both 0:  
RSCFS  
RSCCK  
RSFSn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
P
P
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
F
X
1
2
3
4
5
6
RSDn  
CH24  
A
DUMMY  
CH1  
X
RSSIGn  
X
X
X
X
B
C
D
X
X
X
X
X
A
B
(The 'X' represents the filled bits and has no meaning.)  
Figure - 27. T1/J1 Receive Clock Slave External Signaling Mode - Functional Timing Example 2  
The CMS (b4, T1/J1-078H) is logic 1, i.e., the bankplane clock rate is 4.096Mbit/s.  
The RSCFSFALL (b1, T1/J1-003H) is logic 1 and the RSCCKRISE (b0, T1/J1-003H) is logic 1.  
RSCFS  
RSCCK  
When the RSD_RSCFS_EDGE (b5, T1/J1-078H) is logic 1:  
RSFSn  
1
2
3
4
5
CH24  
A
6
7
8
P
P
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
F
X
1
2
3
4
CH1  
X
5
6
RSDn  
DUMMY  
RSSIGn  
X
X
X
X
B
C
D
X
X
X
X
X
A
B
When the RSD_RSCFS_EDGE (b5, T1/J1-078H) is logic 0:  
RSFSn  
RSDn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
P
P
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
F
X
1
2
3
4
5
6
CH24  
A
CH2  
X
DUMMY  
X
X
X
X
B
C
D
X
X
X
X
X
A
B
RSSIGn  
(The 'X' represents the filled bits and has no meaning.)  
Figure - 28. T1/J1 Receive Clock Slave External Signaling Mode - Functional Timing Example 3  
51  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
3.11.2.2.1  
Receive Clock Master Full T1/J1 Mode  
ceived data of each framer can be controlled by the MRBC (b6, T1/J1-  
Besides all the common functions described in the Receive Clock 003H) to output to the selected multiplexed bus or not.  
Master mode, the special feature in this mode (refer to Figure - 13) is  
In the Receive Multiplexed mode, the data on the system interface  
that the RSCKn is a standard 1.544MHz clock, and the data in all the 24 are clocked by the MRSCCK. The active edge of the MRSCCK to sam-  
channels in a standard T1/J1 frame is clocked out by the RSCKn.  
ple the pulse on the MRSCFS and to update the data on the MRSD,  
Figure - 29 shows the functional timing examples. Bit 1 of each chan- MRSFS and MRSSIG are determined by the following bits in the regis-  
nel is the first bit to be output.  
ters (refer to Table - 24).  
3.11.2.2.2  
Receive Clock Master Fractional T1/J1 Mode  
Table - 24. Active Edge Selection of MRSCCK (in T1/J1 Receive  
Multiplexed Mode)  
Besides all the common functions described in the Receive Clock  
Master mode, the special feature in this mode (refer to Figure - 15) is  
that the RSCKn is a gapped 1.544MHz clock (no clock signal during the  
selected channel).  
The RSCKn is gapped during those channels with their EXTRACT  
(b2, T1/J1-RPLC-indirect registers - 01~18H) in Receive Payload Con-  
trol are logic 0 and clocks out during those channels with their EX-  
TRACT (b2, T1/J1-RPLC-indirect registers - 01~18H) are logic 1. The  
data in the corresponding gapped channel is a don't care condition.  
Figure - 30 shows the functional timing examples. Bit 1 of each chan-  
nel is the first bit to be output.  
the Bit Determining the Active Edge of the MRSCCK  
MRSCFS  
MRSFS  
MRSD  
RSCFSFALL (b1, T1/J1-003H)  
RSCCKRISE (b0, T1/J1-003H)  
MRSSIG  
Note: When the RSCFSFALL/RSCCKRISE of any of the eight framers is  
configured as logic 1, all the others are taken as logic 1. That is, the  
RSCFSFALL/RSCCKRISE should be configured to the same value in  
Receive Multiplexed mode.  
3.11.2.3 Receive Multiplexed Mode  
It is a special case when the CMS (b4, T1/J1-078H) is logic 1 and the  
RSCFSFALL (b1, T1/J1-003H) is not equal to RSCCKRISE (b0, T1/J1-  
003H). The RSD_RSCFS_EDGE (b5, T1/J1-078H) is invalid and the signal  
on the MRSD, MRSSIG and the MRSFS pins are updated on the first active  
edge of RSCCK.  
In this mode (refer to Figure - 17), two multiplexed buses are used to  
receive the data from all eight framers. The data from up to four framers  
is byte-interleaved output on one of the two multiplexed buses. The  
multiplexed bus is selected by the MRBS (b7, T1/J1-003H). When the  
data from four framers are output on one multiplexed bus, the sequence  
of data is arranged by setting the channel offset TSOFF[6:0] (b6~0, T1/  
J1-077H). The data from different framers on one multiplexed bus must  
be shifted at a different channel offset to avoid data mixing. Then the re-  
RSCK is 1.544M  
RSCKn  
When the RSCKRISE (b3, T1/J1-003H) is logic 0:  
RSFSn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
F
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
RSDn  
CH24  
CH1  
CH2  
When the RSCKRISE (b3, T1/J1-003H) is logic 1:  
RSFSn  
RSDn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
F
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
CH24  
CH1  
CH2  
Figure - 29. T1/J1 Receive Clock Master Full T1/J1 Mode - Functional Timing Example  
52  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
RSCK is 1.544M. In this example, RSCK is supposed to be held in inactive state during CH2.  
When the RSCKRISE (b3, T1/J1-003H) is logic 0:  
RSCKn  
RSFSn  
RSDn  
4
5
6
7
8
X
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
Don't Care  
CH24  
CH1  
When the RSCKRISE (b3, T1/J1-003H) is logic 1:  
RSCKn  
RSFSn  
RSDn  
4
5
6
7
8
X
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
Don't Care  
CH24  
CH1  
Figure - 30. T1/J1 Receive Clock Master Fractional T1/J1 Mode - Functional Timing Example  
In the Receive Multiplexed mode, the Multiplexed Receive Side polarity of the RSFSn is configured by the FPINV (b6, T1/J1-078H). The  
System Common Clock (MRSCCK) is provided by the system side. It is FPINV (b6, T1/J1-078H) of the eight framers should be set to the same  
used as a common timing clock for all eight framers. The frequency of value.  
the MRSCCK can be selected by the CMS (b4, T1/J1-078H) to be the  
In the Receive Multiplexed mode, the MRSSIG outputs extracted  
same as the bit rate of the received data stream (8.192Mb/s), or double signaling. The extracted signaling bits are channel aligned with the data  
the bit rate of the received data stream (16.384 Mb/s). If the frequency outputted on the MRSD.  
of the RSCCK is double the bit rate of the received data stream, there  
Figure - 31 & 32 show the functional timing examples. Bit 1 of each  
will be two active edges in one bit duration. In this case, the channel is the first bit to be output.  
RSD_RSCFS_EDGE (b5, T1/J1-078H) determines the active edge to  
update the signal on the MRSD, MRSSIG and MRSFS pin; however, 3.11.2.4 Parity Check  
the pulse on the MRSCFS is always sampled on its first active edge. If  
In all the above modes except for the Receive Clock Slave Fractional  
the CMS (b4, T1/J1-078H) or the RSD_RSCFS_EDGE (b5, T1/J1-078H) T1/J1 mode, if the RPRTYE (b0, T1/J1-002H) is logic 1, parity check can  
of any of the eight framers is configured as logic 1, all the others are be conducted over the bits in the previous frame and the result is in-  
taken as logic 1. That is, the CMS (b4, T1/J1-078H) and the serted into the F-bit on the RSDn/MRSD and RSSIGn/MRSSIG pin. The  
RSD_RSCFS_EDGE (b5, T1/J1-078H) of the eight framers should be even parity or odd parity is selected by the RPTYP (b1, T1/J1-002H) and  
configured to the same value in the Receive Multiplexed mode.  
whether the F-bit is calculated or not is determined by the PTY_EXTD  
In the Receive Multiplexed mode, the Multiplexed Receive Side (b3, T1/J1-002H).  
System Common Frame Pulse (MRSCFS) is used as a common  
framing signal to align the data streams on the two multiplexed buses.  
The MRSCFS is asserted on the F-bit. The valid polarity of the MRSCFS  
is configured by the FPINV (b6, T1/J1-078H). The FPINV (b6, T1/J1-  
078H) of the eight framers should be set to the same value.  
In the Receive Multiplexed mode, the bit rate on the MRSD pin is  
8.192Mb/s.  
In the Receive Multiplexed mode, regardless of the setting in the  
RSFSP (b2, T1/J1-001H) and ALTIFP (b1, T1/J1-001H), the MRSFS can  
only indicate each F-bit of SF/ESF of the selected first framer. The valid  
53  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
The CMS (b4, T1/J1-078H) is logic 0, i.e., the bankplane clock rate is 8.192Mbit/s.  
The RSCCKRISE(b0, T1/J1-003H) is logic 1 and the RSCFSFALL (b1, T1/J1-003H) is logic 0.  
In this example, Framer1 to Frame4 are supposed to be multiplexed to one multiplexed bus.  
MRSCFS  
MRSCCK  
When the TSOFF[6:0] of Framer1 are set to 7'b0000000, the TSOFF[6:0] of Framer2 are set to 7'b0000001, the TSOFF[6:0] of Framer3 are set to 7'b0000010, the TSOFF[6:0] of Framer4 are set to  
7'b0000011, the BOFF_EN of the four Framers are set to logic 0:  
MRSFS  
MRSD  
7
8
P
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
F
P
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
F
P
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
F
P
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
3
6
7
X
X
X
X
F
1
2
4
5
8
Parity  
bit  
Parity  
bit  
Parity  
bit  
Parity  
bit  
F-bit  
F-bit  
F-bit  
F-bit  
Framer1  
Framer2  
Framer3  
Framer4  
Framer1_CH1  
MRSSIG  
C
D
P
X
X
P
X
X
P
X
X
P
X
X
X
X
X
A
B
C
X
X
X
X
X
D
(The 'X' represents the filled bits and has no meaning.)  
Figure - 31. T1/J1 Receive Multiplexed Mode - Functional Timing Example 1  
The CMS (b4, T1/J1-078H) is logic 1, i.e., the bankplane clock rate is 16.384Mbit/s.  
The RSCCKRISE(b0, T1/J1-003H) is logic 1 and the RSCFSFALL (b1, T1/J1-003H) is logic 1.  
In this example, Framer1 to Frame4 are supposed to be multiplexed to one multiplexed bus.  
The TSOFF[6:0] of Framer1 are set to 7'b0000000, the TSOFF[6:0] of Framer2 are set to 7'b0000001, the TSOFF[6:0] of Framer3  
are set to 7'b0000010, the TSOFF[6:0] of Framer4 are set to 7'b0000011, the BOFF_EN of the four Framers are set to logic 0:  
MRSCFS  
MRSCCK  
When the RSD_RSCFS_EDGE (b5, T1/J1-078H) is logic 0:  
MRSFS  
MRSD  
7
8
P
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
F
P
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
F
P
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
F
P
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
3
6
7
X
X
X
X
F
F-bit  
X
1
2
4
5
8
Parity  
bit  
Parity  
bit  
Parity  
bit  
Parity  
bit  
F-bit  
F-bit  
F-bit  
Framer1  
Framer2  
Framer3  
Framer4  
Framer1_CH1  
MRSSIG  
C
D
P
X
X
P
X
X
P
X
X
P
X
X
X
X
A
B
C
X
X
X
X
X
D
When the RSD_RSCFS_EDGE (b5, T1/J1-078H) is logic 1:  
MRSFS  
MRSD  
7
8
P
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
F
P
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
F
P
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
F
P
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
3
6
7
X
X
X
X
F
1
2
4
5
8
Parity  
bit  
Parity  
bit  
Parity  
bit  
Parity  
bit  
F-bit  
F-bit  
X
F-bit  
X
Framer1  
Framer2  
Framer3  
Framer4  
F-bit  
X
Framer1_CH1  
MRSSIG  
C
D
P
X
X
P
X
X
P
X
X
P
X
X
X
X
A
B
C
X
X
X
X
X
D
(The 'X' represents the filled bits and has no meaning.)  
Figure - 32. T1/J1 Receive Multiplexed Mode - Functional Timing Example 2  
54  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
3.11.2.5 Offset  
3.11.2.6 Output On RSDn/MRSD & RSSIGn/MRSSIG  
In all the five modes, the RSDn/MRSD and the RSSIGn/MRSSIG pin  
When the system clock rate is 2.048MHz (in Receive Clock Slave T1/  
J1 mode E1 rate mode) or 8.192MHz (in Receive Multiplexed mode), can be configured by the TRI[1:0] (b5~4, T1/J1-003H) of the correspond-  
channel offset and/or bit offset between the RSCFS and the start of the ing framer to be in high impedance state or to output the processed data  
corresponding frame on the RSDn/MRSD (and RSSIGn/MRSSIG) can stream.  
be configured. Bit offset is disabled when the CMS (b4, T1/J1-078H) is  
logic 1.  
The channel offset is configured in the TSOFF[6:0] (b6~0, T1/J1-  
077H). The TSOFF[6:0] (b6~0, E1-013H) give a binary representation.  
Enabled by the BOFF_EN (b3, T1/J1-078H), the bit offset is  
configured in the BOFF[2:0] (b2~0, T1/J1-078H). The bit offset follows  
the Concentration Highway Interface (CHI) specification (refer to Table -  
25). The CET (clock edge transmit) is counted from the active edge of  
the RSCFS/MRSCFS (refer to the example in Figure - 33). The pulse on  
the RSFSn/MRSFS and the signal on the RSSIGn/MRSSIG (if exists)  
are aligned to the RSDn/MRSD.  
Table - 25. Receive System Interface Bit Offset  
RSCFSFALL  
RSCCKRISE  
BOFF[2:0] (b2~0, T1/J1-078H)  
(b1, T1/J1-003) (b0, T1/J1-003H) 000  
001  
4
3
3
4
010  
6
5
5
6
011  
8
7
7
8
100  
10  
9
9
10  
101  
12  
11  
11  
12  
110  
14  
13  
13  
14  
111  
16  
15  
15  
16  
1
1
0
0
0
1
0
1
2
1
1
2
CET  
For example: when RSCFSFALL (b1, T1/J1-003H) = 1, RSCCKRISE (b0, T1/J1-003H) = 0  
starting edge  
(CET=0)  
1 2 3 4 5 CET=6  
RSCFS  
RSCCK  
The bit offset is 0:  
RSDn  
2
3
4
5
6
8
X
X
X
X
X
F
2
3
4
1
7
P
X
1
CH24  
DUMMY  
CH1  
The bit offset is set as: BOFF_EN (b3, T1/J1-078H) = 1, BOFF[2:0] (b2~0, T1/J1-078H) = 010; i.e. the CET = 6:  
RSDn  
X
X
X
X
X
F
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
P
X
1
2
3
4
CH24  
DUMMY  
CH1  
Figure - 33. Receive Bit Offset in T1/J1 Mode  
55  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Pattern Detector  
3.12 PRBS GENERATOR / DETECTOR (PRGD)  
The PRBS Generator/Detector is shared by eight framers. It can be  
assigned to any of the 8 framers at one time. The PRGD, together with  
the Receive / Transmit Payload Control blocks, is used to test the data  
stream.  
The extracted data from the assigned direction are compared with a  
repetitive or pseudo-random pattern selected by the PS (b4, E1-070H).  
Before being compared, the data can be inverted with the RINV (b2, E1-  
070H) enabled. The extracted data are then compared with a 48-bit fixed  
window loaded with the pattern. This process goes on until the data co-  
incide with the pattern. When they are synchronized, it is indicated by  
the SYNCV (b4, E1-071H). Bit errors in the synchronized data are indi-  
cated in the BEI (b2, E1-071H). When there are more than 10-bit errors  
in the fixed 48-bit window, the extracted data are out of synchronization.  
Automatic search for the re-synch will be done with the AUTOSYNC (b1,  
E1-070H) configured, or manual search can be done when there is a  
transition from low to high on the MANSYNC (b0, E1-070H). A manual  
search is recommended to execute to ensure the PRGD operates cor-  
rectly when there is any setting change of the PRGD registers or the de-  
tector data source changes.  
Selected by the PDR[1:0] (b7~6, E1-070H), the PD[31:0] (b7~0, E1-  
07CH & b7~0, E1-07DH & b7~0, E1-07EH & b7~0, E1-07FH) can con-  
tain the received pattern, the total error count or the total number of re-  
ceived bits. They update when the defined intervals are initiated. The in-  
tervals equal 1 second when the AUTOUPDATE (b0, E1-000H) is set in  
the corresponding framer. They can also be updated by writing to any of  
the PD[31:0] (b7~0, E1-07CH & b7~0, E1-07DH & b7~0, E1-07EH &  
b7~0, E1-07FH), or to the E1 Chip ID / Global PMON Update register  
(E1-009H). The update will be indicated by the XFERI (b1, E1-071H). If  
they are not read in the defined intervals, the PD[31:0] (b7~0, E1-07CH  
& b7~0, E1-07DH & b7~0, E1-07EH & b7~0, E1-07FH) will be  
overwritten with new data. The overwritten condition is indicated by the  
OVR (b0, E1-071H).  
3.12.1 E1 MODE  
The PRBS Generator/Detector is a global control block. Any one of  
the eight framers can be linked to the pattern generator or detector by  
the PRGDSEL[2:0] (b7~5, E1-00CH). The pattern can be inserted in ei-  
ther the transmit or receive direction, and detected in the opposite direc-  
tion. The direction is determined by the RXPATGEN (b2, E1-00CH). The  
pattern can be generated or detected in unframed or framed mode. The  
selection is made by the UNF_GEN (b1, E1-00CH) or UNF_DET (b0,  
E1-00CH) respectively. In unframed mode, all the 32 timeslots are re-  
placed or extracted and the specification of the TEST (b7, E1-RPLC-in-  
direct registers - 20~3FH or b3, E1-TPLC-indirect registers - 20~3FH) in  
Receive / Transmit Payload Control blocks are ignored. In framed mode,  
the timeslot is specified by the TEST (b7, E1-RPLC-indirect registers -  
20~3FH or b3, E1-TPLC-indirect registers - 20~3FH).  
Pattern Generator  
The repetitive or pseudo-random pattern selected by the PS (b4, E1-  
070H) is located in the PI[31:0] (b7~0, E1-078H & b7~0, E1-079H &  
b7~0, E1-07AH & b7~0, E1-07BH). However, the length of the valid data  
in the PI[31:0] is determined by the PL[4:0] (b4~0, E1-072H). If the re-  
petitive pattern is selected, the valid PI[X:0] (X is equal to one number of  
the 31 to 1) reflect its content directly. If the pseudo-random pattern is  
selected, the valid PI[X:0] are its initial value and the feedback tap posi-  
tion (refer to Figure - 34) is determined by the PT[4:0] (b4~0, E1-073H).  
A single bit error can be inserted by setting the EVENT (b3, E1-074H) to  
1, or continuous bit errors can be inserted at a bit error rate determined  
by the EIR[2:0] (b2~0, E1-074H). Before replacing the data in the as-  
signed direction, the pattern can be inverted with the TINV (b3, E1-  
070H) enabled.  
3 kinds of interrupts can be generated by this block:  
- bit errors;  
- synchronization status change (indicated in the SYNCI [b3, E1-  
071H]);  
- the PD[31:0] (b7~0, E1-07CH & b7~0, E1-07DH & b7~0, E1-07EH  
& b7~0, E1-07FH) are updated.  
When the interrupts are enabled by the BEE (b6, E1-071H), SYNCE  
TAP[31]  
TAP[0]  
TAP[1]  
TAP[2]  
SET  
SET  
SET  
SET  
CLR  
D
Q
Q
D
Q
Q
D
Q
Q
D
Q
Q
CLR  
CLR  
CLR  
Figure - 34. PRBS Pattern Generator  
56  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
(b7, E1-071H) and XFERE (b5, E1-071H) respectively, the INT pin is as- J1-000H) is set in the corresponding framer. They can also be updated  
serted.  
by writing to any of the PD[31:0] (b7~0, T1/J1-06CH & b7~0, T1/J1-  
06DH & b7~0, T1/J1-06EH & b7~0, T1/J1-06FH), or to the T1/J1 Chip ID  
/ Global PMON Update register (T1/J1-00CH). The update will be indi-  
3.12.2 T1 / J1 MODE  
The PRBS Generator/Detector is a global control block. Any one of cated by the XFERI (b1, T1/J1-061H). If they are not read in the defined  
the eight framers can be linked to pattern generator or detector by the intervals, the PD[31:0] (b7~0, T1/J1-06CH & b7~0, T1/J1-06DH & b7~0,  
PRGDSEL[2:0] (b7~5, T1/J1-00FH). The pattern can be inserted in ei- T1/J1-06EH & b7~0, T1/J1-06FH) will be overwritten with new data. The  
ther the transmit or receive direction, and detected in the opposite direc- overwritten condition is indicated by the OVR (b0, T1/J1-061H).  
tion. The direction is determined by the RXPATGEN (b2, T1/J1-00FH).  
The pattern can be generated or detected in unframed or framed mode.  
The selection is made by the UNF_GEN (b1, T1/J1-00FH) or UNF_DET  
3 kinds of interrupts can be generated by this block:  
- bit errors;  
- synchronization status change (indicated in the SYNCI [b3, T1/J1-  
(b0, T1/J1-00FH) respectively. In unframed mode, all the 24 channels 061H]);  
are replaced or extracted and the specification of the TEST (b3, T1/J1-  
- the PD[31:0] (b7~0, T1/J1-06CH & b7~0, T1/J1-06DH & b7~0, T1/  
RPLC-indirect registers - 01~18H or b3, T1/J1-TPLC-indirect registers - J1-06EH & b7~0, T1/J1-06FH) are updated.  
01~18H) in Receive / Transmit Payload Control blocks are ignored. In  
When the interrupts are enabled by the BEE (b6, T1/J1-061H)  
framed mode, the channel is specified by the TEST (b3, T1/J1-RPLC-in- SYNCE (b7, T1/J1-061H) and XFERE (b5, T1/J1-061H) respectively, the  
direct registers - 01~18H or b3, T1/J1-TPLC-indirect registers - 01~18H). INT pin is asserted.  
However, fractional T1/J1 signal can be replaced or extracted in the  
specified channel when the Nx56k_GEN (b4, T1/J1-00FH) or  
Nx56k_DET (b3, T1/J1-00FH) is set respectively.  
3.13 TRANSMIT SYSTEM INTERFACE (TRSI)  
The Transmit System Interface determines how to input the data to  
the chip. The input data to the eight framers can be aligned with each  
other or inputted independently. The timing clocks and framing pulses  
can be provided by the system back-plane common to eight framers or  
provided for eight framers individually. The Transmit System Interface  
supports various configurations to meet various requirements in different  
applications.  
Pattern Generator  
The repetitive or pseudo-random pattern selected by the PS (b4, T1/  
J1-060H) is located in the PI[31:0] (b7~0, T1/J1-068H & b7~0, T1/J1-  
069H & b7~0, T1/J1-06AH & b7~0, T1/J1-06BH). However, the length of  
the valid data in the PI[31:0] is determined by the PL[4:0] (b4~0, T1/J1-  
062H). If the repetitive pattern is selected, the valid PI[X:0] (X is valid for  
1 to 31) reflect its content directly. If the pseudo-random pattern is se-  
lected, the valid PI[X:0] are its initial value and the feedback tap position  
(refer to Figure - 34) is determined by the PT[4:0] (b4~0, T1/J1-063H). A  
single bit error can be inserted by setting the EVENT (b3, T1/J1-064H),  
or continuous bit errors can be inserted at a bit error rate determined by  
the EIR[2:0] (b2~0, T1/J1-064H). Before replacing the data in the as-  
signed direction, the pattern can be inverted with the TINV (b3, T1/J1-  
060H) enabled.  
3.13.1 E1 MODE  
In E1 mode, the Transmit System Interface can be set in Non-  
multiplexed Mode or Multiplexed Mode. In Non-multiplexed Mode, the  
TSDn pin is used to input the data to each framer at the bit rate of 2.048  
Mb/s. While in the Multiplexed Mode, the data input to the eight framers  
are byte interleaved from two high speed data streams and input on the  
MTSD1 and MTSD2 pins at the bit rate of 8.192 Mb/s.  
In the Non-multiplexed Mode, if the timing signal for clocking data on  
TSDn pin is provided by the system side and shared by all eight  
framers, the Transmit System Interface should be set in Transmit Clock  
Slave mode. If the timing signal for clocking data on each TSDn pin is  
provided from each line side (processed timing signal), the Transmit  
System Interface should be set in Transmit Clock Master mode.  
In the Non-multiplexed Mode, if there is a common framing pulse  
provided by the system side for the eight framers, the Transmit System  
Interface should be set in Transmit Clock Slave mode. If there is no  
common framing pulse, the Transmit System Interface should be set in  
Transmit Clock Master mode.  
In the Transmit Clock Slave mode, if the multi-function pin TSFSn/  
TSSIGn is used to output the framing indication pulse, the Transmit  
System Interface is in Transmit Clock Slave TSFS Enable mode. If the  
TSFSn/TSSIGn is used to input the signaling bits to be inserted, the  
Transmit System Interface is in Transmit Clock Slave External Signaling  
mode.  
In the Transmit Clock Master mode, the multi-function pin TSFSn/  
TSSIGn is used as TSFSn to input the framing indication pulse.  
Table - 26 summarizes the transmit system interface in different  
operation modes. To set the transmit system interface of each framer  
into various operation modes, the registers must be configured as Table  
- 27.  
Pattern Detector  
The extracted data from the assigned direction are compared with a  
repetitive or pseudo-random pattern selected by the PS (b4, T1/J1-  
060H). Before being compared, the data can be inverted with the RINV  
(b2, T1/J1-060H) enabled. The extracted data are then compared with a  
48-bit fixed window loaded with the pattern. This process continues until  
the data coincide with the pattern. They are then synchronized with an  
indication in the SYNCV (b4, T1/J1-061H). Bit errors in the synchronized  
data are indicated in the BEI (b2, T1/J1-061H). When there are more  
than 10-bit errors in the fixed 48-bit window, the extracted data are out of  
synchronization. Automatic search for the re-synch will be done with the  
AUTOSYNC (b1, T1/J1-060H) configured, or manual search can be  
done when there is a transition from low to high on the MANSYNC (b0,  
T1/J1-060H). A manual search is recommended to execute to ensure  
the PRGD operates correctly when there is any setting change of the  
PRGD registers or the detector data source changes.  
Selected by the PDR[1:0] (b7~6, T1/J1-060H), the PD[31:0] (b7~0,  
T1/J1-06CH & b7~0, T1/J1-06DH & b7~0, T1/J1-06EH & b7~0, T1/J1-  
06FH) can contain the received pattern, the total error count or the total  
number of received bits. They update when the defined intervals are ini-  
tiated. The intervals equal 1 second when the AUTOUPDATE (b0, T1/  
57  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Table - 26. E1 Mode Transmit System Interface in Different Operation Modes  
Operation Mode  
Clock Slave  
Mode  
Data Pin  
TSDn  
Clock Pin  
TSCCKB  
TSCCKB  
LTCKn  
Framing Pin  
TSCFS & TSFSn  
TSCFS  
Signaling Pin  
Reference Clock  
TSCCKA  
Non-  
TSFS Enable  
No  
TSSIGn  
No  
Multiplexed  
Mode  
External Signaling  
TSDn  
TSCCKA  
Clock Master Mode  
Multiplexed Mode  
TSDn  
TSFSn  
TSCCKA & TSCCKB  
TSCCKA  
MTSD  
MTSCCKB  
MTSCFS  
MTSSIG  
Table - 27. Operation Mode Selection in E1 Transmit Path  
RATE[1:0] (b1~0, E1-018H)  
01  
TSCKSLV (b5, E1-018H)  
TSSIG_EN (b6, E1-003H)  
Operation Mode  
0
1
-
Transmit Clock Slave TSFS Enable  
Transmit Clock Slave External Signaling  
Transmit Clock Master  
1
0
1
11(All the eight framers should be set)  
1
Transmit Multiplexed  
3.13.1.1 Transmit Clock Slave Mode  
Basic Frame or Multi-Frame indicated by the FPTYP (b1, E1-019H). The  
valid polarity is congifured by the FPINV (b3, E1-019H).  
In the Transmit Clock Slave mode, the bit rate on the TSDn pin is  
2.048Mb/s.  
The Transmit Clock Slave Mode includes two sub-modes: Transmit  
Clock Slave TSFS Enable Mode and Transmit Clock Slave External  
Signaling Mode.  
In the Transmit Clock Slave mode, the Transmit Side System Com-  
mon Clock B (TSCCKB) is provided by the system side. It is used as a  
common timing clock for all eight framers. The speed of the TSCCKB  
can be selected by the CMS (b2, E1-018H) to be the same as the data to  
be transmitted (2.048MHz), or twice the data (4.096MHz). The CMS (b2,  
E1-018H) of the eight framers should be set to the same value. If the  
speed of the TSCCKB is twice the data to be transmitted, there will be  
two active edges in one bit time. In this case, the COFF (b4, E1-01CH)  
determines the active edge to sample the signal on the TSDn and  
TSSIGn pins and the active edge to update the pulse on the TSFSn pin;  
however, the pulse on the TSCFS is always sampled on its first active  
edge.  
In the Transmit Clock Slave mode, the Transmit Side System Com-  
mon Clock A (TSCCKA) is provided by the system side. It is used as one  
of the reference clocks for the transmit jitter attenuator DPLL for all eight  
framers (refer to the Transmit Clock for details).  
In the Transmit Clock Slave mode, the Transmit Side System Com-  
mon Frame Pulse (TSCFS) is used as a common framing signal to align  
the data streams for the eight framers. The TSCFS is asserted on each  
3.13.1.1.1  
Transmit Clock Slave TSFS Enable Mode  
In this mode (refer to Figure - 35), the data on the system interface  
are clocked by the TSCCKB. The active edge of the TSCCKB used to  
sample the pulse on the TSCFS and the data on the TSDn and TSFSn  
are determined by the following bits in the registers (refer to Table - 28).  
Figure - 36 & 37 show the functional timing examples. Bit 1 of each  
timeslot is the first bit to be transmitted.  
Besides all the common functions described in the Transmit Clock  
Slave mode, the special feature in this mode is that the multi-functional  
pin TSFSn/TSSIGn is used as TSFSn to output a framing pulse to indi-  
cate the first bit of each Basic Frame.  
LRCK[1:8]  
TSCCKA  
TSCCKB  
LTCK[1:8]  
DPLL  
TSCFS *  
Transmit  
TSD[1:8] *  
Frame  
Generator  
System  
TSFS[1:8] *  
LTD[1:8]  
Interface  
FIFO  
TRANSMITTER  
Note: * TSCFS, TSD, TSFS are timed to TSCCKB  
Figure - 35. Transmit Clock Slave TSFS Enable Mode  
58  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
The CMS (b2, E1-018H) is logic 0, i.e., the backplane clock rate is 2.048Mbit/s.  
The DE (b4, E1-018H) is logic 0 and the FE(b3, E1-018H) is logic 0.  
TSCCKB  
TSCFS  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
TSDn  
TS31  
TS0  
TS1  
(When the TSFSRISE (b2, E1-002) is logic 0:)  
(When the TSFSRISE (b2, E1-002) is logic 1:)  
TSFSn  
TSFSn  
Figure - 36. E1 Transmit Clock Slave TSFS Enable Mode - Functional Timing Example 1  
The CMS (b2, E1-018H) is logic 1, i.e., the backplane clock rate is 4.096Mbit/s.  
The FE(b3, E1-018H) is logic 0 and the DE (b4, E1-018H) is logic 1.  
The COFF (b4, E1-01CH) is in its default value.  
TSCCKB  
TSCFS  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
TSDn  
TS31  
TS0  
TS1  
(When the TSFSRISE (b2, E1-002) is logic 0:)  
(When the TSFSRISE (b2, E1-002) is logic 1:)  
TSFSn  
TSFSn  
Figure - 37. E1 Transmit Clock Slave TSFS Enable Mode - Functional Timing Example 2  
59  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Table - 28. Active Edge Selection of TSCCKB (in E1 Transmit Clock Table - 29. Active Edge Selection of TSCCKB (in E1 Transmit Clock  
Slave TSFS Enable Mode) Slave External Signaling Mode)  
the Bit Determining the Active Edge of the TSCCKB  
the Bit Determining the Active Edge of the TSCCKB  
TSCFS  
TSDn  
TSFSn  
FE (b3, E1-018H)  
DE (b4, E1-018H)  
TSFSRISE (b2, E1-002H)  
TSCFS  
TSDn  
TSSIGn  
FE (b3, E1-018H)  
DE (b4, E1-018H)  
Note: If the FE is not equal to the DE, the active edge decided by the FE is  
one clock edge before the active edge decided by the DE.  
The FE (b3, E1-018H) of the eight framers should be set to the same  
value to ensure the TSCFS for the eight framers is sampled on the same  
active edge.  
Note: If the FE is not equal to the DE, the active edge decided by the FE is  
one clock edge before the active edge decided by the DE.  
The FE (b3, E1-018H) of the eight framers should be set to the same  
value to ensure the TSCFS for the eight framers is sampled on the same  
active edge.  
3.13.1.1.2  
Transmit Clock Slave External Signaling Mode  
Besides all the common functions described in the Transmit Clock  
Slave mode, the special feature in this mode is that the multi-functional  
pin TSFSn/TSSIGn is used as TSSIGn to input the signaling. The  
signaling on the TSSIGn pin may replace the data on TS16 when the  
CCS is disabled and the SIGSRC (b4, E1-TPLC-indirect registers -  
61~7FH) in the TPLC block is logic 0.  
In this mode (refer to Figure - 38), the data on the system interface  
are clocked by the TSCCKB. The active edge of the TSCCKB used to  
sample the pulse on the TSCFS and the data on the TSDn and TSSIGn  
is determined by the following bits in the registers (refer to Table - 29).  
Figure - 39 & 40 show the functional timing examples. Bit 1 of each  
timeslot is the first bit to be transmitted.  
LRCK[1:8]  
TSCCKA  
TSCCKB  
LTCK[1:8]  
DPLL  
TSCFS *  
Transmit  
TSD[1:8] *  
Frame  
Generator  
System  
TSSIG[1:8] *  
LTD[1:8]  
Interface  
FIFO  
TRANSMITTER  
Note: * TSCFS, TSD, TSSIG are timed to TSCCKB  
Figure - 38. Transmit Clock Slave External Signaling Mode  
The CMS (b2, E1-018H) is logic 0, i.e., the bankplane clock rate is 2.048Mbit/s.  
The DE (b4, E1-018H) is logic 0 and the FE(b3, E1-018H) is logic 1.  
TSCCKB  
TSCFS  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
TSDn  
TS31  
A
TS0  
X
TS1  
X
TSSIGn  
X
X
X
X
B
C
D
P
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
A
B
(The 'X' represent the filled bits and has no meaning.)  
Figure - 39. E1 Transmit Clock Slave External Signaling Mode - Functional Timing Example 1  
60  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
The CMS (b2, E1-018H) is logic 1, i.e., the bankplane clock rate is 4.096Mbit/s.  
The FE(b3, E1-018H) is logic 1 and the DE (b4, E1-018H) is logic 1.  
The COFF (b4, E1-01CH) is in its default value.  
TSCCKB  
TSCFS  
TSDn  
1
2
3
4
5
TS31  
A
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
TS0  
X
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
TS1  
X
5
6
X
X
X
X
B
C
D
P
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
A
B
TSSIGn  
(The 'X' represent the filled bits and has no meaning.)  
Figure - 40. E1 Transmit Clock Slave External Signaling Mode - Functional Timing Example 2  
3.13.1.2 Transmit Clock Master Mode  
timeslot is the first bit to be transmitted.  
In the Transmit Clock Master mode (refer to Figure - 41), the Trans-  
mit Side System Common Clock A (TSCCKA) and Transmit Side System  
Common Clock B (TSCCKB) provided by the system side are used as  
one of the reference clocks for the transmit jitter attenuator DPLL for all  
eight framers (refer to the Transmit Clock for details).  
In the Transmit Clock Master mode, the multi-functional pin TSFSn/  
TSSIGn is used as TSFSn to output a framing pulse to indicate the first  
bit of each Basic Frame.  
3.13.1.3 Transmit Multiplexed Mode  
In this mode (refer to Figure - 43), two multiplexed buses are used to  
input the data to all eight framers. Selected by the MTBS (b4, E1-003H)  
in each framer, the data on one of the two multiplexed buses is byte-in-  
terleaved input to up to four framers. When each group of four framers  
are selected, the input sequence of the data on the multiplexed bus is  
arranged by setting the timeslot offset TSOFF[6:0] (b6~0, E1-01BH).  
The data to different framers from one multiplexed bus must be shifted  
to a different timeslot offset to avoid data mixing. Then the data on the  
multiplexed bus will be input to each of the four selected framers with a  
byte-interleaved manner.  
In the Transmit Clock Master mode, the bit rate on the TSDn pin is  
2.048Mb/s.  
In the Transmit Clock Master mode, each framer uses its own proc-  
essed clock signal on LTCKn pin to sample/update the data on the sys-  
tem interface. The active edge of the LTCKn to sample the data on the  
TSDn pin is determinded by the DE (b4, E1-018H). The active edge of  
the LTCKn to update the pulse on the TSFSn pin is determinded by the  
TSFSRISE (b2, E1-002H).  
In the Transmit Multiplexed mode, the data on the system interface  
are clocked by the MTSCCKB. The active edge of the MTSCCKB to  
sample the data on the MTSCFS, MTSD and MTSSIG is determined by  
the following bits in the registers (refer to Table - 30).  
Figure - 42 shows the functional timing examples. Bit 1 of each  
TSCCKA  
TSCCKB  
LRCK[1:8]  
LTCK[1:8]  
DPLL  
TSD[1:8] *  
Transmit  
TSFS[1:8] *  
Frame  
Generator  
System  
Interface  
LTD[1:8]  
TRANSMITTER  
Note: * TSD, TSFS are timed to LTCK  
Figure - 41. Transmit Clock Master Mode  
61  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
LTCK is 2.048M  
LTCKn  
When the TSFSRISE (b2, E1-002H) is logic 0 and the DE (b4, E1-018H) is logic 1:  
TSFSn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
TSDn  
TS31  
TS0  
TS1  
When the TSFSRISE (b2, E1-002H) is logic 1 and the DE (b4, E1-018H) is logic 1:  
TSFSn  
TSDn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
TS31  
TS0  
TS1  
When the TSFSRISE (b2, E1-002H) is logic 1 and the DE (b4, E1-018H) is logic 0:  
TSFSn  
TSDn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
TS31  
TS0  
TS1  
When the TSFSRISE (b2, E1-002H) is logic 0 and the DE (b4, E1-018H) is logic 0:  
TSFSn  
TSDn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
TS1  
5
6
TS31  
TS0  
Figure - 42. E1 Transmit Clock Master Mode - Functional Timing Example  
62  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Table - 30. Active Edge Selection of MTSCCKB (in E1 Transmit  
Multiplexed Mode)  
In the Transmit Multiplexed mode, the Transmit Side System Com-  
mon Clock A (TSCCKA) is provided by the system side. It is used as one  
of the reference clocks for the transmit jitter attenuator DPLL for all eight  
framers (refer to the Transmit Clock for details).  
In the Transmit Multiplexed mode, the Multiplexed Transmit Side Sys-  
tem Common Frame Pulse (MTSCFS) is used as a common framing  
signal to align data streams on the two multiplexed buses. The MTSCFS  
is asserted on each Basic Frame of the selected first framer. The valid  
polarity of the MTSCFS is congifured by the FPINV (b3, E1-019H). The  
FPINV (b3, E1-019H) of the eight framers should be set to the same  
value.  
the Bit Determining the Active Edge of the  
MTSCCKB  
MTSCFS  
MTSD  
MTSSIG  
FE (b3, E1-018H)  
DE (b4, E1-018H)  
Note: If the FE is not equal to the DE, the active edge decided by the FE is  
one clock edge before the active edge decided by the DE.  
The FE and the DE of the eight framers should be set to the same  
value respectively.  
In the Transmit Multiplexed mode, the bit rate on the MTSD pin is  
8.192Mb/s.  
In the Transmit Multiplexed mode, the MTSSIG inputs the signaling  
bits to be inserted. The signaling bits are timeslot aligned with the data  
input from the MTSD. The signaling bits may replace the data on TS16  
when the CCS is disabled and the SIGSRC (b4, E1-TPLC-indirect regis-  
ters - 61~7FH) in the TPLC block is logic 0.  
In the Transmit Multiplexed mode, the Multiplexed Transmit Side Sys-  
tem Common Clock B (MTSCCKB) is provided by the system side. It is  
used as a common timing clock for all eight framers. The speed of the  
MTSCCKB can be selected by the CMS (b2, E1-018H) to be the same  
as the data to be transmitted (8.192MHz), or double the data  
(16.384MHz). If the speed of the MTSCCKB is double the data to be  
transmitted, there will be two active edges in one bit duration. In this  
case, the COFF (b4, E1-01CH) determines the active edge to sample the  
signal on the MTSD and MTSSIG pins and the active edge to update the  
pulse on the MTSFS pin; however, the pulse on the MTSCFS is always  
sampled on its first active edge. However, if the CMS (b2, E1-018H) or  
the COFF (b4, E1-01CH) of any of the eight framers is configured as  
logic 1, all the others are taken as logic 1. That is, the CMS (b2, E1-  
018H) and the COFF (b4, E1-01CH) of the eight framers should be  
configured to the same value in the Transmit Multiplexed mode.  
Figure - 44 & 45 show the functional timing examples. Bit 1 of each  
timeslot is the first bit to be transmitted.  
3.13.1.4 Parity Check  
In all the above four modes, parity check is calculated over the bits in  
the previous Basic Frame and the result is inserted into the first bit  
(MSB) of TS0 on the TSDn/MTSD pin. The even parity or odd parity is  
selected by the TPTYP (b7, E1-01AH) and whether the first bit of TS0 is  
calculated or not is determined by the PTY_EXTD (b3, E1-01AH). The  
parity error event will be captured by the TDI (b5, E1-01AH). The parity  
error will cause an interrupt on the INT pin if the TPTYE (b6, E1-01AH)  
is enabled.  
TSCCKA  
The Other Four of the Framer #1~#8  
MTSCCKB  
MTSCFS *  
DPLL  
Frame  
Transmit  
System  
Interface  
Any Four of the Framer #1~#8  
MTSD[1:2] *  
LRCK[1:8]  
LTCK[1:8]  
DPLL  
Frame  
MTSSIG[1:2] *  
Generator  
LTD[1:8]  
FIFO
Note: * MTSCFS, MTSD, MTSSIG are timed to MTSCCKB  
Figure - 43. Transmit Multiplexed Mode  
63  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
The CMS (b2, E1-018H) is logic 0, i.e., the bankplane clock rate is 8.192Mbit/s.  
The FE (b3, E1-018H) is logic 0 and the DE (b4, E1-018) is logic 0.  
In this example, Framer1 to Framer4 are supposed to be demultiplexed from one multiplexed bus.  
The TSOFF[6:0] of Framer1 are set to 7'b0000000, the TSOFF[6:0] of Framer2 are set to 7'b0000001,  
the TSOFF[6:0] of Framer3 are set to 7'b0000010, the TSOFF[6:0] of Framer4 are set to 7'b0000011,  
the CHI and the BOFF[2:0] of the four Framers are set to logic 0:  
MTSCFS  
MTSCCKB  
MTSD  
4
3
6
7
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
5
6
7
8
1
2
4
5
8
1
Framer1_TS31  
Framer1_TS0  
Framer2_TS0  
Framer3_TS0  
Framer4_TS0  
MTSSIG  
X
X
X
A
B
C
X
X
X
A
B
C
X
X
X
A
B
C
X
X
X
A
B
C
X
X
X
A
B
C
D
X
D
X
D
X
D
X
D
X
D
Line Interface (of any of the Framer1 to Framer4):  
LTCK n  
TS31-8  
TS0-1  
TS0-2  
TS0-3  
TS0-4  
TS0-5  
TS0-6  
TS0-7  
TS0-8  
LTDn  
TS31-7  
Figure - 44. E1 Transmit Multiplexed Mode - Functional Timing Example 1  
The CMS (b2, E1-018H) is logic 1, i.e., the bankplane clock rate is 16.384Mbit/s.  
The FE (b3, E1-018H) is logic 1 and the DE (b4, E1-018) is logic 0. The COFF (b4, E1-01CH) is in its default value.  
In this example, Framer1 to Framer4 are supposed to be demultiplexed from one multiplexed bus.  
The TSOFF[6:0] of Framer1 are set to 7'b0000000, the TSOFF[6:0] of Framer2 are set to 7'b0000001, the  
TSOFF[6:0] of Framer3 are set to 7'b0000010, the TSOFF[6:0] of Framer4 are set to 7'b0000011, the CHI and the  
BOFF[2:0] of the four Framers are set to logic 0:  
MTSCFS  
MTSCCKB  
MTSD  
4
3
6
7
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
5
6
7
8
1
2
4
5
8
1
Framer1_TS31  
Framer1_TS0  
Framer2_TS0  
Framer3_TS0  
Framer4_TS0  
MTSSIG  
X
X
X
A
B
C
X
X
X
A
B
C
X
X
X
A
B
C
X
X
X
A
B
C
X
X
X
A
B
C
D
X
D
X
D
X
D
X
D
X
D
Line Interface (of any of the Framer1 to Framer4):  
LTCKn  
TS0-1  
TS0-2  
TS0-8  
LTDn  
TS0-3  
TS0-4  
TS0-5  
TS0-7  
TS31-7  
TS31-8  
TS0-6  
Figure - 45. E1 Transmit Multiplexed Mode - Functional Timing Example 2  
64  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
3.13.1.5 Offset  
value equals the setting in the BOFF[2:0] (b2~0, E1-01CH). That is, ‘000’  
In the Transmit Clock Slave mode and Transmit Multiplexed mode, in the BOFF[2:0] (b2~0, E1-01CH) means no bit offset; ‘001’ in the  
timeslot offset is enabled by setting a non-zero value into the BOFF[2:0] (b2~0, E1-01CH) means one bit offset, and so on (refer to the  
TSOFF[6:0] (b6~0, E1-01BH). The timeslot offset is between the examples in Figure - 46 and Figure - 47). If the CHI (b3, E1-01CH) is  
TSCFS/MTSCFS and the start of the corresponding frame to be trans- logic 1, the bit offset configured in the BOFF[2:0] (b2~0, E1-01CH)  
mitted on the TSDn/MTSD. The timeslot offset can be set in both single meets the Concentration Highway Interface (CHI) specification (refer to  
clock mode (CMS [b2, E1-018H] = 0) and double clock mode (CMS [b2, Table - 31 and Table - 32). The CER (clock edge receive) is counted  
E1-018H] = 1).  
from the active edge of the TSCFS/MTSCFS (refer to the examples in  
In all the above four modes, bit offset is enabled by setting a non- Figure - 48 and Figure - 49). When the bit offset is configured, the signal  
zero value into the BOFF[2:0] (b2~0, E1-01CH). In Transmit Clock Slave on the TSSIGn/MTSSIG or the pulse on the TSFSn is aligned to the  
mode and Transmit Multiplexed mode, the bit offset is between the RSDn/MRSD. In Transmit Clock Master mode, the bit offset is between  
TSCFS/MTSCFS and the start of the corresponding frame to be trans- the TSFSn and the start of the corresponding frame to be transmitted on  
mitted on the TSDn/MTSD. The bit offset can be set in both single clock the TSDn. In this case, the CHI specification is not supported and the bit  
mode (CMS [b2, E1-018H] = 0) and double clock mode (CMS [b2, E1- offset value equals the setting in the BOFF[2:0] (b2~0, E1-01CH) (refer  
018H] = 1). However, if the CHI (b3, E1-01CH) is logic 0, the bit offset to the example in Figure - 50).  
Table - 31. Transmit System Interface Bit Offset (CHI [b3, E1-01CH] = 1, CMS [b2, E1-018H] = 0)  
FE  
DE  
BOFF[2:0] (b2~0, E1-01CH)  
(b3, E1-018H) (b4, E1-018H)  
000  
4
3
3
4
001  
6
5
5
6
010  
8
7
7
8
011  
10  
9
9
10  
100  
12  
11  
11  
12  
101  
14  
13  
13  
14  
110  
16  
15  
15  
16  
111  
18  
17  
17  
18  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
CER  
Table - 32. Transmit System Interface Bit Offset (CHI [b3, E1-01CH] = 1, CMS [b2, E1-018H] = 1)  
FE  
DE  
BOFF[2:0] (b2~0, E1-01CH)  
(b3, E1-018H) (b4, E1-018H)  
000  
6
7
7
6
001  
10  
11  
11  
10  
010  
14  
15  
15  
14  
011  
18  
19  
19  
18  
100  
22  
23  
23  
22  
101  
110  
111  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
26  
27  
27  
26  
30  
31  
31  
30  
34  
35  
35  
34  
CER  
For example: in Transmit Clock Slave mode, CMS (b2, E1-018H) = 0, DE (b4, E1-018H) = 0, FE (b3, E1-018H) = 0:  
TSCFS  
TSCCKB  
The CHI (b3, E1-01CH) = 0 and the bit offset is 0:  
TSDn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
TS31  
TS0  
TS2  
The bit offset is set as: CHI (b3, E1-01CH) = 0, BOFF[2:0] (b2~0, E1-01CH) = 010; i.e. 2-bit offset:  
TSDn  
2
3
4
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
7
1
2
3
4
TS31  
TS0  
TS2  
Figure - 46. Transmit Bit Offset in E1 Mode - 1  
65  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
For example: in Transmit Clock Slave mode, CMS (b2, E1-018H) = 1, FE (b3, E1-018H) = 1, DE (b4, E1-018H) = 1:  
TSCFS  
TSCCKB  
The CHI (b3, E1-01CH) = 0 and the bit offset is 0:  
TSDn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
TS31  
TS0  
TS2  
The bit offset is set as: CHI (b3, E1-01CH) = 0, BOFF[2:0] (b2~0, E1-01CH) = 010; i.e. 2-bit offset:  
TSDn  
2
3
4
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
2
3
4
1
7
1
TS31  
TS0  
TS2  
Figure - 47. Transmit Bit Offset in E1 Mode - 2  
For example: in Transmit Clock Slave mode, CMS (b2, E1-018H) = 0, DE (b4, E1-018H) = 0, FE (b3, E1-018H) = 0:  
starting edge  
(CER=0)  
1 2 3 CER=4  
TSCFS  
TSCCKB  
The CHI (b3, E1-01CH) = 0 and the bit offset is 0:  
TSDn  
2
3
4
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
7
1
2
3
4
2
TS31  
TS0  
TS2  
The bit offset is set as: CHI (b3, E1-01CH) = 1, BOFF[2:0] (b2~0, E1-01CH) = 000; i.e. CER = 4:  
TSDn  
2
3
4
5
6
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
7
1
3
4
TS31  
TS0  
TS2  
Figure - 48. Transmit Bit Offset in E1 Mode - 3  
66  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
For example: in Transmit Clock Slave mode, CMS (b2, E1-018H) = 1, FE (b3, E1-018H) = 1, DE (b4, E1-018H) = 1:  
starting edge  
12345  
CER=6  
(CER=0)  
TSCFS  
TSCCKB  
The CHI (b3, E1-01CH) = 0 and the bit offset is 0:  
2
3
4
5
6
8
TSDn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
7
1
2
3
4
TS31  
TS0  
TS2  
The bit offset is set as: CHI (b3, E1-01CH) = 1, BOFF[2:0] (b2~0, E1-01CH) = 000; i.e. CER = 6:  
TSDn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
TS31  
TS0  
TS2  
Figure - 49. Transmit Bit Offset in E1 Mode - 4  
For example: in Transmit Clock Master mode, DE (b4, E1-018H) = 1, TSFSRISE (b2, E1-002H) = 1:  
TSFSn  
LTCKn  
The bit offset is 0:  
TSDn  
2
3
4
5
6
8
7
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
7
6
1
8
2
1
3
4
TS31  
TS0  
TS2  
The bit offset is set as: BOFF[2:0] (b2~0, E1-01CH) = 001; i.e. 1-bit offset:  
TSDn  
2
3
4
5
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
TS31  
TS0  
TS2  
Figure - 50. Transmit Bit Offset in E1 Mode - 5  
67  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
3.13.2 T1 / J1 MODE  
into various operation modes, the registers must be configured as Table  
In T1/J1 mode, the Transmit System Interface can be set in Non- - 34.  
multiplexed Mode or Multiplexed Mode. In Non-multiplexed Mode, the  
TSDn pin is used to input the data to each framer at the bit rate of 1.544 3.13.2.1 Transmit Clock Slave Mode  
Mb/s or 2.048 Mb/s (T1/J1 mode E1 rate). While in the Multiplexed  
In the Transmit Clock Slave mode, the bit rate on the TSDn pin is  
Mode, the data input to the eight framers are converted to 2.048 Mb/s 1.544 Mb/s. However, if the system clock rate is 2.048MHz, the data to  
format and byte interleaved from two high speed data streams and input be transmitted should be converted into the same rate as the line side,  
on the MTSD1 and MTSD2 pins at the bit rate of 8.192 Mb/s.  
that is, to work in T1/J1 mode E1 rate. Thus the RATE[1:0] (b3~2, T1/J1-  
In the Non-multiplexed Mode, if the timing signal for clocking data on 005H) should be set to ‘01’. The conversion complies as follows: The  
the TSDn pin is provided by the system side and shared by all eight last bit of the Frame N of the system side is the F-bit of the Frame N in  
framers, the Transmit System Interface should be set in Transmit Clock the device. Then one byte of the system side is discarded after the previ-  
Slave mode. If the timing signal for clocking data on each TSDn pin is ous three bytes are converted into the device. This process repeats  
provided from each line side (processed timing signal), the Transmit eight times and the conversion of one frame is completed. Then the  
System Interface should be set in Transmit Clock Master mode.  
In the Non-multiplexed Mode, if there is a common framing pulse  
process goes on (refer to Figure - 51).  
In the Transmit Clock Slave mode, the Transmit Side System Com-  
provided by the system side for the eight framers, the Transmit System mon Clock B (TSCCKB) is provided by the system side. It is used as a  
Interface should be set in Transmit Clock Slave mode. If there is not a common timing clock for all eight framers. The speed of the TSCCKB  
common framing pulse, the Transmit System Interface should be set in can be 1.544MHz or 2.048MHz. When it is 2.048MHz, the TSCCKB can  
Transmit Clock Master mode.  
be selected by the CMS (b5, T1/J1-015H) to be the same as the data  
In the Transmit Clock Slave mode, if the multi-function pin TSFSn/ (2.048Mb/S), or double the data (4.096Mb/s). The CMS (b5, T1/J1-  
TSSIGn is used to output the framing indication pulse, the Transmit 015H) of the eight framers should be set to the same value. If the speed  
System Interface is in Transmit Clock Slave TSFS Enable mode. If the of the TSCCKB is double of the data, there will be two active edges in  
TSFSn/TSSIGn is used to input the signaling bits to be inserted, the one bit duration. In this case, the COFF (b4, T1/J1-015H) determines  
Transmit System Interface is in Transmit Clock Slave External Signaling the active edge to sample the signal on the TSDn and TSSIGn pins and  
mode.  
the active edge to update the pulse on the TSFSn pin; however, the  
The T1/J1 mode E1 rate, which means the system clock rate is pulse on the TSCFS is always sampled on its first active edge.  
2.048 MHz in T1/J1 mode, can only be supported in the Transmit Clock  
Slave mode.  
In the Transmit Clock Slave mode, the Transmit Side System Com-  
mon Clock A (TSCCKA) is provided by the system side. It is used as one  
In the Transmit Clock Master mode, the multi-function pin TSFSn/ of the reference clocks for the transmit jitter attenuator DPLL for all eight  
TSSIGn is used as TSFSn to input the framing indication pulse.  
framers (refer to the Transmit Clock for details).  
Table - 33 summarizes the transmit system interface in different  
In the Transmit Clock Slave mode, the Transmit Side System Com-  
operation modes. To set the transmit system interface of each framer mon Frame Pulse (TSCFS) is used as a common framing signal to align  
Table - 33. T1/J1 Mode Transmit System Interface in Different Operation Modes  
Operation Mode  
Clock Slave  
Mode  
Data Pin  
TSDn  
Clock Pin  
TSCCKB  
TSCCKB  
LTCKn  
Framing Pin  
TSCFS & TSFSn  
TSCFS  
Signaling Pin  
No  
Reference Clock  
TSCCKA  
Non-  
TSFS Enable  
Multiplexed  
Mode  
External Signaling  
TSDn  
TSSIGn  
No  
TSCCKA  
Clock Master Mode  
Multiplexed Mode  
TSDn  
TSFSn  
TSCCKA & TSCCKB  
TSCCKA  
MTSD  
MTSCCKB  
MTSCFS  
MTSSIG  
Table - 34. Operation Mode Selection in T1/J1 Transmit Path  
RATE[1:0] (b3~2, T1/J1-005H)  
EMODE[1:0] (b7~6, T1/J1-005H)  
Operation Mode  
10  
11  
01  
11  
Transmit Clock Slave TSFS Enable  
Transmit Clock Slave External Signaling  
Transmit Clock Master  
00 / 01 *  
00  
11 (in any of the eight framers)  
Transmit Multiplexed  
Note:  
* When the RATE[1:0] are ‘00’, the system clock rate is 1.544MHz.  
When the RATE[1:0] are ‘01’, the system clock rate is 2.048MHz, i.e., T1/J1 mode E1 rate.  
68  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
discarded the last bit  
discarded  
TS4  
discarded the last bit  
2.048M  
bit/s  
TS0  
TS1  
CH1  
TS2  
CH2  
TS3  
CH3  
TS5  
CH5  
TS6  
TS31  
CH24  
TS0  
TS2  
1.544M  
bit/s  
F
CH4  
F
CH1  
Figure - 51. E1 To T1/J1 Format Conversion  
data streams for the eight framers. The TSCFS is asserted on the re-  
quest of each F-bit or the first F-bit of every 12 SFs / every 24 ESFs,  
which is indicated by the TSCFSP (b1, T1/J1-005H). The valid polarity  
of the TSCFS is configured by the FPINV (b5, T1/J1-005H).  
The Transmit Clock Slave Mode includes two sub-modes: Transmit  
Clock Slave TSFS Enable Mode and Transmit Clock Slave External  
Signaling Mode.  
Table - 35. Active Edge Selection of TSCCKB (in T1/J1 Transmit  
Clock Slave TSFS Enable Mode)  
the Bit Determining the Active Edge of the TSCCKB  
TSCFS  
TSD  
TSCCKBFALL (b3, T1/J1-004H)  
TSFS  
TSFSRISE (b5, T1/J1-004H)  
Note: The TSCCKBFALL (b3, T1/J1-004H) of the eight framers should be  
set to the same value to ensure the TSCFS for the eight framers is  
sampled on the same active edge.  
3.13.2.1.1  
Transmit Clock Slave TSFS Enable Mode  
In this mode (refer to Figure - 35), the data on the system interface  
are clocked by the TSCCKB. The active edge of the TSCCKB to sample  
the pulse on the TSCFS and the data on the TSDn and TSFSn is deter-  
mined by the following bits in the registers (refer to Table - 35).  
Figure - 52 to 54 show the functional timing examples. Bit 1 of each  
channel is the first bit to be transmitted.  
Besides all the common functions described in the Transmit Clock  
Slave mode, the special feature in this mode is that the multi-functional  
pin TSFSn/TSSIGn is used as TSFSn to output a framing pulse to indi-  
cate every F-bit.  
The CMS (b5, T1/J1-015H) is logic 0. The bankplane rate is 1.544Mbit/s.  
The TSCCKBFALL (b3, T1/J1-004H) is logic 1.  
TSCCKB  
TSCFS  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
F
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
TSDn  
CH24  
CH1  
CH2  
(When the TSFSRISE (b5, T1/J1-004) is logic 0:)  
(When the TSFSRISE (b5, T1/J1-004) is logic 1:)  
TSFSn  
TSFSn  
Figure - 52. T1/J1 Transmit Clock Slave TSFS Enable Mode - Functional Timing Example 1  
69  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
The CMS (b5, T1/J1-015H) is logic 0. The bankplane clock rate is 2.048Mbit/s.  
The TSCCKBFALL (b3, T1/J1-004H) is logic 0.  
TSCCKB  
TSCFS  
TSDn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
P
X
X
X
X
X
X
F
1
2
3
4
5
6
CH24  
DUMMY  
CH1  
(When the TSFSRISE (b5, T1/J1-004) is logic 0:)  
(When the TSFSRISE (b5, T1/J1-004) is logic 1:)  
TSFSn  
TSFSn  
Figure - 53. T1/J1 Transmit Clock Slave TSFS Enable Mode - Functional Timing Example 2  
The CMS (b5, T1/J1-015H) is logic 1. The bankplane clock rate is 4.096Mbit/s.  
The TSCCKBFALL (b3, T1/J1-004H) is logic 0. The COFF (b4, T1/J1-015H) is in its default value.  
TSCCKB  
TSCFS  
TSDn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
P
X
X
X
X
X
X
F
1
2
3
4
5
6
CH24  
DUMMY  
CH1  
(When the TSFSRISE (b5, T1/J1-004) is logic 0:)  
(When the TSFSRISE (b5, T1/J1-004) is logic 1:)  
TSFSn  
TSFSn  
Figure - 54. T1/J1 Transmit Clock Slave TSFS Enable Mode - Functional Timing Example 3  
70  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
3.13.2.1.2  
Transmit Clock Slave External Signaling Mode  
Figure - 55 to 57 show the functional timing examples. Bit 1 of each  
In this mode (refer to Figure - 38), the data on the system interface channel is the first bit to be transmitted.  
are clocked by the TSCCKB. The active edge of the TSCCKB to sample  
Besides all the common functions described in the Transmit Clock  
the pulse on the TSCFS and the data on the TSDn and TSSIGn is deter- Slave mode, the special feature in this mode is that the multi-functional  
mined by the TSCCKBFALL (b3, T1/J1-004H). The TSCCKBFALL (b3, pin TSFSn/TSSIGn is used as TSSIGn to input the signaling. The  
T1/J1-004H) of the eight framers should be set to the same value to en- signaling on the TSSIGn pin may be configured by the ABXXEN (b4, T1/  
sure the TSCFS for the eight framers is sampled on the same active J1-005H) to be valid only in the upper two-bit positions of the lower nib-  
edge.  
ble of each channel (i.e. XXXXABXX) in T1 ESF mode.  
The CMS (b5, T1/J1-015H) is logic 0. The bankplane rate is 1.544Mbit/s.  
The TSCCKBFALL (b3, T1/J1-004H) is logic 0.  
TSCCKB  
TSCFS  
TSDn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
F
X
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
CH24  
A
CH1  
X
CH2  
X
TSSIGn  
X
X
X
X
B
C
D
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
A
Figure - 55. T1/J1 Transmit Clock Slave External Signaling Mode - Functional Timing Example 1  
The CMS (b5, T1/J1-015H) is logic 0. The bankplane rate is 2.048Mbit/s.  
The TSCCKBFALL (b3, T1/J1-004H) is logic 1.  
TSCCKB  
TSCFS  
TSDn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
P
P
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
F
X
1
2
3
4
5
6
CH24  
DUMMY  
CH1  
TSSIGn  
X
X
X
X
A
B
C
D
X
X
X
X
X
X
A
B
Figure - 56. T1/J1 Transmit Clock Slave External Signaling Mode - Functional Timing Example 2  
71  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
The CMS (b5, T1/J1-015H) is logic 1. The bankplane clock rate is 4.096Mbit/s.  
The TSCCKBFALL (b3, T1/J1-004H) is logic 1.  
TSCCKB  
TSCFS  
TSDn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
P
P
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
F
X
1
2
3
4
5
6
CH24  
DUMMY  
CH1  
TSSIGn  
X
X
X
X
A
B
C
D
X
X
X
X
X
X
A
B
Figure - 57. T1/J1 Transmit Clock Slave External Signaling Mode - Functional Timing Example 3  
3.13.2.2 Transmit Clock Master Mode  
tem Common Clock B (MTSCCKB) is provided by the system side. It is  
used as a common timing clock for all eight framers. The speed of the  
MTSCCKB can be selected by the CMS (b5, T1/J1-015H) to be the  
same as the data to be transmitted (8.192MHz), or double the data  
(16.384MHz). If the speed of the MTSCCKB is double the data to be  
transmitted, there will be two active edges in one bit duration. In this  
case, the COFF (b4, T1/J1-015H) determines the active edge to sample  
the signal on the MTSD and MTSSIG pins and the active edge to update  
the pulse on the MTSFS pin; however, the pulse on the MTSCFS is al-  
ways sampled on its first active edge. If the CMS (b5, T1/J1-015H) or  
the COFF (b4, T1/J1-015H) of any of the eight framers is configured as  
logic 1, all the others are taken as logic 1. That is, the CMS (b5, T1/J1-  
015H) and the COFF (b4, T1/J1-015H) of the eight framers should be  
configured to the same value in the Transmit Multiplexed mode.  
In the Transmit Multiplexed mode, the Transmit Side System Com-  
mon Clock A (TSCCKA) is provided by the system side. It is used as one  
of the reference clocks for the transmit jitter attenuator DPLL for all eight  
framers (refer to the Transmit Clock for details).  
In the Transmit Clock Master mode (refer to Figure - 41), the Trans-  
mit Side System Common Clock A (TSCCKA) and Transmit Side System  
Common Clock B (TSCCKB) provided by the system side are used as  
one of the reference clocks for the transmit jitter attenuator DPLL for all  
eight framers (refer to the Transmit Clock for details).  
In the Transmit Clock Master mode, the multi-functional pin TSFSn/  
TSSIGn is used as TSFSn to output a framing pulse to indicate every F-  
bit.  
In the Transmit Clock Master mode, the bit rate on the TSDn pin is  
1.544Mb/s.  
In the Transmit Clock Master mode, each framer uses its own proc-  
essed clock signal on LTCKn pin to sample/update the data on the sys-  
tem interface. The active edge of the LTCKn to sample the data on the  
TSDn pin is determinded by the TSDFALL (b1, T1/J1-004H). The active  
edge of the LTCKn to update the pulse on the TSFSn pin is determinded  
by the TSFSRISE (b5, T1/J1-004H).  
Figure - 58 shows the functional timing examples. Bit 1 of each chan-  
nel is the first bit to be transmitted.  
In the Transmit Multiplexed mode, the Multiplexed Transmit Side Sys-  
tem Common Frame Pulse (MTSCFS) is used as a common framing sig-  
nal to align data streams on the two multiplexed buses. The MTSCFS is  
asserted on the F-bit of the selected first framer. The valid polarity of the  
MTSCFS is congifured by the FPINV (b5, T1/J1-005H). The FPINV (b5,  
T1/J1-005H) of the eight framers should be the same value.  
3.13.2.3 Transmit Multiplexed Mode  
In this mode (refer to Figure - 43), two multiplexed buses are used to  
input the data to all eight framers. Selected by the MTBS (b6, T1/J1-  
015H) in each framer, the data on one of the two multiplexed buses is  
byte-interleaved input to up to four framers. When each four framers are  
selected, the input sequence of the data on the multiplexed bus is ar-  
ranged by setting the channel offset TSOFF[6:0] (b6~0, T1/J1-014H).  
The data for a different framer from one multiplexed bus must be shifted  
by a different channel offset to avoid data mixing. Then the data on the  
multiplexed bus will be input to each of the four selected framers with a  
byte-interleaved manner.  
In the Transmit Multiplexed mode, the data on the system interface  
are clocked by the MTSCCKB. The active edge of the MTSCCKB to  
sample the data on the MTSCFS, MTSD and MTSSIG is determined by  
the TSCCKBFALL (b3, T1/J1-004H). The TSCCKBFALL (b3, T1/J1-  
004H) of the eight framers should be set to the same value.  
In the Transmit Multiplexed mode, the bit rate on the MTSD pin is  
8.192Mb/s.  
In the Transmit Multiplexed mode, the MTSSIG input the signaling  
bits to be inserted. The signaling bits are channel aligned with the data  
input from the MTSD. The signaling on the MTSSIG pin may be  
configured by the ABXXEN (b4, T1/J1-005H) to be valid only in the upper  
two-bit positions of the lower nibble of each channel (i.e. XXXXABXX)  
in T1 ESF mode.  
Figure - 59 ~ 60 show the functional timing examples. Bit 1 of each  
channel is the first bit to be transmitted.  
In the Transmit Multiplexed mode, the Multiplexed Transmit Side Sys-  
72  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
LTCKn is 1.544M  
LTCKn  
When the TSFSRISE (b5, T1/J1-004H) is logic 1 and the TSDFALL (b1, T1/J1-004) is logic 1:  
TSFSn  
TSDn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
F
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
CH24  
CH1  
CH2  
When the TSFSRISE (b5, T1/J1-004H) is logic 0 and the TSDFALL (b1, T1/J1-004) is logic 0:  
TSFSn  
TSDn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
F
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
CH24  
CH1  
CH2  
When the TSFSRISE (b5, T1/J1-004H) is logic 0 and the TSDFALL (b1, T1/J1-004) is logic 1:  
TSFSn  
TSDn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
F
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
CH24  
CH1  
CH2  
When the TSFSRISE (b5, T1/J1-004H) is logic 1 and the TSDFALL (b1, T1/J1-004) is logic 0:  
TSFSn  
TSDn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
F
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
1
2
3
4
5
CH24  
CH1  
CH2  
Figure - 58. T1/J1 Transmit Clock Master Mode - Functional Timing Example  
73  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
The CMS (b5, T1/J1-015H) is logic 0, i.e., the bankplane rate is 8.192Mbit/s.  
The TSCCKBFALL (b3, T1/J1-004H) is logic 1.  
In this example, Framer1 to Framer4 are supposed to be demultiplexed from one multiplexed bus.  
The TSOFF[6:0] of Framer1 are set to 7'b0000000, the TSOFF[6:0] of Framer2 are set to 7'b0000001,  
the TSOFF[6:0] of Framer3 are set to 7'b0000010, the TSOFF[6:0] of Framer4 are set to 7'b0000011,  
the BOFF[2:0] of the four Framers are set to logic 0:  
MTSCFS  
MTSCCKB  
8
P
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
F
P
X
X
X
X
F
P
X
X
X
X
X
X
F
P
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
3
6
7
MTSD  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
F
1
2
4
5
8
Parity  
bit  
Parity  
bit  
Parity  
bit  
Parity  
bit  
F-bit  
F-bit  
F-bit  
Framer1  
Framer2  
Framer3  
F-bit  
X
Framer4  
Framer1_CH1  
A B  
MTSSIG  
D
P
X
P
X
X
P
X
X
P
X
X
X
X
C
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
D
Line Interface (of any of the Framer1 to Framer4). LTCKn is 1.544M:  
LTCKn  
CH24-7  
CH1-1  
CH1-2  
CH1-3  
CH1-4  
CH1-5  
LTDn  
CH24-8  
F
Figure - 59. T1/J1 Transmit Multiplexed Mode - Functional Timing Example 1  
The CMS (b5, T1/J1-015H) is logic 1, i.e., the bankplane clock rate is 16.384Mbit/s.  
The TSCCKBFALL (b3, T1/J1-004H) is logic 0.  
In this example, Framer1 to Framer4 are supposed to be demultiplexed from one multiplexed bus.  
The TSOFF[6:0] of Framer1 are set to 7'b0000000, the TSOFF[6:0] of Framer2 are set to 7'b0000001,  
the TSOFF[6:0] of Framer3 are set to 7'b0000010, the TSOFF[6:0] of Framer4 are set to 7'b0000011,  
the BOFF of the four Framers are set to logic 0:  
MTSCFS  
MTSCCKB  
MTSD  
8
P
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
F
P
X
X
X
X
X
F
P
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
F
P
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
3
6
Framer1_CH1  
7
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
F
F-bit  
X
1
2
4
5
8
Parity  
bit  
Parity  
bit  
Parity  
bit  
Parity  
bit  
F-bit  
F-bit  
F-bit  
Framer1  
Framer2  
Framer3  
Framer4  
MTSSIG  
D
P
X
P
X
P
X
P
X
X
X
X
A
B
C
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
D
Line Interface (of any of the Framer1 to Framer4). LTCK is 1.544M:  
LTCKn  
LTDn  
CH24-7  
F-bit  
CH1-1  
CH1-2  
CH1-3  
CH1-4  
CH1-5  
CH24-8  
Figure - 60. T1/J1 Transmit Multiplexed Mode - Functional Timing Example 2  
74  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
3.13.2.4 Parity Check  
the start of the corresponding frame on the TSDn/MTSD can be  
In the above four modes, parity check is calculated over the bits in the configured. The channel offset and bit offset can be set in both single  
previous frame and the result is input into the F-bit on the TSDn/MTSD clock mode (CMS [b5, T1/J1-015H] = 0) and double clock mode (CMS  
and TSSIGn/MTSSIG pin. The even parity or odd parity is selected by [b5, T1/J1-015H] = 1).  
the TPTYP (b7, T1/J1-002H) and whether the F-bit is calculated or not is  
The channel offset is enabled by setting a non-zero value into the  
determined by the PTY_EXTD (b3, T1/J1-002H). The parity error event TSOFF[6:0] (b6~0, T1/J1-014H). The TSOFF[6:0] (b6~0, T1/J1-014H)  
on the TSDn pin will be captured by the TSDI (b5, T1/J1-002H) and the give a binary representation.  
parity error event on the TSSIGn pin will be captured by the TSSIGI (b4,  
The bit offset is enabled by setting a non-zero value into the  
T1/J1-002H). The TSDI (b5, T1/J1-002H) and TSSIGI (b4, T1/J1-002H) BOFF[2:0] (b2~0, T1/J1-015H). The bit offset value equals the setting in  
will be cleared after being read. The parity error will cause an interrupt the BOFF[2:0] (b2~0, T1/J1-015H). That is, ‘000’ in the BOFF[2:0]  
on the INT pin if the TPRTYE (b6, T1/J1-002H) is enabled.  
(b2~0, T1/J1-015H) means no bit offset; ‘001’ in the BOFF[2:0] (b2~0,  
T1/J1-015H) means one bit offset, and so on (refer to the examples in  
Figure - 61 and Figure - 62). When the bit offset is configured, the signal  
3.13.2.5 Offset  
When the system clock rate is 2.048MHz (in Transmit Clock Slave on the TSSIGn/MTSSIG or the pulse on the TSFSn is aligned to the  
T1/J1 mode E1 rate mode) or 8.192MHz (in Transmit Multiplexed mode), RSDn/MRSD.  
the channel offset and/or bit offset between the TSCFS/MTSCFS and  
For example: in Transmit Clock Slave mode, CMS (b5, T1/J1-015H) = 0, TSCCKBFALL (b3, T1/J1-004H) = 1:  
TSCFS  
TSCCKB  
The bit offset is 0:  
TSDn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
P
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
F
X
2
F
3
4
2
1
CH24  
DUMMY  
CH1  
The bit offset is set as: BOFF[2:0] (b2~0, E1-01CH) = 010; i.e. 2-bit offset:  
TSDn  
X
X
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
P
X
1
3
4
DUMMY  
CH1  
CH24  
Figure - 61. Transmit Bit Offset in T1/J1 Mode - 1  
For example: in Transmit Clock Slave mode, CMS (b5, T1/J1-015H) = 1, TSCCKBFALL (b3, T1/J1-004H) = 0:  
TSCFS  
TSCCKB  
The bit offset is 0:  
TSDn  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
P
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
F
X
1
2
3
4
1
CH24  
DUMMY  
CH1  
The bit offset is set as: BOFF[2:0] (b2~0, E1-01CH) = 011; i.e. 3-bit offset:  
TSDn  
2
3
4
5
6
8
P
X
X
X
F
2
3
4
1
7
CH24  
DUMMY  
CH1  
Figure - 62. Transmit Bit Offset in T1/J1 Mode - 2  
75  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
pleted, the BUSY (b7, E1-061H) will be set. New operations on the indi-  
rect registers can only be implemented when the BUSY (b7, E1-061H) is  
cleared. The read/write cycle is 490ns.  
3.14 TRANSMIT PAYLOAD CONTROL (TPLC)  
Different test patterns can be inserted in the data to be transmitted or  
the data to be transmitted can be extracted to the PRBS Generator/De-  
tector for test in this block. The Transmit Payload Control of each framer  
operates independently.  
3.14.2 T1 / J1 MODE  
To enable the test for the data to be transmitted, the PCCE (b0, T1/  
J1-030H) must be set to activate the setting in the indirect registers  
(from 01H to 48H of TPLC indirect registers). The following methods can  
be executed for test on a per-channel basis:  
3.14.1 E1 MODE  
To enable the test for the data to be transmitted, the PCCE (b0, E1-  
060H) must be set to activate the setting in the indirect registers (from  
20H to 7FH of TPLC indirect registers). The following methods can be  
used for test on a per-TS basis:  
- Selected by the PRGDSEL[2:0] (b7~5, T1/J1-00FH), the data to be  
transmitted on one of the eight framers will be extracted to the PRBS  
Generator/Detector when the RXPATGEN (b2, T1/J1-00FH) is 1. The  
data can be extracted in framed or unframed mode. The selection is  
made by the UN_DET (b0, T1/J1-00FH). In unframed mode, all 24 chan-  
nels and the F-bit are extracted and the per-channel configuration in the  
TEST (b3, T1/J1-TPLC-indirect registers - 01~18H) is ignored. In framed  
mode, the data to be transmitted will only be extracted on the channel  
specified by the TEST (b3, T1/J1-TPLC-indirect registers - 01~18H).  
Fractional T1/J1 data can also be extracted in the specified channel  
when the Nx56k_DET (b3, T1/J1-00FH) is set. Refer to the section of  
the PRBS GENERATOR / DETECTOR (PRGD) for details.  
- Enable three types of Zero Code Suppression when the ZCS[1:0]  
(b1~0, T1/J1-TPLC-indirect registers - 01~18H) is configured.  
- Enable the payload loopback by setting the LOOP (b2, T1/J1-TPLC-  
indirect registers - 01~18H) (refer to Payload Loopback).  
- Replace the data input from the TSDn/MTSD pin with the milliwatt  
pattern when the DMW (b5, T1/J1-TPLC-indirect registers - 01~18H) is  
logic 1. (The milliwatt is µ-law. Refer to Table - 9.)  
- Selected by the PRGDSEL[2:0] (b7~5, E1-00CH), the data to be  
transmitted on one of the eight framers will be extracted to the PRBS  
Generator/Detector when the RXPATGEN (b2, E1-00CH) is 1. The data  
can be extracted in framed or unframed mode. The selection is made by  
the UN_DET (b0, E1-00CH). In unframed mode, all 32 timeslots are ex-  
tracted and the per-timeslot configuration in the TEST (b3, E1-TPLC-in-  
direct registers - 20~3FH) is ignored. In framed mode, the data to be  
transmitted will only be extracted on the timeslot configured by the TEST  
(b3, E1-TPLC-indirect registers - 20~3FH). Refer to the section of PRBS  
GENERATOR / DETECTOR (PRGD) for details.  
- Enable the payload loopback by setting the LOOP (b2, E1-TPLC-in-  
direct registers - 20~3FH) (refer to Payload Loopback).  
- Replace the data input from the TSDn/MTSD pin with the µ-law or  
A-law milliwatt pattern (refer to Table - 8 & Table - 9) when the SUBS  
(b7, E1-TPLC-indirect registers - 20~3FH), the DS0 (b4, E1-TPLC-indi-  
rect registers - 20~3FH) and the DS1 (b5, E1-TPLC-indirect registers -  
20~3FH) are logic 1,1,1 or 1,1,0 respectively.  
- Selected by the PRGDSEL[2:0] (b7~5, T1/J1-00FH), the test pattern  
from the PRBS Generator/Detector will replace the data input from the  
TSDn pin of one of the eight framers when the RXPATGEN (b2, T1/J1-  
00FH) is 0. The test pattern can replace the data in framed of unframed  
mode. The selection is made by the UN_GEN (b1, T1/J1-00FH). In  
unframed mode, all the 24 channels and the F-bit are replaced and the  
per-channel configuration in the TEST (b3, T1/J1-TPLC-indirect registers  
- 01~18H) is ignored. In framed mode, the received data will only be re-  
placed on the channel specified by the TEST (b3, T1/J1-TPLC-indirect  
registers - 01~18H). Fractional T1/J1 signal can also be replaced in the  
specified channel when the Nx56k_GEN (b4, T1/J1-00FH) is set. Refer  
to the section of PRBS GENERATOR / DETECTOR (PRGD) for details.  
- Replace the data input from the TSDn/MTSD pin with the value in  
the IDLE[7:0] (b7~0, T1/J1-TPLC-indirect registers - 19~30H) when the  
IDLE_DS0 (b6, T1/J1-TPLC-indirect registers - 01~18H) is set.  
- Invert the most significant bit and/or the other bits in a channel input  
from the TSDn pin when the SIGNINV and the INVERT (b4 & b7, T1/J1-  
TPLC-indirect registers - 01~18H) is set.  
(The above methods are arranged from highest to lowest in priority.)  
- Replace the signaling input from the TSSIGn pin with the value in  
the A, B, C, D (b3~0, T1/J1-TPLC-indirect registers - 31~48H) when the  
SIGC[1:0] (b7~6, T1/J1-TPLC-indirect registers - 31~48H) is configured.  
The data of all channels can be selected by the GZCS[1:0] (b1~0, T1/  
J1-044H) to be in GTE and Bell Zero Code Suppression when the bits in  
a channel are all zeros. The setting in the GZCS[1:0] (b1~0, T1/J1-044H)  
are logically ORed with the setting in the ZCS[1:0] (b1~0, T1/J1-TPLC-  
indirect registers - 01~18H).  
- Selected by the PRGDSEL[2:0] (b7~5, E1-00CH), the test pattern  
from the PRBS Generator/Detector will replace the data input from the  
TSDn/MTSD pin of one of the eight framers when the RXPATGEN (b2,  
E1-00CH) is 0. The test pattern can replace the data in framed or  
unframed mode. The selection is made by the UN_GEN (b1, E1-00CH).  
In unframed mode, all the 32 timeslots are replaced and the per-timeslot  
configuration in the TEST (b3, E1-TPLC-indirect registers - 20~3FH) is  
ignored. In framed mode, the received data will only be replaced on the  
timeslot configured by the TEST (b3, E1-TPLC-indirect registers -  
20~3FH). Refer to the section of PRBS GENERATOR / DETECTOR  
(PRGD) for details.  
- Replace the data input from the TSDn/MTSD pin with the value in  
the IDLE[7:0] (b7~0, E1-TPLC-indirect registers - 40~5FH) when the  
SUBS (b7, E1-TPLC-indirect registers - 20~3FH) and the DS0 (b4, E1-  
TPLC-indirect registers - 20~3FH) are logic 1,0.  
- Invert the odd bits, even bits or all bits input from the TSDn/MTSD  
pin when the SUBS (b7, E1-TPLC-indirect registers - 20~3FH), the DS0  
(b4, E1-TPLC-indirect registers - 20~3FH) and the DS1 (b5, E1-TPLC-  
indirect registers - 20~3FH) are logic 0,0,1 or 0,1,0 or 0,1,1 respectively.  
(The above methods are arranged from highest to lowest in priority.)  
- Replace the signaling input from the TSSIGn pin with the value in  
the A, B, C, D (b3~0, E1-TPLC-indirect registers - 61~7FH) with the  
SIGSRC (b4, E1-TPLC indirect registers - 61~7FH) being logic 1 when  
the Channel Associated Signaling (CAS) is selected by the SIGEN (b6,  
E1-040H) & DLEN (b5, E1-040H).  
Addressed by the A[6:0] (b6~0, E1-062H), the data read from or writ-  
ten into the indirect registers are in the D[7:0] (b7~0, E1-063H). The read  
or write operation is determined by the R/WB (b7, E1-062H). The indirect  
registers have a read/write cycle. Before the read/write operation is com-  
Addressed by the A[6:0] (b6~0, T1/J1-032H), the data read from or  
written into the indirect registers are in the D[7:0] (b7~0, T1/J1-033H).  
76  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
The read or write operation is determined by the R/WB (b7, T1/J1- setting will only substitute the IDLE code for the TS1~15 and TS17~31.  
032H). Before the read/write operation is completed, the BUSY (b7, T1/ The TS16 is occupied by signaling. However, the MTRK (b7, E1-041H)  
J1-031H) will be set. New operations on the indirect registers can only takes effect only when the PCCE (b0, E1-060H) in the Transmit Payload  
be implemented when the BUSY (b7, T1/J1-031H) is cleared The read/ Control is logic 1.  
write cycle is 650ns.  
Alarm Indication  
When special conditions occurs in the received data stream, alarm in-  
dication will be transmitted automatically. The alarm indication can also  
be transmitted manually.  
3.15 FRAME GENERATOR (FRMG)  
The Frame Generator of each framer operates independently.  
A logic 1 in the 3rd bit of NFAS (A bit) is the Remote Alarm Indication  
(RAI) signal. It is controlled by the REMAIS (b3, E1-041H), the  
AUTOYELLOW (b3, E1-000H) and the G706RAI (b0, E1-00EH) as illus-  
trated in Table - 36.  
When CRC-4 Multi-Frame is generated, the international bits of frame  
13 & 15 (E1 & E2 bits) are used for FEBE indication only if the FEBEDIS  
(b2, E1-040H) is logic 0. When there are CRC calculated errors in SMF I  
or SMF II in the received data stream, a logic 0 will be automatically re-  
placed in the E1 or the E2 bit for indication respectively. When the re-  
ceived data are out of CRC-4 Multi-Frame synchronization, the E1 and  
E2 bits can be forced to be logic 0 or logic 1, which is selected by the  
OOCMFE0 (b1, E1-00EH).  
When Signaling Multi-Frame is generated, the 6th bit of TS16 of  
frame 0 (Y bit) is for Signaling Multi-frame Alarm Indication. A logic 1 in  
the Y bit means the Signaling Multi-frame Alarm. However, the value of  
the Y bit can be forced to be logic 0 or logic 1 by the MFAIS (b2, E1-  
041H).  
3.15.1 E1 MODE  
In E1 mode, the Frame Generator can generate Basic Frame, CRC-4  
Multi-Frame and Channel Associated Signaling (CAS) Multi-Frame. The  
Frame Generator can also transmit alarm indication signal when special  
conditions occurs in the received data stream. International bits, National  
bits and Extra bits replacement and data invertion are all supported in  
the Frame Generator.  
Generation  
In E1 mode, the data to be transmitted can be formed to be Basic  
Frame, CRC-4 Multi-Frame and Signaling Multi-Frame.  
The Basic Frame is generated when the FDIS (b3, E1-040H) is logic  
0. The Basic Frame alignment sequence (FAS) - X0011011 will replace  
the data on the TS0 of each even frame and a logic 1 should be fixed in  
the 2nd bit of each odd frame.  
The CRC-4 Multi-Frame is generated by setting the GENCRC (b4,  
E1-040H) when the INDIS (b1, E1-040H) is logic 0. The CRC-4 Multi-  
Frame alignment pattern - 001011 will replace the data on the interna-  
tional bits of the odd basic frames 1~11, and the calculated CRC bits will  
replace the data on the international bits of the even Basic Frames. The  
CRC bits are calculated every Sub Multi-Frame (SMF) and located in the  
next SMF. If the data input from the TSDn pin have already been in CRC  
Multi-Frame format, the CRC bits can be modified by setting the  
PATHCRC (b4, E1-002H) to transmit the CRC-4 transparently or modify  
the CRC-4 bits.  
Control Over International / National / Extra Bits  
After the Basic Frame is generated, the international bits (the first bit  
in TS0) can be replaced with the INDIS (b1, E1-040H) being logic 0.  
The setting in the Si[1:0] (b7~6, E1-042H), the CRC-4 Multi-Frame  
and FEBE signal can all replace the international bits. Their priorities are  
controlled by the GENCRC (b4, E1-040H) and the FEBEDIS (b2, E1-  
040H) and illustrated in Table - 37.  
When the setting in the SaX[1:4] (b3~0, E1-047H) is activated by the  
corresponding SaX_EN[1:4] (b7~4, E1-047H), it will replace the data on  
the national bits whose position is selected by the SaSEL[2:0] (b7~5, E1-  
046H).  
When Signaling Multi-Frame is generated, the extra bits (bits 4, 6 & 7  
in TS16 of frame 0 of the Signaling Multi-Frame) can be replaced with  
the setting in the X[2:0] (b0~1 & b3, E1-043H) if the XDIS (b0, E1-040H)  
is logic 0.  
The Signaling Multi-Frame is generated by setting the SIGEN (b6,  
E1-040H) & the DLEN (b5, E1-040H) to logic 1 (CAS enable). The  
Signaling Multi-Frame alignment pattern - 0000 will replace the higher  
nibble (b1 ~ b4) of the TS16 of Basic Frame 0, and the signaling source  
selected by the SIGSRC (b4, E1-TPLC-indirect registers - 61~7FH) will  
replace the data on TS16 of Basic Frame 1~15 (refer to Transmit Pay-  
load Control). When the Signaling Multi-Frame is not generated, setting  
a logic one in the MTRK (b7, E1-041H) will substitute the IDLE code set  
in the IDLE[7:0] (b7~0, E1-TPLC-indirect registers - 40~5FH) for all the  
data on the TS1~31. When the Signaling Multi-Frame is generated, the  
Table - 36. Remote Alarm Indication  
REMAIS  
(b3, E1-041H)  
1
AUTOYELLOW  
(b3, E1-000H)  
-
G706RAI  
(b0, E1-00EH)  
-
Remote Alarm Indication Signal  
Manually force the remote alarm indication signal to be logic 1.  
(per ETSI) The RAI is transmitted in any of the four conditions occurred in the received  
data stream: 1. out of Basic Frame; 2. during AISD; 3. in CRC-4 to non-CRC-4  
interworking; 4. the offline searching is out of Basic Frame sync.  
(per Annex B of G.706) The RAI is transmitted in any of the two conditions occurred in  
the received data stream: 1. out of Basic Frame; 2. during AISD.  
0
0
0
1
0
1
-
The RAI is not transmitted, that is, logic 0 is forced to transmit in its position.  
77  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Table - 37. Content in International Bits (when the INDIS [b1, E1-040H] is logic 0)  
GENCRC  
(b4, E1-040H) (b2, E1-040H)  
FEBEDIS  
The Data on the International Bits  
0
1
-
The international bits of the FAS frame represent the setting in the Si[1] (b7, E1-042H), while the international  
bits of the NFAS frame represent the setting in the Si[0] (b6, E1-042H).  
0
The international bits of the FAS frame represent the calculated CRC-4 bits; the international bits of the  
former six NFAS frames represent the CRC-4 alignment sequence (001011). The other two international bits  
in frame 13 & 15 represent whether there are CRC-4 calculated errors in the received data stream (FEBE).  
The international bits of the FAS frame represent the calculated CRC-4 bits; the international bits of the  
former six NFAS frames represent the CRC-4 alignment sequence (001011). The other two international bits  
in frame 13 & 15 represent the setting in the Si[1:0] (b7~6, E1-042H) respectively.  
1
1
Diagnostics  
and the FDIS (b3, T1/J1-006H) are logic 0, that is, the F-bit can be re-  
For diagnostic purposes, three kinds of data invertion can be ex-  
ecuted:  
placed with the Frame Alignment Pattern, DL and CRC-6 (the DL and  
CRC-6 bits only exist in the ESF format). Thus, the FAS can be replaced  
in its position when the FBITBYP (b2, T1/J1-006H) is logic 0. In SF for-  
mat, the Frame Alignment Pattern is ‘10001101110X’ and replaces the F-  
bit of each frame input from the TSDn pin (refer to Table - 3). In ESF for-  
mat, the Frame Alignment Pattern is ‘001011’ and replaces the F-bit in  
every 4th frame starting with Frame 4. The CRC-6 can replace the F-bit  
in every 4th frame starting with Frame 2 if the CRCBYP (b1, T1/J1-  
006H) is logic 0. The CRC-6 algorithm is selected between the T1 stand-  
ard and the J1 standard by the J1_CRC (b6, T1/J1-044H). The DL bits  
will replace the F-bit in every other frame starting with Frame 1 when the  
FDLBYP (b0, T1/J1-006H) is logic 0 (refer to Table - 4).  
Before the data coming into the Frame Generator, if the SIGC[1:0]  
(b7~6, T1/J1-TPLC-indirect registers - 31~48H) select the signaling bit  
input from the TSDn pin to be replaced with the signaling input from the  
TSSIGn pin, the signaling bit of all channels can be replaced with the  
signaling of the 1st frame when the SIGAEN (b5, T1/J1-006H) is set.  
This configuration is to avoid the signaling change in the middle of a SF/  
ESF.  
The data input from the TSDn pin will be replaced by the code set in  
the IDLE[7:0] (b7~0, T1/J1-TPLC-indirect registers - 19~30H) when the  
MTRK (b7, T1/J1-044H) is set. When the MTRK (b7, T1/J1-044H) is set,  
the signaling bits of all channels may also be replaced by the signaling  
input from the TSSIGn pin or the data set in the A, B, C, D (b3~0, T1/J1-  
TPLC-indirect registers - 31~48H) according to the setting in the  
SIGC[1:0] (b7~6, T1/J1-TPLC-indirect registers - 31~48H). The MTRK  
(b7, T1/J1-044H) takes effect only when the PCCE (b0, T1/J1-030H) in  
1. When Basic Frame is generated, the FAS can be inverted from  
‘0011011’ to ‘1100100’ by setting the FPATINV (b6, E1-041H);  
2. When Basic Frame is generated, the 2nd bit of the NFAS can be  
inverted from ‘1’ to ‘0’ by setting the SPLRINV (b5, E1-041H);  
3. When Signaling Multi-Frame is generated, the Signaling Multi-  
Frame alignment pattern can be inverted from ‘0000’ to ‘1111’ by setting  
the SPATINV (b4, E1-041H).  
Of all the operations, transmitting all ones take the highest priority. All  
ones can be transmitted only in TS16 when the TS16AIS (b1, E1-041H)  
is set. All ones can also be transmitted on all the timeslots when the AIS  
(b0, E1-041H) is set.  
A FIFO is employed in the Frame Generator to store the data stream  
to be transmitted. The FIFO can be initiated by setting the FRESH (b7,  
E1-040H).  
Interrupt Summary  
The interrupt sources are summaried in Table - 38. When the condi-  
tions are met, the corresponding Interrupt Status bit will be logic 1. Then  
the interrupt will occur on the INT pin if the Interrupt Enable bit is logic 1.  
3.15.2 T1 / J1 MODE  
In T1/J1 mode, the data to be transmitted can be either the Super  
Frame (SF) or the Extended Super Frame (ESF) format. The selection is  
made by the ESF (b4, T1/J1-044H).  
The SF/ESF is generated on the base of the UF (b6, T1/J1-046H)  
Table - 38. Interrupt Summary  
No.  
1
Interrupt Sources  
Indication Bits  
SIGMFI  
(b4, E1-045H)  
MFI  
(b2, E1-045H)  
SMFI  
Interrupt Mask Bits  
SIGMFE  
The end of the first frame of a Signaling Multi-Frame is input to the Frame Generator when  
Signaling Multi-Frame is generated and coincides with the CRC Multi-Frame.  
The end of the first frame of a CRC-4 Multi-Frame is input to the Frame Generator when  
CRC Multi-Frame is generated.  
The end of the first frame of a CRC-4 Sub Multi-Frame is input to the Frame Generator  
when CRC Multi-Frame is generated.  
(b4, E1-044H)  
2
3
4
MFE  
(b4, E1-044H)  
SMFE  
(b1, E1-045H)  
(b4, E1-044H)  
The boundary of a FAS is input to the Frame Generator when Basic Frame is generated.  
FASI  
FASE  
(b3, E1-045H)  
(b4, E1-044H)  
78  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
the TPLC is logic 1.  
be realized only if the EN (b0, E1-050H) is set to logic 1; otherwise, all  
Configured by the TXMFP (b1, T1/J1-00AH), the mimic pattern can ones will be transmitted on the assigned data link.  
be inserted in the 1st bit of each channel. The content of the mimic pat-  
A normal HDLC packet (refer to Figure - 3) is started with a 7E (Hex)  
tern is the same as the F-bit. The mimic pattern insertion is for diagnos- flag, then the HDLC data are transmitted. Before closing, two bytes of  
tic purposes.  
CRC-CCITT frame check sequences (FCS) are added if the CRC (b1,  
The Yellow alarm signal can be inserted in the data stream to be E1-050H) is enabled. The HDLC packet is closed with another 7E flag.  
transmitted when the XYEL (b2, T1/J1-045H) is enabled. The alarm sig- However, if the FLGSHARE (b7, E1-050H) is set, the closing flag of the  
nal pattern is selected between the T1 and J1 mode by the J1_YEL (b5, current HDLC packet and the opening flag of the next HDLC packet are  
T1/J1-044H). The pattern is:  
shared.  
A FIFO buffer is used to store the HDLC data written to the TD[7:0]  
(b7~0, E1-055H). The UTHR[6:0] (b6~0, E1-051H) sets the upper  
threshold of the FIFO. When the data exceed the fill level, the data will  
be transmitted. The opening flag will be prepended before the data auto-  
- In T1 SF format: Transmit the logic 0 on the 2nd bit of each channel.  
- In J1 SF format: Transmit the logic 1 on the 12th F-bit.  
- In T1 ESF format: Transmit the ‘FF00’ on each DL of F-bit.  
- In J1 ESF format: Transmit the ‘FFFF’ on each DL of F-bit.  
The Yellow alarm signal can also be inserted automatically by setting matically. The transmission won’t stop until the entire HDLC data are  
the AUTOYELLOW (b3, T1/J1-000H) when Red alarm is declared in the transmitted and the data in the FIFO are below the upper threshold. The  
received data stream.  
end of the current entire HDLC frame is set by the EOM (b3, E1-050H).  
In ESF format, if the Yellow alarm signal is stopped by setting the When it is set, the HDLC data should be transmitted even if they don’t  
XYEL (b2, T1/J1-045H) to be logic 0, a Yellow alarm disabled pattern will exceed the upper threshold of the FIFO. The FCS, if enabled, will be  
be transmitted automatically. In T1 mode, the pattern is ‘FFFF’. In J1 added before the closing flag automatically. Zero stuffing is automatically  
mode, the pattern is ‘FF7E’. The disable pattern should be repeated 16 performed to the serial output data when there are five consecutive ones  
times before the BOC (refer to Bit-Oriented Message Transmitter) or the in the HDLC data or in the FCS. A 7F (Hex) abort sequence which deac-  
HDLC bits (refer to HDLC Transmitter) are inserted in the DL bit. The tivates the current HDLC packet can be inserted anytime the ABT (b2,  
Yellow alarm takes the highest priority in these three kinds of insertion.  
E1-050H) is set. When the ABT (b2, E1-050H) is set, the current byte in  
If there are no Yellow alarm signal, no BOC, no HDLC bits or the TD[7:0] (b7~0, E1-055H) is still transmitted, and then the FIFO is  
noTPLC insertion in the DL of the F-bit, the DL position will be forced to cleared and the 7F abort sequence is transmitted continuously. The low  
transmit ‘FFFF’ in T1 mode or ‘7E7E’ in J1 mode continuously.  
threshold of the FIFO can be set in the LINT[6:0] (b6~0, E1-052H),  
A FIFO is employed in the Frame Generator to store the data stream which should always be less than the value of the UTHR[6:0] (b6~0, E1-  
to be transmitted. The FIFO can be initiated by setting the FRESH (b7, 051H). The FIFO can be cleared anytime the FIFOCLR (b6, E1-050H) is  
T1/J1-006H).  
set. Flags (7E) will consecutively be transmitted when there is no HDLC  
data to be transmitted if the data link is activated.  
Four interrupt sources can be derived from this block.  
3.16 HDLC TRANSMITTER (THDLC)  
1. When the data in the FIFO is empty or less than the setting in the  
LINT[6:0] (b6~0, E1-052H), the BLFILL (b5, E1-054H) will indicate. A  
transition from logic 0 to 1 on the BLFILL (b5, E1-054H) will cause a  
logic 1 in the LFILLI (b0, E1-054H). The interrupt on the INT pin will oc-  
cur when the LFILLE (b0, E1-053H) is enabled;  
The HDLC data insertion is performed in this block. The HDLC Trans-  
mitters #1, #2 and #3 in E1 mode or the HDLC Transmitter #1 and #2 in  
T1/J1 mode ESF format of each framer operate independently.  
3.16.1 E1 MODE  
2. When the data in the FIFO reach its maximum capacity - 128  
bytes, the FULL (b6, E1-054H) will be set for indication. A transition from  
logic 0 to 1 on the FULL (b6, E1-054H) will cause a logic 1 in the FULLI  
(b3, E1-054H). The interrupt on the INT pin will occur when the FULLE  
(b3, E1-053H) is enabled;  
3. When the FIFO has already been filled with 128 bytes and new  
data are still written to it, the FIFO will overflow and the OVRI (b2, E1-  
054H) will be set for indication. The interrupt on the INT pin will occur  
when the OVRE (b2, E1-053H) is enabled.  
4. When the transmission is in process and it is out of data to be  
transmitted in the FIFO, the FIFO is underrun and the UDRI (b1, E1-  
054H) will be set for indication. The interrupt on the INT pin will occur  
when the UDRE (b1, E1-053H) is enabled.  
Three HDLC Transmitter blocks are provided for each framer to trans-  
mit a HDLC link. Before selecting the HDLC link, the TXCISEL (b3, E1-  
0AH) should be set to 1. Thus, the congifuration of Link Control and Bits  
Select registers (addressed from 028H to 02DH) is for THDLC. The  
THDLCSEL[1:0] (b5~4, E1-00AH) select one of the three HDLC control-  
lers to be accessed by the microcontroller. The #2 and #3 blocks can  
also be disabled by setting the V52DIS (b3, E1-007H). The functionality  
of the HDLC link can be defined as the follows:  
1. Set the DL_EVEN (b7, E1-028H or b7, E1-02AH or b7, E1-02CH)  
and/or the DL_ODD (b6, E1-028H or b6, E1-02AH or b6, E1-02CH) to  
select the even and/or odd frames (the even frames are FAS frames  
while the odd frames are NFAS frames);  
2. Set the DL_TS[4:0] (b4~0, E1-028H or b4~0, E1-02AH or b4~0,  
E1-02CH) to select the timeslot of the assigned frame or to select the  
TS16_EN (b5, E1-028H) to define the TS16 of the assigned frame (this  
HDLC link can only be set in the #1 block and is enabled when the CCS  
is selected by the SIGEN [b6, E1-040H] and the DLEN [b5, E1-040H]);  
3. Set the DL_BIT[7:0] (b7~0, E1-029H or b7~0, E1-02BH or b7~0,  
E1-02DH) to select the bit of the assigned timeslot.  
3.16.2 T1 / J1 MODE  
In the SF format, there is no HDLC link.  
In the ESF format, two HDLC Transmitter blocks (#1 and #2) are em-  
ployed for each framer to transmit the HDLC link. Before selecting the  
HDLC link, the TXCISEL (b3, T1/J1-00DH) should be set to 1. Thus, the  
configuration of the Link Control and Bits Select registers (addressed  
from 070H to 071H) is for THDLC. Selected by the THDLCSEL[1:0]  
Thereafter, the HDLC packet will replace the data on the assigned  
data link. All the functions of the selected HDLC Transmitter block can  
79  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
(b5~4, T1/J1-00DH), registers in one of the two HDLC Transmitter transmitted in the FIFO, the FIFO is underrun and the UDRI (b1, T1/J1-  
blocks are accessable to the microprocessor. The #1 block transmits the 038H) will be set for indication. The interrupt on the INT pin will occur  
HDLC link in the DL of F-bit (its position is shown in the Table - 4). The when the UDRE (b1, T1/J1-037H) is enabled.  
#2 block transmits the HDLC link in a channel and its position is selected  
as follows:  
3.17 BIT-ORIENTED MESSAGE TRANSMITTER (TBOM)  
1. Set the DL2_EVEN (b7, T1/J1-070H) and/or the DL2_ODD (b6,  
T1/J1-070H) to select the even and/or odd frames;  
- T1 / J1 ONLY  
The Bit Oriented Message (BOM) can only be transmitted in the ESF  
2. Set the DL2_TS[4:0] (b4~0, T1/J1-070H) to select the channel of  
format in T1/J1 mode. The standard of the BOM is defined in the ANSI  
the assigned frame;  
T1.403-1989. The Bit Oriented Message (BOM) of each framer operates  
independently.  
3. Set the DL2_BIT[7:0] (b7~0, T1/J1-071H) to select the bit of the  
assigned channel.  
The BOM pattern is ‘111111110XXXXXX0’ which occupies the DL of  
All the functions of the selected HDLC Transmitter block can be real-  
the F-bit in the ESF format (refer to Table - 4). The six ‘X’s represent the  
ized only if the EN (b0, T1/J1-034H) is enabled; otherwise, all ones will  
code that can be programmed in the BOC[5:0] (b5~0, T1/J1-05DH).  
be transmitted on the assigned data link.  
When the BOC[5:0] (b5~0, T1/J1-05DH) are written with the bits other  
The structure of the HDLC packet (refer to Figure - 3) is the same as  
than the ‘111111’, they will occupy the six ‘X’s’ positions and the BOM will  
it is described in the E1 mode. When the FLGSHARE (b7, T1/J1-034H)  
be transmitted.  
is set, the closing flag of the current HDLC and the opening flag of the  
If the BOM transmission is stopped by setting all ones in the  
next HDLC is shared.  
BOC[5:0] (b5~0, T1/J1-05DH), a BOM disabled pattern will be transmit-  
A FIFO buffer is used to store the HDLC data written to the TD[7:0]  
ted automatically. In T1 mode, the pattern is ‘FFFF’. In J1 mode, the pat-  
(b7~0, T1/J1-039H). The UTHR[6:0] (b6~0, T1/J1-035H) limit the upper  
tern is ‘FF7E’. The disable pattern should be repeated 16 times before  
threshold of the FIFO. When the data exceed the fill level, the data will  
the HDLC bits (refer to HDLC Transmitter) are inserted in the DL bit. The  
be transmitted. The opening flag will be added before the data automati-  
transmission of the BOM takes priority over any other substitutions of the  
cally. The transmission won’t stop until an entire HDLC frame is trans-  
DL bit except for the Yellow alarm signal.  
mitted and the data in the FIFO is below the upper threshold. The end of  
the current entire HDLC frame is indicated by the EOM (b3, T1/J1-  
3.18 INBAND LOOPBACK CODE GENERATOR (IBCG) -  
034H). When it is set, the HDLC data should be transmitted even if it  
T1 / J1 ONLY  
does not exceed the upper threshold of the FIFO. The FCS, if enabled  
by the CRC (b1, T1/J1-034H), will be added before the closing flag auto-  
matically. Zero stuffing is automatically performed to the serial output  
data when there are five consecutive ones in the HDLC data or in the  
FCS. A 7F abort sequence which deactivates the current HDLC packet  
can be inserted anytime the ABT (b2, T1/J1-034H) is set. When the ABT  
(b2, T1/J1-034H) is set, the current byte in the TD[7:0] (b7~0, T1/J1-  
039H) is still transmitted, and then the FIFO is cleared and the 7F abort  
sequence is transmitted continuously. The low threshold of the FIFO can  
be set in the LINT[6:0] (b6~0, T1/J1-036H), which should always be less  
than the value of the UTHR[6:0] (b6~0, T1/J1-035H). The FIFO can be  
cleared anytime the FIFOCLR (b6, T1/J1-034H) is set. Flags (7E) will  
consecutively be transmitted when there is no HDLC data to be trans-  
mitted during the data link activating.  
The Inband Loopback Code Generator can only transmit inband  
loopback code in a framed or unframed T1/J1 data stream. The Inband  
Loopback Code Generator of each framer operates independently.  
The length and the content of the inband loopback code are pro-  
grammed in the CL[1:0] (b1~0, T1/J1-046H) and the IBC[7:0] (b7~0, T1/  
J1-047H) respectively. The code can only be transmitted when the EN  
(b7, T1/J1-046H) is enabled. In framed mode, which is configured by the  
UF (b6, T1/J1-046H), the F-bit can be replaced by the Frame Alignment  
Pattern, DL and CRC-6 which are set in the Frame Generator block and  
the 24 channels are replaced with the inband loopback code. In un-  
framed mode, which is configured by the UF (b6, T1/J1-046H), all 193  
bits are replaced with the inband loopback code.  
It is recommended that the setting of the EN (b7, T1/J1-046H) and  
the UF (b6, T1/J1-046H) should be the same.  
Four interrupt sources can be derived from this block.  
1. When the FIFO is empty or the data in the FIFO is less than the  
setting in the LINT[6:0] (b6~0, T1/J1-036H), the BLFILL (b5, T1/J1-038H) 3.19 JITTER ATTENUATOR (RJAT/TJAT)  
will be set for indication. A transition from logic 0 to 1 on the BLFILL (b5,  
T1/J1-038H) will cause a logic 1 in the LFILLI (b0, T1/J1-038H). The in-  
terrupt on the INT pin will occur when the LFILLE (b0, T1/J1-037H) is  
enabled;  
2. When the data in the FIFO reach its maximum capacity - 128  
bytes, the FULL (b6, T1/J1-038H) will be set for indication. A transition  
from logic 0 to 1 on the FULL (b6, T1/J1-038H) will cause a logic 1 in the  
FULLI (b3, T1/J1-038H). The interrupt on the INT pin will occur when the  
FULLE (b3, T1/J1-037H) is enabled;  
3. When the FIFO has been filled with 128 bytes already and new  
data are still written to it, the FIFO is will overflow and the OVRI (b2, T1/  
J1-038H) will be set for indication. The interrupt on the INT pin will occur  
when the OVRE (b2, T1/J1-037H) is enabled.  
The Jitter Attenuator of each framer operates independently  
3.19.1 E1 MODE  
Two Jitter Attenuators are provided independently in the receive path  
and the transmit path.  
The Jitter Attenuator integrates a FIFO and a DPLL. The smoothed  
clock output from the jitter attenuator is generated by adaptively dividing  
the 49.152MHz XCK according to the phase difference between the out-  
put smoothed clock and the input reference clock. The ratio between the  
frequency of the input reference clock and the frequency applied to the  
phase discriminator input is equal to the (N1 + 1) (the N1 is in b7~0, E1-  
021H for receive path and in b7~0, E1-025H for transmit path). The ratio  
between the frequency of the output smoothed clock and the frequency  
applied to the phase discriminator input is equal to the (N2 + 1) (the N2  
4. When the transmission is in process and it is out of data to be  
80  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
is in b7~0, E1-022H for receive path and in b7~0, E1-026H for transmit specified, however, outgoing jitter may be dominated by the generated  
path). The phase fluctuations of the input reference clock are attenuated residual jitter in cases where incoming jitter is insignificant. This  
by dividing the input reference clock and output smoothed clock by the generated residual jitter is directly related to the use of 24X (49.152MHz)  
(N1 + 1) and the (N2 + 1) respectively in the DPLL so that the frequency digital phase locked loop for transmit clock generation.  
of the output smoothed clock is equal to the average frequency of the in-  
The Jitter Attenuator meets the jitter transfer requirements of ITU-T  
put reference clock. The phase fluctuations with a jitter frequency above Recommendations G.737, G.738, G.739, and G.742.  
8.8Hz are attenuated by 6dB per octave when the N1 (b7~0, E1-021H  
for receive path and b7~0, E1-025H for transmit path) and the N2 (b7~0, Jitter Tolerance  
E1-022H for receive path and b7~0, E1-026H for transmit path) are set  
Jitter tolerance is the maximum input phase jitter at a given jitter  
to their default value. It will change when the N1 and the N2 are frequency that a device can accept without exceeding its linear operating  
changed. Generally, when the N1 and the N2 increase, the curves of the range, or corrupting data. For the Jitter Attenuator, the input jitter  
Jitter Tolerance and Jitter Transfer in the graph will left-shift and when tolerance is 43 UIpp with no frequency offset. The frequency offset is the  
N1 and N2 decrease, they will right-shift. The phase fluctuations (wan- difference between the frequency of XCK divided by 24 and that of the  
der) with frequency below 8.8Hz are tracked by the output smoothed input reference clock.  
clock. The output smoothed clock is used to clock the data out of the  
FIFO.  
Refer to Figure - 63 for the Jitter Tolerance.  
The FIFO is is 48 bits deep. If data is still written into the FIFO when Jitter Transfer  
the FIFO is already full, overflow will occur and the OVRI (b1, E1-020H  
The output jitter for jitter frequencies from 0 to 9 Hz is no more than  
for receive path and b1, E1-024H for transmit path) will indicate. If data 0.1dB greater than the input jitter. Jitter frequencies above 9 Hz are at-  
is still read from the FIFO when the FIFO is already empty, under-run tenuated at a level of 6 dB per octave, as shown in Figure - 64.  
will occur and the UNDI (b0, E1-020H for receive path and b0, E1-024H  
for transmit path) will indicate. Thus, if the OVRE (b2, E1-023H for re- Frequency Range  
ceive path and b2, E1-027H for transmit path) and the UNDE (b3, E1-  
In the non-attenuating mode, that is, when the FIFO is within one UI  
023H for receive path and b3, E1-027H for transmit path) are set re- of overrunning or under running, the tracking range is 1.963 to 2.133  
spectively, the interrupts on the INT pin will occur. The jitter attenuation MHz. The guaranteed linear operating range is 2.048 MHz ± 1278 Hz  
can be limited by setting the LIMIT (b0, E1-023H for receive path and with no jitter or XCK frequency offset.  
b0, E1-027H for transmit path) to keep the FIFO 1UI away from being  
full or empty. Thus, the DPLL will track the jitter of the input reference  
clock by increasing or decreasing the frequency of the output smoothed  
clock to prevent the FIFO being empty or full. The FIFO can also self-  
center its read pointer by setting the CENT (b4, E1-023H for receive  
path and b4, E1-027H for transmit path). The FIFO can be set to be by-  
passed by the FIFOBYP (b7, E1-000H for receive path and b7, E1-002H  
for transmit path).  
However, in Transmit Clock Master mode, the TJAT should be by-  
passed.  
Jitter Characteristics  
Each Jitter Attenuator block provides excellent jitter tolerance and  
jitter attenuation while generating minimal residual jitter. It can  
accommodate up to 43UIpp of input jitter at jitter frequencies above 9Hz.  
For jitter frequencies below 9Hz, which can be correctly called wander,  
the tolerance increases 20dB per decade. In most applications the each  
Jitter Attenuator block will limit jitter tolerance at lower jitter frequencies  
only. For high frequency jitter, above 10kHz for example, other factors  
such as clock and data recovery circuitry may limit jitter tolerance and  
must be considered. For low frequency wander, below 10Hz for  
example, other factors such as slip buffer hysteresis may limit wander  
tolerance and must be considered. The Jitter Attenuator blocks meet the  
low frequency jitter tolerance requirements ITU-T Recommendation  
G.823.  
The Jitter Attenuator exhibits negligible jitter gain for jitter frequencies  
below 9Hz, and attenuates jitter at frequencies above 9Hz by 20dB per  
decade. In most applications the Jitter Attenuator blocks will determine  
jitter attenuation for higher jitter frequencies only. Wander, below 10Hz  
for example, will essentially be passed unattenuated through the Jitter  
Attenuator. Jitter, above 10Hz for example, will be attenuated as  
81  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Amp.(UI)  
7Hz,64UI  
9Hz,43UI  
100  
1.667,18UI  
10  
4.88x10-3, 36.9UI  
18UI  
G.823  
1
18k,0.2UI  
20,1.5UI  
2.4k,1.5UI  
1000  
Frequency(Hz)  
0.1  
0.001  
0.01  
0.1  
1
10  
100  
10k  
100k  
Figure - 63. E1 Mode Jitter Tolerance (N1 = N2 = 2fH)  
Attenuation(db)  
40Hz,0.5db  
0
20db/decade  
9Hz,-3db  
G.823  
1
10  
100  
Frequency(Hz)  
Figure - 64. E1 Mode Jitter Transfer (N1 = N2 = 2fH)  
82  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
only. For high frequency jitter, above 10kHz for example, other factors  
such as clock and data recovery circuitry may limit jitter tolerance and  
3.19.2 T1 / J1 MODE  
Two Jitter Attenuators are provided independly in the receive path must be considered. For low frequency wander, below 10Hz for  
and the transmit path. example, other factors such as slip buffer hysteresis may limit wander  
The Jitter Attenuator integrates a FIFO and a DPLL. The smoothed tolerance and must be considered. The Jitter Attenuator blocks meet the  
clock output from the jitter attenuator is generated by adaptively dividing low frequency jitter tolerance requirements AT&T TR 62411 for T1.  
the 37.056MHz XCK according to the phase difference between the out-  
The Jitter Attenuator exhibits negligible jitter gain for jitter frequencies  
put smoothed clock and the input reference clock. The ratio between the below 7Hz, and attenuates jitter at frequencies above 7Hz by 20 dB per  
frequency of the input reference clock and the frequency applied to the decade. In most applications the Jitter Attenuator blocks will determine  
phase discriminator input is equal to the (N1 + 1) (the N1 is in b7~0, T1/ jitter attenuation for higher jitter frequencies only. Wander, below 10 Hz  
J1-011H for receive path and in b7~0, T1/J1-019H for transmit path). The for example, will essentially be passed unattenuated through DJAT. Jitter,  
ratio between the frequency of the output smoothed clock and the fre- above 10 Hz for example, will be attenuated as specified, however,  
quency applied to the phase discriminator input is equal to the (N2 + 1) outgoing jitter may be dominated by the generated residual jitter in cases  
(the N2 is in b7~0, T1/J1-012H for receive path and in b7~0, T1/J1-01AH where incoming jitter is insignificant. This generated residual jitter is  
for transmit path). The phase fluctuations of the input reference clock are directly related to the use of 24X (37.056MHz) digital phase locked loop  
attenuated by dividing the input reference clock and output smoothed for transmit clock generation.  
clock by the (N1 + 1) and the (N2 + 1) respectively in the DPLL so that  
The Jitter Attenuator meets the jitter transfer requirements of AT&T  
the frequency of the output smoothed clock is equal to the average fre- TR 62411. The block allows to meet the implied jitter attenuation  
quency of the input reference clock. The phase fluctuations with a jitter requirements for a TE or NT1 given in ANSI Standard T1.408, and the  
frequency above 6.6Hz are attenuated by 6dB per octave when the N1 implied jitter attenuation requirements for a type II customer interface  
(b7~0, T1/J1-011H for receive path and b7~0, T1/J1-019H for transmit given in ANSI T1.403.  
path) and the N2 (b7~0, T1/J1-012H for receive path and b7~0, T1/J1-  
01AH for transmit path) are in their default value. It will change when the Jitter Tolerance  
N1 and the N2 are changed. Generally, when the N1 and the N2 in-  
Jitter tolerance is the maximum input phase jitter at a given jitter  
crease, the curves of the Jitter Tolerance and Jitter Transfer in the graph frequency that a device can accept without exceeding its linear operating  
will left-shift and When N1 and N2 decrease, they will right-shift. The range, or corrupting data. For the Jitter Attenuator, the input jitter  
phase fluctuations (wander) with frequency below 6.6Hz are tracked by tolerance is 48 UIpp with no frequency offset. The frequency offset is the  
the output smoothed clock. The output smoothed clock is used to clock difference between the frequency of XCK divided by 24 and that of the  
the data out of the FIFO.  
input reference clock.  
The FIFO is 48 bits deep. If data is still written into the FIFO when  
the FIFO is already full, overflow will occur and the OVRI (b1, T1/J1-  
010H for receive path and b1, T1/J1-018H for transmit path) will indicate.  
If data is still read from the FIFO when the FIFO is already empty,  
underrun will occur and the UNDI (b0, T1/J1-010H for receive path and  
b0, T1/J1-018H for transmit path) will indicate. Thus, if the OVRE (b2,  
T1/J1-013H for receive path and b2, T1/J1-01BH for transmit path) and  
the UNDE (b3, T1/J1-013H for receive path and b3, T1/J1-01BH for  
transmit path) are set respectively, the interrupts on the INT pin may oc-  
cur. The jitter attenuation can be limited by setting the LIMIT (b0, T1/J1-  
013H for receive path and b0, T1/J1-01BH for transmit path) to keep the  
FIFO 1UI away from being full or empty,. Thus, the DPLL will track the  
jitter of the input reference clock by increasing or decreasing the fre-  
quency of the output smoothed clock to prevent the FIFO being empty or  
full. The FIFO can also self-center its read pointer by setting the CENT  
(b4, T1/J1-013H for receive path and b4, T1/J1-01BH for transmit path).  
The FIFO can be set to be bypassed by the FIFOBYP (b7, T1/J1-000H  
for receive path and b7, T1/J1-004H for transmit path).  
Refer to Figure - 65 for the Jitter Tolerance.  
Jitter Transfer  
The output jitter for jitter frequencies from 0 to 7Hz is no more than  
0.1 dB greater than the input jitter. Jitter frequencies above 7Hz are at-  
tenuated at a level of 6 dB per octave, as shown in Figure - 66.  
Frequency Range  
In the non-attenuating mode, that is, when the FIFO is within one UI  
of overrunning or under running, the tracking range is 1.48 to 1.608  
MHz. The guaranteed linear operating range is 1.544 MHz ± 963 Hz  
(for T1) with no jitter or XCK frequency offset.  
However, in Transmit Clock Master mode, the TJAT should be by-  
passed.  
Jitter Characteristics  
Each Jitter Attenuator block provides excellent jitter tolerance and  
jitter attenuation while generating minimal residual jitter. It can  
accommodate up to 45UI of input jitter at jitter frequencies above 12HZ.  
For jitter frequencies below 9 Hz, which can be correctly called wander,  
the tolerance increases 20dB per decade. In most applications the each  
Jitter Attenuator block will limit jitter tolerance at lower jitter frequencies  
83  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
UI(jitter)  
Amp.(UI)  
4Hz,76UI  
100  
12Hz,45UI  
138UI  
4.9Hz,28UI  
10  
TR62411  
300Hz,10UI  
0.31Hz,10UI  
1
0.2UI  
10Hz,0.3UI  
TR-TSY-000170  
Frequency(Hz)  
0.1  
0.1  
1
10  
100  
1K  
10K  
100K  
Figure - 65. T1/J1 Mode Jitter Tolerance (N1 = N2 = 2fH)  
Attenuation(Db)  
0
-20  
-40  
-60  
-80  
20Hz,0db  
20db/decade  
7Hz,-3Db  
TR62411  
1
10  
100  
1k  
10k  
Frequency(Hz)  
Figure - 66. T1/J1 Mode Jitter Transfer (N1 = N2 = 2fH)  
84  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
LRCKn is selected by the RCKFALL (b7, E1-001H).  
3.20 TRANSMIT CLOCK  
On the transmit line interface, the data to be transmitted on the LTDn  
pin are updated on the active edge of the LTCKn. The active edge of the  
LTCKn is selected by the LTCKRISE (b0, E1-002H). All ones can be  
forced to transmit on the LTDn pin when the TAISEN (b6, E1-002H) is  
configured. All zeros can also be forced to transmitted when the TXDIS  
(b0, E1-007H) is configured.  
The Transmit Clock of each framer operates independently.  
3.20.1 E1 MODE  
The Transmit Clock helps the Transmit Jitter Attenuator to select the  
source of the input reference clock for the DPLL, and selects the clock  
source used to drive the clock to be output on the LTCKn pin. Refer to  
Figure - 67 for details.  
3.21.2 T1 / J1 MODE  
On the receive line interface, the received data on the LRDn pin are  
sampled on the active edge of the LRCKn. The active edge of the  
LRCKn is selected by the LRCKFALL (b2, T1/J1-003H).  
On the transmit line interface, the data to be transmitted on the LTDn  
pin are updated on the active edge of the LTCKn. The active edge of the  
LTCKn is selected by the LTCKRISE (b0, T1/J1-004H). All ones can be  
forced to transmitted on the LTDn pin when the TAISEN (b6, T1/J1-  
004H) is configured. All zeros can also be forced to transmit when the  
TXDIS (b0, T1/J1-00AH) is configured.  
3.20.2 T1 / J1 MODE  
The Transmit Clock helps the Transmit Jitter Attenuator to select the  
source of the input reference clock for the DPLL, and selects the clock  
source used to drive the clock to be output on the LTCKn pin. Refer to  
Figure - 67 for details.  
3.21 LINE INTERFACE  
3.21.1 E1 MODE  
On the receive line interface, the received data on the LRDn pin are  
sampled on the active edge of the LRCKn. The active edge of the  
TSCCKA  
TSCCKB  
LRCK  
XCK/24  
LTCKn  
TSCCKA  
TSCCKA/8  
TSCCKB  
input reference clock  
output smoothed clock  
LRCK  
XCK/24  
Transmit  
Clock  
DPLL  
TSCCKA/8  
selected by the LTCK_SEL[2:0]  
(b2~0, E1-004H) / (b2~0, T1/J1-007H)  
Transmit  
Jitter Attenuator  
selected by the TJATREF_SEL[2:0]  
(b5~3, E1-004H) / (b5~3, T1/J1-007H)  
FIFO  
data to be transmitted  
LTDn  
Figure - 67. Transmit Clock Select  
85  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
3.22 INTERRUPT SUMMARY  
3.23.3 PAYLOAD LOOPBACK  
By programming the LOOP (b2, E1-TPLC-indirect registers-20~3FH /  
b2, T1/J1-TPLC-indirect registers-10~18H) (the PCCE [b0, E1-060H /  
b0, T1/J1-030H] in the TPLC must be logic 1), each framer can be set in  
the Payload Loopback mode. When Receive Clock Master modes are  
enabled, the Elastic Store is used to align the line received data to the  
frame to be transmitted. When Receive Clock Slave modes are ena-  
bled, the Elastic Store is unavailable to implement the payload loop-  
backs, and loop-back functionality is provided only when the Transmit  
System Interfaces are also in a Transmit Clock Slave mode, and the re-  
ceived and transmitting clocks and frame alignment are identical  
(RSCCK = TSCCKB, RSCFS = TSCFS). Thus, the selected timeslot/  
channel in the transmit path will be overwritten by the corresponding re-  
ceived timeslot/channel. The remaining timeslots/channels in the trans-  
mit path are intact. Figure - 70 shows the process.  
3.22.1 E1 MODE  
When the INT pin asserts low, which means at least one interrupt has  
occurred in the device, reading the INT[8:1] (b7~0, E1-00BH) will find in  
which framer the interrupt occurs. After reading the INT regiser, the in-  
terrupt source bits from the interrupting framer are read. The Interrupt  
Source bits (PMON [b7, E1-005H], FRMG [b6, E1-005H], FRMP [b5,  
E1-005H], PRGD [b4, E1-005H], ELSB [b3, E1-005H], RHDLC#1 [b2,  
E1-005H], RHDLC#2 [b1, E1-005H], RHDLC#3 [b0, E1-005H], TRSI [b7,  
E1-006H], TJAT [b5, E1-006H], RJAT [b4, E1-006H], THDLC#1 [b3, E1-  
006H], THDLC#2 [b2, E1-006H], THDLC#3 [b1, E1-006H] and RCRB  
[b0, E1-006H]) will be logic 1 if there are interrupts in the corresponding  
block. To find the eventual interrupt sources, the interrupt Indication and  
Status bits in the block are polled if their Interrupt Enable bits are ena-  
bled. Then the sources are served after they are found.  
3.22.2 T1 / J1 MODE  
3.24 CLOCK MONITOR  
When the INT pin asserts low, which means at least one interrupt has  
occurred in the device, reading the INT[8:1] (b7~0, T1/J1-00EH) will find  
that in which framer the interrupt occurs. After reading the INT regiser,  
the interrupt source bits from the interrupting framer are read. The Inter-  
rupt Source bits (PMON [b7, T1/J1-008H], IBCD [b6, T1/J1-008H],  
FRMP [b5, T1/J1-008H], PRGD [b4, T1/J1-008H], ELSB [b3, T1/J1-  
008H], RHDLC#1 [b2, T1/J1-008H], RBOM [b1, T1/J1-008H], ALMD [b0,  
T1/J1-008H], RHDLC#2 [b7, T1/J1-009H], TJAT [b5, T1/J1-009H], RJAT  
[b4, T1/J1-009H], THDLC#1 [b3, T1/J1-009H], THDLC#2 [b2, T1/J1-  
009H] and RCRB [b0, T1/J1-009H]) will be logic 1 if there are interrupts  
in the corresponding block. To find the eventual interrupt sources, the in-  
terrupt Indication and Status bits in the block are polled if their Interrupt  
Enable bits are enabled. Then the sources are served after they are  
found.  
The transition from low to high of the Crystal Clock (XCK), the Trans-  
mit Side System Common Clock #A (TSCCKA), the Transmit Side Sys-  
tem Common Clock #B (TSCCKB), the Receive Side System Common  
Clock (RSCCK) and the Line Receive Clock (LRCK) are monitored and  
are reported by the XCK (b4, E1-00DH / b4, T1/J1-027H), the TSCCKB  
(b3, E1-00DH / b3, T1/J1-027H), the TSCCKA (b2, E1-00DH / b2, T1/J1-  
027H), the RSCCK (b1, E1-00DH / b1, T1/J1-027H) and the LRCK (b0,  
E1-00DH / b0, T1/J1-027H) respectively.  
However, another Interrupt Source bit PRTY (b6, T1/J1-009H) is pro-  
vided to route to the pending parity error.  
3.23 LOOPBACK MODE  
There are three diagnostic loopback modes: Line Loopback, Digital  
Loopback and Payload Loopback are provided in this device.  
3.23.1 LINE LOOPBACK  
By programming the LINEB (b4, E1-007H / b4, T1/J1-00AH), each  
framer can be set in the Line Loopback mode. In this configuration, the  
jitter-attenuated clock and data from the Receive Jitter Attenuator are  
looped internally to the Line Transmit Clock and Data (LTDn and LTCKn).  
However, the Receive Jitter Attenuator can be bypassed if required. The  
received data stream is still output to the system side while the data  
stream input from the system side is ignored. Figure - 68 shows the proc-  
ess.  
3.23.2 DIGITAL LOOPBACK  
By programming the DDLB (b2, E1-007H / b2, T1/J1-00AH), each  
framer can be set in the Digital Loopback mode. In this configuration, the  
data to be transmitted on the LTCKn and LTDn are looped internally to  
the Line Receive Clock and Data (LRDn and LRCKn). The data stream  
to be transmitted is still output to the line side while the data stream re-  
ceived from the line side is ignored. Figure - 69 shows the process.  
86  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
One of the Eight Framers  
TSCCKA  
Transmit  
Clock  
TSCCKB/  
MTSCCKB  
TSCFS/  
MTSCFS  
Transmit  
System  
Interface  
TSFSn/  
TSSIGn  
MTSSIG[1:2]  
MTSD[1:2]  
Transmit  
Payload  
Control  
Frame Generator  
Transmit  
Jitter  
Attenuator  
LTCKn  
LTDn  
TSDn  
Bit-  
Oriented  
Message  
Inband  
HDLC  
Loopback  
Transmitter  
#2 #3  
Code  
#1  
Transmitter  
Generator  
PRBS  
Generator  
/Detector  
XCK  
Inband  
Loopback  
Code  
Bit-Oriented  
Message  
Receiver  
Detector  
HDLC  
Receiver #1  
Alarm  
Detector  
Line  
Loopback  
#2 #3  
MRSD[1:2]  
RSDn  
Receive  
CAS/RBS  
Buffer  
Receive  
Payload  
Control  
RSCKn/  
RSSIGn  
MRSSIG[1:2]  
MRSFS[1:2]  
Frame Processor  
LRCKn  
LRDn  
Receive  
System  
Interface  
Receive  
Jitter  
Attenuator  
RSFSn  
Performance  
Monitor  
RSCCK/  
MRSCCK  
Elastic  
Store  
Buffer  
RSCFS/  
MRSCFS  
Figure - 68. Line Loopback  
87  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
One of the Eight Framers  
TSCCKA  
Transmit  
Clock  
TSCCKB/  
MTSCCKB  
TSCFS/  
MTSCFS  
Transmit  
System  
Interface  
TSFSn/  
TSSIGn  
MTSSIG[1:2]  
MTSD[1:2]  
Transmit  
Payload  
Control  
Frame Generator  
Transmit  
Jitter  
Attenuator  
LTCKn  
LTDn  
TSDn  
Bit-  
Oriented  
Message  
Inband  
HDLC  
Loopback  
Transmitter  
Digital  
Loopback  
#2 #3  
Code  
#1  
Transmitter  
Generator  
PRBS  
Generator  
/Detector  
Inband  
Loopback  
Code  
XCK  
Bit-Oriented  
Message  
Receiver  
Detector  
HDLC  
Alarm  
Receiver #1 #2 #3  
Frame Processor  
Detector  
MRSD[1:2]  
RSDn  
Receive  
CAS/RBS  
Buffer  
Receive  
Payload  
Control  
RSCKn/  
RSSIGn  
MRSSIG[1:2]  
MRSFS[1:2]  
LRCKn  
LRDn  
Receive  
System  
Interface  
Receive  
Jitter  
Attenuator  
RSFSn  
Performance  
Monitor  
RSCCK/  
MRSCCK  
Elastic  
Store  
Buffer  
RSCFS/  
MRSCFS  
Figure - 69. Digital Loopback  
88  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
One of the Eight Framers  
TSCCKA  
Transmit  
Clock  
TSCCKB/  
MTSCCKB  
TSCFS/  
MTSCFS  
Transmit  
System  
Interface  
TSFSn/  
TSSIGn  
MTSSIG[1:2]  
MTSD[1:2]  
Transmit  
Payload  
Control  
Frame Generator  
Transmit  
Jitter  
Attenuator  
LTCKn  
LTDn  
TSDn  
Inband  
Loopback  
Code  
Bit-Oriented  
Message  
Transmitter  
HDLC  
Transmitter  
#1  
#2 #3  
Generator  
Payload  
Loopback  
PRBS  
Generator  
/Detector  
XCK  
Inband  
Loopback  
Code  
Bit-Oriented  
Message  
Receiver  
Detector  
Alarm  
Detector Receiver #1  
HDLC  
#2 #3  
MRSD[1:2]  
RSDn  
Receive  
CAS/RBS  
Buffer  
Receive  
Payload  
Control  
RSCKn/  
RSSIGn  
Frame Processor  
MRSSIG[1:2]  
MRSFS[1:2]  
LRCKn  
LRDn  
Receive  
System  
Interface  
Receive  
Jitter  
Attenuator  
RSFSn  
Performance  
Monitor  
RSCCK/  
MRSCCK  
Elastic  
Store  
Buffer  
RSCFS/  
MRSCFS  
Figure - 70. Payload Loopback  
89  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
- Mode: the default operation mode of the device is T1 mode. When  
the E1 mode is desired, the TEMODE (b0, 400H) must be set to logic 0.  
- Receive Path: the default setting of each block in the receive path  
is illustrated in Table - 39.  
4
OPERATION  
4.1 E1 MODE  
- Transmit Path: the default setting of each block in the transmit path  
is illustrated in Table - 40.  
4.1.1  
When the device is powered-up, all the registers contain their default  
values.  
Any of the eight framers can be reset anytime when the RESET (b0,  
E1-00AH / b0, T1/J1-00DH) in its framer is set. The device can also be  
reset anytime when the RST pin is low for at least 100ns.  
After the hardware reset, the IDT82V2108 will default to the  
following settings:  
DEFAULT SETTING  
4.1.2  
VARIOUS OPERATION MODES CONFIGURATION  
Five operation modes can be set in the receive path and four opera-  
tion modes can be set in the transmit path. In each operation mode, the  
configurations in Table - 41 and Table - 42 are illustrated for reference.  
Table - 39. Default Setting in Receive Path  
Function Block  
Default Setting Description  
Line Interface  
• The LRDn inputs Non-Return to Zero (NRZ) data and are sampled on rising edge of the LRCKn.  
• The RJAT Clock Divisors (N1, N2) are set to ‘2F’ .  
Frame Processor  
• Basic Frame per G.704 with CRC Multi-Frame enabled.  
• Channel Associated Signaling enabled.  
HDLC Receiver #1, #2, #3  
Receive System Interface  
• RHDLCs disabled.  
• In Receive Clock Slave External Signaling Mode.  
• The data on the RSDn, RSSIGn pins are updated on rising edge of the RSCCK.  
• RSCFS indicates Basic Frame Alignment.  
• RSDn, RSSIGn, RSFSn pins are held in high-impedance state.  
• The PRGD is configured to monitor the extracted data patterns in Frame One.  
PRGD  
Table - 40. Default Setting in Transmit Path  
Function Block  
Default Setting Description  
PRGD  
• The PRGD is configured to insert test patterns to Frame One.  
• In Transmit Clock Slave External Signaling Mode.  
Transmit System Interface  
• The data on the TSDn and TSSIGn pins are sampled on rising edge of TSCCKB.  
• CRC Multi-Frame is disabled.  
FrameGenerator  
• Channel Associated Signaling is enabled.  
HDLC Transmitter #1, #2, #3  
Line Interface  
• THDLCs are disabled.  
• The LTDn outputs Non-Return to Zero (NRZ) data and is updated on falling edge of LTCKn.  
• TJAT Clock Divisors (N1, N2) are set to ‘2F’  
• Digital jitter attenuation is enabled. The PLL is synchronized to the TSCCKB clock. The smoothed clock  
output from the PLL is selected as the LTCKn.  
90  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Table - 41. Various Operation Modes in Receive Path for Reference  
Mode  
Register 1  
001H  
Value (from Bit7 to Bit0)  
00000000  
Description 2  
In Receive Clock Slave RSCK Reference mode. The RSCK is 8KHZ.  
The output on the RSFSn pin is determined by the ROHM, BRXSMFP, BRCMFP  
and ALTIFP.  
In Receive Clock Slave mode. The FE and DE are both 0. The receive  
backplane rate is 2.048Mbit/s.  
Receive Clock  
Slave RSCK  
Reference Mode  
00EH  
00001000  
010H  
00100001  
011H  
012H  
001H  
00EH  
00100000  
00000001  
01000000  
00001000  
The RSCFS is used.  
Enable the normal operation of the RSDn pin.  
In Receive Clock Slave External Signaling mode.  
The output on the RSFSn pin is determined by the ROHM, BRXSMFP, BRCMFP  
andALTIFP.  
In Receive Clock Slave mode. The FE and DE are both 0. The receive  
backplane rate is 2.048Mbit/s.  
Receive Clock  
Slave External  
Signaling Mode  
010H  
00100001  
011H  
012H  
010H  
011H  
012H  
010H  
011H  
012H  
05CH  
00100000  
00000001  
00001001  
00000000  
00000001  
10001001  
00000000  
00000001  
00000011  
01000000  
The RSCFS is used.  
Enable the normal operation of the RSDn and RSSIGn pins.  
In Receive Clock Master Full E1 Mode. The FE is logic 1 and the DE is logic 0.  
The RSCFS is un-used.  
Enable the normal operation of the RSDn pin.  
In Receive Clock Master Nx64K Mode. The FE is logic 1 and the DE is logic 0.  
The RSCFS is un-used.  
Enable the normal operation of the RSDn pin.  
Enable the Receive Payload Control.  
The code in the DTRK[7:0] replaces the data output on the RSDn pin in the  
corresponding channel.  
Receive Clock  
Master Full E1  
Receive  
Clock  
Master  
Fractional  
E1  
20H-3FH (RPLC  
indirectregisters)  
001H  
Mode  
01001000  
01001000  
01001000  
01001000  
01011000  
01011000  
01011000  
01011000  
00111011  
00111011  
00111011  
00111011  
00111011  
00111011  
00111011  
00111011  
081H  
101H  
181H  
201H  
281H  
301H  
381H  
010H  
090H  
110H  
190H  
210H  
290H  
310H  
390H  
Multiplex the data stream of these four framers to the multiplexed bus 1.  
Receive  
Multiplexed  
Mode  
Multiplex the data stream of these four framers to the multiplexed bus 2.  
In Receive Multiplexed mode. The receive backplane rate is 8.192Mbit/s. The FE  
is logic 1 and the DE is logic 1.  
91  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Table - 41. Various Operation Modes in Receive Path for Reference (Continued)  
Mode  
Register 1  
011H  
091H  
111H  
191H  
211H  
291H  
311H  
391H  
012H  
092H  
112H  
192H  
212H  
292H  
312H  
392H  
013H  
093H  
113H  
193H  
213H  
293H  
313H  
393H  
Value (from Bit7 to Bit0)  
00100000  
00100000  
00100000  
00100000  
00100000  
00100000  
00100000  
00100000  
00000001  
00000001  
00000001  
00000001  
00000001  
00000001  
00000001  
00000001  
00000000  
00000001  
00000010  
00000011  
00000000  
00000001  
00000010  
00000011  
Description 2  
Receive  
The MRSCFS is used.  
Multiplexed  
Mode  
Enable the normal operation of the MRSD and MRSSIG pins.  
(Continued)  
TSOFF[6:0] = 0. The timeslot offset is 0.  
TSOFF[6:0] = 1. The timeslot offset is 1.  
TSOFF[6:0] = 2. The timeslot offset is 2.  
TSOFF[6:0] = 3. The timeslot offset is 3.  
TSOFF[6:0] = 0. The timeslot offset is 0.  
TSOFF[6:0] = 1. The timeslot offset is 1.  
TSOFF[6:0] = 2. The timeslot offset is 2.  
TSOFF[6:0] = 3. The timeslot offset is 3.  
Note:  
1. In the ‘Register’ column, except for the Receive Multiplexed mode, the register position of the Framer One is listed to represent the set of the registers  
of eight framers. The other registers position are tabulated in the ‘Register Map’. However, in Receive Multiplexed mode, the register position of eight  
framers are all listed.  
2. The ‘Description’ illustrates the fundamental function of the operation mode. The others can be configured as desired.  
92  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Table - 42. Various Operation Modes in Transmit Path for Reference  
Mode  
Register 1  
018H  
003H  
Value (from Bit7 to Bit0)  
00100001  
Description 2  
In Transmit Clock Slave mode. The FE is logic 0 and the DE is logic 0.  
In Transmit Clock Slave External Signaling mode.  
Channel Associated Signaling (CAS) is enabled. The CRC Multi-Frame is  
generated.  
TSCCKB is selected as TJAT input reference clock. Smoothed clock is selected  
as Line Transmit Clock (LTCK).  
Transmit Clock  
Slave External  
Signaling Mode  
01000000  
01110000  
040H  
004H  
00001111  
027H  
018H  
003H  
040H  
00010000  
00100001  
00000000  
01110000  
The FIFO is set to self-center its read pointer.  
In Transmit Clock Slave mode. The FE is logic 0 and the DE is logic 0.  
In Transmit Clock Slave TSFS Enable mode.  
Channel Associated Signaling (CAS) is enabled. The CRC Multi-Frame is  
generated.  
Transmit Clock  
Slave TSFS  
004H  
00001111  
TSCCKB is selected as TJAT input reference clock. Smoothed clock is selected  
as Line Transmit Clock (LTCK).  
Enable Mode  
027H  
018H  
040H  
00010000  
00011001  
01110000  
The FIFO is set to self-center its read pointer.  
In Transmit Clock Master Full E1 mode.  
Channel Associated Signaling (CAS) is enabled. The CRC Multi-Frame is  
generated.  
XCK/24 is selected as TJAT input reference clock. XCK/24 is selected as Line  
Transmit Clock (LTCK).  
The data stream is taken from the multiplexed bus 1.  
The data stream is taken from the multiplexed bus 2.  
The data stream is taken from the multiplexed bus 1.  
The data stream is taken from the multiplexed bus 2.  
The data stream is taken from the multiplexed bus 1.  
The data stream is taken from the multiplexed bus 2.  
The data stream is taken from the multiplexed bus 1.  
The data stream is taken from the multiplexed bus 2.  
Transmit Clock  
Master Mode  
Transmit  
004H  
00100100  
003H  
083H  
103H  
183H  
203H  
283H  
303H  
383H  
018H  
098H  
118H  
198H  
218H  
298H  
318H  
398H  
01BH  
09BH  
11BH  
19BH  
21BH  
29BH  
31BH  
39BH  
01000000  
01010000  
01000000  
01010000  
01000000  
01010000  
01000000  
01010000  
00110011  
00110011  
00110011  
00110011  
00110011  
00110011  
00110011  
00110011  
00000000  
00000000  
00000001  
00000001  
00000010  
00000010  
00000011  
00000011  
Multiplexed  
Mode  
In Transmit Multiplexed mode. The FE is logic 0 and the DE is logic 1.  
TSOFF[6:0] = 0. The timeslot offset is 0.  
TSOFF[6:0] = 1. The timeslot offset is 1.  
TSOFF[6:0] = 2. The timeslot offset is 2.  
TSOFF[6:0] = 3. The timeslot offset is 3.  
93  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Table - 42. Various Operation Modes in Transmit Path for Reference (Continued)  
Mode  
Register 1  
040H  
0C0H  
140H  
1C0H  
240H  
2C0H  
340H  
3C0H  
004H  
084H  
104H  
184H  
204H  
284H  
304H  
384H  
027H  
0A7H  
127H  
1A7H  
227H  
2A7H  
327H  
3A7H  
Value (from Bit7 to Bit0)  
01110000  
01110000  
01110000  
01110000  
01110000  
01110000  
01110000  
01110000  
00011101  
00011101  
00011101  
00011101  
00011101  
00011101  
00011101  
00011101  
00010000  
00010000  
00010000  
00010000  
00010000  
00010000  
00010000  
00010000  
Description 2  
Channel Associated Signaling (CAS) is enabled. The CRC Multi-Frame is  
generated.  
Transmit  
Multiplexed  
Mode  
TSCCKA is selected as TJAT input reference clock. Smoothed clock is selected  
as Line Transmit Clock (LTCK).  
(Continued)  
The FIFO is set to self-center its read pointer.  
Note:  
1. In the ‘Register’ column, except for the Transmit Multiplexed mode, the register position of the Framer One is listed to represent the set of the registers  
of eight framers. The other registers position are tabulated in the ‘Register Map’. However, in Transmit Multiplexed mode, the register position of eight  
framers are all listed.  
2. The ‘Description’ illustrates the fundamental function of the operation mode. The others can be configured as desired.  
94  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
the Interrupt ID register and Interrupt Source registers. If the source of  
the interrupt is HDLC Receive, the Interrupt Service procedure will be  
carried out as shown in Figure - 71.  
4.1.3  
In this chapter, some common operation examples are given for ref-  
erence.  
OPERATION EXAMPLE  
- Polling Mode  
4.1.3.1 Using The HDLC Receiver  
In polling mode, the operation procedure is the same as Figure - 71,  
except that the entry of the service is from a local timer rather than an  
interrupt.  
Before using the HDLC Receiver, the TXCISEL (b3, E1-00AH) must  
be set to 0 to enable the HDLC data link position for receive path.  
Since three HDLC Receive data links are integrated in one framer,  
one of the three HDLC Receive data links must be selected in the  
RHDLCSEL[1:0] (b7~6, E1-00AH). Then the HDLC data link can be  
configured to extract from even and/or odd frames, from any timeslot,  
and from any bit. The following examples show how to select the HDLC  
Receiver data link positions:  
To summarize the procedure of using HDLC Receive, a complete ex-  
ample is shown in Table - 43.  
Table - 43. Example for Using HDLC Receiver  
a. to extract the HDLC data link from all bits of TS16 in HDLC Re-  
ceive #1:  
Register Value Description  
- set the TXCISEL (b3, E1-00AH) to 0;  
- set the RHDLCSEL[1:0] (b7~6, E1-00AH) to 00;  
- set the DL1_EVEN (b7, E1-028H) to 0;  
- set the DL1_ODD (b6, E1-028H) to 0;  
- set the TS16_EN (b5, E1-028H) to 1.  
00AH  
02AH  
50H  
RHDLC #2 is selected. The HDLC Receive is  
accessable to the CPU interface.  
The TS4 of even frames and odd frames are  
selected.  
C4H  
b. to extract the HDLC data link from the Sa8 National bit in HDLC  
Receive #1:  
02BH  
048H  
FFH All the 8 bits are selected.  
0DH  
The function of the RHDLC #2 is enabled. Set  
- set the TXCISEL (b3, E1-00AH) to 0;  
- set the RHDLCSEL[1:0] (b7~6, E1-00AH) to 00;  
- set the DL1_EVEN (b7, E1-028H) to 0;  
- set the DL1_ODD (b6, E1-028H) to 1;  
- set the TS16_EN (b5, E1-028H) to 0;  
the address match mode.  
049H  
8FH  
Set the INTE to 1. When the number of bytes in  
the RHDLC FIFO exceeds 15, an interrupt is  
generated.  
- set the DL1_TS[4:0] (b4~0, E1-028H) to 00000  
- set the DL1_BIT[7:0] (b7~0, E1-029H) to 00000001.  
c. to extract the HDLC data link from all bits of TS20 of all frames in  
HDLC Receive #2:  
04CH  
04DH  
13H  
The primary address is set to 13H.  
FFH The secondary address is set to FFH.  
Then read the data status in register 04AH. Until a complete packet is  
received, read the data from register 04BH.  
- set the TXCISEL (b3, E1-00AH) to 0;  
- set the RHDLCSEL[1:0] (b7~6, E1-00AH) to 01;  
- set the DL2_EVEN (b7, E1-02AH) to 1;  
- set the DL2_ODD (b6, E1-02AH) to 1;  
4.1.3.2 Using The HDLC Transmitter  
Before using the HDLC Transmit, the TXCISEL (b3, E1-00AH) must  
be set to 1 to enable the HDLC data link position for transmit path.  
Since three HDLC Transmit data links are integrated in one framer,  
one of the three HDLC Transmit data links must be selected in the  
THDLCSEL[1:0] (b5~4, E1-00AH). Then the HDLC data link can be  
configured to insert to even and/or odd frames, to any timeslot, and to  
any bit. The following examples show how to select the HDLC Transmit  
data link positions:  
- set the DL2_TS [4:0] (b4~0, E1-02AH) to 10100;  
- set the DL2_BIT [7:0] (b7~0, E1-02BH) to 11111111.  
After setting the HDLC data link position properly, the selected  
HDLC Receiver should be enabled by setting the EN (b0, E1-048H)to  
logic 1. If needed, set the MEN (b3, E1-048H) and the MM (b2, E1-  
048H) to determine which Address Matching Mode to be selected (refer  
to Register Description for details). After setting these 3 bits, the  
RHDLC Primary Address Match register and the RHDLC Secondary  
Address Match register should be set to proper values. If the INTC[6:0]  
(b6~0, E1-049H) are set, whenever the number of bytes in the RHDLC  
FIFO exceeds the value set in the INTC[6:0] (b6~0, E1-049H), the  
INTR (b0, E1-04AH) will be set to logic 1. This interrupt will persist until  
the RHDLC FIFO becomes empty. Setting the INTE (b7, E1-049H) to  
logic 1 allows the internal interrupt status to be propagated to the INT  
output pin.  
a. to insert the HDLC data link to all bits of TS16 in HDLC Transmit  
#1:  
- set the TXCISEL (b3, E1-00AH) to 1;  
- set the THDLCSEL [1:0] (b5~4, E1-00AH) to 00;  
- set the DL1_EVEN (b7, E1-028H) to 0;  
- set the DL1_ODD (b6, E1-028H) to 0;  
- set the TS16_EN (b5, E1-028H) to 1.  
b. to insert the HDLC data link to the Sa4-Sa8 National bits in HDLC  
Transmit #1:  
After setting these registers properly, the HDLC data can be  
received in a polled or interrupt driven mode.  
- set the TXCISEL (b3, E1-00AH) to 1;  
- set the THDLCSEL [1:0] (b5~4, E1-00AH) to 00;  
- set the DL1_EVEN (b7, E1-028H) to 0;  
- Interrupt Driven Mode  
- set the DL1_ODD (b6, E1-028H) to 1;  
- set the TS16_EN (b5, E1-028H) to 0;  
When the INTE (b7, E1-049H) is set to logic 1, if the INT pin is  
asserted, the source of the interrupt should be first identified by reading  
95  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
INT asserts  
Other block  
interrupt service  
N
RHDLC  
interrupt  
Y
Read RHDLC STATUS  
Y
OVR=1  
Discard the last packet  
Set EMPTY FIFO flag  
N
Y
COLS=1  
N
Y
PKIN=1  
PACKET COUNT * increment  
N
Read RHDLC data  
Read RHDLC status  
Y
OVR=1  
Discard the last packet  
N
Y
COLS=1  
Set EMPTY FIFO * flag  
N
Y
PKIN=1  
PACKET COUNT * increment  
N
000  
PBS[2:0]=?  
1XX  
Store this byte, decrement the PACKET COUNT *,  
check for CRC or non-integer number of bytes errors  
before deciding whether to keep the packet or not.  
store the packet data  
001  
010  
Discard this data byte,  
Set LINK ACTIVE * Flag  
Discard this data byte,  
Clear LINK ACTIVE * Flag  
N
FE=1  
Y
End of Interrupt  
Service  
Note:  
* The PACKET COUNT, EMPTY FIFO and LINK ACTIVE are local software variable.  
Figure - 71. Interrupt Service in E1 Mode HDLC Receiver  
96  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
- set the DL1_TS[4:0] (b4~0, E1-028H) to 00000  
- set the DL1_BIT[7:0] (b7~0, E1-029H) to 00011111.  
c. to insert the HDLC data link to all bits of TS20 of all frames in  
HDLC Transmit #3:  
THDLC Initial  
- set the TXCISEL (b3, E1-00AH) to 1;  
- set the THDLCSEL [1:0] (b5~4, E1-00AH) to 10;  
- set the DL3_EVEN (b7, E1-02CH) to 1;  
- set the DL3_ODD (b6, E1-02CH) to 1;  
- set the DL3_TS [4:0] (b4~0, E1-02CH) to 10100;  
- set the DL3_BIT [7:0] (b7~0, E1-02DH) to 11111111.  
N
Data is available  
Y
Write data into  
THDLC FIFO  
After setting the HDLC data link position properly, the selected  
HDLC Transmit should be enabled by setting the EN (b0, E1-050H) to  
logic 1. The FIFOCLR (b6, E1-050H) should be set and then cleared to  
initialize the THDLC FIFO.  
Set the CRC (b1, E1-050H) to logic 1 if the Frame Check  
Sequences (FCS) generation is desired. Set the FULLE (b3, E1-053H),  
OVRE (b2, E1-053H), UDRE (b1, E1-053H) and LFILLE (b0, E1-053H)  
to logic 1 if interrupt driven mode is used. Set THDLC Upper Transmit  
Threshold and THDLC Lower Transmit Threshold registers to the  
desired values. If a complete packet has been written into THDLC  
FIFO, the EOM (b3, E1-050H) should be set.  
N
End of packet  
Y
Set EOM  
Figure - 72. Writing Data to E1 Mode THDLC FIFO  
After setting these registers properly, the HDLC data can be  
transmitted in a polled or interrupt driven mode.  
- Interrupt Driven Mode  
Table - 44. Example for Using HDLC Transmitter  
Register Value Description  
Writing HDLC data to THDLC FIFO , the THDLC will transmit the  
HDLC data if the end of a packet was written or if the THDLC FIFO fill  
level reaches the Upper Transmit Threshold. The writing procedure is  
shown in Figure - 72.  
When the FULLE (b3, E1-053H), OVRE (b2, E1-053H), UDRE (b1,  
E1-053H) and LFILLE (b0, E1-053H) are set to logic 1, if the INT pin is  
asserted, the source of the interrupt should be identified firstly by  
reading the Interrupt ID register and Interrupt Source registers. If the  
source of the interrupt is HDLC Transmit, the Interrupt Service  
procedure will be carried out as shown in Figure - 73.  
00AH  
58H  
THDLC #2 is selected. The HDLC Transmit is  
accessable to the CPU interface.  
02AH  
C4H  
The TS4 of even frames and odd frames are  
selected.  
02BH  
050H  
050H  
053H  
055H  
055H  
055H  
055H  
055H  
055H  
055H  
055H  
050H  
FFH  
C3H  
83H  
0FH  
12H  
34H  
56H  
78H  
9AH  
BCH  
DEH  
FFH  
8BH  
All the 8 bits are selected.  
The function of the THDLC #2 is enabled. The  
FCS is enables and the THDLC FIFO is reset.  
Enable the THDLC Interrupt Enable bits.  
- Polling Mode  
In packet transmission polling mode, the FULLE (b3, E1-053H),  
OVRE (b2, E1-053H), UDRE (b1, E1-053H) and LFILLE (b0, E1-053H)  
should be set to logic 0. The THDLC Lower Transmit Threshold should  
be set to such a value that sufficient warning of an underrun is given.  
The procedure shown in Figure - 74 should be followed.  
Write data into THDLC FIFO.  
To summarize the procedure of using HDLC Transmit, a complete ex-  
ample is shown in Table - 44.  
End of packet and set the EOM to 1.  
97  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
INT Asserts  
N
Other Blocks Interrupt  
Service  
THDLC Interrupt  
Y
Y
Y
UNDRI=1  
N
OVRI=1  
N
FULLI=1  
N
Y
Y
Start a timer 2  
FULL=1  
N
Set the RLP Flag 1  
N
LFILLI=1  
Y
BLFILL=1  
N
Y
End of  
packet  
N
Y
Set EOM  
End of  
Interrupt Service  
Note:  
1. RLP-Retransmit the last packet, a local software variable.  
2. A local timer to wait for a certain time until the Full = 0 or the BLFILL = 1.  
Figure - 73. Interrupt Service in E1 Mode HDLC Transmitter  
98  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
THDLC initial  
Data is  
available  
N
Y
Read THDLC  
interrupt status  
Y
Wait, until FULL=0  
or BBLFILL=1  
FULL=1  
N
Write the data  
into the THDLC FIFO  
More Data to  
be tarnsmitted  
Y
N
Set EOM  
Figure - 74. Polling Mode in E1 Mode HDLC Transmitter  
4.1.3.3 Using The PRBS Generator / Detector  
After the above settings, read the PRGD Interrupt Enable/Status  
(071H) register twice. If the SYNCV (b4, E1-071H) is logic 1 and the  
BEI (b2, E1-071H) is logic 0, the pattern detector is in synchronization  
The IDT82V2108 provides one PRBS generator/detector block to  
generate and detect an enormous variety of pseudo-random and  
repetitive patterns to diagnose E1 data stream of all eight framers. The  
common test patterns are shown in tabular form in Table - 45.  
The PRBS generator/detector block can be used to test E1 line  
transmit-receive integrity and system backplane integrity.  
state.  
Then insert errors into this link. Here suppose to insert 3 errors, then  
the configuration is shown in Table - 49.  
- Example For Testing E1 System Backplane Integrity  
- Example For Testing E1 Line Transmit-Receive Integrity  
To monitor the errors in Framer 2 without taking the entire E1 span  
off line, the following procedure should be done:  
- Use the PRGD block to test Framer 2;  
To test the E1 system backplane integrity, the RXPATGEN (b2, E1-  
00CH) should be set to logic 1 and the other registers are set as above.  
Then the PRGD can be used to test the system backplane integrity.  
- Configure the PRGD register;  
- Chose a desired set of timeslots (for example TS2, TS4, TS5) for  
insertion/extraction of PRGD test data;  
- Set the far end of the line to loop back at least the selected  
timeslots;  
- Monitor the E1 line transmit-receive integrity.  
To realize the above function, the configuration in Table - 46 to Table -  
48 should be set.  
Table - 46 is the configuration for PRGD and loopback. Table - 47  
shows the process to initialize the TPLC. Table - 48 shows the process  
to initialize the RPLC.  
99  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Table - 45. Test Pattern  
Pseudo-Random Pattern Generation (the PS [b4, E1-070H] is logic 0)  
Pattern Type  
TR 1  
00  
00  
01  
04  
00  
03  
03  
04  
02  
08  
0D  
02  
06  
02  
01  
00  
11  
LR 2  
02  
03  
04  
05  
06  
06  
06  
08  
09  
0A  
0E  
10  
11  
13  
14  
15  
16  
18  
1B  
1C  
1E  
IR#1 3  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
IR#2 4  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
IR#3 5  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
IR#4 6  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
TINV 7  
RINV 7  
3
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
–1  
–1  
-1  
–1  
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
4
5
6
7
7
7
9
10  
11  
15  
17  
18  
20  
21  
22  
23  
25  
28  
29  
31  
–1 (Fractional T1 LB Activate)  
–1 (Fractional T1 LB Activate)  
–1  
–1 (O.153)  
-1  
-1 (O.152,O.153)  
-1 (O.151)  
-1  
-1  
-1 (O.153)  
-1  
-1  
-1 (O.151)  
-1  
-1  
-1  
-1  
02  
02  
01  
02  
Repetitive Pattern Generation (the PS [b4, E1-070H] is logic 1)  
Pattern Type  
All ones  
All zeros  
Alternatingones/zeros  
Double alternatingones/zeros  
3 in 24  
1 in 16  
1 in 8  
TR 1  
00  
00  
00  
00  
00  
00  
00  
00  
00  
00  
LR 2  
00  
00  
01  
03  
17  
0F  
07  
03  
04  
02  
IR#1 3  
FF  
FE  
FE  
FC  
22  
01  
01  
F1  
F0  
IR#2 4  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
00  
IR#3 5  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
20  
FF  
FF  
FF  
IR#4 6  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
TINV 7  
RINV 7  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
00  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
1 in 4  
DS1 Inbandloopback activate  
DS1 InbandLoopback deactivate  
FF  
FF  
0F  
FF  
FC  
Note:  
1. TR - Tap Register  
2. LR - Shift Register Length Register  
3. IR#1 - PRGD Pattern Insertion #1 Register  
4. IR#2 - PRGD Pattern Insertion #2 Register  
5. IR#3 - PRGD Pattern Insertion #3 Register  
6. IR#4 - PRGD Pattern Insertion #4 Register  
7. TINV, RINV - contained in the PRGD Control register  
100  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Table - 46. The Setting of PRGD  
Register Value Description  
Table - 47. Initializtion of TPLC (Continued)  
Register  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
Value  
00H  
2EH  
00H  
2FH  
00H  
30H  
00H  
31H  
00H  
32H  
00H  
33H  
00H  
34H  
00H  
35H  
00H  
36H  
00H  
37H  
00H  
38H  
00H  
39H  
00H  
3AH  
00H  
3BH  
00H  
3CH  
00H  
3DH  
00H  
3EH  
00H  
3FH  
00H  
60H  
00H  
61H  
00H  
62H  
00H  
63H  
00H  
64H  
00H  
65H  
00CH  
20H Select Framer 2 to be tested by the PRGD  
block. The PRGD pattern is inserted in the TPLC  
and detected in the RPLC.  
070H  
82H Set Pattern Detector registers as error counter  
register. Enable automatic resynchronization.  
18H Set the pattern length.  
02H Set the feedback tap position.  
FFH Set the Pattern Insertion registers.  
FFH Load the data in the Pattern Insertion registers to  
generate the pattern.  
072H  
073H  
078H  
07BH  
087H  
0E0H  
04H Set diagnostic digital loopback mode.  
01H Enable the TPLC indirect registers to be  
accessable.  
0DCH  
01H Enable the RPLC indirect registers to be  
accessable.  
Table - 47. Initializtion of TPLC  
Register  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
Value  
00H  
20H  
00H  
21H  
00H  
22H  
00H  
23H  
00H  
24H  
00H  
25H  
00H  
26H  
00H  
27H  
00H  
28H  
00H  
29H  
00H  
2AH  
00H  
2BH  
00H  
2CH  
00H  
2DH  
101  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Table - 47. Initializtion of TPLC (Continued)  
Table - 47. Initializtion of TPLC (Continued)  
Register  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
Value  
00H  
66H  
00H  
67H  
00H  
68H  
00H  
69H  
00H  
6AH  
00H  
6BH  
00H  
6CH  
00H  
6DH  
00H  
6EH  
00H  
6FH  
00H  
70H  
00H  
71H  
00H  
72H  
00H  
73H  
00H  
74H  
00H  
75H  
00H  
76H  
00H  
77H  
00H  
78H  
00H  
79H  
00H  
7AH  
00H  
7BH  
00H  
7CH  
00H  
7DH  
Register  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
Value  
00H  
7EH  
00H  
7FH  
Then set the TEST in TPLC Payload Control register for TS2, TS4  
and TS5. The process is:  
Register Value  
Description  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
0E3H  
0E2H  
08H  
22H  
08H  
24H  
08H  
25H  
Set the TEST in TPLC Payload Control register  
for TS2.  
Set the TEST in TPLC Payload Control register  
for TS4.  
Set the TEST in TPLC Payload Control register  
forTS5.  
102  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Table - 48. Initializtion of RPLC  
Table - 48. Initializtion of RPLC (Continued)  
Register  
0DFH  
0DEH  
0DFH  
0DEH  
0DFH  
0DEH  
0DFH  
0DEH  
0DFH  
0DEH  
0DFH  
0DEH  
0DFH  
0DEH  
0DFH  
0DEH  
0DFH  
0DEH  
0DFH  
0DEH  
0DFH  
0DEH  
0DFH  
0DEH  
0DFH  
0DEH  
0DFH  
0DEH  
0DFH  
0DEH  
0DFH  
0DEH  
0DFH  
0DEH  
0DFH  
0DEH  
0DFH  
0DEH  
0DFH  
0DEH  
0DFH  
0DEH  
0DFH  
0DEH  
0DFH  
0DEH  
0DFH  
0DEH  
Value  
00H  
20H  
00H  
21H  
00H  
22H  
00H  
23H  
00H  
24H  
00H  
25H  
00H  
26H  
00H  
27H  
00H  
28H  
00H  
29H  
00H  
2AH  
00H  
2BH  
00H  
2CH  
00H  
2DH  
00H  
2EH  
00H  
2FH  
00H  
30H  
00H  
31H  
00H  
32H  
00H  
33H  
00H  
34H  
00H  
35H  
00H  
36H  
00H  
37H  
Register  
0DFH  
0DEH  
0DFH  
0DEH  
0DFH  
0DEH  
0DFH  
0DEH  
0DFH  
0DEH  
0DFH  
0DEH  
0DFH  
0DEH  
0DFH  
0DEH  
Value  
00H  
38H  
00H  
39H  
00H  
3AH  
00H  
3BH  
00H  
3CH  
00H  
3DH  
00H  
3EH  
00H  
3FH  
Then set the TEST in RPLC Payload Control register for TS2, TS4  
and TS5. The process is:  
Register Value  
Description  
Set the TEST in RPLC Payload Control  
register for TS2.  
Set the TEST in RPLC Payload Control  
register for TS4  
0DFH  
0DEH  
0DFH  
0DEH  
0DFH  
0DEH  
80H  
22H  
80H  
24H  
80H  
25H  
Set the TEST in RPLC Payload Control  
register for TS5  
Table - 49. Error Insertion  
Register  
074H  
074H  
074H  
074H  
074H  
074H  
Value  
08H  
00H  
08H  
00H  
08H  
00H  
Then write 00H into the 07CH register to update the error counter  
registers. Then read the registers from 07CH to 07FH to check the  
error numbers.  
103  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
4.1.3.4 Using Payload Control and Receive CAS/RBS Buffer  
Before using the Receive/Transmit Payload Control and Receive  
CAS/RBS Buffer, the indirect registers of these blocks must be initialized  
to eliminate erroneous control data. The PCCE (b0, E1-05CH & b0, E1-  
060H & b0, E1-064H) of these blocks must be set to logic 1 to enable  
these blocks.  
Then the BUSY (b7, E1-05DH & b7, E1-061H & b7, E1-065H) must  
be checked before a new access request to the RPLC, TPLC and RCRB  
indirect registers. When the BUSY is logic 0, the new reading and writing  
access operations can be performed.  
Set PCCE=1  
N
BUSY=0  
Y
Data are set in the Channel  
Indirect Data Buffer Register  
Figure - 75 shows the writing sequence of the RPLC, TPLC and  
RCRB indirect registers. Figure - 76 shows the reading sequence of the  
RPLC, TPLC and RCRB indirect registers.  
RWB=0 and address is specified  
in the Channel Indirect Address/  
Control Register.  
4.1.3.5 Using TJAT / Timing Option  
In different operation modes, the Timing Options and Clock Divisor  
Control registers can be set as the follows:  
Y
More data  
to be written  
- Transmit Clock Slave Mode (System Backplane Rate: 2.048M bit/s)  
The TSCCKA or TSCCKB is selected as the TJAT DPLL input refer-  
ence clock. The TSCCKA and TSCCKB are both equal to 2.048M. The  
N1 (b7~0, E1-025H) and N2 (b7~0, E1-026H) are set to their default  
value (2FH).  
N
End  
The smoothed clock output from the TJAT is selected as the LTCK.  
Figure - 75. Writing Sequence of Indirect Register in E1 Mode  
- Transmit Clock Slave Mode (System Backplane Rate: 4.096M bit/s)  
The TSCCKA is selected as the TJAT DPLL input reference clock.  
The TSCCKA is equal to 2.048M. The N1 (b7~0, E1-025H) and N2  
(b7~0, E1-026H) are set to their default value (2FH).  
Set PCCE=1  
The smoothed clock output from the TJAT is selected as the LTCK.  
N
- Transmit Clock Master Mode  
BUSY=0  
The XCK/24 is selected as the TJAT DPLL input reference clock.  
The XCK/24 is selected as the LTCK.  
Y
RWB=1 and address is specified in  
the Channel Indirect Address/  
Control Register.  
- Transmit Multiplexed Mode (System Backplane Rate: 8.192M bit/s)  
The TSCCKA is selected as the TJAT DPLL input reference clock.  
The TSCCKA is equal to 2.048M. The N1 (b7~0, E1-025H) and N2  
(b7~0, E1-026H) are set to their default value (2FH).  
N
BUSY=0  
The smoothed clock output from the TJAT is selected as the LTCK.  
Y
Read Channel Indirect Data  
Buffer Register  
- Transmit Multiplexed Mode (System Backplane Rate: 16.384M bit/s)  
The TSCCKA or TSCCKA/8 is selected as the TJAT DPLL input ref-  
erence clock. The TSCCKA is equal to 2.048M or 16.384M. The N1  
(b7~0, E1-025H) and N2 (b7~0, E1-026H) are set to their default value  
(2FH).  
Y
More data  
to be read  
The smoothed clock output from the TJAT is selected as the LTCK.  
N
End  
Figure - 76. Reading Sequence of Indirect Register in E1 Mode  
104  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
in bit 5 and the J1_CRC in bit 6 of FRMG Configuration registers  
(044H, 0C4H, 144H, 1C4H, 244H, 2C4H, 344H, 3C4H), the setting of  
the other registers are the same as the setting in T1 mode.  
The follows illustrate the setting in J1 mode difference from the  
setting in the T1 mode.  
4.2 T1/J1 MODE  
4.2.1  
When the device is power up, all the registers are in their default  
values.  
DEFAULT SETTING  
In receive path, set the JYEL in bit 3 of FRMP Configuration  
registers (020H, 0A0H, 120H, 1A0H, 220H, 2A0H, 320H, 3A0H) to logic  
1, the Frame Processor will operate in J1 mode. Set the J1_YEL in bit 5  
of ALMD Configuration registers (02CH, 0ACH, 12CH, 1ACH, 22CH,  
2ACH, 32CH, 3ACH) to logic 1, the Alarm Detector will operate in J1  
mode.  
In transmit path, set the J1_CRC in bit 6 of FRMG Configuration  
registers (044H, 0C4H, 144H, 1C4H, 244H, 2C4H, 344H, 3C4H) to logic  
1, the Frame Generator will generate J1 frame. Set the J1_YEL in bit 5  
of FRMG Configuration registers (044H, 0C4H, 144H, 1C4H, 244H,  
2C4H, 344H, 3C4H) to logic 1, the IDT82V2108 will transmit the Yellow  
alarm in J1 format if Yellow alarm transmission is enabled.  
Any of the eight framers can be reset anytime when the RESET (b0,  
E1-00AH / b0, T1/J1-00DH) in its framer is set. The device can also be  
reset anytime when the RST pin is low for at least 100ns.  
After the hardware reset, the IDT82V2108 will default to the  
following settings:  
- Mode: the default operation mode of the device is T1 mode.  
- Receive Path: the default setting of each block in the receive path  
is illustrated in the Table - 50.  
- Transmit Path: the default setting of each block in the transmit path  
is illustrated in the Table - 51.  
4.2.2  
OPERATION IN J1 MODE  
IDT82V2108 can also be operated in J1 mode when the TEMODE  
(b0, 400H) is set to logic 1. Except for the setting of the JYEL in bit 3 of  
FRMP Configuration registers (020H, 0A0H, 120H, 1A0H, 220H, 2A0H,  
320H, 3A0H), the J1_YEL in bit 5 of ALMD Configuration registers  
(02CH, 0ACH, 12CH, 1ACH, 22CH, 2ACH, 32CH, 3ACH), the J1_YEL  
4.2.3  
VARIOUS OPERATION MODES CONFIGURATION  
Five operation modes can be set in the receive path and four opera-  
tion modes can be set in the transmit path. In each operation modes, the  
configurations in Table - 52 and Table - 53 are illustrated for reference.  
Table - 50. Default Setting in Receive Path  
Function Block  
Default Setting Description  
Line Interface  
• The LRDn inputs Non-Return to Zero (NRZ) data and is sampled on rising edge of the LRCKn.  
• The RJAT Clock Divisors (N1, N2) are set to ‘2F’.  
• Super Frame (SF) format is enabled.  
FrameProcessor  
HDLC Receiver #1, #2  
Receive System Interface  
• RHDLCs are disabled.  
• In Recieve Clock Slave External Signaling Mode.  
• The data on the RSDn, RSSIGn pins are updated on falling edge of the RSCCK.  
• RSCFS indicates each F-bit.  
• The data on the RSDn, RSSIGn, RSFSn pins are held in high-impedance state.  
• The RPLC is disabled.  
• The PRGD is configured to monitor the extracted data patterns in Frame One.  
Receive Payload Control  
PRGD  
Table - 51. Default Setting in Transmit Path  
Function Block  
Default Setting Description  
PRGD  
• The PRGD is configured to insert test patterns to Frame One.  
• In Transmit Clock Slave External Signaling Mode.  
• The data on the TSDn and TSSIGn pins are sampled on rising edge of TSCCKB.  
• The TPLC is disabled.  
Transmit System Interface  
Transmit Payload Control  
FrameGenerator  
• Super Frame (SF) format is enabled.  
HDLC Transmitter #1, #2  
• THDLCs are disabled.  
Bit-Oriented Message Transmitter • The BOMT is disabled.  
Inband Loop-back Code Generator • The Inband Loop-back Code Generator is disabled.  
Line Interface  
• The LTDn outputs Non-Return to Zero (NRZ) data and is updated on falling edge of LTCKn.  
• TJAT Clock Divisors (N1, N2) are set to ‘2F’  
• Digital jitter attenuation is enabled. The PLL is synchronized to the TSCCKB clock. The smoothed clock  
output from the PLL is selected as the LTCKn.  
105  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Table - 52. Various Operation Modes in Receive Path for Reference  
Mode  
Register 1  
001H  
Value (from Bit7 to Bit0)  
10000000  
Description 2  
In Receive Clock Slave RSCK Reference mode.  
Receive Clock  
Slave RSCK  
Reference Mode  
003H  
00010011  
Enable the normal operation of the RSDn pin. The data on the RSDn are  
updated on the rising edge of the RSCCK. The data on the RSCFS are  
sampled on the falling edge of the RSCCK.  
The Frame Processor is set in ESF format. The CRC-6 calculation is  
performed when mimic framing pattern is present.  
The Alarm Detector is set in ESF format.  
The Receive CAS/RBS Buffer is set in ESF format.  
In Receive Clock Slave External Signaling mode. The backplane rate is  
1.544Mbit/s.  
020H  
00110000  
02CH  
040H  
001H  
00010000  
00000100  
11000000  
Receive  
003H  
020H  
00010011  
00110000  
Enable the normal operation of the RSDn and RSSIGn pins. The data on the  
RSDn and RSSIGn are updated on the rising edge of the RSCCK. The data  
on the RSCFS are sampled on the falling edge of the RSCCK.  
The Frame Processor is set in ESF format. The CRC-6 calculation is  
performed when mimic framing pattern is present.  
The Alarm Detector is set in ESF format.  
The Receive CAS/RBS Buffer is set in ESF format.  
In Receive Clock Slave External Signaling mode. The backplane rate is  
2.048Mbit/s.  
Enable the normal operation of the RSDn and RSSIGn pins. The data on the  
RSDn and RSSIGn are updated on the rising edge of the RSCCK. The data  
on the RSCFS are sampled on the falling edge of the RSCCK.  
The Frame Processor is set in ESF format. The CRC-6 calculation is  
performed when mimic framing pattern is present.  
The Alarm Detector is set in ESF format.  
The Receive CAS/RBS Buffer is set in ESF format.  
In Receive Clock Master Full T1/J1 mode.  
Enable the normal operation of the RSDn pin. The data on the RSDn and  
RSFSn are updated on the rising edge of the RSCK.  
The Frame Processor is set in SF format.  
The Alarm Detector is set in SF format.  
The Receive CAS/RBS Buffer is set in SF format.  
In Receive Clock Master Nx64k mode.  
(1.544M  
Clock  
bit/s)  
Slave  
02CH  
040H  
001H  
00010000  
00000100  
11010000  
External  
Signaling  
Mode  
003H  
020H  
00010011  
00110000  
(2.048M  
bit/s)  
02CH  
040H  
001H  
003H  
00010000  
00000100  
01000000  
00010000  
Receive Clock  
Master Full  
T1/J1 Mode  
020H  
02CH  
040H  
001H  
003H  
00000000  
00000000  
00000000  
00000000  
00010000  
Receive Clock  
Master Fractional  
T1/J1 Mode  
Enable the normal operation of the RSDn pin. The data on the RSDn and  
RSFSn are updated on the rising edge of the RSCK.  
The Frame Processor is set in ESF format. The CRC-6 calculation is  
performed when mimic framing pattern is present.  
The Alarm Detector is set in ESF format.  
The Receive CAS/RBS Buffer is set in ESF format.  
Enable the Receive Payload Control.  
The code in the DTRK[7:0] replaces the data output on the RSDn pin in the  
correspondingchannel.  
020H  
00110000  
02CH  
040H  
050H  
00010000  
00000100  
00000001  
01000000  
01H-18H (RPLC  
Indirect Registers)  
106  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Table - 52. Various Operation Modes in Receive Path for Reference (Continued)  
Mode  
Receive  
Multiplexed  
Mode  
Register 1 Value (from Bit7 to Bit0)  
Description 2  
001H  
081H  
101H  
181H  
201H  
281H  
301H  
381H  
003H  
083H  
103H  
183H  
203H  
283H  
303H  
383H  
077H  
0F7H  
177H  
1F7H  
277H  
2F7H  
377H  
3F7H  
020H  
0A0H  
120H  
1A0H  
220H  
2A0H  
320H  
3A0H  
02CH  
0ACH  
12CH  
1ACH  
22CH  
2ACH  
32CH  
3ACH  
040H  
0C0H  
140H  
1C0H  
240H  
2C0H  
340H  
3C0H  
11001000  
11001000  
11001000  
11001000  
11001000  
11001000  
11001000  
11001000  
01010011  
01010011  
01010011  
01010011  
11010011  
11010011  
11010011  
11010011  
00000000  
00000001  
00000010  
00000011  
00000000  
00000001  
00000010  
00000011  
00110000  
00110000  
00110000  
00110000  
00110000  
00110000  
00110000  
00110000  
00010000  
00010000  
00010000  
00010000  
00010000  
00010000  
00010000  
00010000  
00000100  
00000100  
00000100  
00000100  
00000100  
00000100  
00000100  
00000100  
In Receive Multiplexed mode. The receive backplane rate is 8.192Mbit/s.  
Multiplex the data stream of these four framers to the multiplexed bus 1. Enable the  
normal operation of the MRSD and MRSSIG pins. The data on the MRSD and MRSSIG  
are updated on the rising edge of the MRSCCK. The data on the MRSCFS are sampled  
on the falling edge of the MRSCCK.  
Multiplex the data stream of these four framers to the multiplexed bus 2. Enable the  
normal operation of the MRSD and MRSSIG pins. The data on the MRSD and MRSSIG  
are updated on the rising edge of the MRSCCK. The data on the MRSCFS are sampled  
on the falling edge of the MRSCCK.  
TSOFF[6:0] = 0. The timeslot offset is 0.  
TSOFF[6:0] = 1. The timeslot offset is 1.  
TSOFF[6:0] = 2. The timeslot offset is 2.  
TSOFF[6:0] = 3. The timeslot offset is 3.  
TSOFF[6:0] = 0. The timeslot offset is 0.  
TSOFF[6:0] = 1. The timeslot offset is 1.  
TSOFF[6:0] = 2. The timeslot offset is 2.  
TSOFF[6:0] = 3. The timeslot offset is 3.  
The Frame Processor is set in ESF format. The CRC-6 calculation is performed when  
mimic framing pattern is present.  
The Alarm Detector is set in ESF format.  
The Receive CAS/RBS Buffer is set in ESF format.  
107  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Table - 53. Various Operation Modes in Transmit Path for Reference  
Mode  
Transmit Clock  
Slave TSFS  
Enable Mode  
Register 1  
004H  
Value (from Bit7 to Bit0)  
Description 2  
00001000  
The data on the TSDn and TSCFS pins are sampled on the falling edge of the  
TSCCKB. The data on the TSFSn pin are updated on the falling edge of the TSCCKB.  
In Transmit Clock Slave TSFS Enabled mode. The backplane rate is 1.544Mbit/s.  
The Frame Generator is set in ESF format.  
TSCCKB is selected as TJAT input reference clock. Smoothed clock is selected  
as Line Transmit Clock (LTCK).  
005H  
044H  
007H  
10000000  
00010000  
00001101  
01BH  
004H  
00010000  
00001000  
The FIFO is set to self-center its read pointer.  
The data on the TSDn, TSSIGn and TSCFS pins are sampled on the falling edge  
of the TSCCKB.  
Transmit  
005H  
11000000  
In Transmit Clock Slave External Signaling mode. The backplane rate is  
1.544Mbit/s.  
(1.544M  
bit/s)  
Clock  
044H  
007H  
00010000  
00001101  
The Frame Generator is set in ESF format.  
TSCCKB is selected as TJAT input reference clock. Smoothed clock is selected  
as Line Transmit Clock (LTCK).  
Slave  
01BH  
004H  
00010000  
00001000  
The FIFO is set to self-center its read pointer.  
The data on the TSDn, TSSIGn and TSCFS pins are sampled on the falling edge  
of the TSCCKB.  
External  
005H  
11000100  
In Transmit Clock Slave External Signaling mode. The backplane rate is  
2.048Mbit/s.  
(2.048M 044H  
00010000  
00001101  
The Frame Generator is set in ESF format.  
TSCCKB is selected as TJAT input reference clock. Smoothed clock is selected  
as Line Transmit Clock (LTCK).  
Signaling bit/s)  
007H  
019H  
01AH  
01BH  
004H  
11111111  
11000000  
00010000  
00000110  
Set the Reference Clock Divisor(N1) to 255.  
Set the Output Clock Divisor(N2) to 192.  
The FIFO is set to self-center its read pointer.  
The data on the TSFSn pin are updated on the rising edge of the LTCK. The data  
on the TSDn pin are sampled on the falling edge of the LTCK.  
In Transmit Clock Master Full T1/J1 mode. The backplane rate is 1.544Mbit/s.  
The Frame Generator is set in SF format.  
XCK/24 is selected as TJAT input reference clock and Line Transmit Clock  
(LTCK).  
Mode  
Transmit Clock  
MasterMode  
005H  
044H  
007H  
01000000  
00000000  
00100100  
004H  
084H  
104H  
184H  
204H  
284H  
304H  
384H  
005H  
085H  
105H  
185H  
205H  
285H  
305H  
385H  
00001000  
00001000  
00001000  
00001000  
00001000  
00001000  
00001000  
00001000  
11001100  
11001100  
11001100  
11001100  
11001100  
11001100  
11001100  
11001100  
Transmit  
Multiplexed  
Mode  
The data on the TSDn, TSSIGn and TSCFS pins are sampled on the falling edge  
of TSCCKB.  
In Transmit Multiplexed mode. The backplane rate is 8.192Mbit/s.  
108  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Table - 53. Various Operation Modes in Transmit Path for Reference (Continued)  
Mode  
Register 1 Value (from Bit7 to Bit0)  
Description 2  
TSOFF[6:0] = 0. The timeslot offset is 0.  
014H  
094H  
114H  
194H  
214H  
294H  
314H  
394H  
015H  
095H  
115H  
195H  
215H  
295H  
315H  
395H  
044H  
0C4H  
144H  
1C4H  
244H  
2C4H  
344H  
3C4H  
007H  
087H  
107H  
187H  
207H  
287H  
307H  
387H  
019H  
099H  
119H  
199H  
219H  
299H  
319H  
399H  
01AH  
09AH  
11AH  
19AH  
21AH  
29AH  
31AH  
39AH  
00000000  
00000000  
00000001  
00000001  
00000010  
00000010  
00000011  
00000011  
00000000  
01000000  
00000000  
01000000  
00000000  
01000000  
00000000  
01000000  
00010000  
00010000  
00010000  
00010000  
00010000  
00010000  
00010000  
00010000  
00011101  
00011101  
00011101  
00011101  
00011101  
00011101  
00011101  
00011101  
11111111  
11111111  
11111111  
11111111  
11111111  
11111111  
11111111  
11111111  
11000000  
11000000  
11000000  
11000000  
11000000  
11000000  
11000000  
11000000  
TSOFF[6:0] = 1. The timeslot offset is 1.  
TSOFF[6:0] = 2. The timeslot offset is 2.  
TSOFF[6:0] = 3. The timeslot offset is 3.  
Transmit  
Multiplexed  
Mode  
The data stream is taken from the multiplexed bus 1.  
The data stream is taken from the multiplexed bus 2.  
The data stream is taken from the multiplexed bus 1.  
The data stream is taken from the multiplexed bus 2.  
The data stream is taken from the multiplexed bus 1.  
The data stream is taken from the multiplexed bus 2.  
The data stream is taken from the multiplexed bus 1.  
The data stream is taken from the multiplexed bus 2.  
The Frame Generator is set in ESF format.  
TSCCKA is selected as TJAT input reference clock. Smoothed clock is selected as Line  
Transmit Clock (LTCK).  
(Continued)  
Set the Reference Clock Divisor(N1) to 255.  
Set the Output Clock Divisor(N2) to 192.  
109  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Table - 53. Various Operation Modes in Transmit Path for Reference (Continued)  
Mode  
Register 1 Value (from Bit7 to Bit0)  
Description 2  
Transmit  
01BH  
09BH  
11BH  
19BH  
21BH  
29BH  
31BH  
39BH  
00010000  
00010000  
00010000  
00010000  
00010000  
00010000  
00010000  
00010000  
Multiplexed  
Mode  
The FIFO is set to self-center its read pointer.  
(Continued)  
Note:  
1. In the ‘Register’ column, except for the Receive/Transmit Multiplexed mode, the register position of the Framer One is listed to represent the set of the  
registers of eight framers. The other registers position are tabulated in the ‘Register Map’. However, in Receive/Transmit Multiplexed mode, the register position  
of eight framers are all listed.  
2. The ‘Description’ illustrates the fundamental function of the operation mode. The others can be configured as desired.  
After setting these registers properly, the HDLC data can be  
received in a polled or interrupt driven mode.  
4.2.4  
In this chapter, some common operation examples are given for ref-  
erence.  
OPERATION EXAMPLE  
- Interrupt Driven Mode  
When the INTE (b7, T1/J1-055H) is set to logic 1, if the INT pin is  
asserted, the source of the interrupt should be identified firstly by  
reading the Interrupt ID register and Interrupt Source registers. If the  
source of the interrupt is HDLC Receive, the Interrupt Service  
procedure will be carried out as shown in Figure - 77.  
4.2.4.1 Using The HDLC Receiver  
In T1/J1 mode, the HDLC Receive can only be used in ESF format.  
Before using the HDLC#2 Receive, the TXCISEL (b3, T1/J1-00DH) must  
be set to 0 to enable the HDLC data link position for receive path.  
Since two HDLC Receive data links are integrated in one framer, one  
of the two HDLC Receive data links must be selected in the  
RHDLCSEL[1:0] (b7~6, T1/J1-00DH). The RHDLC #1 can only extract  
from F-bit of each odd frame. The RHDLC #2 can be set to extract from  
even and/or odd frames, from any channel, and from any bit. The follow  
is an example for selecting the HDLC Receive data link positions in  
RHDLC #2:  
- Polling Mode  
In polling mode, the operation procedure is the same as Figure - 77,  
except that the entry of the service is from a local timer rather than an  
interrupt.  
To summarize the procedure of using HDLC Receive, a complete ex-  
ample is shown in Table - 54.  
a. to extract the HDLC data link from all bits of channel 20 of all fram-  
ers in HDLC Receive #2:  
- set the TXCISEL (b3, T1/J1-00DH) to 0;  
- set the RHDLCSEL[1:0] (b7~6, T1/J1-00DH) to 01;  
- set the DL2_EVEN (b7, T1/J1-070H) to 1;  
Table - 54 . Example for Using HDLC Receiver  
- set the DL2_ODD (b6, T1/J1-070H) to 1;  
- set the DL2_TS[4:0] (b4~0, T1/J1-070H) to 10100;  
- set the DL2_BIT[7:0] (b7~0, T1/J1-071H) to 11111111.  
Register Value  
Description  
RHDLC #2 is selected. The HDLC Receive is  
accessable to the CPU interface.  
00DH  
50H  
After setting the HDLC data link position properly, the selected HDLC  
Receive should be enabled by setting the EN (b0, T1/J1-054H)to logic  
1. If needed, set the MEN (b3, T1/J1-054H) and the MM (b2, T1/J1-  
054H) to determine which Address Matching Mode to be selected (refer  
to Register Description for details). After setting these 3 bits, the  
RHDLC Primary Address Match register and the RHDLC Secondary Ad-  
dress Match register should be set to proper values. If the INTC[6:0]  
(b6~0, T1/J1-055H) are set, whenever the number of bytes in the  
RHDLC FIFO exceeds the value set in the INTC[6:0] (b6~0, T1/J1-  
055H), the INTR (b0, T1/J1-056H) will be set to logic 1. This interrupt  
will persist until the RHDLC FIFO becomes empty. Setting the INTE (b7,  
T1/J1-055H) to logic 1 allows the internal interrupt status to be propa-  
gated to the INT output pin.  
070H  
C4H The TS4 of even frames and odd frames are  
selected.  
071H  
054H  
FFH  
0DH  
All the 8 bits are selected.  
The function of the RHDLC #2 is enabled. Set  
the address match mode.  
055H  
8FH  
Set the INTE to 1. When the number of bytes in  
the RHDLC FIFO exceeds 15, an interrupt is  
generated.  
058H  
059H  
13H  
FFH  
The primary address is set to 13H.  
The secondary address is set to FFH.  
Then read the data status in register 056H. Until a complete packet is  
received, read the data from register 057H .  
110  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
INT asserts  
Other block  
interrupt service  
N
RHDLC  
interrupt  
Y
Read RHDLC STATUS  
Y
OVR=1  
Discard the last packet  
Set EMPTY FIFO * flag  
N
Y
COLS=1  
N
Y
PACKET COUNT * increment  
PKIN=1  
N
Read RHDLC data  
Read RHDLC status  
Y
OVR=1  
Discard the last packet  
N
Y
COLS=1  
Set EMPTY FIFO * flag  
N
Y
PKIN=1  
PACKET COUNT * increment  
N
000  
PBS[2:0]=?  
1XX  
Store this byte, decrement the PACKET COUNT *,  
check for CRC or non-integer number errors before  
deciding whether to keep the packet or not.  
store the packet data  
001  
010  
Discard this data byte,  
Set LINK ACTIVE * Flag  
Discard this data byte ,  
Clear LINK ACTIVE * Flag  
N
FE=1  
Y
End of Interrupt  
service  
Note:  
* The PACKET COUNT ,EMPTY FIFO and LINK ACTIVE is a local software variable  
Figure - 77. Interrupt Service in T1/J1 Mode HDLC Receiver  
111  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
4.2.4.2 Using The HDLC Transmitter  
THDLC Initial  
In T1/J1 mode, the HDLC Transmit can only be used in ESF format.  
Before using the HDLC#2 Transmit, the TXCISEL (b3, T1/J1-00DH) must  
be set to 1 to enable the HDLC data link position for transmit path.  
Since two HDLC Transmit data links are integrated in one framer, one  
of the two HDLC Transmit data links must be selected in the  
THDLCSEL[1:0] (b5~4, T1/J1-00DH). The THDLC #1 can only insert to  
F-bit of each odd frame. The THDLC #2 can be set to insert to even and/  
or odd frames, to any channel, and to any bit. The follow is an example  
for selecting the HDLC Transmit data link positions in THDLC #2:  
a. to insert the HDLC data link to all bits of channel 20 of all framers  
in HDLC Transmit #2:  
Data is available  
Y
N
Write data into  
THDLC FIFO  
- set the TXCISEL (b3, T1/J1-00DH) to 1;  
- set the THDLCSEL[1:0] (b5~4, T1/J1-00DH) to 01;  
- set the DL2_EVEN (b7, T1/J1-070H) to 1;  
- set the DL2_ODD (b6, T1/J1-070H) to 1;  
N
End of packet  
- set the DL2_TS[4:0] (b4~0, T1/J1-070H) to 10100;  
- set the DL2_BIT[7:0] (b7~0, T1/J1-071H) to 11111111.  
Y
Set EOM  
After setting the HDLC data link position properly, the selected  
HDLC Transmit should be enabled by setting the EN (b0, T1/J1-034H)  
to logic 1. The FIFOCLR (b6, T1/J1-034H) should be set and then  
cleared to initialize the THDLC FIFO.  
Set the CRC (b1, T1/J1-034H) to logic 1 if the Frame Check  
Sequences (FCS) generation is desired. Set the FULLE (b3, T1/J1-  
037H), OVRE (b2, T1/J1-037H), UDRE (b1, T1/J1-037H) and LFILLE  
Figure - 78. Writing Data to T1/J1 Mode THDLC FIFO  
(b0, T1/J1-037H) to logic 1 if interrupt driven mode is used. Set THDLC Table - 55. Example for Using HDLC Transmitter  
Upper Transmit Threshold and THDLC Lower Transmit Threshold  
registers to the desired values. If a complete packet has been written  
into THDLC FIFO, the EOM (b3, T1/J1-034H) should be set.  
After setting these registers properly, the HDLC data can be  
transmitted in a polled or interrupt driven mode.  
Register Value Description  
00DH  
58H  
THDLC #2 is selected. The HDLC Transmit is  
accessable to the CPU interface.  
070H  
C4H  
The TS4 of even frames and odd frames are  
selected.  
- Interrupt Driven Mode  
Writing HDLC data to THDLC FIFO , the THDLC will transmit the  
HDLC data if the end of a packet was written or if the THDLC FIFO fill  
level reaches the Upper Transmit Threshold. The writing procedure is  
shown in Figure - 78.  
When the FULLE (b3, T1/J1-037H), OVRE (b2, T1/J1-037H), UDRE  
(b1, T1/J1-037H) and LFILLE (b0, T1/J1-037H) are set to logic 1, if the  
INT pin is asserted, the source of the interrupt should be identified firstly  
by reading the Interrupt ID register and Interrupt Source registers. If the  
source of the interrupt is HDLC Transmit, the Interrupt Service  
procedure will be carried out as shown in Figure - 79.  
071H  
034H  
034H  
037H  
039H  
039H  
039H  
039H  
039H  
039H  
039H  
039H  
034H  
FFH  
C3H  
83H  
0FH  
12H  
34H  
56H  
78H  
9AH  
BCH  
DEH  
FFH  
8BH  
All the 8 bits are selected.  
The function of the THDLC #2 is enabled. The  
FCS is enables and the THDLC FIFO is reset.  
Enable the THDLC Interrupt Enable bits.  
Write data into THDLC FIFO.  
- Polling Mode  
In packet transmission polling mode, the FULLE (b3, T1/J1-037H),  
OVRE (b2, T1/J1-037H), UDRE (b1, T1/J1-037H) and LFILLE (b0, T1/  
J1-037H) should be set to logic 0. The THDLC Lower Transmit  
Threshold should be set to such a value that sufficient warning of an  
underrun is given. The procedure shown in Figure - 80 should be  
followed.  
End of packet and set the EOM to 1.  
To summarize the procedure of using HDLC Transmit, a complete ex-  
ample is shown in Table - 55.  
112  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
INT Asserts  
N
Other Blocks Interrupt  
Service  
THDLC Interrupt  
Y
Y
Y
UNDRI=1  
N
OVRI=1  
N
FULLI=1  
N
Y
Y
Start a timer 2  
FULL=1  
N
Set the RLP Flag 1  
N
LFILLI=1  
Y
BLFILL=1  
N
Y
End of  
packet  
N
Y
Set EOM  
End of  
Interrupt Service  
Note:  
1. RLP-Retransmit the last packet, a local software variable.  
2. A local timer to wait for a certain time until the Full = 0 or the BLFILL = 1.  
Figure - 79. Interrupt Service in T1/J1 Mode HDLC Transmitter  
113  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
THDLC initial  
Data is  
available  
N
Y
Read THDLC  
interrupt status  
Y
Wait, Until FULL=0  
or BBLFILL=1  
FULL=1  
N
Write the data  
into the THDLC FIFO  
More data to  
be tarnsmitted  
Y
N
Set EOM  
Figure - 80. Polling Mode in T1/J1 Mode HDLC Transmitter  
4.2.4.3 Using The PRBS Generator / Detector  
Then insert errors into this link. Here suppose to insert 3 errors, then  
the configuration is shown in Table - 60.  
IDT82V2108 provide one PRBS generator/detector block to  
generate and detect an enormous variety of pseudo-random and  
repetitive patterns to diagnose T1/J1 data stream of eight framers. The  
common test patterns are tabulrized in Table - 56.  
The PRBS generator/detector block can be used to test T1/J1 line  
transmit-receive integrity and system backplane integrity.  
- Example For Testing T1/J1 System Backplane Integrity  
To test the T1/J1 system backplane integrity, the RXPATGEN (b2,  
T1/J1-00FH) should be set to logic 1 and the other registers are set as  
above. Then the PRGD can be used to test the system backplane  
integrity.  
- Example For Testing T1/J1 Line Transmit-Receive Integrity  
Suppose to monitor the errors in Framer Two without taking the  
entire T1/J1 offline. Following procedure should be done.  
- Select Framer Two to be tested by the PRGD block;  
- Configure the PRGD register;  
- Chose a desired set of channels (for example CH2, CH4, CH5) for  
insert/extract PRGD test data;  
- Set the far end of the line to loop back at least the selected  
channels;  
- Monitor the T1/J1 line transmit-receive integrity.  
To realize the above function, the configuration in Table - 57 to Table -  
59 should be set.  
Table - 57 is the configuration for PRGD and loopback. Table - 58  
shows the process to initialize the TPLC. Table - 59 shows the process  
to initialize the RPLC.  
After the above setting, read the 061H register twice. If the SYNCV  
(b4, T1/J1-061H) is logic 1 and the BEI (b2, T1/J1-061H) is logic 0, the  
pattern detector is in synchronization state.  
114  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Table - 56. Test Pattern  
Pseudo-Random Pattern Generation (the PS [b4, T1/J1-060H] is logic 0)  
Pattern Type  
TR 1  
00  
00  
01  
04  
00  
03  
03  
04  
02  
08  
0D  
02  
06  
02  
01  
00  
11  
LR 2  
02  
03  
04  
05  
06  
06  
06  
08  
09  
0A  
0E  
10  
11  
13  
14  
15  
16  
18  
1B  
1C  
1E  
IR#1 3  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
IR#2 4  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
IR#3 5  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
IR#4 6  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
TINV 7  
RINV 7  
3
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
–1  
–1  
-1  
–1  
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
4
5
6
7
7
7
9
10  
11  
15  
17  
18  
20  
21  
22  
23  
25  
28  
29  
31  
–1 (Fractional T1 LB Activate)  
–1 (Fractional T1 LB Activate)  
–1  
–1 (O.153)  
-1  
-1 (O.152,O.153)  
-1 (O.151)  
-1  
-1  
-1 (O.153)  
-1  
-1  
-1 (O.151)  
-1  
-1  
-1  
-1  
02  
02  
01  
02  
Repetitive Pattern Generation (the PS [b4, T1/J1-060H] is logic 1)  
Pattern Type  
All ones  
All zeros  
Alternatingones/zeros  
Double alternatingones/zeros  
3 in 24  
1 in 16  
1 in 8  
TR 1  
00  
00  
00  
00  
00  
00  
00  
00  
00  
00  
LR 2  
00  
00  
01  
03  
17  
0F  
07  
03  
04  
02  
IR#1 3  
FF  
IR#2 4  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
00  
IR#3 5  
FF  
IR#4 6  
FF  
TINV 7  
RINV 7  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
FE  
FE  
FC  
22  
01  
01  
F1  
F0  
FC  
FF  
FF  
FF  
20  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
0F  
00  
FF  
FF  
FF  
FF  
1 in 4  
DS1 Inbandloopback activate  
DS1 InbandLoopback deactivate  
FF  
FF  
Note:  
1. TR - Tap Register  
2. LR - Shift Register Length Register  
3. IR#1 - PRGD Pattern Insertion #1 Register  
4. IR#2 - PRGD Pattern Insertion #2 Register  
5. IR#3 - PRGD Pattern Insertion #3 Register  
6. IR#4 - PRGD Pattern Insertion #4 Register  
7. TINV, RINV - contained in the PRGD Control register  
115  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Table - 57. The Setting of PRGD  
Table - 58. Initializtion of TPLC (Continued)  
Register Value  
Description  
Register  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
Value  
0FH  
00H  
10H  
00H  
11H  
00H  
12H  
00H  
13H  
00H  
14H  
00H  
15H  
00H  
16H  
00H  
17H  
00H  
18H  
00H  
31H  
00H  
32H  
00H  
33H  
00H  
34H  
00H  
35H  
00H  
36H  
00H  
37H  
00H  
38H  
00H  
39H  
00H  
3AH  
00H  
3BH  
00H  
3CH  
00H  
3DH  
00H  
3EH  
00H  
00FH  
060H  
20H Select Framer 2 to be tested by the PRGD  
block. The PRGD pattern is inserted in the TPLC  
and detected in the RPLC.  
82H Set Pattern Detector registers as error counter  
register. Enable automatic resynchronization.  
18H Set the pattern length.  
02H Set the feedback tap position.  
FFH Set the Pattern Insertion registers.  
FFH Load the data in the Pattern Insertion registers to  
generate the pattern.  
062H  
063H  
068H  
06BH  
08AH  
0B0H  
04H Set diagnostic digital loopback mode.  
01H Enable the TPLC indirect registers to be  
accessable.  
0D0H  
01H Enable the RPLC indirect registers to be  
accessable.  
Table - 58. Initializtion of TPLC  
Register  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
Value  
00H  
01H  
00H  
02H  
00H  
03H  
00H  
04H  
00H  
05H  
00H  
06H  
00H  
07H  
00H  
08H  
00H  
09H  
00H  
0AH  
00H  
0BH  
00H  
0CH  
00H  
0DH  
00H  
0EH  
00H  
116  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Table - 58. Initializtion of TPLC (Continued)  
Table - 59. Initializtion of RPLC (Continued)  
Register  
0D3H  
0D2H  
0D3H  
0D2H  
0D3H  
0D2H  
0D3H  
0D2H  
0D3H  
0D2H  
0D3H  
0D2H  
0D3H  
0D2H  
0D3H  
0D2H  
0D3H  
0D2H  
0D3H  
0D2H  
0D3H  
0D2H  
0D3H  
0D2H  
0D3H  
0D2H  
0D3H  
0D2H  
0D3H  
0D2H  
0D3H  
0D2H  
0D3H  
0D2H  
Value  
00H  
08H  
00H  
09H  
00H  
0AH  
00H  
0BH  
00H  
0CH  
00H  
0DH  
00H  
0EH  
00H  
0FH  
00H  
10H  
00H  
11H  
00H  
12H  
00H  
13H  
00H  
14H  
00H  
15H  
00H  
16H  
00H  
17H  
00H  
18H  
Register  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
Value  
3FH  
00H  
40H  
00H  
41H  
00H  
42H  
00H  
43H  
00H  
44H  
00H  
45H  
00H  
46H  
00H  
47H  
00H  
48H  
Then set the TEST in TPLC Payload Control register for CH2, CH4  
and CH5. The process is:  
Register Value  
Description  
Set the TEST in TPLC Payload Control register  
for CH2.  
Set the TEST in TPLC Payload Control register  
for CH4.  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
0B3H  
0B2H  
08H  
02H  
08H  
04H  
08H  
05H  
Set the TEST in TPLC Payload Control register  
for CH5.  
Table - 59. Initializtion of RPLC  
Register  
0D3H  
0D2H  
0D3H  
0D2H  
0D3H  
0D2H  
0D3H  
0D2H  
0D3H  
0D2H  
0D3H  
0D2H  
0D3H  
0D2H  
Value  
00H  
01H  
00H  
02H  
00H  
03H  
00H  
04H  
00H  
05H  
00H  
06H  
00H  
07H  
Then set the TEST in RPLC Payload Control register for CH2, CH4  
and CH5. The process is:  
Register Value  
Description  
Set the TEST in RPLC Payload Control  
register for CH2.  
Set the TEST in RPLC Payload Control  
register for CH4  
0D3H  
0D2H  
0D3H  
0D2H  
0D3H  
0D2H  
08H  
02H  
08H  
04H  
08H  
05H  
Set the TEST in RPLC Payload Control  
register for CH5  
117  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Table - 60. Error Insertion  
Set PCCE=1  
Register  
064H  
064H  
064H  
064H  
064H  
064H  
Value  
08H  
00H  
08H  
00H  
08H  
00H  
N
BUSY=0  
Y
Data are set in the Channel  
Indirect Data Buffer Register  
RWB=0 and address is specified  
in the Channel Indirect Address/  
Control Register.  
Then write 00H into the 06CH register to update the error counter  
registers. Then read the registers from 06CH to 06FH to check the  
error numbers.  
Y
More data  
to be written  
4.2.4.4 Using Payload Control and Receive CAS/RBS Buffer  
Before using the Receive/Transmit Payload Control and Receive  
CAS/RBS Buffer, the indirect registers of these blocks must be initialized  
to eliminate erroneous control data. The the PCCE (b0, T1/J1-050H &  
b0, T1/J1-030H & b0, T1/J1-040H) of these blocks must be set to logic 1  
to enable these blocks.  
N
End  
Then the BUSY (b7, T1/J1-051H & b7, T1/J1-031H & b7, T1/J1-  
041H) must be checked before a new access request to the RPLC,  
TPLC and RCRB indirect registers. When the BUSY is logic 0, the new  
reading and writing access operations can be performed.  
Figure - 81. Writing Sequence of Indirect Register in T1/J1 Mode  
Figure - 81 shows the writing sequence of the RPLC, TPLC and  
RCRB indirect registers. Figure - 82 shows the reading sequence of the  
RPLC, TPLC and RCRB indirect registers.  
Set PCCE=1  
4.2.4.5 Using TJAT / Timing Option  
In different operation modes, the Timing Options and Clock Divisor  
Control registers can be set as the follows:  
N
BUSY=0  
Y
RWB=1 and address is specified in  
the Channel Indirect Address/  
Control Register.  
- Transmit Clock Slave Mode (System Backplane Rate: 1.544M bit/s)  
The TSCCKA or TSCCKB is selected as the TJAT DPLL input refer-  
ence clock. The TSCCKA and TSCCKB are both equal to 1.544M. The  
N1 (b7~0, T1/J1-019H) and N2 (b7~0, T1/J1-01AH) are set to their de-  
fault value (2FH).  
N
BUSY=0  
The smoothed clock output from the TJAT is selected as the LTCK.  
Y
- Transmit Clock Slave Mode (System Backplane Rate: 2.048M bit/s)  
The TSCCKA or TSCCKB is selected as the TJAT DPLL input refer-  
ence clock. The TSCCKA and TSCCKB are both equal to 2.048M. The  
N1 (b7~0, T1/J1-019H) is set to ‘b11111111 and the N2 (b7~0, T1/J1-  
01AH) is set to ‘b11000000.  
Read Channel Indirect Data  
Buffer Register  
Y
More data  
to be read  
The smoothed clock output from the TJAT is selected as the LTCK.  
- Transmit Clock Slave Mode (System Backplane Rate: 4.096M bit/s)  
The TSCCKA is selected as the TJAT DPLL input reference clock.  
The TSCCKA is equal to 2.048M. The N1 (b7~0, T1/J1-019H) is set to  
‘b11111111 and the N2 (b7~0, T1/J1-01AH) is set to ‘b11000000.  
The smoothed clock output from the TJAT is selected as the LTCK.  
N
End  
Figure - 82. Reading Sequence of Indirect Register in T1/J1 Mode  
118  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
- Transmit Clock Master Mode  
5
PROGRAMMING INFORMATION  
The XCK/24 is selected as the TJAT DPLL input reference clock.  
The XCK/24 is selected as the LTCK.  
The Micro-Processor Interface provides the logic to connect the  
microprocessor interface. For all accesses, CS must be low. The data  
bus and address bus of the interface can work in multiplexed on non-  
multiplexed mode. In non-multiplexed mode, ALE pin should be  
connected to high. In multiplexed mode, data bus and address bus  
should be externally connected.  
- Transmit Multiplexed Mode (System Backplane Rate: 8.192M bit/s)  
The TSCCKA is selected as the TJAT DPLL input reference clock.  
The TSCCKA is equal to 2.048M. The N1 (b7~0, T1/J1-019H) is set to  
‘b11111111 and the N2 (b7~0, T1/J1-01AH) is set to ‘b11000000.  
The smoothed clock output from the TJAT is selected as the LTCK.  
5.1 REGISTER MAP  
The registers are devided into two parts: E1 part and T1/J1 part. Be-  
fore operation, the TEMODE (b0, 400H) must be set to specify which  
part to be accessed by the microprocessor.  
- Transmit Multiplexed Mode (System Backplane Rate: 16.384M bit/s)  
The TSCCKA or TSCCKA/8 is selected as the TJAT DPLL input ref-  
erence clock. The TSCCKA is equal to 2.048M or 16.384M. The N1  
(b7~0, T1/J1-019H) is set to ‘b11111111 and the N2 (b7~0, T1/J1-01AH)  
is set to ‘b11000000.  
Table - 61. T1/E1 Mode Selection Register  
The smoothed clock output from the TJAT is selected as the LTCK.  
Address  
Register  
400  
T1 / E1 Mode Selection  
119  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
5.1.1  
When the TEMODE (b0, 400H) is logic 0, the E1 mode registers are  
accessed.  
E1 MODE REGISTER MAP  
Table - 62a. E1 Mode Register Map - Direct Register  
E1 Address  
Register  
Receive Path Line Options  
Receive Side System Interface Options  
Transmit Path Configuration  
Transmit Side System Interface Options  
Transmit Timing Options  
Interrupt Source #1  
Framer 1 Framer 2 Framer 3 Framer4 Framer 5 Framer 6 Framer 7 Framer8  
000  
001  
002  
003  
004  
005  
006  
007  
008  
080  
081  
082  
083  
084  
085  
086  
087  
088  
100  
101  
102  
103  
104  
105  
106  
107  
108  
180  
181  
182  
183  
184  
185  
186  
187  
188  
200  
201  
202  
203  
204  
205  
206  
207  
208  
280  
281  
282  
283  
284  
285  
286  
287  
288  
300  
301  
302  
303  
304  
305  
306  
307  
308  
380  
381  
382  
383  
384  
385  
386  
387  
388  
Interrupt Source #2  
Diagnostic  
Reserved  
009  
Chip ID/ Global PMON Update  
HDLC Micro Select/Framer Reset  
Framer Interrupt ID  
PRGD Positioning/control  
ClockMonitor  
Receive Path Frame Pulse Configuration  
Reserved  
RESI Configuration  
00A  
08A  
10A  
18A  
20A  
28A  
30A  
38A  
00B  
00C  
00D  
00E  
00F  
010  
011  
012  
013  
014  
08D  
08E  
08F  
090  
091  
092  
093  
094  
10D  
10E  
10F  
110  
111  
112  
113  
114  
18D  
18E  
18F  
190  
191  
192  
193  
194  
20D  
20E  
20F  
210  
211  
212  
213  
214  
28D  
28E  
28F  
290  
291  
292  
293  
294  
30D  
30E  
30F  
310  
311  
312  
313  
314  
38D  
38E  
38F  
390  
391  
392  
393  
394  
RESI Frame Pulse Configuration  
RESI Parity Configuration  
RESI Timeslot Offset  
RESI Bit Offset  
015~017 095~097 115~117 195~197 215~217 295~297 315~317 395~397 Reserved  
018  
019  
01A  
01B  
01C  
098  
099  
09A  
09B  
09C  
118  
119  
11A  
11B  
11C  
198  
199  
19A  
19B  
19C  
218  
219  
21A  
21B  
21C  
298  
299  
29A  
29B  
29C  
318  
319  
31A  
31B  
31C  
398  
399  
39A  
39B  
39C  
TRSI Configuration  
TRSI Frame Pulse Configuration  
TRSI Parity Configuration and Status  
TRSI Timeslot Offset  
TRSI Bit Offset  
01D~01F 09D~09F 11D~11F 19D~19F 21D~21F 29D~29F 31D~31F 39D~39F Reserved  
020  
021  
022  
023  
024  
025  
026  
027  
028  
0A0  
0A1  
0A2  
0A3  
0A4  
0A5  
0A6  
0A7  
0A8  
120  
121  
122  
123  
124  
125  
126  
127  
128  
1A0  
1A1  
1A2  
1A3  
1A4  
1A5  
1A6  
1A7  
1A8  
220  
221  
222  
223  
224  
225  
226  
227  
228  
2A0  
2A1  
2A2  
2A3  
2A4  
2A5  
2A6  
2A7  
2A8  
320  
321  
322  
323  
324  
325  
326  
327  
328  
3A0  
3A1  
3A2  
3A3  
3A4  
3A5  
3A6  
3A7  
3A8  
RJAT Interrupt Status  
RJAT Reference Clock Divisor(N1)  
RJAT Reference Clock Divisor(N2)  
RJATConfiguration  
TJAT Interrupt Status  
TJAT Reference Clock Divisor(N1)  
TJAT Reference Clock Divisor(N2)  
TJATConfiguration  
RHDLC 1(TXCISEL=0) Link Control/  
THDLC 1(TXCISEL=1) Link Control  
RHDLC 1(TXCISEL=0) bits select/  
THDLC 1(TXCISEL=1) bits select  
RHDLC 2(TXCISEL=0) Link Control/  
THDLC 2(TXCISEL=1) Link Control  
029  
02A  
0A9  
129  
12A  
1A9  
229  
22A  
2A9  
329  
32A  
3A9  
0AA  
1AA  
2AA  
3AA  
120  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Table - 62a. E1 Mode Register Map - Direct Register (Continued)  
E1 Address  
Register  
Framer 1 Framer 2 Framer 3 Framer4 Framer 5 Framer 6 Framer 7 Framer8  
02B  
02C  
02D  
0AB  
0AC  
0AD  
12B  
12C  
12D  
1AB  
1AC  
1AD  
22B  
22C  
22D  
2AB  
2AC  
2AD  
32B  
32C  
32D  
3AB  
3AC  
3AD  
RHDLC 2(TXCISEL=0) bits select/  
THDLC 2(TXCISEL=1) bits select  
RHDLC 3(TXCISEL=0) Link Control/  
THDLC 3(TXCISEL=1) Link Control  
RHDLC 3(TXCISEL=0) bits select/  
THDLC 3(TXCISEL=1) bits select  
02E~02F 0AE~0AF 12E~12F 1AE~1AF 22E~22F 2AE~2AF 32E~32F 3AE~3AF Reserved  
030  
031  
032  
033  
034  
035  
036  
037  
038  
039  
03A  
03B  
03C  
03D  
03E  
03F  
040  
041  
042  
043  
044  
045  
046  
047  
048  
049  
04A  
04B  
04C  
04D  
0B0  
0B1  
0B2  
0B3  
0B4  
0B5  
0B6  
0B7  
0B8  
0B9  
0BA  
0BB  
0BC  
0BD  
0BE  
0BF  
0C0  
0C1  
0C2  
0C3  
0C4  
0C5  
0C6  
0C7  
0C8  
0C9  
0CA  
0CB  
0CC  
0CD  
130  
131  
132  
133  
134  
135  
136  
137  
138  
139  
13A  
13B  
13C  
13D  
13E  
13F  
140  
141  
142  
143  
144  
145  
146  
147  
148  
149  
14A  
14B  
14C  
14D  
1B0  
1B1  
1B2  
1B3  
1B4  
1B5  
1B6  
1B7  
1B8  
1B9  
1BA  
1BB  
1BC  
1BD  
1BE  
1BF  
1C0  
1C1  
1C2  
1C3  
1C4  
1C5  
1C6  
1C7  
1C8  
1C9  
1CA  
1CB  
1CC  
1CD  
230  
231  
232  
233  
234  
235  
236  
237  
238  
239  
23A  
23B  
23C  
23D  
23E  
23F  
240  
241  
242  
243  
244  
245  
246  
247  
248  
249  
24A  
24B  
24C  
24D  
2B0  
2B1  
2B2  
2B3  
2B4  
2B5  
2B6  
2B7  
2B8  
2B9  
2BA  
2BB  
2BC  
2BD  
2BE  
2BF  
2C0  
2C1  
2C2  
2C3  
2C4  
2C5  
2C6  
2C7  
2C8  
2C9  
2CA  
2CB  
2CC  
2CD  
330  
331  
332  
333  
334  
335  
336  
337  
338  
339  
33A  
33B  
33C  
33D  
33E  
33F  
340  
341  
342  
343  
344  
345  
346  
347  
348  
349  
34A  
34B  
34C  
34D  
3B0  
3B1  
3B2  
3B3  
3B4  
3B5  
3B6  
3B7  
3B8  
3B9  
3BA  
3BB  
3BC  
3BD  
3BE  
3BF  
3C0  
3C1  
3C2  
3C3  
3C4  
3C5  
3C6  
3C7  
3C8  
3C9  
3CA  
3CB  
3CC  
3CD  
FRMP Frame Alignment Option  
FRMP Maintenance Mode Options  
FRMP Framing Status Interrupt Enable  
FRMP Maintenance/Alarm Status Interrupt Enable  
FRMP Framing Status Interrupt Indication  
FRMP Maintenance/Alarm Status Interrupt Indication  
FRMP Framing Status  
FRMP Maintenance/Alarm Status  
FRMP TS0 International/National Bits  
FRMP CRC Error Counter-LSB  
FRMP CRC Error Counter-MSB/TS16 Extra Bits  
FRMP National Bit Code-word Interrupt Enable  
FRMP National Bit Code-word Interrupts  
FRMP National Bit Code-word  
FRMP Frame pulse/Alarm/V5.2 Link ID Interrupt Enable  
FRMP Frame Pulse/Alarm Interrupts  
FRMG Configuration  
FRMG Alarm/Diagnostic Control  
FRMG International Bits  
FRMG Extra Bits  
FRMGInterruptEnable  
FRMG Interrupt Status  
FRMG National Bit Code-word Select  
FRMG National Bit Code-word  
RHDLC #1, 2, 3 Configuration  
RHDLC #1, 2, 3 Interrupt Control  
RHDLC #1, 2, 3 Status  
RHDLC #1, 2, 3 Data  
RHDLC #1, 2, 3 Primary Address Match  
RHDLC #1, 2, 3 Secondary Address Match  
04E~04F 0CE~0CF 14E~14F 1CE~1CF 24E~24F 2CE~2CF 34E~34F 3CE~3CF Reserved  
050  
051  
052  
053  
054  
055  
0D0  
0D1  
0D2  
0D3  
0D4  
0D5  
150  
151  
152  
153  
154  
155  
1D0  
1D1  
1D2  
1D3  
1D4  
1D5  
250  
251  
252  
253  
254  
255  
2D0  
2D1  
2D2  
2D3  
2D4  
2D5  
350  
351  
352  
353  
354  
355  
3D0  
3D1  
3D2  
3D3  
3D4  
3D5  
THDLC #1, 2, 3 Configuration  
THDLC #1, 2, 3 Upper Transmit Threshold  
THDLC #1, 2, 3 Lower Transmit Threshold  
THDLC #1, 2, 3 Interrupt Enable  
THDLC #1, 2, 3 interrupt Status  
THDLC #1, 2, 3 Transmit Data  
056~058 0D6~0D8 156~158 1D6~1D8 256~258 2D6~2D8 356~358 3D6~3D8 Reserved  
059  
05A  
0D9  
0DA  
159  
15A  
1D9  
1DA  
259  
25A  
2D9  
2DA  
359  
35A  
3D9  
3DA  
ELSB Interrupt Enable/ Status  
ELSB Idle Code  
121  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Table - 62a. E1 Mode Register Map - Direct Register (Continued)  
E1 Address  
Register  
Framer 1 Framer 2 Framer 3 Framer4 Framer 5 Framer 6 Framer 7 Framer8  
05B  
05C  
05D  
05E  
05F  
060  
061  
062  
063  
064  
0DB  
0DC  
0DD  
0DE  
0DF  
0E0  
0E1  
0E2  
0E3  
0E4  
15B  
15C  
15D  
15E  
15F  
160  
161  
162  
163  
164  
1DB  
1DC  
1DD  
1DE  
1DF  
1E0  
1E1  
1E2  
1E3  
1E4  
25B  
25C  
25D  
25E  
25F  
260  
261  
262  
263  
264  
2DB  
2DC  
2DD  
2DE  
2DF  
2E0  
2E1  
2E2  
2E3  
2E4  
35B  
35C  
35D  
35E  
35F  
360  
361  
362  
363  
364  
3DB  
3DC  
3DD  
3DE  
3DF  
3E0  
3E1  
3E2  
3E3  
3E4  
Reserved  
RPLC Configuration  
RPLC mP Access Status  
RPLC Channel indirect Address/Control  
RPLC Channel Indirect Data Buffer  
TPLCConfiguration  
TPLC mP Access Status  
TPLC Channel indirect Address/Control  
TPLC Channel Indirect Data Buffer  
RCRB Configuration (COSS=0) /  
RCRB COSS[30:25] (COSS=1)  
RCRB mP Access Status (COSS=0) /  
RCRB COSS[24:17] (COSS=1)  
RCRB CH IND Addr/Control (COSS=0) /  
RCRB COSS[16:9] (COSS=1)  
RCRB CH Indirect Data Buffer (COSS=0) /  
RCRB COSS[8:1] (COSS=1)  
PMON Interrupt Enable/Status  
PMON FER Count  
065  
066  
067  
0E5  
0E6  
0E7  
165  
166  
167  
1E5  
1E6  
1E7  
265  
266  
267  
2E5  
2E6  
2E7  
365  
366  
367  
3E5  
3E6  
3E7  
068  
069  
06A  
06B  
06C  
06D  
0E8  
0E9  
0EA  
0EB  
0EC  
0ED  
168  
169  
16A  
16B  
16C  
16D  
1E8  
1E9  
1EA  
1EB  
1EC  
1ED  
268  
269  
26A  
26B  
26C  
26D  
2E8  
2E9  
2EA  
2EB  
2EC  
2ED  
368  
369  
36A  
36B  
36C  
36D  
3E8  
3E9  
3EA  
3EB  
3EC  
3ED  
PMON FEBE Count (LSB)  
PMON FEBE Count (MSB)  
PMON CRC Count (LSB)  
PMON CRC Count (MSB)  
06E~06F 0EE~0EF 16E~16F 1EE~1EF 26E~26F 2EE~2EF 36E~36F 3EE~3EF Reserved  
070  
071  
072  
PRGD Control  
PRGD Interrupt Enable/Status  
PRGD Shift Register Length  
PRGD Tap  
073  
074  
PRGD Error Insertion  
075 ~ 077  
078  
Reserved  
PRGD Pattern Insertion #1  
PRGD Pattern Insertion #2  
PRGD Pattern Insertion #3  
PRGD Pattern Insertion #4  
PRGD Pattern Detector #1  
PRGD Pattern Detector #2  
PRGD Pattern Detector #3  
PRGD Pattern Detector #4  
079  
07A  
07B  
07C  
07D  
07E  
07F  
122  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Table - 62b. E1 Mode Register Map - Indirect Register  
Address  
Register  
RPLC  
Indirect Registers  
20-3FH  
40-5FH  
61-7FH  
20-3FH  
40-5FH  
Payload control byte for TS0 to TS 31  
Data trunk conditioning code for TS0 to TS31  
Signaling trunk conditioning code for TS1 to TS31  
Payload control byte for TS0 to TS 31  
Idle code for TS0 to TS31  
TPLC  
Indirect Registers  
61-7FH  
01-1FH / 21-3FH  
41-5FH  
Signaling control byte for TS1 to TS31  
Signaling data for TS1 to TS31  
Signaling control for TS1 to TS31  
RCRB  
Indirect Registers  
5.1.2  
T1 / J1 MODE REGISTER MAP  
When the TEMODE (b0, 400H) is logic 1, the T1/J1 mode registers  
are accessed.  
Table - 63a. T1/J1 Mode Register Map - Direct Register  
T1 / J1 Address  
Register  
Framer 1 Framer 2 Framer 3 Framer4 Framer 5 Framer 6 Framer 7 Framer8  
000  
001  
002  
003  
004  
005  
006  
007  
008  
009  
00A  
080  
081  
082  
083  
084  
085  
086  
087  
088  
089  
08A  
100  
101  
102  
103  
104  
105  
106  
107  
108  
109  
10A  
180  
181  
182  
183  
184  
185  
186  
187  
188  
189  
18A  
200  
201  
202  
203  
204  
205  
206  
207  
208  
209  
20A  
280  
281  
282  
283  
284  
285  
286  
287  
288  
289  
28A  
300  
301  
302  
303  
304  
305  
306  
307  
308  
309  
30A  
380  
381  
382  
383  
384  
385  
386  
387  
388  
389  
38A  
Receive Line Options  
Receive Side System Interface Options  
Back-plane Parity configuration/Status  
Receive Interface Configuration  
Transmit Interface Configuration  
Transmit Side System Interface Options  
Transmit Framing and Bypass Options  
Transmit Timing Options  
Interrupt Source #1  
Interrupt Source #2  
Diagnostic  
00B  
00C  
Reserved  
Chip ID/ Global PMON Update  
HDLC Micro Select/Framer Reset  
Framer Interrupt ID  
PRGD Positioning/control  
RJAT Interrupt Status  
RJAT Reference Clock Divisor(N1)  
RJAT Reference Clock Divisor(N2)  
RJATConfiguration  
00D  
08D  
10D  
18D  
20D  
28D  
30D  
38D  
00E  
00F  
010  
011  
012  
013  
014  
015  
090  
091  
092  
093  
094  
095  
110  
111  
112  
113  
114  
115  
190  
191  
192  
193  
194  
195  
210  
211  
212  
213  
214  
215  
29F  
291  
292  
293  
294  
295  
310  
311  
312  
313  
314  
315  
390  
391  
392  
393  
394  
395  
TRSI Timeslot Offset  
TRSI Bit Offset  
016~017 096~097 116~117 196~197 216~217 296~297 316~317 396~397 Reserved  
018  
019  
01A  
01B  
01C  
01D  
098  
099  
09A  
09B  
09C  
09D  
118  
119  
11A  
11B  
11C  
11D  
198  
199  
19A  
19B  
19C  
19D  
218  
219  
21A  
21B  
21C  
21D  
298  
299  
29A  
29B  
29C  
29D  
318  
319  
31A  
31B  
31C  
31D  
398  
399  
39A  
39B  
39C  
39D  
TJAT Interrupt Status  
TJAT Reference Clock Divisor(N1)  
TJAT Reference Clock Divisor(N2)  
TJATConfiguration  
Reserved  
ELSB Interrupt Enable/ Status  
123  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Table - 63a. T1/J1 Mode Register Map - Direct Register (Continued)  
T1 / J1 Address  
Register  
Framer 1 Framer 2 Framer 3 Framer4 Framer 5 Framer 6 Framer 7 Framer8  
01E  
01F  
020  
021  
022  
09E  
09F  
0A0  
0A1  
0A2  
11E  
11F  
120  
121  
122  
19E  
19F  
1A0  
1A1  
1A2  
21E  
21F  
220  
221  
222  
29E  
29F  
2A0  
2A1  
2A2  
31E  
31F  
320  
321  
322  
39E  
39F  
3A0  
3A1  
3A2  
ELSB Idle Code  
Reserved  
T1 FRMP Configuration  
T1 FRMP interrupt enable  
T1 FRMP interrupt status  
023~026 0A3~0A6 123~126 1A3~1A6 223~226 2A3~2A6 323~326 3A3~3A6 Reserved  
027 0A7 127 1A7 227 2A7 327 3A7 Clock Monitor  
028~029 0A8~0A9 128~129 1A8~1A9 228~229 2A8~2A9 328~329 3A8~3A9 Reserved  
02A  
02B  
02C  
02D  
02E  
02F  
030  
031  
032  
033  
034  
035  
036  
037  
038  
039  
0AA  
0AB  
0AC  
0AD  
0AE  
0AF  
0B0  
0B1  
0B2  
0B3  
0B4  
0B5  
0B6  
0B7  
0B8  
0B9  
12A  
12B  
12C  
12D  
121  
12F  
130  
131  
132  
133  
134  
135  
136  
137  
138  
139  
1AA  
1AB  
1AC  
1AD  
1A1  
1AF  
1B0  
1B1  
1B2  
1B3  
1B4  
1B5  
1B6  
1B7  
1B8  
1B9  
22A  
22B  
22C  
22D  
221  
22F  
230  
231  
232  
233  
234  
235  
236  
237  
238  
239  
2AA  
2AB  
2AC  
2AD  
2A1  
2AF  
2B0  
2B1  
2B2  
2B3  
2B4  
2B5  
2B6  
2B7  
2B8  
2B9  
32A  
32B  
32C  
32D  
321  
32F  
330  
331  
332  
333  
334  
335  
336  
337  
338  
339  
3AA  
3AB  
3AC  
3AD  
3A1  
3AF  
3B0  
3B1  
3B2  
3B3  
3B4  
3B5  
3B6  
3B7  
3B8  
3B9  
RBOM Configuration  
RBOM Code Status  
ALMD Configuration  
ALMDInterruptEnable  
ALMD Interrupt Status  
ALMD Alarm Detection Status  
TPLCConfiguration  
TPLC mP Access Status  
TPLC Channel indirect Address/Control  
TPLC Channel Indirect Data Buffer  
THDLC #1, 2, 3 Configuration  
THDLC #1, 2, 3 Upper Transmit Threshold  
THDLC #1, 2, 3 Lower Transmit Threshold  
THDLC #1, 2, 3 Interrupt Enable  
THDLC #1, 2, 3 interrupt Status  
THDLC #1, 2, 3 Transmit Data  
03A~03B0BA~0BB 13A~13B 1BA~1BB 23A~23B 2BA~2BB 33A~33B 3BA~3BB Reserved  
03C  
03D  
03E  
03F  
040  
0BC  
0BD  
0BE  
0BF  
0C0  
13C  
13D  
13E  
13F  
140  
1BC  
1BD  
1BE  
1BF  
1C0  
23C  
23D  
23E  
23F  
240  
2BC  
2BD  
2BE  
2BF  
2C0  
33C  
33D  
33E  
33F  
340  
3BC  
3BD  
3BE  
3BF  
3C0  
IBCD Configuration  
IBCD Interrupt Enable/Status  
IBCD Active Code  
IBCD Deactivate Code  
RCRB Configuration (COSS=0) /  
RCRB COSS[30:25] (COSS=1)  
RCRB mP Access Status (COSS=0) /  
RCRB COSS[24:17] (COSS=1)  
RCRB CH IND Addr/Control (COSS=0) /  
RCRB COSS[16:9] (COSS=1)  
RCRB CH Indirect Data Buffer (COSS=0) /  
RCRB COSS[8:1] (COSS=1)  
FRMG Configuration  
FRMG Alarm Transmit  
IBCG Configuration  
IBCG Loop-back Code  
Reserved  
041  
042  
043  
0C1  
0C2  
0C3  
141  
142  
143  
1C1  
1C2  
1C3  
241  
242  
243  
2C1  
2C2  
2C3  
341  
342  
343  
3C1  
3C2  
3C3  
044  
045  
046  
047  
048  
049  
04A  
04B  
04C  
04D  
0C4  
0C5  
0C6  
0C7  
0C8  
0C9  
0CA  
0CB  
0CC  
0CD  
144  
145  
146  
147  
148  
149  
14A  
14B  
14C  
14D  
1C4  
1C5  
1C6  
1C7  
1C8  
1C9  
1CA  
1CB  
1CC  
1CD  
244  
245  
246  
247  
248  
249  
24A  
24B  
24C  
24D  
2C4  
2C5  
2C6  
2C7  
2C8  
2C9  
2CA  
2CB  
2CC  
2CD  
344  
345  
346  
347  
348  
349  
34A  
34B  
34C  
34D  
3C4  
3C5  
3C6  
3C7  
3C8  
3C9  
3CA  
3CB  
3CC  
3CD  
PMON Interrupt Enable/Status  
PMON BEE Count (LSB)  
PMON BEE Count (MSB)  
PMON FER Count (LSB)  
PMON FER Count (MSB)  
124  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Table - 63a. T1/J1 Mode Register Map - Direct Register (Continued)  
T1 / J1 Address  
Register  
Framer 1 Framer 2 Framer 3 Framer4 Framer 5 Framer 6 Framer 7 Framer8  
04E  
04F  
050  
051  
052  
053  
054  
055  
056  
057  
058  
059  
0CE  
0CF  
0D0  
0D1  
0D2  
0D3  
0D4  
0D5  
0D6  
0D7  
0D8  
0D9  
14E  
14F  
150  
151  
152  
153  
154  
155  
156  
157  
158  
159  
1CE  
1CF  
1D0  
1D1  
1D2  
1D3  
1D4  
1D5  
1D6  
1D7  
1D8  
1D9  
24E  
24F  
250  
251  
252  
253  
254  
255  
256  
257  
258  
259  
2CE  
2CF  
2D0  
2D1  
2D2  
2D3  
2D4  
2D5  
2D6  
2D7  
2D8  
2D9  
34E  
34F  
350  
351  
352  
353  
354  
355  
356  
357  
358  
359  
3CE  
3CF  
3D0  
3D1  
3D2  
3D3  
3D4  
3D5  
3D6  
3D7  
3D8  
3D9  
PMON OOF Count  
PMON COFA Count  
RPLC Configuration  
RPLC mP Access Status  
RPLC Channel indirect Address/Control  
RPLC Channel Indirect Data Buffer  
RHDLC #1, 2, 3 Configuration  
RHDLC #1, 2, 3 Interrupt Control  
RHDLC #1, 2, 3 Status  
RHDLC #1, 2, 3 Data  
RHDLC #1, 2, 3 Primary Address Match  
RHDLC #1, 2, 3 Secondary Address Match  
05A~05C 0DA~0DC 15A~15C 1DA~1DC 25A~25C 2DA~2DC 35A~35C 3DA~3DC Reserved  
05D 0DD 15D 1DD 25D 2DD 35D 3DD TBOM Code  
05E~05F 0DE~0DF 15E~15F 1DE~1DF 25E~25F 2DE~2DF 35E~35F 3DE~3DF Reserved  
060  
061  
062  
PRGD Control  
PRGD Interrupt Enable/Status  
PRGD Shift Register Length  
PRGD Tap  
063  
064  
PRGD Error Insertion  
065 ~ 067  
068  
Reserved  
PRGD Pattern Insertion #1  
PRGD Pattern Insertion #2  
PRGD Pattern Insertion #3  
PRGD Pattern Insertion #4  
PRGD Pattern Detector #1  
PRGD Pattern Detector #2  
PRGD Pattern Detector #3  
PRGD Pattern Detector #4  
RHDLC 2(TXCISEL=0) Link Control /  
THDLC 2(TXCISEL=1) Link Control  
RHDLC 2(TXCISEL=0) bits select /  
THDLC 2(TXCISEL=1) bits select  
069  
06A  
06B  
06C  
06D  
06E  
06F  
070  
071  
0F0  
0F1  
170  
171  
1F0  
1F1  
270  
271  
2F0  
2F1  
370  
371  
3F0  
3F1  
072~076 0F2~0F6 172~176 1F2~1F6 272~276 2F2~0F6 372~376 3F2~3F6 Reserved  
077  
078  
0F7  
0F8  
177  
178  
1F7  
1F8  
277  
278  
2F7  
2F8  
377  
378  
3F7  
3F8  
RESI Timeslot Offset  
RESI Bit Offset  
Table - 63b. T1/J1 Mode Register Map - Indirect Register  
Address  
Register  
RPLC  
Indirect Register  
01-18H  
19-30H  
31-48H  
01-18H  
19-30H  
Payload control byte for CH1 to CH24  
Data trunk conditioning code for CH1 to CH24  
Signaling trunk conditioning code for CH1 to CH24  
Payload control byte for CH1 to CH24  
Idle code for CH1 to CH24  
TPLC  
Indirect Register  
31-48H  
01-18H / 21-38H  
41-58H  
Signaling control byte for CH1 to CH24  
Signaling data for CH1 to CH24  
Signaling control for CH1 to CH24  
RCRB  
Indirect Register  
125  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
5.2 REGISTER DESCRIPTION  
E1 Or T1 / J1 Mode Selection (400H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TEMODE  
R/W  
Reserved  
Default  
1
TEMODE:  
This bit selects the operation mode globally for the chip.  
= 0: The chip operates in the E1 mode.  
= 1: The chip operates in the T1/J1 mode.  
5.2.1  
E1 MODE  
E1 Receive Path Line Options(000H, 080H, 100H, 180H, 200H, 280H, 300H, 380H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
FIFOBYP  
R/W  
6
5
WORDERR  
R/W  
4
3
2
1
0
UNF  
R/W  
0
CNTNFAS AUTOYELLOW AUTORED  
AUTOOOF AUTOUPDATE  
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
Default  
0
0
FIFOBYP:  
This bit decides whether the received data should pass through or bypass the Receive Jitter Attenuation FIFO.  
= 0: The received data pass through the RJAT FIFO.  
= 1: The RJAT FIFO is bypassed. The delay is reduced by typically 24 bits.  
UNF:  
= 0: The Frame Processor operates normally.  
= 1: Frame searching is disabled, the Receive CAS/RBS Buffer holds its signaling frozen, and Auto_OOF function, if enabled, will consider OOF  
to be declared.  
WORDERR, CNTNFAS:  
WORDERR  
CNTNFAS  
Framing Bit Error  
0
1
0
0
0
1
Each bit error in a 7-bit FAS pattern is counted as a single framing bit error.  
One or more than one bit errors in a 7-bit FAS pattern is counted as a single framing bit error.  
Each bit error in a 7-bit FAS pattern is counted as a single framing bit error, and  
a logic 0 in the second bit of TS0 of NFAS is counted as a single bit error too.  
An 8-bit Error Word is consisted of a 7-bit FAS pattern and the second bit of timeslot 0 in the next NFAS  
frame. One or more than one bit errors in this 8-bit Error Word is counted as a single framing bit error.  
1
1
AUTOYELLOW:  
This bit decides whether to send Yellow Alarm signal automatically.  
= 0: The automatic Yellow Alarm Transmission is disabled. It means that the RAI bit, the 3rd bit of NFAS frame, can only be transmitted when the  
REMAIS (b3, E1-041H) is set to 1.  
= 1: The automatic Yellow Alarm Transmission is enabled. It means that the RAI bit (the 3rd bit of NFAS frame) in the transmit data stream will be  
set to 1 automatically during loss of frame alignment or receiving AIS. The G706RAI (b0, E1-00EH) is used to select the conditions, under which the  
Yellow Alarm signal will be transmitted automatically.  
AUTORED:  
This bit decides whether to start trunk conditioning (replacing data on RSDn with the data stored in the data trunk conditioning registers in RPLC)  
automatically when Red Alarm is declared.  
= 0: The trunk conditioning is not activated automatically when RED (b3, E1-037 H) becomes 1.  
= 1: The trunk conditioning will be initiated automatically when the RED (b3, E1-037H) becomes 1.  
126  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
AUTOOOF:  
This bit decides whether to start trunk conditioning (replacing data on RSDn with the data stored in the data trunk conditioning registers in RPLC)  
automatically in the duration of loss of basic frame.  
= 0: The trunk conditioning is not activated automatically when the OOFV (b6, E1-036 H) becomes 1.  
= 1: The trunk conditioning will be activated automatically when the OOFV (b6, E1-036 H) becomes 1.  
AUTOUPDATE:  
This bit decides whether the PMON and PRGD registers are automatically updated once every second.  
= 0: The PMON and PRGD registers are not automatically updated. They can only be updated by MCU operation.  
= 1: The PMON and PRGD registers will be automatically updated once every second.  
E1 Receive Side System Interface Options (001H, 081H, 101H, 181H, 201H, 281H, 301H, 381H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
LRCKFALL  
R/W  
6
RSSIG_EN  
R/W  
5
RSCKSEL  
R/W  
4
MRBS  
R/W  
0
3
MRBC  
R/W  
0
2
OOSMFAIS  
R/W  
1
TRKEN  
R/W  
0
0
RXMTKC  
R/W  
Default  
0
1
0
0
0
LRCKFALL:  
This bit selects the active edge of LRCKn to sample the data on the corresponding LRDn.  
= 0: the rising edge is selected.  
= 1: the falling edge is selected.  
RSSIG_EN:  
When Receive Clock Slave Mode is enabled (RSCKSLV = 1, b5, E1-010H), this bit configures the receive side system interface.  
= 0: the Receive Clock Slave RSCK Reference Mode is selected. The RSCKn/RSSIGn pin will be used as RSCKn to output a 2.048 MHz jitter  
attenuated version of LRCKn or an 8KHz clock.  
= 1: the Receive Clock Slave External Signaling mode is selected. The RSCKn/RSSIGn pin is used as RSSIGn to output the extracted signaling  
data. Each time-slot’s signaling bits are timeslot aligned with the RSDn data stream and located in lower nibble (b5b6b7b8).  
RSCKSEL:  
When Receive Clock Slave RSCK Reference Mode is selected, this bit selects the frequency of the RSCKn.  
= 0: the RSCKn outputs an 8 KHz timing reference that is generated by dividing the jitter attenuated version of LRCKn.  
= 1: the RSCKn outputs a jitter attenuated version of the 2.048 MHz Line Receive Clock (LRCKn).  
MRBS:  
In Receive Multiplexed mode, this bit decides which bus the corresponding framer will use to output the received data.  
= 0: The first multiplexed bus (MRSD[1], MRSFS[1], MRSSIG[1]) is selected.  
= 1: The second multiplexed bus (MRSD[2], MRSFS[2], MRSSIG[2]) is selected.  
MRBC:  
This bit turns on or off the transmission of received data from the corresponding framer to the selected multiplexed receive bus. Users should  
complete the setting in the MRBS (b4, E1-001H) before enabling this bit.  
= 0: The corresponding framer will not output its data stream on the multiplexed bus.  
= 1: The corresponding framer will output its data stream on the multiplexed bus.  
OOSMFAIS:  
This bit decides whether to send Alarm Indication Signals (All Ones Signals) on RSSIGn to the system side in the condition of out of signaling  
multi-frame. This bit affects the corresponding timeslot of the MRSSIGn data stream if the multiplexed bus is enabled.  
= 0: The output on RSSIGn/MRSSIG pin will not be affected by the indication of out of Signaling Multi-Frame.  
= 1: The output on RSSIGn/MRSSIG pin will be set to all “1” in the condition of out of Signaling Multi-Frame.  
127  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
TRKEN:  
This bit decides whether to substitute the data on RSDn with the contents in the ELSB Idle Code Register during out of Basic frame. After  
substitution, the ELSB Idle Code can still be overwritten by the contents in RPLC Data Trunk Conditioning Registers and Signaling Trunk  
Conditioning Registers on per timeslot basis. This bit only has effect in Receive Clock Slave mode, and it affects the corresponding timeslot of  
multiplexed bus MRSD when multiplexed bus operation is enabled.  
= 0: ELSB Idle Code Substitution is disabled.  
= 1: Data in all timeslots on the RSDn will be replaced by the contents in ELSB Idle Code Register during out of Basic frame.  
RXMTKC:  
This bit decides how to substitute the received data stream on RSDn and RSSIGn with the contents in the RPLC Data Trunk Conditioning  
Registers and the RPLC Signaling Trunk Conditioning Registers. This bit affects the corresponding timeslot of the MRSD and MRSSIG if the  
multiplexed backplane is enabled.  
= 0: The data and signaling are substituted on a per-timeslot basis in accordance with the control bits contained in the per-timeslot Payload  
Control Byte registers in the RPLC.  
= 1: the data on RSDn of all timeslots are replaced with the data contained in the Data Trunk Conditioning registers in RPLC, and the data on  
RSSIGn of all timeslots are replaced with the data contained in the Signaling Trunk Conditioning registers. To enable this function, the PCCE (b0, E1-  
05CH) of the RPLC must be set to logic 1.  
E1 Transmit Path Configuration(002H, 082H, 102H, 182H, 202H, 282H, 302H, 382H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
FIFOBYP  
R/W  
6
TAISEN  
R/W  
0
5
4
PATHCRC  
R/W  
3
2
TSFSRISE  
R/W  
1
0
LTCKRISE  
R/W  
Reserved  
Reserved  
Reserved  
Default  
0
0
0
0
FIFOBYP:  
This bit decides whether the transmit data should pass through or bypass the Transmit Jitter Attenuation FIFO.  
= 0: The transmit data pass through the TJAT FIFO.  
= 1: The TJAT FIFO is bypassed. The delay is reduced by typically 24 bits.  
TAISEN:  
This bit enables the line interface to generate an un-framed all-ones Alarm Indication Signal on the LTDn pin.  
= 0: normal operation.  
= 1: LTDn transmits all ones.  
PATHCRC:  
This bit allows upstream bit errors to be transmitted to the downstream transparently. When the data stream on TSDn is already in the CRC Multi-  
Frame format, and the IDT82V2108 is going to change some bits in the data stream, this bit decides whether to replace the original CRC-4 bits with  
re-calculated CRC-4 bits or just modify the original CRC-4 bits according to the contribution caused by changing bits in the data stream. This bit only  
takes effect when the FPTYP (b1, E1-019H) is set to 1 and one of the INDIS (b1, E1-040H) or FDIS (b3, E1-045H) is set to 1.  
= 0: A new re-calculated CRC-4 value will overwrite the incoming CRC-4 word. As the new CRC-4 value is transmitted to downstream, the bit  
errors in upstream can not be detected by the downstream.  
= 1: The incoming CRC-4 value is modified to just reflect the bit changes made by IDT82V2108. If there is any bit error in the upstream, it will be  
transmitted to the downstream transparently, and the downstream machine can detect it.  
TSFSRISE:  
This bit selects the active edge of TSCCKB to update the Transmit Frame Pulse on TSFSn pin.  
= 0: the signal on TSFSn is updated on the falling edge of TSCCKB.  
= 1: the signal on TSFSn is updated on the rising edge of TSCCKB.  
LTCKRISE:  
This bit selects the active edge of LTCKn to update the data on LTDn.  
= 0: the data on LTDn pin is updated on the falling edge of LTCKn.  
= 1: the data on LTDn pin is updated on the rising edge of LTCKn.  
128  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 Transmit Side System Interface Options(003H, 083H, 103H, 183H, 203H, 283H, 303H, 383H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
TSSIG_EN  
R/W  
5
4
MTBS  
R/W  
0
3
2
1
0
Reserved  
Reserved  
Reserved  
Default  
1
TSSIG_EN:  
In Transmit Clock Slave mode (TSCKSLV=1, b5, E1-018H), this bit configures the transmit side system interface.  
= 0: the Transmit Clock Slave TSFS Enable mode is selected. The TSFSn/TSSIGn pin is used as TSFSn output.  
= 1: the Transmit Clock Slave External Signaling mode is selected. The TSFSn/TSSIGn pin is used as TSSIGn input.  
In Transmit Multiplexed mode, this bit must be set to 1.  
MTBS:  
In Transmit Multiplexed mode, this bit selects which multiplexed bus will interface with the corresponding framer.  
= 0: The incoming data is taken from the first multiplexed bus (MTSD1, MTSSIG1).  
= 1: The incoming data is taken from the second multiplexed bus (MTSD2, MTSSIG2).  
E1 Transmit Timing Options(004H, 084H, 104H, 184H, 204H, 284H, 304H, 384H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TJATREF_SEL[2] TJATREF_SEL[1] TJATREF_SEL[0] LTCK_SEL[2] LTCK_SEL[1] LTCK_SEL[0]  
Reserved  
R/W  
1
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
1
R/W  
0
R/W  
1
Default  
TJATREF_SEL[2:0] - Transmit Jitter Attenuation DPLL Input Reference Clock Selection  
The TJATREF_SEL[2:0] select the input reference clock for the TJAT DPLL.  
TJATREF_SEL[2:0]  
Input Reference Clock  
TSCCKA / 8  
TSCCKB  
000  
001  
010  
LRCK  
011  
TSCCKA  
100  
XCK / 24  
Others  
TSCCKB  
LTCK_SEL[2:0] - LineTransmit Clock (LTCKn) Selection  
LTCK_SEL[2:0]  
Line Transmit Clock  
TSCCKA / 8  
TSCCKB  
000  
001  
010  
LRCK  
011  
TSCCKA  
100  
XCK / 24  
Others  
A smoothed clock output from the TJAT DPLL  
129  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 Interrupt Source #1(005H, 085H, 105H, 185H, 205H, 285H, 305H, 385H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
PMON  
R
6
FRMG  
R
5
FRMP  
R
4
PRGD  
R
3
ELSB  
R
2
1
0
RHDLC#1  
RHDLC#2  
RHDLC#3  
R
X
R
X
R
X
Default  
X
X
X
X
X
Bits in this register indicate which function block caused an interrupt signal on INT pin. Reading this register does not remove the interrupt  
indication. To remove the interrupt indication on the INT pin, the corresponding interrupt status register must be read.  
E1 Interrupt Source #2(006H, 086H, 106H, 186H, 206H, 286H, 306H, 386H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
TRSI  
R
6
5
TJAT  
R
4
RJAT  
R
3
2
1
0
RCRB  
R
THDLC#1  
THDLC#2  
THDLC#3  
Reserved  
R
X
R
X
R
X
Default  
X
X
X
X
Bits in this register indicate which function block caused an interrupt signal on INT pin. Reading this register does not remove the interrupt  
indication. To remove the interrupt indication on the INT pin, the corresponding interrupt status register must be read.  
E1 Diagnostics (007H, 087H, 107H, 187H, 207H, 287H, 307H, 387H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
LINELB  
R/W  
0
3
V52DIS  
R/W  
0
2
DDLB  
R/W  
0
1
RAIS  
R/W  
0
0
TXDIS  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Default  
LINELB:  
Line Loop back means that the transmit line interface data and clock (LTDn and LTCKn) are internal directly comes from the received line data  
and clock (LRDn and LRCKn). The loop back data stream can pass through the Receive Jitter Attenuator or bypass the Receive Jitter Attenuator (if  
the Receive Jitter Attenuator is configured to be bypassed)  
= 0: Line loop back is disabled.  
= 1: Line loop back is enabled.  
V52DIS:  
= 0: All HDLC controllers of the corresponding framer are available to use.  
= 1: Only the first HDLC controller in receive direction (RHDLC#1) and transmit direction (THDLC#1) are available to use, the remaining HDLC  
controllers are disabled.  
Note that this bit can not be reset by software reset. It can only reset by hardware reset.  
DDLB:  
Digital Loop back means that the received line data and clock (LRDn and LRCKn) are internal directly comes from the transmit line data and clock  
(LTDn and LTCKn) without the Receive Jitter Attenuator.  
= 0: Digital loop back is disabled.  
= 1: Digital loop back is enabled  
RAIS:  
= 0: normal operation.  
= 1: force the data output on RSDn to be all ones, and freeze the signal on RSSIGn at the current valid signaling in Receive Clock Slave External  
Signaling mode. In Receive Multiplexed mode, the data of the corresponding framer output on MRSD is forced to be all ones, and the signal of the  
corresponding framer output on MRSSIG is frozen at the current valid signaling.  
TXDIS:  
= 0: normal transmission.  
= 1: force the data to be transmitted on the TLDn pin to be all zeros.  
130  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 Revision / Chip ID / Global PMON Update(009H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
ID[4]  
R
3
ID[3]  
R
2
ID[2]  
R
1
ID[1]  
R
0
ID[0]  
R
TYPE[2]  
TYPE[1]  
TYPE[0]  
R
0
R
0
R
0
Default  
0
0
0
0
1
Writing to this register causes all Performance Monitor and PRGD Generator/Detector counters to be updated simultaneously.  
TYPE[2:0]:  
TYPE[2:0] are fixed to 000, representing the IDT82V2108 chip.  
ID[4:0]:  
ID[4:0] are fixed to 00011, representing the current version number of the IDT82V2108.  
E1 Data Link Micro Select / Framer Reset(00AH, 08AH, 10AH, 18AH, 20AH, 28AH, 30AH, 38AH)  
Bit No.  
7
6
5
4
3
TXCISEL  
R/W  
2
1
0
RESET  
R/W  
0
BitName RHDLCSEL[1] RHDLCSEL[0] THDLCSEL[1] THDLCSEL[0]  
Type  
Default  
R/W  
X
R/W  
X
R/W  
X
R/W  
X
Reserved  
X
RHDLCSEL[1:0]:  
The RHDLCSEL[1:0] select one of the three HDLC Receivers to be accessed by the microprocessor. At one time, the microprocessor can only  
access one HDLC controller. These bits must be set before using the HDLC controller.  
RHDLCSEL[1:0]  
the HDLC Receiver  
RHDLC #1  
00  
01  
10  
11  
RHDLC #2  
RHDLC #3  
Reserved  
THDLCSEL[1:0]:  
The THDLCSEL[1:0] select one of the three HDLC Transmitters to be accessed by the microprocessor. At one time, the microprocessor can only  
access one HDLC controller. These bits must be set before using the HDLC controller.  
THDLCSEL[1:0]  
the HDLC Transmitter  
THDLC #1  
00  
01  
10  
11  
THDLC #2  
THDLC #3  
Reserved  
TXCISEL:  
The registers addressed from E1-028H to E1-02DH are shared by the HDLC Receiver and HDLC Transmitter to decide the position of the  
extracted bit in the received data stream and the inserted bit in the transmitting data stream respectively. So this bit is used to decide whether the  
Read/Write operation on the registers addressed from E1-028H to E1-02DH is for the HDLC receiver or for the HDLC transmitter.  
= 0: the Read/Write operation on registers addressed from 028 H to 02D H is for HDLC receiver.  
= 1: the Read/Write operation on registers addressed from 028H to 02D H is for the HDLC transmitter.  
RESET:  
This bit implements a software reset for individual framer.  
= 0: normal operation.  
= 1: The corresponding framer is held in reset. However, this bit, the bits in this register and the V52DIS (b3, E1-007H) can not be reset. Therefor,  
a logic 0 must be written to bring the framer out of reset. Holding the framer in a reset state effectively puts it into a low power standby mode. A  
hardware reset clears the RESET bit, the bits in this register and the V52DIS (b3, E1-007H).  
131  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 Interrupt ID(00BH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
INT[8]  
R
6
INT[7]  
R
5
INT[6]  
R
4
INT[5]  
R
3
INT[4]  
R
2
INT[3]  
R
1
INT[2]  
R
0
INT[1]  
R
Default  
X
X
X
X
X
0
0
0
This register indicates which one of the eight framers caused the interrupt INT pin to be logic low. When any one of the eight framers caused the  
interrupt, the corresponding bit in the INT[8:1] will be high.  
E1 Pattern Generator / Detector Positioning / Control (00CH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
RXPATGEN  
R/W  
1
UNF_GEN  
R/W  
0
UNF_DET  
R/W  
PRGDSEL[2] PRGDSEL[1] PRGDSEL[0]  
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Default  
0
0
0
The IDT82V2108 has only one PRBS Generator/Detector (PRGD) shared by all the eight framers. At one time, only one framer can use this  
PRGD. This register selects which framer will use the PRGD and how the PRGD will be used.  
PRGDSEL[2:0]:  
PRGDSEL[2:0] select one of the eight framers to be tested by the PRGD block.  
PRGDSEL[2:0]  
Selected Framer  
Framer 1  
Framer 2  
Framer 3  
Framer 4  
Framer 5  
Framer 6  
Framer 7  
Framer 8  
000  
001  
010  
011  
100  
101  
110  
111  
RXPATGEN:  
= 0: the pattern in PRGD is generated in the transmit path and is detected in the receive path.  
= 1: the pattern in PRGD is generated in the receive path and is detected in the transmit path.  
UNF_GEN:  
= 0: which timeslots of the selected path will be replaced by the PRGD pattern is specified in TPLC or RPLC.  
= 1: all the 32 timeslots of the selected path will be replaced by the PRGD pattern.  
UNF_DET:  
= 0: which timeslots of the selected path will be detected by PRGD pattern is specified in TPLC or RPLC.  
= 1: all the 32 timeslots of the selected path will be detected by PRGD pattern.  
132  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 Clock Monitor (00DH, 08DH, 10DH, 18DH, 20DH, 28DH, 30DH, 38DH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
XCK  
R
3
2
1
0
LRCK  
R
TSCCKB  
TSCCKA  
RSCCK  
Reserved  
R
X
R
X
R
X
Default  
X
X
This register provides activity monitoring on the IDT82V2108 clocks. When a monitored clock signal makes a low to high transition, the  
corresponding bit in this register is set to 1, and this bit remains to be 1 until this register is read. After a read operation on this register, all the bits in  
this register will be cleared to 0. A lack of transitions of the monitored clock will be indicated by 0 in the corresponding bit, which means that the  
clock fails. This register should be read periodically to detect clock failures.  
XCK:  
= 0: after the bit is read.  
= 1: a low to high transition occurs on the XCK.  
TSCCKB:  
= 0: after the bit is read.  
= 1: a low to high transition occurs on the TSCCKB.  
TSCCKA:  
= 0: after the bit is read.  
= 1: a low to high transition occurs on the TSCCKA.  
RSCCK:  
= 0: after the bit is read.  
= 1: a low to high transition occurs on the RSCCK.  
LRCK:  
= 0: after the bit is read.  
= 1: a low to high transition occurs on the LRCK.  
E1 Receive Path Frame Pulse Configuration(00EH, 08EH, 10EH, 18EH, 20EH, 28EH, 30EH, 38EH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
G706RAI  
R/W  
PERTS_RSFS REF_MRSFS OOCMFE0  
Reserved  
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
Default  
0
PERTS_RSFS, REF_MRSFS:  
PERTS_RSFS  
REF_MRSFS  
the Pulse on the RSFSn/MRSFS  
0
1
0
0
The pulse output on the RSFS/MRSFS pin is forced to be logic 0.  
The signal on the RSFS/MRSFS pin is determined by the ROHM,  
BRXSMFP, BRCMFP and ALTIFP (b3b2b1b0, E1-011 H).  
X
1
RSFSn/MRSFS contains a reference frame pulse identical to the receive  
system side common frame pulse on the RSCFS/MRSCFS pin.  
In Receive Multiplexed mode, these two bits in the eight framers should be set in the same value.  
OOCMFE0:  
This bit selects one of two operation modes concerning the transmission of E-bits when the framer is out of CRC-4 multiframe.  
= 0: transmit ones for the E-bits while out of CRC-4 Multi-Frame.  
= 1: transmit zeros for the E-bits while out of CRC-4 Multi-Frame. (This setting is compliant with the CRC-4 to non-CRC-4 interworking procedure  
in Annex B of G.706)  
133  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
G706RAI:  
When the AUTOYELLOW (b3, E1-00H) is set as 1, which means the RAI bit will be transmitted automatically in certain conditions, this bit selects  
one of two criteria defining the conditions. If the AUTOYELLOW (b3, E1-00H) is 0, G706RAI does not have any effect.  
= 0: The RAI bit will be transmitted when out of Basic Frame, when AISD is declared, when CRC-4 to non-CRC-4 interworking is declared or  
when the off-line searching indicates out of Basic frame. This definition follows the ETSI standards.  
= 1: The RAI bit will be transmitted when out of Basic frame or when AISD is declared, but not when CRC-4 to non-CRC-4 interworking is  
declared nor when offline out-of frame is declared. This definition follows the Annex B of G.706.  
E1 Receive Backplane Configuration(010H, 090H, 110H, 190H, 210H, 290H, 310H, 390H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
FRACTN[1]  
R/W  
6
FRACTN[0]  
R/W  
5
RSCKSLV  
R/W  
4
DE  
R/W  
1
3
FE  
R/W  
1
2
1
RATE[1]  
R/W  
0
0
RATE[0]  
R/W  
0
CMS  
R/W  
0
Default  
0
0
1
FRACTN[1:0]:  
When Receive Clock Master mode is selected, (RSCKSLV=0, b5, E1-010H), these two bits selects one of the operation modes shown in the  
following table. The two bits will be ignored if the Receive Clock Slave mode is selected. (RSCKSLV=1, b5, E1-010H).  
FRACTN[1:0]  
Operation Mode  
Receive Clock Master Full E1 mode  
Reserved  
0 0  
0 1  
1 0  
1 1  
Receive Clock Master Fractional E1 mode  
Receive Clock Master Fractional E1 with F-bit mode  
“Full E1” mode means that the received entire frame (256 bits) is clocked out from RSDn pin, and there are no gaps in the RSCKn clock pulse.  
“Fractional E1” mode means that the RSCKn only clocks out on the selected time slots, and RSCKn does not pulse during those un-selected time  
slots. The time slots selection is decided by DTRKC/NxTS (b6, E1-RPLC-Indirect Register-20-3F H).  
“Fractional E1 with F-bit” mode is to support ITU recommendation G.802 where 1.544 Mbit/s data is carried within a 2.048 Mbit/s data stream. In  
this configuration, bits from the second bit of TS 26 to the last bit of the Basic Frame are suppressed, and the remaining bits can be selectively  
gapped by the DTRKC/NxTS (b6, E1-RPLC-Indirect Register-20-3F H).  
RSCKSLV:  
= 0: Receive Clock Master mode is selected.  
= 1: Received Clock Slave mode is selected.  
RSCKSLV must be set to 1 to support multiplexed backplane.  
DE:  
= 0: the signal on the RSDn and RSSIGn pins are updated on the falling edge of the RSCCK or the RSCK.  
= 1: the signal on the RSDn and RSSIG pins are updated on the rising edge of the RSCCK or the RSCK.  
In Receive Multiplexed mode, the DE in all eight framers should be set at the same value.  
FE:  
If FE is not equal to DE, the frame pulse will be sampled or updated one clock edge after the corresponding data pulse.  
= 0: the signal on the RSCFS pin is sampled or the signal on the RSFSn pin is updated on the falling edge of the RSCCK or the RSCKn.  
= 1: the signal on the RSCFS pin is sampled or the signal on the RSFSn pin is updated on the rising edge of the RSCCK or the RSCKn.  
In Receive Multiplexed mode, the FE in all eight framers should be set at the same value.  
CMS:  
= 0: the clock frequency of RSCCK/MRSCCK is the same as the bit rate of the backplane.  
= 1: the clock frequency of RSCCK/MRSCCK is the double of the bit rate of the backplane.  
The CMS of all eight framers should be set at the same value.  
134  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
RATE[1:0]:  
These bits determine the bit rate of the received data stream on the backplane. Note that to operate in the Receive Multiplexed mode, the  
RATE[1:0] in all eight framers should be configured to select the 8.192 Mbit/s backplane bit rate. When the RATE[1:0] selects the 8.192 Mbit/s, the  
RSCKSLV (b5, E1-010H) must be set to 1.  
RATE[1:0]  
0 0  
Backplane Rate  
Reserved  
0 1  
1 0  
2.048M bit/s  
Reserved  
1 1  
8.192M bit/s  
E1 Receive Backplane Frame Pulse Configuration(011H, 091H, 111H, 191H, 211H, 291H, 311H, 391H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
FPINV  
R/W  
0
5
FPMODE  
R/W  
4
3
ROHM  
R/W  
0
2
BRXSMFP  
R/W  
1
BRXCMFP  
R/W  
0
ALTIFP  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Reserved  
Default  
1
0
0
FPINV:  
= 0: The framing pulse RSCFS and RSFSn/MRSFS are active high.  
= 1: The framing pulse RSCFS and RSFSn/MRSFS are active low.  
When this bit is used to indicate the active pulse for RSCFS or MRSFS, then it should be set to the same value for all eight framers.  
FPMODE:  
This bit decides whether to use RSCFS as the framing pulse or not. In Receive Clock Master mode (RSCKSLV=0, b5, E1-010H), the FPMODE  
must be 0.  
= 0: RSCFS/MRSCFS is unused.  
= 1: RSCFS/MRSCFS is used.  
In Receive Multiplexed mode, the FPMODE in all eight framers should be set to the same value.  
ROHM:  
When the PERTS_RSFS and the REF_MRSFS (b3~2, E1-00EH) are 1 and 0 respectively, this bit decides whether to use RSFSn pin to indicate  
TS0 and TS16. Details are tabulated in the following table.  
BRXSMFP, BRXCMFP:  
When the PERTS_RSFS and the REF_MRSFS (b3~2, E1-00EH) are 1 and 0 respectively, these two bits, together with the ALTIFP bit, select the  
output signal seen on the RSFSn pin. Details are tabulated in the following table.  
ALTIFP:  
When the RSFSn pin is configured to output the framing pulse for Basic Frame, Signaling Multiframe or CRC Multiframe, this bit permits  
suppression of every other framing pulse. The following table shows the details for the different configurations of RSFSn pin.  
135  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
ROHM BRXSMFP BRXCMFP ALTIFP  
RSFSn / MRSFS Indication  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
The RSFSn asserts for 1 bit cycle on the first bit of each Basic Frame output on the RSDn.  
The RSFSn asserts for 1 bit cycle on the first bit of every second Basic Frame output on the  
RSDn.  
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
X
1
1
0
0
1
1
X
0
1
0
1
0
1
X
The RSFSn asserts for 1 bit cycle on the first bit of the first frame of each CRC Multi-Frame  
output on the RSDn (in case CRC Multi-Frame is disabled, the RSFSn asserts every 16  
frames).  
The RSFSn asserts for 1 bit cycle on the first bit of the first frame of every second CRC Multi-  
Frame output on the RSDn (in case CRC Multi-Frame is disabled, the RSFSn asserts every  
32 frames).  
The RSFSn asserts for 1 bit cycle on the first bit of the first frame of each Signaling Multi-  
Frame output on the RSDn (in case Signaling Multi-Frame is disabled, the RSFSn asserts  
every 16 frames).  
The RSFSn asserts for 1 bit cycle on the first bit of the first frame of every second Signaling  
Multi-Frame output on the RSDn (in case Signaling Multi-Frame is disabled, the RSFSn  
asserts every 32 frames).  
The RSFSn goes high/low at the start of the first bit of the first frame of each Signaling Multi-  
Frame, and does the opposite at the end of the first bit of the first frame of each CRC Multi-  
Frame.  
The RSFSn goes high/low at the start of the first bit of the first frame of every second  
Signaling Multi-Frame, and does the opposite at the end of the first bit of the first frame of  
every second CRC Multi-Frame.  
The RSFSn pin pulses during the entire TS0 period and the entire TS16.  
In Receive Multiplexed mode, when the PERTS_RSFS and the REF_MRSFS (b3~2, E1-00EH) are 1 and 0 respectively, the MRSFS can only  
indicate the first bit of a Basic Frame of the selected first framer no matter what is set in the ROHM, BRXSMFP, BRXCMFP and ALTIFP.  
136  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 Receive Backplane Parity / F-bit Configuration(012H, 092H, 112H, 192H, 212H, 292H, 312H, 392H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
RPTYP  
R/W  
0
6
RPTYE  
R/W  
0
5
4
FIXPOL  
R/W  
0
3
PTY_EXTD  
R/W  
2
1
TRI[1]  
R/W  
0
0
TRI[0]  
R/W  
0
FIXF  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Default  
0
RPTYP:  
This bit selects the parity type for the receive side system data.  
= 0: even parity is employed, which means a logic one should be inserted in the first bit of TS0 of each basic frame when the number of ones in  
the previous basic frame is odd.  
= 1: odd parity is employed, which means a logic one should be inserted in the first bit of TS0 of each basic frame when the number of ones in  
the previous basic frame is even.  
RPTYE:  
This bit enables the parity for the receive side system data. The bit is invalid in Receive Clock Master Fractional E1 (with F-bit) mode.  
= 0: disable the parity on the RSDn/MRSD pin.  
= 1: enable the parity on the RSDn/MRSD pin.  
FIXF:  
This bit controls whether the parity bit position is fixed at the level defined by the FIXPOL. It is invalid in Receive Clock Master Fractional E1 (with  
F-bit) mode and valid when RPTYE = 0.  
= 0: no action.  
= 1: the setting in the FIXPOL is valid. The first bit of TS0 of each basic frame output on the RSDn/MRSD pin is fixed with the value of FIXPOL.  
FIXPOL:  
This bit is invalid in Receive Clock Master Fractional E1 (with F-bit) mode and valid when the RPTYE = 0 and the FIXF = 1.  
= 0: force the first bit of TS0 of each basic frame output on the RSDn/MRSD pin to be logic 0.  
= 1: force the first bit of TS0 of each basic frame output on the RSDn/MRSD pin to be logic 1.  
PTY_EXTD:  
When the parity is calculated over the previous basic frame, the first bit of TS0 on the RSDn pin can be included or not. The decision is made by  
this bit.  
= 0: the first bit of TS0 on the RSDn/MRSD pin is not calculated.  
= 1: the first bit of TS0 on the RSDn/MRSD pin is calculated.  
TRI[1:0]:  
TRI[1:0]  
0 0  
Output Status on the RSDn/MRSD and RSSIGn/MRSSIG pin  
in high impedance  
Reserved  
1 0  
0 1  
1 1  
normal output  
Reserved  
137  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 Receive Backplane Time Slot Offset(013H, 093H, 113H, 193H, 213H, 293H, 313H, 393H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
TSOFF[6]  
R/W  
5
TSOFF[5]  
R/W  
4
TSOFF[4]  
R/W  
3
TSOFF[3]  
R/W  
2
TSOFF[2]  
R/W  
1
TSOFF[1]  
R/W  
0
TSOFF[0]  
R/W  
Reserved  
Default  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
These bits determine the timeslot offset between the signal on the RSCFS pin and the start of the Basic Frame output on the RSDn & RSSIGn  
pin. If the RSCFS does not exist, the timeslot offset is between the RSFSn and the start of the Basic Frame output on the RSDn & RSSIGn. In  
Receive Multiplexed mode, each framer contributes every fourth timeslot on MRSD[1:2] and MRSSIG[1:2].  
They define a binary number. The offset can be set from 0 to 127 timeslots.  
E1 Receive Backplane Bit Offset(014H, 094H, 114H, 194H, 214H, 294H, 314H, 394H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
BOFF_EN  
R/W  
2
BOFF[2]  
R/W  
0
1
BOFF[1]  
R/W  
0
0
BOFF[0]  
R/W  
0
RSD_RSCFS_EDGE  
Reserved  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Default  
0
RSD_RSCFS_EDGE:  
Valid when the CMS (b2, E1-010H) is logic 1 and the DE (b4, E1-010H) is not equal to the FE (b3, E1-010H).  
= 0: select the second active edge of the RSCCK to update the signal on the RSDn, RSSIGn and RSFSn pins, or select the first active edge of  
the MRSCCK to update the signal on the MRSD, MRSSIG and MRSFS pins.  
= 1: select the first active edge of the RSCCK to update the signal on the RSDn, RSSIGn and RSFSn pins, or select the second active edge of  
the MRSCCK to update the signal on the MRSD, MRSSIG and MRSFS pins.  
(The signal on the RSCFS/MRSCFS pin is always sampled on the first active edge.)  
In Receive Multiplexed mode, the RSD_RSCFS_EDGE in all eight framers should be set at the same value.  
When the CMS (b2, E1-010H) is logic 1 and the DE (b4, E1-010H) is equal to FE (b3, E1-010H), the signals on the RSDn/MRSD, RSSIGn/  
MRSSIG and RSFSn/MRSFS pins are updated on the first active edge of the RSCCK/MRSCCK.  
BOFF_EN:  
Valid when the CMS (b2, E1-010H) is logic 0.  
= 0: disable the bit offset.  
= 1: enable the bit offset.  
BOFF[2:0]:  
Valid when the CMS (b2, E1-010H) is logic 0 and the BOFF_EN is logic 1.  
These bits define a binary number. The content in the BOFF[2:0] determines the bit offset between the signal on the RSCFS pin and the start of  
the Basic Frame output on the RSDn & RSSIGn pin. If the RSCFS does not exist, the timeslot offset is between the RSFSn and the start of the Basic  
Frame output on the RSDn & RSSIGn. It is also available in Receive Multiplexed mode.  
Programming of the Bit Offsets is consistent with the convention established by the Concentration Highway Interface (CHI) specification. Refer to  
the Functional Description for details.  
138  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 Transmit Backplane Configuration(018H, 098H, 118H, 198H, 218H, 298H, 318H, 398H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
TSCKSLV  
R/W  
4
DE  
R/W  
1
3
FE  
R/W  
1
2
1
RATE[1]  
R/W  
0
0
RATE[0]  
R/W  
0
CMS  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Default  
1
TSCKSLV:  
= 0: Transmit Clock Master mode is selected.  
= 1: Transmit Clock Slave mode or Transmit Multiplexed mode is selected.  
DE:  
= 0: the data on the TSDn/MTSD and TSSIGn/MTSSIG pins are sampled on the falling edge of the TSCCKB/MTSCCKB or the LTCKn.  
= 1: the data on the TSDn/MTSD and TSSIGn/MTSSIG pins are sampled on the rising edge of the TSCCKB/MTSCCKB or the LTCKn.  
In Transmit Multiplexed mode, the DE of the eight framers should be set to the same value.  
FE:  
Valid in Transmit Clock Slave mode and Transmit Multiplexed mode.  
= 0: the data on the TSCFS/MTSCFS pin is sampled on the falling edge of TSCCKB/MTSCCKB.  
= 1: the data on the TSCFS/MTSCFS pin is sampled on the rising edge of TSCCKB/MTSCCKB.  
In Transmit Multiplexed mode, the FE of the eight framers should be set to the same value.  
CMS:  
= 0: the clock rate of TSCCKB/MTSCCKB is the same as that of the backplane.  
= 1: the clock rate of TSCCKB/MTSCCKB is twice that of the backplane.  
The CMS of the eight framers should be set to the same value.  
RATE[1:0]:  
These bits determine the bit rate of the transmit data stream on the backplane. Note that if any of the eight framers selects the 8.192 Mbit/s  
backplane bit rate, the multiplxed bus will be enabled for the chip. When the RATE[1:0] selects the 8.192 Mbit/s, the TSCKSLV (b5, E1-018H) must  
be set to 1.  
RATE[1:0]  
0 0  
Backplane Rate  
Reserved  
0 1  
2.048M bit/s  
1 0  
Reserved  
1 1  
8.192M bit/s (valid to eight frames)  
139  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 Transmit Backplane Frame Pulse Configuration(019H, 099H, 119H, 199H, 219H, 299H, 319H, 399H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
FPINV  
R/W  
0
2
1
FPTYP  
R/W  
0
0
Reserved  
Reserved  
Reserved  
Default  
FPINV:  
= 0: the positive pulse on the TSCFS pin is valid.  
= 1: the negative pulse on the TSCFS pin is valid.  
The FPINV of the eight framers should be the same value.  
FPTYP:  
= 0: indicate that the signal on the TSCFS pin pulses during the first bit of each Basic Frame.  
= 1: indicate that the signal on the TSCFS pin asserts on the first bit of each Signaling Multi-Frame and asserts oppositely following the first bit of  
each CRC Multi-Frame.  
The FPTYP of the eight framers should be the same value.  
E1 Transmit Backplane Parity Configuration and Status(01AH, 09AH, 11AH, 19AH, 21AH, 29AH, 31AH, 39AH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
TPTYP  
R/W  
0
6
TPTYE  
R/W  
0
5
TDI  
R
4
3
PTY_EXTD  
R/W  
2
1
0
Reserved  
Reserved  
Default  
X
0
TPTYP:  
= 0: even parity is employed in the first bit of TS0 of each Basic Frame input from the TSDn/MTSD pin, which means a logic one is expected in  
the position when the number of ones in the previous Basic Frame is odd.  
= 1: odd parity is employed in the first bit of TS0 of each Basic Frame input from the TSDn/MTSD pin, which means a logic one is expected in the  
position when the number of ones in the previous Basic Frame is even.  
TPTYE:  
This bit decides whether to generate an interrupt when a parity error is detected on the TSDn/MTSD pin.  
= 0: No interrupt is generated when a parity error is detected on the TSDn/MTSD pin.  
= 1: An interrupt on the INT pin is generated when a parity error is detected on the TSDn/MTSD pin.  
TDI:  
This bit indicates the parity error detected on the TSDn/MTSD pin.  
= 0: no parity error is detected on the TSDn/MTSD pin.  
= 1: a parity error is detected on the TSDn/MTSD pin.  
This bit is cleared to 0 when it is read.  
PTY_EXTD:  
= 0: the parity checking is calculated over the previous basic frame, excluding the first bit of TS0 on the TSDn/MTSD pin.  
= 1: the parity checking is calculated over the previous basic frame, including the first bit of TS0 on the TSDn/MTSD pin.  
140  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 Transmit Backplane Time Slot Offset(01BH, 09BH, 11BH, 19BH, 21BH, 29BH, 31BH, 39BH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
TSOFF[6]  
R/W  
5
TSOFF[5]  
R/W  
4
TSOFF[4]  
R/W  
3
TSOFF[3]  
R/W  
2
TSOFF[2]  
R/W  
1
TSOFF[1]  
R/W  
0
TSOFF[0]  
R/W  
Reserved  
Default  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
In Transmit Clock Slave mode, the content in the TSOFF[6:0] determines the timeslot offset between the TSCFS and the start of the Basic Frame  
transmitted on the TSDn & TSSIGn. In Transmit Multiplexed mode, the content in the TSOFF[6:0] determines the timeslot offset between the  
MTSCFS and the start of the Basic Frame transmitted on the MTSD & MTSSIG for the corresponding framer.  
In Transmit Clock Master mode, the timeslot offset is disabled, that is, the TSOFF[6:0] must be logic 0.  
The TSOFF[6:0] define a binary number. The offset can be set from 0 to 127 timeslots.  
E1 Transmit Backplane Bit Offset(01CH, 09CH, 11CH, 19CH, 21CH, 29CH, 31CH, 39CH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
COFF  
R/W  
0
3
2
BOFF[2]  
R/W  
0
1
BOFF[1]  
R/W  
0
0
BOFF[0]  
R/W  
0
CHI  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Default  
COFF:  
Valid when the CMS (b2, E1-018H) is logic 1.  
= 0: select the first active edge of the TSCCKB/MTSCCKB to sample the data on the TSDn/MTSD, TSSIGn/MTSSIG and to update the data on  
the TSFSn.  
= 1: select the second active edge of the TSCCKB/MTSCCKB to sample the data on the TSDn/MTSD, TSSIGn/MTSSIG and to update the data  
on the TSFSn.  
(The signal on the TSCFS/MTSCFS pin is always sampled on the first active edge.)  
CHI:  
This bit controls if the value in the BOFF[2:0] is the actual value or meets the Concentration Highway Interface (CHI) specification.  
= 0: disable the CHI specification.  
= 1: enable the CHI specification.  
BOFF[2:0]:  
In Transmit Clock Master mode, the content in the BOFF[2:0] determines the bit offset between the signal on the TSFSn and the start of the Basic  
Frame transmitted on the TSDn.  
In Transmit Clock Slave mode, the content in the BOFF[2:0] determines the bit offset between the TSCFS and the start of the Basic Frame  
transmitted on the TSDn & TSSIGn.  
In Transmit Multiplexed mode, the content in the BOFF[2:0] determines the bit offset between the MTSCFS and the start of the Basic Frame  
transmitted on the MTSD & MTSSIG.  
These bits define a binary number. When the CHI = 0, the setting in the BOFF[2:0] is their actual value (0 stands for 0 bit offset, 1 stands for 1 bit  
offset). When the CHI = 1, programming of the BOFF[2:0] is consistent with the convention established by the Concentration Highway Interface (CHI)  
specification. Refer to the Functional Description for details.  
141  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 RJAT Interrupt Status (020H, 0A0H, 120H, 1A0H, 220H, 2A0H, 320H, 3A0H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
OVRI  
R
0
UNDI  
R
Reserved  
Default  
X
X
OVRI:  
If data are still attempted to write into the FIFO when the FIFO is already full, the overwritten event will occur.  
= 0: the RJAT FIFO is not overwritten.  
= 1: the RJAT FIFO is overwritten.  
This bit is cleared to 0 when it is read.  
UNDI:  
If data are still attempted to read from the FIFO when the FIFO is already empty, the under-run event will occur.  
= 0: the RJAT FIFO is not under-run.  
= 1: the RJAT FIFO is under-run.  
This bit is cleared to 0 when it is read.  
E1 RJAT Reference Clock Divisor (N1) Control(021H, 0A1H, 121H, 1A1H, 221H, 2A1H, 321H, 3A1H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
N1[7]  
R/W  
0
6
N1[6]  
R/W  
0
5
N1[5]  
R/W  
1
4
N1[4]  
R/W  
0
3
N1[3]  
R/W  
1
2
N1[2]  
R/W  
1
1
N1[1]  
R/W  
1
0
N1[0]  
R/W  
1
Default  
These bits define a binary number. The (N1[7:0] + 1) is the divisor of the input reference clock, which is the ratio between the frequency of the  
input reference clock and the frequency applied to the phase discriminator input.  
Writing to this register will reset the DPLL in the RJAT.  
E1 RJAT Output Clock Divisor (N2) Control(022H, 0A2H, 122H, 1A2H, 222H, 2A2H, 322H, 3A2H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
N2[7]  
R/W  
0
6
N2[6]  
R/W  
0
5
N2[5]  
R/W  
1
4
N2[4]  
R/W  
0
3
N2[3]  
R/W  
1
2
N2[2]  
R/W  
1
1
N2[1]  
R/W  
1
0
N2[0]  
R/W  
1
Default  
These bits define a binary number. The (N2[7:0] + 1) is the divisor of the output smoothed clock, which is the ratio between the frequency of the  
output smoothed clock and the frequency applied to the phase discriminator input.  
Writing to this register will reset the DPLL in the RJAT.  
142  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 RJAT Configuration (023H, 0A3H, 123H, 1A3H, 223H, 2A3H, 323H, 3A3H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
CENT  
R/W  
0
3
UNDE  
R/W  
0
2
OVRE  
R/W  
0
1
0
LIMIT  
R/W  
1
Reserved  
Reserved  
Default  
CENT:  
The CENT allows the RJAT FIFO to self-center its read pointer, maintaining the pointer at least 4 UI away from the FIFO being empty or full.  
= 0: disable the self-center. Data are pass through uncorrupted.  
= 1: enable the FIFO to self-center its read pointer when the FIFO is 4 UI away from being empty or full.  
A positive transition in this bit will execute a self-center action immediately.  
UNDE:  
This bit decides whether to generate an interrupt when the RJAT FIFO is under-run.  
= 0: No interrupt is generated when the RJAT FIFO is under-run.  
= 1: An interrupt on the INT pin is generated when the RJAT FIFO is under-run.  
OVRE:  
This bit decides whether to generate an interrupt when the RJAT FIFO is overwritten.  
= 0: No interrupt is generated when the RJAT FIFO is overwritten.  
= 1: An interrupt on the INT pin is generated when the RJAT FIFO is overwritten.  
LIMIT:  
= 0: disable the limitation of the jitter attenuation.  
= 1: enable the DPLL to limit the jitter attenuation by enabling the FIFO to increase or decrease the frequency of the output smoothed clock when  
the read pointer is 1 UI away from the FIFO being empty or full. This limitation of jitter attenuation ensures that no data is lost during high phase shift  
conditions.  
E1 TJAT Interrupt Status (024H, 0A4H, 124H, 1A4H, 224H, 2A4H, 324H, 3A4H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
OVRI  
R
0
UNDI  
R
Reserved  
Default  
X
X
OVRI:  
If data are still attempted to write into the FIFO when the FIFO is already full, the overwritten event will occur.  
= 0: the TJAT FIFO is not overwritten.  
= 1: the TJAT FIFO is overwritten.  
This bit is cleared to 0 when it is read.  
UNDI:  
If data are still attempted to read from the FIFO when the FIFO is already empty, the under-run event will occur.  
= 0: the TJAT FIFO is not under-run.  
= 1: the TJAT FIFO is under-run.  
This bit is cleared to 0 when it is read.  
143  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 TJAT Reference Clock Divisor (N1) Control(025H, 0A5H, 125H, 1A5H, 225H, 2A5H, 325H, 3A5H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
N1[7]  
R/W  
0
6
N1[6]  
R/W  
0
5
N1[5]  
R/W  
1
4
N1[4]  
R/W  
0
3
N1[3]  
R/W  
1
2
N1[2]  
R/W  
1
1
N1[1]  
R/W  
1
0
N1[0]  
R/W  
1
Default  
These bits define a binary number. The (N1[7:0] + 1) is the divisor of the input reference clock, which is the ratio between the frequency of the  
input reference clock and the frequency applied to the phase discriminator input.  
Writing to this register will reset the DPLL in the TJAT.  
E1 TJAT Output Clock Divisor (N2) Control(026H, 0A6H, 126H, 1A6H, 226H, 2A6H, 326H, 3A6H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
N2[7]  
R/W  
0
6
N2[6]  
R/W  
0
5
N2[5]  
R/W  
1
4
N2[4]  
R/W  
0
3
N2[3]  
R/W  
1
2
N2[2]  
R/W  
1
1
N2[1]  
R/W  
1
0
N2[0]  
R/W  
1
Default  
These bits define a binary number. The (N2[7:0] + 1) is the divisor of the output smoothed clock, which is the ratio between the frequency of the  
output smoothed clock and the frequency applied to the phase discriminator input.  
Writing to this register will reset the DPLL in the TJAT.  
E1 TJAT Configuration (027H, 0A7H, 127H, 1A7H, 227H, 2A7H, 327H, 3A7H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
CENT  
R/W  
0
3
UNDE  
R/W  
0
2
OVRE  
R/W  
0
1
0
LIMIT  
R/W  
1
Reserved  
Reserved  
Default  
CENT:  
The CENT allows the TJAT FIFO to self-center its read pointer, maintaining the pointer at least 4 UI away from the FIFO being empty or full.  
= 0: disable the self-center. Data are pass through uncorrupted.  
= 1: enable the FIFO to self-center its read pointer when the FIFO is 4 UI away from being empty or full.  
A positive transition in this bit will execute a self-center action immediately.  
UNDE:  
This bit decides whether to generate an interrupt when the TJAT FIFO is under-run.  
= 0: No interrupt is generated when the TJAT FIFO is under-run.  
= 1: An interrupt on the INT pin is generated when the TJAT FIFO is under-run.  
OVRE:  
This bit decides whether to generate an interrupt when the TJAT FIFO is overwritten.  
= 0: No interrupt is generated when the TJAT FIFO is overwritten.  
= 1: An interrupt on the INT pin is generated when the TJAT FIFO is overwritten.  
LIMIT:  
= 0: disable the limitation of the jitter attenuation.  
= 1: enable the DPLL to limit the jitter attenuation by enabling the FIFO to increase or decrease the frequency of the output smoothed clock when  
the read pointer is 1 UI away from the FIFO being empty or full. This limitation of jitter attenuation ensures that no data is lost during high phase shift  
conditions.  
144  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 RHDLC Receive Data Link 1 Control (TXCISEL = 0)(028H, 0A8H, 128H, 1A8H, 228H, 2A8H, 328H, 3A8H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
DL1_EVEN  
R/W  
6
DL1_ODD  
R/W  
5
TS16_EN  
R/W  
4
DL1_TS[4]  
R/W  
3
DL1_TS[3]  
R/W  
2
DL1_TS[2]  
R/W  
1
DL1_TS[1]  
R/W  
0
DL1_TS[0]  
R/W  
Default  
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
When the TXCISEL (b3, E1-00AH) is 0, this register is used for the Receive HDLC #1.  
DL1_EVEN:  
= 0: the data is not extracted from the even frames.  
= 1: the data is extracted from the even frames.  
The even frames are FAS frames.  
DL1_ODD:  
= 0: the data is not extracted from the odd frames.  
= 1: the data is extracted from the odd frames.  
The odd frames are NFAS frames.  
TS16_EN:  
This bit is valid when the DL1_EVEN and DL1_ODD are both 0.  
= 0: the data is not extracted from the TS16.  
= 1: the data is extracted from the TS16.  
DL1_TS[4:0]:  
These bits represent the binary value of the timeslot to extract the data from. They are invalid when the DL1_EVEN and the DL1_ODD are both  
logic 0.  
E1 RHDLC Data Link 1 Bit Select (TXCISEL = 0) (029H, 0A9H, 129H, 1A9H, 229H, 2A9H, 329H, 3A9H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
DL1_BIT[7]  
R/W  
6
DL1_BIT[6]  
R/W  
5
DL1_BIT[5]  
R/W  
4
DL1_BIT[4]  
R/W  
3
DL1_BIT[3]  
R/W  
2
DL1_BIT[2]  
R/W  
1
DL1_BIT[1]  
R/W  
0
DL1_BIT[0]  
R/W  
Default  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
When the TXCISEL (b3, E1-00AH) is 0, this register is used for the Receive HDLC #1.  
DL1_BITn:  
= 0: the data is not extracted from the corresponding bit.  
= 1: the data is extracted from the corresponding bit of the assigned timeslot.  
These bits are invalid when the DL1_EVEN and the DL1_ODD are both logic 0.  
The DL1_BIT[7] corresponds to the first bit (MSB) of the selected timeslot.  
145  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 RHDLC Receive Data Link 2 Control (TXCISEL = 0)(02AH, 0AAH, 12AH, 1AAH, 22AH, 2AAH, 32AH, 3AAH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
DL2_EVEN  
R/W  
6
DL2_ODD  
R/W  
5
4
DL2_TS[4]  
R/W  
3
DL2_TS[3]  
R/W  
2
DL2_TS[2]  
R/W  
1
DL2_TS[1]  
R/W  
0
DL2_TS[0]  
R/W  
Reserved  
Default  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
When the TXCISEL (b3, E1-00AH) is 0, this register is used for the Receive HDLC #2.  
DL2_EVEN:  
= 0: the data is not extracted from the even frames.  
= 1: the data is extracted from the even frames.  
The even frames are FAS frames.  
DL2_ODD:  
= 0: the data is not extracted from the odd frames.  
= 1: the data is extracted from the odd frames.  
The odd frames are NFAS frames.  
DL2_TS[4:0]:  
These bits represent the binary value of the timeslot to extract the data from. They are invalid when the DL2_EVEN and the DL2_ODD are both  
logic 0.  
E1 RHDLC Data Link 2 Bit Select (TXCISEL = 0) (02BH, 0ABH, 12BH, 1ABH, 22BH, 2ABH, 32BH, 3ABH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
DL2_BIT[7]  
R/W  
6
DL2_BIT[6]  
R/W  
5
DL2_BIT[5]  
R/W  
4
DL2_BIT[4]  
R/W  
3
DL2_BIT[3]  
R/W  
2
DL2_BIT[2]  
R/W  
1
DL2_BIT[1]  
R/W  
0
DL2_BIT[0]  
R/W  
Default  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
When the TXCISEL (b3, E1-00AH) is 0, this register is used for the Receive HDLC #2.  
DL2_BITn:  
= 0: the data is not extracted from the corresponding bit.  
= 1: the data is extracted from the corresponding bit of the assigned timeslot.  
These bits are invalid when the DL2_EVEN and the DL2_ODD are both logic 0.  
The DL2_BIT[7] corresponds to the first bit (MSB) of the selected timeslot.  
146  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 RHDLC Receive Data Link 3 Control (TXCISEL = 0)(02CH, 0ACH, 12CH, 1ACH, 22CH, 2ACH, 32CH, 3ACH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
DL3_EVEN  
R/W  
6
DL3_ODD  
R/W  
5
4
DL3_TS[4]  
R/W  
3
DL3_TS[3]  
R/W  
2
DL3_TS[2]  
R/W  
1
DL3_TS[1]  
R/W  
0
DL3_TS[0]  
R/W  
Reserved  
Default  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
When the TXCISEL (b3, E1-00AH) is 0, this register is used for the Receive HDLC #3.  
DL3_EVEN:  
= 0: the data is not extracted from the even frames.  
= 1: the data is extracted from the even frames.  
The even frames are FAS frames.  
DL3_ODD:  
= 0: the data is not extracted from the odd frames.  
= 1: the data is extracted from the odd frames.  
The odd frames are NFAS frames.  
DL3_TS[4:0]:  
These bits represent the binary value of the timeslot to extract the data from. They are invalid when the DL3_EVEN and the DL3_ODD are both  
logic 0.  
E1 RHDLC Data Link 3 Bit Select (TXCISEL = 0) (02DH, 0ADH, 12DH, 1ADH, 22DH, 2ADH, 32DH, 3ADH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
DL3_BIT[7]  
R/W  
6
DL3_BIT[6]  
R/W  
5
DL3_BIT[5]  
R/W  
4
DL3_BIT[4]  
R/W  
3
DL3_BIT[3]  
R/W  
2
DL3_BIT[2]  
R/W  
1
DL3_BIT[1]  
R/W  
0
DL3_BIT[0]  
R/W  
Default  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
When the TXCISEL (b3, E1-00AH) is 0, this register is used for the Receive HDLC #3.  
DL3_BITn:  
= 0: the data is not extracted from the corresponding bit.  
= 1: the data is extracted from the corresponding bit of the assigned timeslot.  
These bits are invalid when the DL3_EVEN and the DL3_ODD are both logic 0.  
The DL3_BIT[7] corresponds to the first bit (MSB) of the selected timeslot.  
147  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 THDLC Transmit Data Link 1 Control (TXCISEL = 1)(028H, 0A8H, 128H, 1A8H, 228H, 2A8H, 328H, 3A8H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
DL1_EVEN  
R/W  
6
DL1_ODD  
R/W  
5
TS16_EN  
R/W  
4
DL1_TS[4]  
R/W  
3
DL1_TS[3]  
R/W  
2
DL1_TS[2]  
R/W  
1
DL1_TS[1]  
R/W  
0
DL1_TS[0]  
R/W  
Default  
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
0
When the TXCISEL (b3, E1-00AH) is 1, this register is used for the Transmit HDLC #1.  
DL1_EVEN:  
= 0: the data is not inserted to the even frames.  
= 1: the data is inserted to the even frames.  
The even frames are FAS frames.  
DL1_ODD:  
= 0: the data is not inserted to the odd frames.  
= 1: the data is inserted to the odd frames.  
The odd frames are NFAS frames.  
TS16_EN:  
This bit is valid when the DL1_EVEN and DL1_ODD are both 0 and the CCS is selected (the SIGEN [b6, E1-040H] and the DLEN [b5, E1-040H]  
are logic 1).  
= 0: the data is not inserted to the TS16.  
= 1: the data is inserted to the TS16.  
DL1_TS[4:0]:  
The data is inserted into the timeslot defined by the binary number in these bits. They are invalid when the DL1_EVEN and the DL1_ODD are both  
logic 0.  
E1 THDLC Data Link 1 Bit Select (TXCISEL = 1) (029H, 0A9H, 129H, 1A9H, 229H, 2A9H, 329H, 3A9H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
DL1_BIT[7]  
R/W  
6
DL1_BIT[6]  
R/W  
5
DL1_BIT[5]  
R/W  
4
DL1_BIT[4]  
R/W  
3
DL1_BIT[3]  
R/W  
2
DL1_BIT[2]  
R/W  
1
DL1_BIT[1]  
R/W  
0
DL1_BIT[0]  
R/W  
Default  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
When the TXCISEL (b3, E1-00AH) is 1, this register is used for the Transmit HDLC #1.  
DL1_BITn:  
= 0: the data is not inserted to the corresponding bit.  
= 1: the data is inserted to the corresponding bit of the assigned timeslot.  
These bits are invalid when the DL1_EVEN and the DL1_ODD are both logic 0.  
The DL1_BIT[7] corresponds to the first bit (MSB) of the selected timeslot.  
148  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 THDLC Transmit Data Link 2 Control (TXCISEL = 1)(02AH, 0AAH, 12AH, 1AAH, 22AH, 2AAH, 32AH, 3AAH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
DL2_EVEN  
R/W  
6
DL2_ODD  
R/W  
5
4
DL2_TS[4]  
R/W  
3
DL2_TS[3]  
R/W  
2
DL2_TS[2]  
R/W  
1
DL2_TS[1]  
R/W  
0
DL2_TS[0]  
R/W  
Reserved  
Default  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
When the TXCISEL (b3, E1-00AH) is 1, this register is used for the Transmit HDLC #2.  
DL2_EVEN:  
= 0: the data is not inserted to the even frames.  
= 1: the data is inserted to the even frames.  
The even frames are FAS frames.  
DL2_ODD:  
= 0: the data is not inserted to the odd frames.  
= 1: the data is inserted to the odd frames.  
The odd frames are NFAS frames.  
DL2_TS[4:0]:  
The data is inserted into the timeslot defined by the binary number in these bits. They are invalid when the DL2_EVEN and the DL2_ODD are  
both logic 0.  
E1 THDLC Data Link 2 Bit Select (TXCISEL = 1) (02BH, 0ABH, 12BH, 1ABH, 22BH, 2ABH, 32BH, 3ABH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
DL2_BIT[7]  
R/W  
6
DL2_BIT[6]  
R/W  
5
DL2_BIT[5]  
R/W  
4
DL2_BIT[4]  
R/W  
3
DL2_BIT[3]  
R/W  
2
DL2_BIT[2]  
R/W  
1
DL2_BIT[1]  
R/W  
0
DL2_BIT[0]  
R/W  
Default  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
When the TXCISEL (b3, E1-00AH) is 1, this register is used for the Transmit HDLC #2.  
DL2_BITn:  
= 0: the data is not inserted to the corresponding bit.  
= 1: the data is inserted to the corresponding bit of the assigned timeslot.  
These bits are invalid when the DL2_EVEN and the DL2_ODD are both logic 0.  
The DL2_BIT[7] corresponds to the first bit (MSB) of the selected timeslot.  
149  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 THDLC Transmit Data Link 3 Control (TXCISEL = 1)(02CH, 0ACH, 12CH, 1ACH, 22CH, 2ACH, 32CH, 3ACH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
DL3_EVEN  
R/W  
6
DL3_ODD  
R/W  
5
4
DL3_TS[4]  
R/W  
3
DL3_TS[3]  
R/W  
2
DL3_TS[2]  
R/W  
1
DL3_TS[1]  
R/W  
0
DL3_TS[0]  
R/W  
Reserved  
Default  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
When the TXCISEL (b3, E1-00AH) is 1, this register is used for the Transmit HDLC #3.  
DL3_EVEN:  
= 0: the data is not inserted to the even frames.  
= 1: the data is inserted to the even frames.  
The even frames are FAS frames.  
DL3_ODD:  
= 0: the data is not inserted to the odd frames.  
= 1: the data is inserted to the odd frames.  
The odd frames are NFAS frames.  
DL3_TS[4:0]:  
The data is inserted into the timeslot defined by the binary number in these bits. They are invalid when the DL3_EVEN and the DL3_ODD are  
both logic 0.  
E1 THDLC Data Link 3 Bit Select (TXCISEL = 1) (02DH, 0ADH, 12DH, 1ADH, 22DH, 2ADH, 32DH, 3ADH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
DL3_BIT[7]  
R/W  
6
DL3_BIT[6]  
R/W  
5
DL3_BIT[5]  
R/W  
4
DL3_BIT[4]  
R/W  
3
DL3_BIT[3]  
R/W  
2
DL3_BIT[2]  
R/W  
1
DL3_BIT[1]  
R/W  
0
DL3_BIT[0]  
R/W  
Default  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
When the TXCISEL (b3, E1-00AH) is 1, this register is used for the Transmit HDLC #3.  
DL3_BITn:  
= 0: the data is not inserted to the corresponding bit.  
= 1: the data is inserted to the corresponding bit of the assigned timeslot.  
These bits are invalid when the DL3_EVEN and the DL3_ODD are both logic 0.  
The DL3_BIT[7] corresponds to the first bit (MSB) of the selected timeslot.  
150  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 FRMP Frame Alignment Options(030H, 0B0H, 130H, 1B0H, 230H, 2B0H, 330H, 3B0H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
CRCEN  
R/W  
1
6
CASDIS  
R/W  
0
5
C2NCIWCK  
R/W  
4
3
2
REFR  
R/W  
0
1
REFCRCE  
R/W  
0
REFRDIS  
R/W  
Reserved  
Default  
0
1
0
CRCEN:  
= 0: disable searching for the CRC Multi-Frame.  
= 1: enable searching for the CRC Multi-Frame alignment signal and monitor the errors in the CRC Multi-Frame.  
CASDIS:  
= 0: enable searching for the Channel Associated Signaling (CAS) Multi-Frame alignment signal and monitor the errors in the Signaling Multi-  
Frame.  
= 1: disable searching for the Channel Associated Signaling Multi-Frame.  
C2NCIWCK:  
= 0: stop searching for the CRC Multi-Frame alignment signal in CRC to non-CRC inter-working mode.  
= 1: continue searching for the CRC Multi-Frame alignment signal even if CRC to non-CRC inter-working has been declared.  
REFR:  
A transition from logic 0 to logic 1 forces to re-search for a new Basic Frame.  
REFCRCE:  
This bit decides if the Frame Processor re-searches for the Basic Frame when there are excessive CRC errors. The excessive CRC errors is  
defined as more than 914 CRC errors in one second. One CRC error is counted when the local calculated CRC-4 is not equal to the received CRC-  
4.  
= 0: disable re-searching for the Basic Frame when there are excessive CRC errors.  
= 1: enable re-searching for the Basic Frame when there are excessive CRC errors.  
REFRDIS:  
0 = enable re-searching for the Basic Frame when it is out of basic frame sync or there are excessive CRC errors.  
1 = “locked in frame” once initial frame alignment has been found. Disable re-searching for the Basic Frame under any error conditions once the  
initial Basic Frame sync is acquired.  
While the FRMP remains locked in frame due to REFRDIS=1, a received AIS will not be detected since the Frame Processor must be out-of-  
frame to detect AIS.  
151  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 FRMP Maintenance Mode Options (031H, 0B1H, 131H, 1B1H, 231H, 2B1H, 331H, 3B1H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
BIT2C  
R/W  
1
5
SMFASC  
R/W  
4
TS16C  
R/W  
0
3
RAIC  
R/W  
0
2
1
0
AISC  
R/W  
X
EXCRCERR  
Reserved  
Reserved  
R
X
Default  
0
BIT2C:  
= 0: out of basic frame sync is declared on 3 consecutive FAS errors.  
= 1: enable the additional criteria to declare out of basic frame sync. Thus, out of basic frame sync is declared when 3 consecutive logic 0 are  
received in bit 2 of TS0 of NFAS or 3 consecutive FAS are in errors.  
SMFASC:  
= 0: enable the declaration of out of signaling multi-frame sync when 2 consecutive Signaling Multi-Frame alignment patterns have been received  
in error.  
= 1: enable the declaration of out of signaling multi-frame sync when 2 consecutive Signaling Multi-Frame alignment patterns have been received  
in error or when all the content in TS16 of Frame 0 are logic 0 for one or two consecutive multi-frames which is defined in TS16C (b4, E1-031H).  
TS16C:  
Valid when the SMFASC (b5, E1-031H) is logic 1.  
= 0: enable the declaration of out of signaling multi-frame sync when all the content in TS16 are logic 0 for one multi-frame.  
= 1: enable the declaration of out of signaling multi-frame sync when all the content in TS16 are logic 0 for two consecutive multi-frames.  
RAIC:  
= 0: set the RAIV (b7, E1-037H) to be logic 1 on the reception of any A bit being logic one, and set the RAIV (b7, E1-037H) to be logic 0 on the  
reception of any A bit being logic zero.  
= 1: set the RAIV (b7, E1-037H) to be logic 1 on the reception of the A bit being logic one for 4 or more consecutive occasions, and set the RAIV  
(b7, E1-037H) to be logic 0 on the reception of any A bit being logic zero.  
AISC:  
= 0: set the AISD (b5, E1-037H) to logic 1 when it is out of basic frame sync and less than 3 zeros are detected in a 512-bit stream, and set the  
AISD (b5, E1-037H) to logic 0 when 3 or more zeros are detected in a 512-bit stream.  
= 1: set the AISD (b5, E1-037H) to logic 1 when it is out of basic frame sync and less than 3 zeros are detected in each of 2 consecutive 512-bit  
stream, and set the AISD (b5, E1-037H) to logic 0 when 3 or more zeros are detected in each of 2 consecutive 512-bit stream.  
EXCRCERR:  
The excessive CRC errors is defined as more than 914 CRC errors in one second. One CRC error is counted when the local calculated CRC-4 is  
not equal to the received CRC-4.  
= 0: normal operation.  
= 1: indicate that there are excessive CRC errors in the received data stream.  
This bit is cleared to 0 after it is read  
152  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 FRMP Framing Status Interrupt Enable (032H, 0B2H, 132H, 1B2H, 232H, 2B2H, 332H, 3B2H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
C2NCIWE  
R/W  
6
OOFE  
R/W  
0
5
OOSMFE  
R/W  
4
OOCMFE  
R/W  
3
COFAE  
R/W  
0
2
FERE  
R/W  
0
1
SMFERE  
R/W  
0
CMFERE  
R/W  
Default  
0
0
0
1
0
C2NCIWE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the C2NCIWI (b7, E1-034H) is logic one.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the C2NCIWI is logic one.  
OOFE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the OOFI (b6, E1-034H) is logic one.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the OOFI is logic one.  
OOSMFE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the OOSMFI (b5, E1-034H) is logic one.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the OOSMFI is logic one.  
OOCMFE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the OOCMFI (b4, E1-034H) is logic one.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the OOCMFI is logic one.  
COFAE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the position of the basic frame alignment signal changes.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the position of the basic frame alignment signal changes.  
FERE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when there is error in the basic frame alignment pattern.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when there is error in the basic frame alignment pattern.  
SMFERE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when there is an error in the signaling multi-frame alignment pattern.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when there is an error in the signaling multi-frame alignment pattern.  
CMFERE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when there is error in the CRC multi-frame alignment pattern.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when there is error in the CRC multi-frame alignment pattern.  
153  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 FRMP Maintenance / Alarm Status Interrupt Enable (033H, 0B3H, 133H, 1B3H, 233H, 2B3H, 333H, 3B3H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
RAIE  
R/W  
0
6
RMAIE  
R/W  
0
5
AISDE  
R/W  
0
4
3
REDE  
R/W  
0
2
AISE  
R/W  
0
1
FEBEE  
R/W  
0
0
CRCEE  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Default  
RAIE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the RAII (b7, E1-035H) is logic one.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the RAII is logic one.  
RMAIE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the RMAII (b6, E1-035H) is logic one.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the RMAII is logic one.  
AISDE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the AISDI (b5, E1-035H) is logic one.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the AISDI is logic one.  
REDE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the REDI (b3, E1-035H) is logic one.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the REDI is logic one.  
AISE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the AISI (b2, E1-035H) is logic one.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the AISI is logic one.  
FEBEE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when a logic 0 is received in the E1 (the first bit in TS0 in the 13th Frame of CRC-4 Multi-Frame) or E2  
(the first bit in TS0 in the 15th Frame of CRC-4 Multi-Frame) bit.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when a logic 0 is received in the E1 or E2 bit.  
CRCEE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when there is difference between the calculated CRC-4 remainder and the received CRC-4.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when there is difference between the calculated CRC-4 remainder and the received CRC-4.  
154  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 FRMP Framing Status Interrupt Indication (034H, 0B4H, 134H, 1B4H, 234H, 2B4H, 334H, 3B4H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
OOFI  
R
5
4
3
COFAI  
R
2
FERI  
R
1
0
C2NCIWI  
OOSMFI  
OOCMFI  
SMFERI  
CMFERI  
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
Default  
X
X
X
All the bits in this register are clear to 0 after the register is read.  
C2NCIWI:  
= 0: no status change on the C2NCIWV (b7, E1-036H).  
= 1: there is a transition (from 0 to 1 or from 1 to 0) on the C2NCIWV (b7, E1-036H).  
OOFI:  
= 0: no status change on the OOFV (b6, E1-036H)  
= 1: there is a transition (from 0 to 1 or from 1 to 0) on the OOFV (b6, E1-036H).  
OOSMFI:  
= 0: no status change on the OOSMFV (b5, E1-036H)  
= 1: there is a transition (from 0 to 1 or from 1 to 0) on the OOSMFV (b5, E1-036H).  
OOCMFI:  
= 0: no status change on the OOCMFV (b4, E1-036H)  
= 1: there is a transition (from 0 to 1 or from 1 to 0) on the OOCMFV (b4, E1-036H).  
COFAI:  
= 0: the position of the basic frame alignment signal does not change  
= 1: the position of the basic frame alignment signal changes.  
FERI:  
= 0: there is no error in the basic frame alignment pattern.  
= 1: there is an error in the basic frame alignment pattern.  
SMFERI:  
= 0: there is no error in the signaling multi-frame alignment pattern.  
= 1: there is an error in the signaling multi-frame alignment pattern.  
CMFERI:  
= 0: there is no error in the CRC multi-frame alignment pattern.  
= 1: there is an error in the CRC multi-frame alignment pattern.  
155  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 FRMP Maintenance / Alarm Status Interrupt Indication (035H, 0B5H, 135H, 1B5H, 235H, 2B5H, 335H, 3B5H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
RAII  
R
6
RMAII  
R
5
AISDI  
R
4
3
REDI  
R
2
AISI  
R
1
FEBEI  
R
0
CRCEI  
R
Reserved  
Default  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
All the bits in this register are clear to 0 after the register is read.  
RAII:  
= 0: no status change on the RAIV (b7, E1-037H).  
= 1: there is a transition (from 0 to 1 or from 1 to 0) on the RAIV (b7, E1-037H).  
RMAII:  
= 0: no status change on the RMAIV (b6, E1-037H).  
= 1: there is a transition from 0 to 1 or from 1 to 0 on the RMAIV (b6, E1-037H).  
AISDI:  
= 0: no status change on the AISD (b5, E1-037H).  
= 1: there is a transition from 0 to 1 or from 1 to 0 on the AISD (b5, E1-037H).  
REDI:  
= 0: no status change on the RED (b3, E1-037H).  
= 1: there is a transition from 0 to 1 or from 1 to 0 on the RED (b3, E1-037H).  
AISI:  
= 0: no status change on the AIS (b2, E1-037H).  
= 1: there is a transition from 0 to 1 or from 1 to 0 on the AIS (b2, E1-037H).  
FEBEI:  
= 0: No logic 0 is received in the E1 or E2 bit.  
= 1: A logic 0 is received in the E1 or E2 bit.  
CRCEI:  
= 0: No difference between the calculated CRC-4 remainder and the received CRC-4.  
= 1: There is difference between the calculated CRC-4 remainder and the received CRC-4 remainder.  
156  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 FRMP Framing Status (036H, 0B6H, 136H, 1B6H, 236H, 2B6H, 336H, 3B6H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
OOFV  
R
5
4
3
2
1
0
C2NCIWV  
OOSMFV  
OOCMFV  
OOOFV  
RAICCRCV  
CFEBEV  
V52LINKV  
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
Default  
X
C2NCIWV:  
= 0: the Frame Processor does not operate in CRC to non-CRC inter-working mode.  
= 1: the Frame Processor operates in CRC to non-CRC inter-working mode.  
OOFV:  
= 0: the Basic Frame is in sync.  
= 1: the Basic Frame is out of sync.  
OOSMFV:  
= 0: the Signaling Multi-Frame is in sync.  
= 1: the Signaling Multi-Frame is out of sync.  
OOCMFV:  
= 0: the CRC Multi-Frame is in sync.  
= 1: the CRC Multi-Frame is out of sync  
OOOFV:  
= 0: the offline frame is in sync.  
= 1: the offline frame is out of sync.  
RAICCRCV:  
= 0: normal operation.  
= 1: the remote alarm (logic 1 in A bit) and the FEBE (logic 0 in bit E1 or E2) have existed for a period of 10ms.  
CFEBEV:  
= 0: normal operation.  
= 1: FEBE (logic 0 in bit E1 and E2) has existed for more than or equal to 990 occasions in each second for 5 consecutive seconds.  
V52LINKV:  
= 0: V5.2 link ID signal is not received.  
= 1: V5.2 link ID signal is received, i.e., 2 out of 3 Sa7 bits are logic zeros  
157  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 FRMP Maintenance / Alarm Status (037H, 0B7H, 137H, 1B7H, 237H, 2B7H, 337H, 3B7H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
RAIV  
R
6
RMAIV  
R
5
AISD  
R
4
3
RED  
R
2
AIS  
R
1
0
Reserved  
Reserved  
Default  
X
X
X
X
X
RAIV:  
This bit indicates the value of the Remote Alarm Indication (A) bit.  
= 0: the A bit is logic 0.  
= 1: RAI is detected according to the criterion set in the RAIC (b3, E1-031H). When the RAIC is 0, RAI is detected when the A bit is received as  
logic 1. When the RAIC is 1, RAI is detected when the A bit is received as logic 1 for 4 or more consecutive occasions.  
The RAIV is updated every two frames.  
RMAIV:  
This bit indicates the value of the Remote Signaling Multi-Frame Alarm Indication (Y) bit.  
= 0: the Y bit is logic 0.  
= 1: logic 1 has been received in Y bit for 3 consecutive signaling multi-frames.  
The RMAIV is updated every 16 frames.  
AISD:  
This bit indicates the Alarm Indication Signal (AIS) detect value. The detection of AIS is disabled in unframed mode.  
= 0: AIS is clear according to the criterion set in the AISC (b1, E1-031H). When the AISC is 0, AIS is clear when 3 or more zeros are detected in a  
512-bit stream. When the AISC is 1, AIS is clear when 3 or more zeros are detected in each of 2 consecutive 512-bit stream.  
= 1: AIS is detected according to the criterion set in the AISC (b1, E1-031H). When the AISC is 0, AIS is detected when it is out of basic frame  
sync and less than 3 zeros are detected in a 512-bit stream. When the AISC is 1, AIS is detected when it is out of basic frame sync and less than 3  
zeros are detected in each of 2 consecutive 512-bit stream.  
The AISD bit is updated once every 512 bit periods.  
RED:  
= 0: out of basic frame sync has been absent for 100ms.  
= 1: out of basic frame sync has persisted for 100ms.  
AIS:  
= 0: the condition of AIS has been absent for 100ms.  
= 1: the condition of AIS has persisted for 100ms.  
158  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 FRMP Timeslot0 International / National Bits (038H, 0B8H, 138H, 1B8H, 238H, 2B8H, 338H, 3B8H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
Si[1]  
R
6
Si[0]  
R
5
A
R
X
4
Sa[4]  
R
3
Sa[5]  
R
2
Sa[6]  
R
1
Sa[7]  
R
0
Sa[8]  
R
Default  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
The content in this register reflects the international bits, Remote Alarm Indication bit and national bits. The Si[1:0] bits are the international bits.  
The A bit is the Remote Alarm Indication bit. The Sa[4:8] bits are the national bits. Their position is shown in the following table:  
Frame  
Type  
FAS  
the Eight Bits in TS0  
0
Si[1]  
Si[0]  
1
0
1
2
0
A
3
1
4
1
5
0
6
1
7
1
NFAS  
Sa[4]  
Sa[5]  
Sa[6]  
Sa[7]  
Sa[8]  
Note that the contents of this register are not updated while the the received data stream is out of Basic Frame.  
Si[1]:  
Directly reflect the content in the International bit in the latest received FAS frame and is updated on the generation of the IFPI interrupt on FAS  
frames.  
Si[0]:  
Directly reflect the content in the International bit in the latest received NFAS frame and is updated on the generation of the IFPI interrupt on  
NFAS frames.  
A:  
Directly reflect the content in the Remote Alarm Indication (A) bit in the latest received NFAS frame and is updated on the generation of the IFPI  
interrupt on NFAS frames.  
Sa[4:8]:  
Directly reflect the content in the National bit in the latest received NFAS frame and is updated on the generation of the IFPI interrupt on NFAS  
frames.  
E1 FRMP CRC Error Counter-LSB (039H, 0B9H, 139H, 1B9H, 239H, 2B9H, 339H, 3B9H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
CRCERR[7] CRCERR[6] CRCERR[5] CRCERR[4] CRCERR[3] CRCERR[2] CRCERR[1] CRCERR[0]  
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
Default  
The CRCERR[7:0], together with the CRCERR[9:8], represent the number of the CRC errors and update every second. The CRCERR[0] is the  
LSB.  
159  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 FRMP CRC Error Counter-MSB / Timeslot16 Extra Bits (03AH, 0BAH, 13AH, 1BAH, 23AH, 2BAH, 33AH, 3BAH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
OVR  
R
6
5
X[0]  
R
4
Y
R
X
3
X[1]  
R
2
X[2]  
R
1
0
NEWDATA  
CRCERR[9] CRCERR[8]  
R
0
R
X
R
X
Default  
0
X
X
X
OVR:  
The overwritten means that the data is still written into the CRCERR[9:0] (b1~0, E1-03AH & b7~0, E1-039H) without the data being read in the  
latest one second interval.  
= 0: the CRCERR[9:0] (b1~0, E1-03AH & b7~0, E1-039H) are not overwritten.  
= 1: the CRCERR[9:0] (b1~0, E1-03AH & b7~0, E1-039H) are overwritten.  
This bit is clear to 0 after it is read.  
NEWDATA:  
= 0: the value in the CRCERR[9:0] (b1~0, E1-03AH & b7~0, E1-039H) has not been updated with new value.  
= 1: the value in the CRCERR[9:0] (b1~0, E1-03AH & b7~0, E1-039H) has been updated with new value.  
This bit is clear to 0 after it is read. This bit can be polled to determine the 1 second timing boundary used by the Frame Processor.  
X[0:2], Y:  
Directly reflect the content in the Extra bits (X[0:2]) and the Remote Signaling Multi-frame Alarm bit (Y) in Frame0 of TS16 of the latest received  
Signaling Multi-Frame. They are updated on the generation of the IFPI interrupt on NFAS frames. Note that these bits are not updated when the  
received data stream is out of Basic Frame. The position of the X[2:0] and Y bit is shown in the following table:  
the Eight Bits in TS16  
Frame 0  
0
0
1
0
2
0
3
0
4
X[0]  
5
Y
6
X[1]  
7
X[2]  
CRCERR[9:8]:  
The CRCERR[9:8], together with the CRCERR[7:0], represent the number of the CRC errors and update every second. The CRCERR[9] is the  
MSB.  
160  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 FRMP National Bit Codeword Interrupt Enables (03BH, 0BBH, 13BH, 1BBH, 23BH, 2BBH, 33BH, 3BBH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
SaSEL[2]  
R/W  
6
SaSEL[1]  
R/W  
5
SaSEL[0]  
R/W  
4
Sa4E  
R/W  
0
3
Sa5E  
R/W  
0
2
Sa6E  
R/W  
0
1
Sa7E  
R/W  
0
0
Sa8E  
R/W  
0
Default  
0
0
0
SaSEL[2:0]:  
The SaSEL[2:0] select the National Bit Codeword (SaX) to appear in the SaX[1:4] (b3~0, E1-03DH) of the National Bit Codeword register.  
SaSEL[2:0]  
001  
National Bit Codeword  
010  
Reserved  
011  
100  
101  
110  
111  
Sa4  
Sa5  
Sa6  
Sa7  
Sa8  
000  
Sa4E, Sa5E, Sa6E, Sa7E, Sa8E:  
= 0 (in any of the 5 bits): disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the value is changed in its corresponding SaX[1:4] (b3~0, E1-03DH).  
= 1 (in any of the 5 bits): enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the value is changed in its corresponding SaX[1:4] (b3~0, E1-03DH) (X is 4  
through 8).  
The interrupt enable should be logic 0 for any bit receiving a HDLC data link.  
E1 FRMP National Bit Codeword Interrupts(03CH, 0BCH, 13CH, 1BCH, 23CH, 2BCH, 33CH, 3BCH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
Sa4I  
R
3
Sa5I  
R
2
Sa6I  
R
1
Sa7I  
R
0
Sa8I  
R
Reserved  
Default  
X
X
X
X
X
Sa4I, Sa5I, Sa6I, Sa7I, Sa8I:  
= 0 (in any of the 5 bits): the value is not changed in its corresponding SaX[1:4] (b3~0, E1-03DH) bits (X is 4 through 8).  
= 1 (in any of the 5 bits): the value is changed in its corresponding SaX[1:4] (b3~0, E1-03DH) bits (X is 4 through 8).  
This bit is clear to 0 after the register is read.  
161  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 FRMP National Bit Codeword (03DH, 0BDH, 13DH, 1BDH, 23DH, 2BDH, 33DH, 3BDH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
SaX[1]  
R
2
SaX[2]  
R
1
SaX[3]  
R
0
SaX[4]  
R
Reserved  
Default  
X
X
X
X
These bits directly reflect the content in the SaX nibble codeword of the CRC Sub Multi-Frame. “X” is determined by the SaSEL[2:0] (b7~5, E1-  
03BH). SaX[1] is the first SaX bit of the Sub Multi-Frame and analogically. The SaX[1:4] are debounced. They are updated only when two consecutive  
codewords are the same.  
E1 FRMP Frame Pulse/Alarm/V5.2 Link ID Interrupt Enables(03EH, 0BEH, 13EH, 1BEH, 23EH, 2BEH, 33EH, 3BEH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
OOOFE  
R/W  
0
6
RAICCRCE  
R/W  
5
CFEBEE  
R/W  
4
V52LINKE  
R/W  
3
2
ICSMFPE  
R/W  
1
ICMFPE  
R/W  
0
0
ISMFPE  
R/W  
0
IFPE  
R/W  
0
Default  
0
0
0
0
OOOFE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the OOOFI (b7, E1-03FH) is logic one.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the OOOFI (b7, E1-03FH) is logic one.  
RAICCRCE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the remote alarm (logic 1 in A bit) and the FEBE (logic 0 in bit E1 or E2) being existed for a period  
of 10ms.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the remote alarm (logic 1 in A bit) and the FEBE (logic 0 in bit E1 or E2) being existed for a period of  
10ms.  
CFEBEE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the FEBE (logic 0 in bit E1 or E2) has existed for more than 990 occasions in each second for 5  
consecutive seconds.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the FEBE (logic 0 in bit E1 or E2) has existed for more than 990 occasions in each second for 5  
consecutive seconds.  
V52LINKE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the V52LINKI is logic one.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the V52LINKI (b4, E1-03FH) is logic one.  
IFPE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the first bit of each basic frame is received.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the first bit of each basic frame is received.  
ICSMFPE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the first bit of each CRC sub-multi-frame is received.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the first bit of each CRC sub-multi-frame is received.  
ICMFPE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the first bit of each CRC multi-frame is received.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the first bit of each CRC multi-frame is received.  
ISMFPE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the first bit of each signaling multi-frame is received.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the first bit of each signaling multi-frame is received.  
162  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 FRMP Frame Pulse / Alarm Interrupts (03FH, 0BFH, 13FH, 1BFH, 23FH, 2BFH, 33FH, 3BFH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
IFPI  
R
2
1
0
OOOFI  
RAICCRCI  
CFEBEI  
V52LINKI  
ICSMFPI  
ICMFPI  
ISMFPI  
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
Default  
X
The bits of this register are clear to 0 after the register is read.  
OOOFI:  
= 0: there is no transition (from 0 to 1 or from I to 0) on the OOOFV (b3, E1-036H).  
= 1: there is a transition (from 0 to 1 or from I to 0) on the OOOFV (b3, E1-036H).  
RAICCRCI:  
= 0: there is no transition from normal operation to the remote alarm (logic 1 in A bit) or the FEBE (logic 0 in bit E1 or E2) has being absent for a  
period of 10ms.  
= 1: there is a transition from normal operation to the remote alarm (logic 1 in A bit) and the FEBE (logic 0 in bit E1 or E2) has being existed for a  
period of 10ms.  
CFEBEI:  
= 0: there is no transition from normal operation to FEBE (logic 0 in bit E1 or E2) existed for more than 990 occasions in each second for 5  
consecutive seconds.  
= 1: there is a transition from normal operation to FEBE (logic 0 in bit E1 or E2) existed for more than 990 occasions in each second for 5  
consecutive seconds.  
V52LINKI:  
= 0: there is no transition (from 0 to 1 or from 1 to 0) on the V52LINKV (b0, E1-036H).  
= 1: there is a transition (from 0 to 1 or from 1 to 0) on the V52LINKV (b0, E1-036H).  
IFPI:  
= 0: the received bit is not the first bit of each Basic Frame.  
= 1: the first bit of each Basic Frame is received.  
ICSMFPI:  
= 0: the received bit is not the first bit of each CRC sub-Multi-Frame.  
= 1: the first bit of each CRC sub-Multi-Frame is received.  
ICMFPI:  
= 0: the received bit is not the first bit of each CRC multi-frame.  
= 1: the first bit of each CRC multi-frame is received.  
ISMFPI:  
= 0: the received bit is not the first bit of each Signaling Multi-Frame.  
= 1: the first bit of each Signaling Multi-Frame is received.  
163  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 FRMG Configuration (040H, 0C0H, 140H, 1C0H, 240H, 2C0H, 340H, 3C0H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
FRESH  
R/W  
0
6
SIGEN  
R/W  
1
5
DLEN  
R/W  
1
4
GENCRC  
R/W  
3
FDIS  
R/W  
0
2
FEBEDIS  
R/W  
1
INDIS  
R/W  
0
0
XDIS  
R/W  
0
Default  
0
0
FRESH:  
= 0: normal operation.  
= 1: initiate the FIFO in the Frame Generator block.  
After initialization of the backplane interface, the user should write 1 into this bit and then clear it.  
SIGEN, DLEN:  
These two bits select the signaling sources for TS16. They are valid when the AIS (b0, E1-041H) is logic 0:  
SIGEN, DLEN  
0 0  
Signaling Source  
Signaling insertion disabled or CCS enabled. TS16 data is taken directly from the input TSDn TS16 or from the THDLC if the  
THDLC selects this inserted position. The XDIS (b0, E1-040H) must also be set to logic 1 to disable the insertion of the extra  
bits in TS16 of frame 0.  
0 1  
0 1  
1 1  
Reserved  
Reserved  
CAS enabled. TS16 data is taken from either TSSIGn stream or from the TPLC Signaling/PCM Control byte as selected on a  
per-timeslot basis via the SIGSRC (b4, E1-TPLC-indirect registers - 61~7FH). However, the TS16 of Frame0 of Signaling Multi-  
Frame is overwritten by ‘0000X[0]YX[1]X[2]’.  
GENCRC:  
= 0: CRC Multi-Frame generation is disabled. Then the International Bits are replaced with the value contained in the Si[1:0] (b7~6, E1-042H) if  
the INDIS (b1, E1-040H) is enabled (logic 0), or, if the INDIS (b1, E1-040H) is not enabled, the international bits are taken directly from TSDn/MTSD.  
= 1: CRC Multi-Frame generation is enabled. When CRC Multi-Frame is generated, the international bits on the TSDn pin are replaced with CRC  
Multi-Frame alignment pattern and calculated CRC-4 bits. The CRC bits calculated during the transmission of the SMFn are transmitted in the  
following SMF (SMF n+1). If the FEBEDIS (b2, E1-040H) is enabled (logic 0), the FEBE indication is inserted in the E1 and E2 bit positions. The  
setting to 1 is valid when the FDIS (b3, E1-040H) and the INDIS (b1, E1-040H) are logic 0.  
FDIS:  
= 0: replace the data on the TS0 of FAS on the TSDn/MTSD pin with Basic Frame alignment sequence (FAS).  
= 1: keep the data on the TSDn/MTSD pin to pass through the Frame Generation transparently. The values in the control bits GENCRC (b4, E1-  
040H), FEBEDIS (b2, E1-040H) and INDIS (b1, E1-040H) are ignored.  
FEBEDIS:  
Valid when the FDIS (b3, E1-040H) and the INDIS (b1, E1-040H) are logic 0 and the GENCRC (b4, E1-040H) is logic 1.  
= 0: the international bit of frame 13 & 15 are for FEBE indication.  
= 1: FEBE indication is disabled.  
INDIS:  
= 0: enabled to replace the international bit.  
= 1: disable to replace the international bit. The value of the international bit is directly taken from the TSDn/MTSD or from the THDLC if the  
THDLC selects this inserted position.  
XDIS:  
Valid when FDIS (b3, E1-040H) is logic 0, and the SIGEN (b6, E1-040H) and the DLEN (b5, E1-040H) are logic 1.  
= 0: replace the extra bits with the setting in the X[2:0].  
= 1: ignore the setting in the X[2:0] bits. The value in the extra bits is taken from the TSDn/MTSD.  
164  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 FRMG Transmit Alarm / Diagnostic Control (041H, 0C1H, 141H, 1C1H, 241H, 2C1H, 341H, 3C1H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
MTRK  
R/W  
0
6
FPATINV  
R/W  
5
SPLRINV  
R/W  
4
SPATINV  
R/W  
3
REMAIS  
R/W  
0
2
MFAIS  
R/W  
0
1
TS16AIS  
R/W  
0
AIS  
R/W  
0
Default  
0
0
0
0
MTRK:  
Valid when the FDIS (b3, E1-040H) is logic 0 and the PCCE (b0, E1-060H) is 1.  
= 0: ignore the setting in the IDLE Code Byte register.  
= 1: replace the data on the TS1~15 & TS17~31 with the IDLE code. And when the SIGEN (b6, E1-040H) is logic 1, replace the data on the TS16  
with signaling; when the SIGEN (b6, E1-040H) is logic 0, replace the data on the TS16 with IDLE code.  
FPATINV:  
Valid when the FDIS (b3, E1-040H) is logic 0.  
= 0: disable the inversion of the FAS.  
= 1: enable the inversion of the FAS (from ‘0011011’ to ‘1100100’).  
SPLRINV:  
Valid when the FDIS (b3, E1-040H) is logic 0.  
= 0: disable the inversion of the 2nd bit of NFAS.  
= 1: enable the inversion of the 2nd bit of NFAS (from 1 to 0).  
SPATINV:  
Valid when the FDIS (b3, E1-040H) is logic 0 and the SIGEN (b6, E1-040H) & the DLEN (b5, E1-040H) are logic 1.  
= 0: disable the inversion of the Signaling Multi-Frame alignment signal.  
= 1: enable the inversion of the Signaling Multi-Frame alignment signal (from ‘0000’ to ‘1111’).  
REMAIS:  
Valid when the FDIS (b3, E1-040H) is logic 0.  
= 0: normal operation.  
= 1: force the 3rd bit of NFAS to be logic 1.  
MFAIS:  
Valid when the FDIS (b3, E1-040H) is logic 0.  
= 0: normal operation.  
= 1: force to transmit the Y bit as logic 1.  
TS16AIS:  
Valid when the FDIS (b3, E1-040H) is logic 0 and Signaling Multi-Frame generator is enabled.  
= 0: normal transmission.  
= 1: force to transmit all ones in TS16 unconditionally.  
AIS:  
= 0: normal transmission.  
= 1: force to transmit all ones on all timeslots unconditionally.  
165  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 FRMG International Bits Control (042H, 0C2H, 142H, 1C2H, 242H, 2C2H, 342H, 3C2H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Si[1]  
R/W  
1
Si[0]  
R/W  
1
Reserved  
Default  
Si[1:0]:  
Valid when the FDIS (b3, E1-040H) and the INDIS (b1, E1-040H) are logic 0.  
When CRC Multi-Frame generation is disabled (GENCRC is logic 0), the Si[1] and Si[0] bits can be programmed to any value and will be inserted  
into the first of each FAS frame and NFAS frame, respectively. When CRC Multi-Frame generation is enabled (GENCRC is logic 1), and FEBE  
indication is disabled (FEBEDIS is logic 1), the values programmed in the Si[1] and Si[0] bit positions are inserted into the E1 & E2 bit positions  
respectively. When GENCRC is logic 1 and FEBEDIS is logic 0, both Si[1] and Si[0] are ignored.  
E1 FRMG Extra Bits Control (043H, 0C3H, 143H, 1C3H, 243H, 2C3H, 343H, 3C3H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
X[0]  
R/W  
1
X[1]  
R/W  
1
X[2]  
R/W  
1
Reserved  
Reserved  
Default  
X[2:0]:  
Valid when the FDIS (b3, E1-040H), the XDIS (b0, E1-040H), the SIGEN (b6, E1-040H) and the DLEN (b5, E1-040H) are all logic 0.  
Replace the extra bits located in bits 5, 7 & 8 in TS16 of frame 0 of the Signaling Multi-Frame.  
166  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 FRMG Interrupt Enable (044H, 0C4H, 144H, 1C4H, 244H, 2C4H, 344H, 3C4H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
SIGMFE  
R/W  
3
FASE  
R/W  
0
2
1
SMFE  
R/W  
0
0
MFE  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Reserved  
(must be 0)  
Default  
0
SIGMFE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the SIGMFI (b4, E1-045H) is logic one.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the SIGMFI (b4, E1-045H) is logic one.  
FASE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the FASI (b3, E1-045H) is logic one.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the FASI (b3, E1-045H) is logic one.  
MFE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the MFI (b2, E1-045H) is logic one.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the MFI (b2, E1-045H) is logic one.  
SMFE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the SMFI (b1, E1-045H) is logic one.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the SMFI (b1, E1-045H) is logic one.  
167  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 FRMG Interrupt Status (045H, 0C5H, 145H, 1C5H, 245H, 2C5H, 345H, 3C5H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
FASI  
R
2
MFI  
R
1
SMFI  
R
0
SIGMFI  
Reserved  
R
X
Reserved  
Default  
X
X
X
The bits in this register are clear to 0 after the register is read.  
SIGMFI:  
Valid when the Signaling Multi-Frame is generated and coincides with the CRC Multi-Frame.  
= 0: not at the end of the first frame of a Signaling Multi-Frame.  
= 1: indicate the end of the first frame of a Signaling Multi-Frame.  
FASI:  
Valid when the Basic Frame is generated.  
= 0: not on the boundary of a FAS frame.  
= 1: indicate the boundary of a FAS frame.  
MFI:  
Valid when the CRC-4 Multi-Frame is generated.  
= 0: not at the end of the first frame of a CRC-4 Multi-Frame.  
= 1: indicate the end of the first frame of a CRC-4 Multi-Frame.  
SMFI:  
Valid when the CRC-4 Multi-Frame is generated.  
= 0: not at the end of the first frame of a CRC-4 Sub Multi-Frame.  
= 1: indicate the end of the first frame of a CRC-4 Sub Multi-Frame.  
168  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 FRMG National Bit Codeword Select (046H, 0C6H, 146H, 1C6H, 246H, 2C6H, 346H, 3C6H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
SaSEL[2]  
R/W  
6
SaSEL[1]  
R/W  
5
SaSEL[0]  
R/W  
4
3
2
1
0
Reserved  
Default  
0
0
0
SaSEL[2:0]:  
The SaSEL[2:0] select which National Bit Codeword (SaX) will be replaced by the SaX[1:4] (b3~0, E1-047H).  
SaSEL[2:0]  
000  
National Bit Codeword  
001  
Reserved  
010  
011  
100  
101  
110  
Sa4  
Sa5  
Sa6  
Sa7  
Sa8  
111  
E1 FRMG National Bit Codeword (047H, 0C7H, 147H, 1C7H, 247H, 2C7H, 347H, 3C7H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
SaX_EN[1]  
R/W  
6
SaX_EN[2]  
R/W  
5
SaX_EN[3]  
R/W  
4
SaX_EN[4]  
R/W  
3
2
1
SaX[3]  
R/W  
1
0
SaX[4]  
R/W  
1
SaX[1]  
R/W  
1
SaX[2]  
R/W  
1
Default  
0
0
0
0
SaX_ENn:  
Valid when the FDIS (b3, E1-040H) is logic 0, and the INDIS (b1, E1-040H) is logic 0.  
= 0: disable the corresponding bit in the SaX[1:4] to replace the national bit codeword selected by the SaSEL[2:0].  
= 1: enable the corresponding bit in the SaX[1:4] to replace the national bit codeword selected by the SaSEL[2:0].  
SaX[1:4]:  
These bits are the codeword to be inserted into a CRC-4 sub-multiframe.  
The setting in the SaX[1:4] will replace the national bits which are assigned by the SaSEL[2:0].  
If the code word is written during SMF I of a CRC-4 Multi-Frame, it will appear in the SaX[1:4] bits of SMF II of the same Multi-frame. If the code  
word is written during SMF II of a Multi-Frame, its contents will be latched internally and will appear in SMF I of the next Multi-Frame.  
169  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 RHDLC #1, #2, #3 Configuration (048H, 0C8H, 148H, 1C8H, 248H, 2C8H, 348H, 3C8H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
MEN  
R/W  
0
2
MM  
R/W  
0
1
TR  
R/W  
0
0
EN  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Default  
Selection of the RHDLC block (#1, #2, or #3) whose registers are visible on the microprocessor interface is done via the RHDLCSEL[1:0] (b7~6,  
E1-00AH).  
MEN, MM:  
The MEN & MM define the address matching mode:  
MEN  
0
1
MM  
X
0
Address Matching Mode  
No address matching is needed. All the HDLC data are stored in the FIFO.  
The HDLC data are stored in the FIFO when the first byte is all ones or the same as the setting in the PA[7:0] (b7~0,  
E1-04CH) or the SA[7:0] (b7~0, E1-04DH).  
1
1
The HDLC data are stored in the FIFO when the most significant 6 bits in the first byte are all ones or the same as the  
setting in the PA[7:2] (b7~2, E1-04CH)or the SA[7:2] (b7~2, E1-04DH).  
TR:  
= 0: Normal operation.  
= 1: force the RHDLC to immediately terminate the reception of the current data frame, empty the FIFO buffer, clear the interrupts and initiate a  
new HDLC search.  
This bit is clear to 0 after a rising and falling edge occur on the internal clock or after the register is read.  
EN:  
= 0: disable the operation of the RHDLC block and all the FIFO buffer and interrupts are cleared.  
= 1: enable the operation of the RHDLC block and the HDLC opening flag will be searched immediately.  
If the EN is set from logic 1 to logic 0 and back to logic 1, the RHDLC will immediately terminate the reception of the current data frame, empty  
the FIFO buffer, clear the interrupts and initiate a new HDLC search.  
170  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 RHDLC #1, #2, #3 Interrupt Control (049H, 0C9H, 149H, 1C9H, 249H, 2C9H, 349H, 3C9H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
INTC[6]  
R/W  
0
5
INTC[5]  
R/W  
0
4
INTC[4]  
R/W  
0
3
INTC[3]  
R/W  
0
2
INTC[2]  
R/W  
0
1
INTC[1]  
R/W  
0
0
INTC[0]  
R/W  
0
INTE  
R/W  
0
Default  
Selection of the RHDLC block (#1, #2, or #3) whose registers are visible on the microprocessor interface is done via the RHDLCSEL[1:0] (b7~6,  
E1-00AH).  
INTE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when there is a transition from 0 to 1 on the INTR (b0, E1-04AH).  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when there is a transition from 0 to 1 on the INTR (b0, E1-04AH).  
INTC[6:0]:  
These bits set the interrupt threshold point of the FIFO buffer. Exceeding the set point will cause an interrupt, and the interrupt will persist until the  
FIFO is empty. The set point is decimal 128 when the INTC[6:0] is all zeros.  
The contents of this register should only be changed when the EN (b0, E1-048H) is logic 0. This prevents any erroneous interrupt generation.  
171  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 RHDLC #1, #2, #3 Status (04AH, 0CAH, 14AH, 1CAH, 24AH, 2CAH, 34AH, 3CAH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
FE  
R
6
OVR  
R
5
COLS  
R
4
PKIN  
R
3
PBS[2]  
R
2
PBS[1]  
R
1
PBS[0]  
R
0
INTR  
R
Default  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Selection of the RHDLC block (#1, #2, or #3) whose registers are visible on the microprocessor interface is done via the RHDLCSEL[1:0] (b7~6,  
E1-00AH).  
FE:  
= 0: the FIFO is loaded with data.  
= 1: the FIFO is empty.  
OVR:  
The overwritten condition occurs when data are written over unread data in the FIFO buffer. This bit is cleared to 0 after the register is read.  
= 0: no overwriting occurs.  
= 1: the FIFO is overwritten, and then the FIFO is reset , which cause the COLS and PKIN to be reset to logic 0.  
COLS:  
This bit reflects the HDLC link status change.  
= 0: normal operation.  
= 1: the first HDLC opening flag sequence (7E) activated the HDLC or the HDLC abort sequence (7F) deactivated the HDLC is detected.  
This bit is cleared to 0 after the bit is read, or after the OVR transits to be logic 1, or after the EN is clear.  
PKIN:  
= 0: a HDLC packet has not been written into the FIFO.  
= 1: a HDLC packet has been written into the FIFO.  
This bit is cleared to 0 after the bit is read, or after the OVR transitions to logic 1.  
PBS[2:0]:  
The PBS[2:0] indicate the status of the last byte read from the FIFO.  
PBS[2:0]  
Status of the Data  
000  
001  
010  
011  
100  
Normal data  
A dummy byte to indicate the first HDLC opening flag sequence (7E) was detected, which means the HDLC link became active.  
A dummy byte to indicate the HDLC abort sequence (7F) was detected, which means the HDLC link became inactive.  
Reserved.  
The last byte of a non-aborted HDLC packet was received. The HDLC packet is in an integer number of bytes and has no FCS  
error..  
101  
110  
111  
The last byte of a non-aborted HDLC packet was received and a non-integer number of bytes are in the packet.  
The last byte of a non-aborted HDLC packet was received. The HDLC packet is in an integer number of bytes and has FCS errors.  
The last byte of a non-aborted HDLC packet was received. The HDLC packet is in a non-integer number of bytes and has FCS  
errors..  
INTR:  
= 0: no interrupt sources in the HDLC Receiver block occurs  
= 1: any one of the interrupt sources in the HDLC Receiver block occurs. The interrupt sources in the HDLC Receiver are: 1. Receiving the first  
7E opening flag sequence which activates the HDLC link; 2. A packet was received; 3. Change of link status; 4. Exceeding the set point of the FIFO  
which is defined in the INTC[6:0] (b6~0, E1-049H); 5. Over-writting the FIFO.  
This bit is cleared to 0 after the bit is read.  
172  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 RHDLC #1, #2, #3 Data (04BH, 0CBH, 14BH, 1CBH, 24BH, 2CBH, 34BH, 3CBH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
RD[7]  
R
6
RD[6]  
R
5
RD[5]  
R
4
RD[4]  
R
3
RD[3]  
R
2
RD[2]  
R
1
RD[1]  
R
0
RD[0]  
R
Default  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Selection of the RHDLC block (#1, #2, or #3) whose registers are visible on the microprocessor interface is done via the RHDLCSEL[1:0] (b7~6,  
E1-00AH).  
RD[7:0]:  
This register represents the bytes read from the FIFO. This register should not be accessed at a rate greater than 1/15 of the XCK rate.  
The RD[0] corresponds to the first bit of the serial received data from the FIFO.  
E1 RHDLC #1, #2, #3 Primary Address Match (04CH, 0CCH, 14CH, 1CCH, 24CH, 2CCH, 34CH, 3CCH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PA[7]  
R/W  
1
PA[6]  
R/W  
1
PA[5]  
R/W  
1
PA[4]  
R/W  
1
PA[3]  
R/W  
1
PA[2]  
R/W  
1
PA[1]  
R/W  
1
PA[0]  
R/W  
1
Default  
Selection of the RHDLC block (#1, #2, or #3) whose registers are visible on the microprocessor interface is done via the RHDLCSEL[1:0] (b7~6,  
E1-00AH).  
PA[7:0]:  
These bits stipulate the primary address pattern.  
PA[0] stores the first bit of the serial data.  
E1 RHDLC #1, #2, #3 Secondary Address Match (04DH, 0CDH, 14DH, 1CDH, 24DH, 2CDH, 34DH, 3CDH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
SA[7]  
R/W  
1
6
SA[6]  
R/W  
1
5
SA[5]  
R/W  
1
4
SA[4]  
R/W  
1
3
SA[3]  
R/W  
1
2
SA[2]  
R/W  
1
1
SA[1]  
R/W  
1
0
SA[0]  
R/W  
1
Default  
Selection of the RHDLC block (#1, #2, or #3) whose registers are visible on the microprocessor interface is done via the RHDLCSEL[1:0] (b7~6,  
E1-00AH).  
SA[7:0]:  
These bits stipulate the secondary address pattern.  
SA[0] stores the first bit of the serial data.  
173  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 THDLC #1, #2, #3 Configuration(050H, 0D0H, 150H, 1D0H, 250H, 2D0H, 350H, 3D0H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
FLGSHARE  
R/W  
6
FIFOCLR  
R/W  
5
4
3
EOM  
R/W  
0
2
1
0
EN  
R/W  
0
ABT  
R/W  
0
CRC  
R/W  
1
Reserved  
Default  
1
0
Selection of the THDLC block (#1, #2, or #3) whose registers are visible on the microprocessor interface is done via the THDLCSEL[1:0] (b5~4,  
E1-00AH).  
FLGSHARE:  
= 0: the opening flag of the next HDLC frame and closing flag of the current HDLC frame are separate.  
= 1: the opening flag of the next HDLC frame and closing flag of the current HDLC frame are shared  
FIFOCLR:  
= 0: normal operation.  
= 1: clear the FIFO.  
EOM:  
= 0: normal operation.  
= 1: a positive transition of this bit starts a packet transmission. Then if the CRC(b1, E1-050H) is set, the 16-bit FCS word is appended to the last  
data byte transmitted.  
ABT:  
= 0: normal operation.  
= 1: transmit the 7F abort sequence after the current setting in the Transmit Data register is transmitted, so that the FIFO is cleared and all data in  
the FIFO will be lost.  
Aborts are continuously sent and the FIFO is held in reset until this bit is reset to a logic 0. At least one Abort sequence will be sent when the ABT  
transitions from logic 0 to logic 1.  
CRC:  
= 0: do not append the CRC-16 frame check sequences (FCS) to the end of the HDLC data.  
= 1: append the FCS to the end of the HDLC data.  
EN:  
= 0: disable the operation of the THDLC block.  
= 1: enable the operation of the THDLC block and flag sequences are sent until data is written into the THDLC Transmit Data register and the  
EOM is set to logic 1.  
174  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 THDLC #1, #2, #3 Upper Transmit Threshold (051H, 0D1H, 151H, 1D1H, 251H, 2D1H, 351H, 3D1H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
UTHR[6]  
R/W  
5
UTHR[5]  
R/W  
4
UTHR[4]  
R/W  
3
UTHR[3]  
R/W  
2
UTHR[2]  
R/W  
1
UTHR[1]  
R/W  
0
UTHR[0]  
R/W  
Reserved  
Default  
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
Selection of the THDLC block (#1, #2, or #3) whose registers are visible on the microprocessor interface is done via the THDLCSEL[1:0] (b5~4,  
E1-00AH).  
UTHR[6:0]:  
These bits define the upper fill level of the FIFO. Once the fill level exceeds the UTHR[6:0] value, the data stored in the FIFO will start to transmit.  
The transmission will not stop until the complete packet is transmitted and the THDLC FIFO fill level is below UTHR[6:0] + 1.  
It should be greater than the value of the LINT[6:0] unless both are equal to 00H.  
E1 THDLC #1, #2, #3 Lower Interrupt Threshold(052H, 0D2H, 152H, 1D2H, 252H, 2D2H, 352H, 3D2H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
LINT[6]  
R/W  
0
5
LINT[5]  
R/W  
0
4
LINT[4]  
R/W  
0
3
LINT[3]  
R/W  
0
2
LINT[2]  
R/W  
1
1
LINT[1]  
R/W  
1
0
LINT[0]  
R/W  
1
Reserved  
Default  
Selection of the THDLC block (#1, #2, or #3) whose registers are visible on the microprocessor interface is done via the THDLCSEL[1:0] (b5~4,  
E1-00AH).  
LINT[6:0]:  
These bits define the fill level of the FIFO that can cause an interrupt. That is, when the fill level of the FIFO is below the LINT[6:0], an interrupt will  
be generated. The LINT[6:0] should be less than the value of the UTHR[6:0] unless both are equal to 00H.  
175  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 THDLC #1, #2, #3 Interrupt Enable(053H, 0D3H, 153H, 1D3H, 253H, 2D3H, 353H, 3D3H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
FULLE  
R/W  
0
2
OVRE  
R/W  
0
1
UDRE  
R/W  
0
0
LFILLE  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Default  
Selection of the THDLC block (#1, #2, or #3) whose registers are visible on the microprocessor interface is done via the THDLCSEL[1:0] (b5~4,  
E1-00AH).  
FULLE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the FULLI (b3, E1-054H) is logic 1.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the FULLI (b3, E1-054H) is logic 1.  
OVRE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the OVRI (b2, E1-054H) is logic 1.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the OVRI (b2, E1-054H) is logic 1.  
UDRE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the UDRI (b1, E1-054H) is logic 1.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the UDRI (b1, E1-054H) is logic 1.  
LFILLE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the LFILLI (b0, E1-054H) is logic 1.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the LFILLI (b0, E1-054H) is logic 1.  
176  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 THDLC #1, #2, #3 Interrupt Status / UDR Clear(054H, 0D4H, 154H, 1D4H, 254H, 2D4H, 354H, 3D4H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
FULL  
R
5
BLFILL  
R
4
3
FULLI  
R
2
OVRI  
R
1
UDRI  
R
0
LFILLI  
R
Reserved  
Reserved  
Default  
X
X
X
X
X
X
Selection of the THDLC block (#1, #2, or #3) whose registers are visible on the microprocessor interface is done via the THDLCSEL[1:0] (b5~4,  
E1-00AH).  
FULL:  
= 0: the THDLC FIFO is not full.  
= 1: the THDLC FIFO is full (128 bytes).  
BLFILL:  
= 0: the fill level in the THDLC FIFO is not below the value of the LINT[6:0] (b6~0, E1-052H).  
= 1: the fill level in the THDLC FIFO is empty or below the value of the LINT[6:0] (b6~0, E1-052H).  
FULLI:  
= 0: there is no transition (from 0 to 1) on the FULL.  
= 1: there is a transition (from 0 to 1) on the FULL.  
This bit is cleared to 0 after the bit is read.  
OVRI:  
The Over-Written is that the THDLC FIFO was already full when another data byte was written to the THDLC Transmit Data register.  
= 0: the THDLC FIFO is not overwritten.  
= 1: the THDLC FIFO is overwritten.  
This bit is cleared to 0 after the bit is read.  
UDRI:  
The Under-Run is that the THDLC was in the process of transmitting a packet when it ran out of data to be transmitted.  
= 0: the THDLC FIFO is not under-run.  
= 1: the THDLC FIFO is under-run.  
This bit is cleared to 0 after the bit is read.  
LFILLI:  
= 0: there is no transition (from 0 to 1) on the BLFILL.  
= 1: there is a transition (from 0 to 1) on the BLFILL.  
This bit is cleared to 0 after the bit is read.  
177  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 THDLC #1, #2, #3 Transmit Data(055H, 0D5H, 155H, 1D5H, 255H, 2D5H, 355H, 3D5H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
TD[7]  
R/W  
X
6
TD[6]  
R/W  
X
5
TD[5]  
R/W  
X
4
TD[4]  
R/W  
X
3
TD[3]  
R/W  
X
2
TD[2]  
R/W  
X
1
TD[1]  
R/W  
X
0
TD[0]  
R/W  
X
Default  
Selection of the THDLC block (#1, #2, or #3) whose registers are visible on the microprocessor interface is done via the THDLCSEL[1:0] (b5~4,  
E1-00AH).  
The content is the data to be transmitted. It is serially transmitted (TD[0] is the first).  
E1 ELSB Interrupt Enable / Status(059H, 0D9H, 159H, 1D9H, 259H, 2D9H, 359H, 3D9H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
SLIPE  
R/W  
0
1
SLIPD  
R
0
SLIPI  
R
Reserved  
Default  
X
X
SLIPE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when a slip occurs.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when a slip occurs.  
SLIPD:  
This bit makes sense only when the SLIPI is logic 1.  
= 0: the latest slip is due to the Elastic Store Buffer being empty; a frame was duplicated.  
= 1: the latest slip is due to the Elastic Store Buffer being full; a frame was deleted.  
SLIPI:  
= 0: no slip occurs.  
= 1: a slip occurs.  
This bit is cleared to 0 after the bit is read.  
E1 ELSB Idle Code (05AH, 0DAH, 15AH, 1DAH, 25AH, 2DAH, 35AH, 3DAH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
D7  
R/W  
1
6
D6  
R/W  
1
5
D5  
R/W  
1
4
D4  
R/W  
1
3
D3  
R/W  
1
2
D2  
R/W  
1
1
D1  
R/W  
1
0
D0  
R/W  
1
Default  
These bits set the idle code that will replace the data on the RSDn/MRSD when it is out of Basic Frame and the TRKEN (b1, E1-001H) is logic 1.  
D7 is the first bit to be inserted.  
The writing of the idle code pattern is asynchronous with respect to the output data clock. One timeslot of idle code data will be corrupted if the  
register is written to when the framer is out of frame.  
178  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 RPLC Configuration (05CH, 0DCH, 15CH, 1DCH, 25CH, 2DCH, 35CH, 3DCH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PCCE  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Default  
PCCE:  
= 0: the per-TS functions in RPLC are disabled.  
= 1: the per-TS functions in RPLC are enabled.  
E1 RPLC mP Access Status (05DH, 0DDH, 15DH, 1DDH, 25DH, 2DDH, 35DH, 3DDH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
BUSY  
R
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reserved  
Default  
0
BUSY:  
= 0: no reading or writing operation on the indirect registers.  
= 1: an internal indirect register is being accessed, any new operation on the internal indirect register is not allowed.  
This bit goes low timed to an internal high-speed clock rising edge after the operation has been completed. The operation cycle is 490ns. No  
operations to the indirect registers are possible until this bit is logic 0.  
179  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 RPLC Channel Indirect Address / Control (05EH, 0DEH, 15EH, 1DEH, 25EH, 2DEH, 35EH, 3DEH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
R/WB  
R/W  
0
6
A6  
R/W  
0
5
A5  
R/W  
0
4
A4  
R/W  
0
3
A3  
R/W  
0
2
A2  
R/W  
0
1
A1  
R/W  
0
0
A0  
R/W  
0
Default  
Writing to this register with a valid address and R/WB bit initiates an internal operation cycle to the indirect registers.  
R/WB:  
= 0: write the data to the specified indirect register.  
= 1: read the data from the specified indirect register.  
A[6:0]:  
Specify the address of the indirect registers (from 20H to 7FH) for the microprocessor access.  
E1 RPLC Channel Indirect Data Buffer (05FH, 0DFH, 15FH, 1DFH, 25FH, 2DFH, 35FH, 3DFH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
D7  
R/W  
0
6
D6  
R/W  
0
5
D5  
R/W  
0
4
D4  
R/W  
0
3
D3  
R/W  
0
2
D2  
R/W  
0
1
D1  
R/W  
0
0
D0  
R/W  
0
Default  
This register hold the value which will be read from or write into the indirect registers (from 20H to 7FH). If data is to be written to the indirect  
registers, the byte to be written must be written into this register before the target indirect register’s address and R/WB=0 is written into the Address/  
Control register, initiating the access. If data is to be read from the indirect registers, only the target indirect register’s address and R/WB=1 is written  
into the Address/Control register, initiating the request. After 490 ns, this register will contain the requested data byte.  
RPLC Indirect Registers Map  
20H~3FH  
40H~5FH  
61H ~ 7FH  
Per-TS Configuration Byte for TS0 ~ TS31  
Data Trunk Conditioning Code Byte for TS0 ~ TS31  
Signaling Trunk Conditioning Byte for TS1 ~ TS31  
180  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 RPLC Per-TS Configuration Registers (RPLC Indirect Registers 20H – 3FH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
TEST  
R/W  
X
6
5
STRKC  
R/W  
X
4
3
DMWALAW  
R/W  
2
SIGNINV  
R/W  
1
RINV[1]  
R/W  
X
0
RINV[0]  
R/W  
X
DTRKC/NxTS  
DMW  
R/W  
X
R/W  
X
Default  
X
X
TEST:  
= 0: disable the data in the corresponding timeslot to be tested by PRGD.  
= 1: enable the data in the corresponding timeslot to be extracted to PRGD for test (when the RXPATGEN [b2, E1-00CH] is logic 0), or enable the  
test pattern from PRGD to replace the data in the corresponding timeslot for test (when the RXPATGEN [b2, E1-00CH] is logic 1).  
All the timeslots that are extracted to the PRGD are concatenated and treated as a continuous stream in which pseudo random are searched for.  
Similarly, all timeslots set to be replaced with PRGD test pattern data are concatenated replaced by the PRBS.  
DTRKC/NxTS:  
= 0: disable the data in the corresponding timeslot to be replaced by the data set in the DTRK[7:0] (b7~0, E1-RPLC-indirect registers-40~5FH)  
when output on the RSDn/MRSD pin.  
= 1: enable the data in the corresponding timeslot to be replaced by the data set in the DTRK[7:0] (b7~0, E1-RPLC-indirect registers-40~5FH)  
when output on the RSDn/MRSD pin.  
In addition, it controls the RSCKn of the corresponding timeslot in Receive Clock Slave Fractional E1 mode:  
= 0: RSCKn is clocked for the corresponding timeslot.  
= 1: RSCKn is held in its inactive state.  
STRKC:  
= 0: disable the signaling of the corresponding timeslot to be replaced by the data set in the A, B, C, D (b3~0, E1-RPLC-indirect registers-  
61~7FH) when output on the RSSIGn/MRSSIG pin.  
= 1: enable the signaling of the corresponding timeslot to be replaced by the data set in the A, B, C, D (b3~0, E1-RPLC-indirect registers-  
61~7FH) when output on the RSSIGn/MRSSIG pin.  
DMW:  
= 0: disallow the data in the corresponding timeslot to be replaced by a digital milliwatt pattern when output on the RSDn/MRSD pin.  
= 1: enable the data in the corresponding timeslot to be replaced by a digital milliwatt pattern when output on the RSDn/MRSD pin.  
DMWALAW:  
= 0: the milliwatt pattern is the m-Law pattern.  
= 1: the milliwatt pattern is the A-Law pattern.  
SIGNINV, RINV[1:0]:  
The SIGNINV and the RINV[1:0] bits select the bits in the corresponding timeslot to be inverted when output on the RSDn/MRSD pin:  
SIGNINV  
RINV[1:0]  
0 0  
0 1  
1 0  
1 1  
0 0  
0 1  
1 0  
1 1  
Bits Inverted  
No inversion  
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
Invert the even bits (2, 4, 6, 8) of the timeslot (bit 1 is the MSB)  
Invert the odd bits (1, 3, 5, 7) of the timeslot (bit 1 is the MSB)  
Invert all the bits of the timeslot  
Invert the bit 1 (MSB) of the timeslot  
Invert the bits 1, 2, 4, 6 and 8 of the timeslot  
Invert the bits 3, 5 and 7 of the timeslot  
Invert all the bits of the timeslot except the MSB (bit1)  
The priority of the RPLC operation on the RSDn pin from high to low is:  
Extract data to PRGD for test; Replace the data with the value in the DTRK[7:0]; Replace the data with the milliwatt pattern; Replace the data with  
the pattern generated in the PRGD; Invert the bit.  
181  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 RPLC Data Trunk Conditioning Code Byte Registers (RPLC Indirect Registers 40H – 5FH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
DTRK7  
R/W  
X
6
DTRK6  
R/W  
X
5
DTRK5  
R/W  
X
4
DTRK4  
R/W  
X
3
DTRK3  
R/W  
X
2
DTRK2  
R/W  
X
1
DTRK1  
R/W  
X
0
DTRK0  
R/W  
X
Default  
They contain the data that will replace the data output on the RSDn/MRSD pin when the corresponding bit DTRKC/NxTS (b6, E1-RPLC-indirect  
registers-20~3FH) is logic 1. The DTRK7 is the MSB.  
E1 RPLC Signaling Trunk Conditioning Byte Registers (RPLC Indirect Registers 61H – 7FH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
A
R/W  
X
2
B
R/W  
X
1
C
R/W  
X
0
D
R/W  
X
Reserved  
Default  
These bits contain the data that will replace the data output on the RSSIGn/MRSSIG pin when the corresponding STRKC (b5, E1-RPLC-indirect  
registers-20~3FH) is logic 1. They are in the least significant nibble.  
182  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 TPLC Configuration (060H, 0E0H, 160H, 1E0H, 260H, 2E0H, 360H, 3E0H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PCCE  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Default  
PCCE:  
= 0: the per-TS functions in TPLC are disabled.  
= 1: the per-TS functions in TPLC are enabled.  
E1 TPLC mP Access Status (061H, 0E1H, 161H, 1E1H, 261H, 2E1H, 361H, 3E1H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
BUSY  
R
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reserved  
Default  
0
BUSY:  
= 0: no reading or writing operation on the indirect registers.  
= 1: an internal indirect register is being accessed, any new operation on the internal indirect register is not allowed.  
This bit goes low timed to an internal high-speed clock rising edge after the operation has been completed. The operation cycle is 490ns. No  
more operations to the indirect registers could be done until this bit is cleared.  
183  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 TPLC Channel Indirect Address / Control (062H, 0E2H, 162H, 1E2H, 262H, 2E2H, 362H, 3E2H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
R/WB  
R/W  
0
6
A6  
R/W  
0
5
A5  
R/W  
0
4
A4  
R/W  
0
3
A3  
R/W  
0
2
A2  
R/W  
0
1
A1  
R/W  
0
0
A0  
R/W  
0
Default  
Writing to this register with a valid address and R/WB bit initiates an internal operation cycle to the indirect registers.  
R/WB:  
= 0: write the data to the specified indirect register.  
= 1: read the data from the specified indirect register.  
A[6:0]:  
Specify the address of the indirect registers (from 20H to 7FH) for the microprocessor access.  
E1 TPLC Channel Indirect Data Buffer (063H, 0E3H, 163H, 1E3H, 263H, 2E3H, 363H, 3E3H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
D7  
R/W  
0
6
D6  
R/W  
0
5
D5  
R/W  
0
4
D4  
R/W  
0
3
D3  
R/W  
0
2
D2  
R/W  
0
1
D1  
R/W  
0
0
D0  
R/W  
0
Default  
This register hold the value which will be read from or write into the indirect registers (from 20H to 7FH). If data are to be written to the indirect  
registers, the byte to be written must be written into this register before the target indirect register’s address and R/WB=0 is written into the Address/  
Control register, initiating the access. If data are to be read from the indirect registers, only the target indirect register’s address and R/WB=1 is  
written into the Address/Control register, initiating the request. After 490 ns, this register will contain the requested data byte.  
TPLC Indirect Registers Map  
20H~3FH  
40H~5FH  
61H~7FH  
Per-TS Control Byte for TS0 ~ TS31  
IDLE Code Byte for TS0 ~ TS31  
Signaling /PCM Control Byte for TS1 ~ TS31  
184  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 TPLC Per-TS Control Registers(TPLC Indirect Registers 20H – 3FH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
SUBS  
R/W  
X
6
5
4
3
TEST  
R/W  
X
2
LOOP  
R/W  
X
1
0
DS1  
R/W  
X
DS0  
R/W  
X
Reserved  
Reserved  
Default  
SUBS, DS1, DS0:  
The SUBS, DS[1:0] bits select one of the operation to the corresponding timeslot:  
SUBS  
DS[1]  
DS[0]  
OPERATION  
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
1
0
1
-
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
No change to the timeslot  
Invert the odd bits (1, 3, 5, 7) of the timeslot (bit 1 is the LSB)  
Invert the even bits (2, 4, 6, 8) of the timeslot (bit 8 is the MSB)  
Invert all the bits of the timeslot  
Replace the timeslot with the IDLE code  
Replace the timeslot with the A-law digital milliwatt pattern (per G.711)  
Replace the timeslot with the m-law digital milliwatt pattern (per G.711)  
0
1
TEST:  
= 0: disable the data in the corresponding timeslot to be tested by PRGD.  
= 1: enable the data in the corresponding timeslot to be extracted to PRGD for test (when the RXPATGEN [b2, E1-00CH] is logic 1), or enable the  
test pattern from PRGD to replace the data in the corresponding timeslot for test (when the RXPATGEN [b2, E1-00CH] is logic 0).  
All the timeslots that are extracted to the PRGD are concatenated and treated as a continuous stream in which pseudo random are searched for.  
Similarly, all timeslots set to be replaced with PRGD test pattern data are concatenated replaced by the PRBS.  
LOOP:  
= 0: disable the payload loopback.  
= 1: enable the payload loopback. When the Receive Clock Master modes are enabled, the Elastic Store is used to align the receive line data to  
the data to be transmitted. When Receive Clock Slave modes are enabled, the Elastic Store is unavailable to facilitate the payload loopbacks, and  
loopback functionality is provided only when the transmit path is also in Transmit Clock Slave mode, and the received clock and the clock to be  
transmitted and Common Frame Pulse are identical (RSCCK = TSCCKB, RSCFS = TSCFS).  
The priority of the TPLC operation on the TSDn pin from high to low is:  
Extract data to PRGD for test; Payload loopback; Replace the data with the milliwatt pattern; Replace the data with the pattern generated in the  
PRGD; Replace the data with the value in the IDLE[7:0]; Invert the even bits or/and odd bits.  
185  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 TPLC IDLE Code Byte Registers(TPLC Indirect Registers 40H – 5FH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
IDLE7  
R/W  
X
6
IDLE6  
R/W  
X
5
IDLE5  
R/W  
X
4
IDLE4  
R/W  
X
3
IDLE3  
R/W  
X
2
IDLE2  
R/W  
X
1
IDLE1  
R/W  
X
0
IDLE0  
R/W  
X
Default  
They contain the data that will replace the data input from the TSDn pin when the corresponding SUBS and DS[1:0] are allowed. IDLE7 is the  
MSB.  
E1 TPLC Signaling / PCM Control Byte Registers(TPLC Indirect Registers 61H – 7FH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
SIGSRC  
R/W  
3
A
R/W  
X
2
B
R/W  
X
1
C
R/W  
X
0
D
R/W  
X
Reserved  
Default  
X
SIGSRC:  
This bit is valid only if the Channel Associated Signaling (CAS) is selected in the E1 FRMG Configuration Register.  
= 0: use the data on the TSSIGn pin as the signaling.  
= 1: use the data in the A, B, C, D bits as the signaling.  
A, B, C, D:  
They contain the data that can be used as signaling when the corresponding SIGSRC is logic 1. They are in the least significant nibble.  
186  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 RCRB Configuration (COSS = 0) (064H, 0E4H, 164H, 1E4H, 264H, 2E4H, 364H, 3E4H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
COSS  
R/W  
0
5
4
3
2
1
0
PCCE  
R/W  
0
SIGE  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Reserved  
Default  
COSS:  
= 0: allow the RCRB registers to access the indirect registers.  
= 1: allow the RCRB registers to reflect the change of the signaling of its corresponding timeslot.  
SIGE:  
= 0: disable generation of an interrupt on the INT pin when there is a signaling change in any one of the 30 timeslots.  
= 1: enable generation of an interrupt on the INT pin when there is a signaling change in any one of the 30 timeslots.  
PCCE:  
= 0: the per-TS functions in RCRB are disabled.  
= 1: the per-TS functions in RCRB are enabled.  
E1 RCRB Timeslot Indirect Status (COSS = 0) (065H, 0E5H, 165H, 1E5H, 265H, 2E5H, 365H, 3E5H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
BUSY  
R
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reserved  
Default  
0
BUSY:  
= 0: no reading or writing operation on the indirect registers.  
= 1: an internal indirect register is being accessed, any new operation on the internal indirect register is not allowed.  
This bit goes low timed to an internal high-speed clock rising edge after the operation has been completed. The operation cycle is 490ns. No  
operations to the indirect registers can be done until this bit is cleared.  
187  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 RCRB Timeslot Indirect Address / Control (COSS = 0) (066H, 0E6H, 166H, 1E6H, 266H, 2E6H, 366H, 3E6H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
R/WB  
R/W  
0
6
A6  
R/W  
0
5
A5  
R/W  
0
4
A4  
R/W  
0
3
A3  
R/W  
0
2
A2  
R/W  
0
1
A1  
R/W  
0
0
A0  
R/W  
0
Default  
R/WB:  
= 0: write the data to the specified indirect register.  
= 1: read the data from the specified indirect register.  
A[6:0]:  
Specified the address of the indirect registers (from 20H to 5FH) for the microprocessor access.  
E1 RCRB Timeslot Indirect Data Buffer (COSS = 0) (067H, 0E7H, 167H, 1E7H, 267H, 2E7H, 367H, 3E7H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
D7  
R/W  
X
6
D6  
R/W  
X
5
D5  
R/W  
X
4
D4  
R/W  
X
3
D3  
R/W  
X
2
D2  
R/W  
X
1
D1  
R/W  
X
0
D0  
R/W  
X
Default  
This register holds the value which will be read from or written to the indirect registers (from 20H to 7FH). If data are to be written to the indirect  
registers, the byte to be written must be written into this register before the target indirect register’s address and R/WB=0 is written into the Address/  
Control register, initiating the access. If data are to be read from the indirect registers, only the target indirect register’s address and R/WB=1 is  
written into the Address/Control register, initiating the request. After 490 ns, this register will contain the requested data byte.  
188  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 RCRB Change of Signaling State (COSS = 1) (064H, 0E4H, 164H, 1E4H, 264H, 2E4H, 364H, 3E4H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
COSS  
R/W  
0
5
4
3
2
1
0
COSS[30]  
COSS[29]  
COSS[28]  
COSS[27]  
COSS[26]  
COSS[25]  
Reserved  
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
Default  
COSS:  
= 0: allow the RCRB registers to access the indirect registers.  
= 1: allow the RCRB registers to reflect the change of the signaling of its corresponding timeslot.  
COSSn:  
= 0: the signaling in its corresponding timeslot is not changed.  
= 1: the signaling in its corresponding timeslot is changed.  
These bits are cleared to 0 after the register is read. COSS[30:25] correspond to timeslots 31 to 26.  
E1 RCRB Change of Signaling State (COSS = 1) (065H, 0E5H, 165H, 1E5H, 265H, 2E5H, 365H, 3E5H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
COSS[24]  
COSS[23]  
COSS[22]  
COSS[21]  
COSS[20]  
COSS[19]  
COSS[18]  
COSS[17]  
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
Default  
COSSn:  
= 0: the signaling in its corresponding timeslot is not changed.  
= 1: the signaling in its corresponding timeslot is changed.  
These bits are cleared to 0 after the register is read. COSS[24:17] correspond to timeslots 25 to 18.  
E1 RCRB Change of Signaling State (COSS = 1) (066H, 0E6H, 166H, 1E6H, 266H, 2E6H, 366H, 3E6H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
COSS[16]  
COSS[15]  
COSS[14]  
COSS[13]  
COSS[12]  
COSS[11]  
COSS[10]  
COSS[9]  
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
Default  
COSSn:  
= 0: the signaling in its corresponding timeslot is not changed.  
= 1: the signaling in its corresponding timeslot is changed.  
These bits are cleared to 0 after the register is read. COSS[16] corresponds to timeslots 17. COSS[15:9] correspond to timeslot 15 to 9.  
E1 RCRB Change of Signaling State (COSS = 1) (067H, 0E7H, 167H, 1E7H, 267H, 2E7H, 367H, 3E7H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
COSS[8]  
COSS[7]  
COSS[6]  
COSS[5]  
COSS[4]  
COSS[3]  
COSS[2]  
COSS[1]  
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
Default  
COSSn:  
= 0: the signaling in its corresponding timeslot is not changed.  
= 1: the signaling in its corresponding timeslot is changed.  
These bits are cleared to 0 after the register is read. COSS[8:1] correspond to timeslots 8 to 1.  
189  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
RCRB Indirect Registers Map  
20H  
-
01H ~ 0FH / 21H ~ 2FH  
Signaling Data Register for TS1 ~ 15  
-
10H, 30H  
11H ~ 1FH / 31H ~ 3FH  
40H ~ 5FH  
Signaling Data Register for TS17 ~31  
TS0 ~ 31 Configuration Data  
E1 RCRB Timeslot / Channel Signaling Data Registers (COSS = 0) (RCRB Indirect Registers 01H - 1FH / 21H – 3FH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
A
R
X
2
B
R
X
1
C
R
X
0
D
R
X
Reserved  
Default  
A, B, C, D:  
They contain the signaling of the corresponding timeslot. The value for TS0 and TS16 are not valid.  
There is a maximum 2 ms delay between the transition of the COSS[n] bit (E1-064H & E1-065H & E1-066H & E1-067H) and the updating of the  
A, B, C, D code in the corresponding indirect registers 21H ~ 3FH. To avoid this 2ms delay, users can read the corresponding b3~0 in the indirect  
registers 01H ~ 1FH first. If the value of these four bits are different from the previous A, B, C, D code, then the content of b3~0 in the 01H ~ 1FH is  
the updated A, B, C, D code. If the conternt of the four bits is the same as the previous A, B, C, D code, then users should read the b3~0 in the 21H  
~ 3FH to get the updated A, B, C, D code.  
E1 RCRB Per-Timeslot Configuration Registers (COSS = 0) (RCRB Indirect Registers 40H – 5FH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DEB  
R/W  
X
Reserved  
Default  
DEB:  
= 0: disable signaling debounce.  
= 1: enable signaling debounce (valid only if the PCCE is logic 1). That is, the signaling is acknowledged only when 2 consecutive signaling of a  
timeslot are the same.  
190  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 PMON Interrupt Enable / Status (068H, 0E8H, 168H, 1E8H, 268H, 2E8H, 368H, 3E8H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
XFER  
R
0
OVR  
R
INTE  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Default  
0
0
INTE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the counter data has been transferred into the Error Count registers.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the counter data has been transferred into the Error Count registers.  
XFER:  
= 0: indicate that the counter data has not been transferred to the Error Count registers.  
= 1: indicate that the counter data has been transferred to the Error Count registers.  
This bit is clear to 0 after the bit is read.  
OVR:  
= 0: indicate that no overwritten on the Error Count registers has occurred.  
= 1: indicate that one of the Error Count registers is overwritten.  
This bit is clear to 0 after the bit is read.  
Registers 069H-06DH, 0E9H-0EDH, 16H-16DH, 1E9H-1EDH, 269H-26DH,2E9H-2EDH ,369H-36DH, 3E9H-3EDH:  
The PMON Error Count registers for a single framer are updated as a group by writing to any of the PMON count registers or updated every 1  
second when the AUTOUPDATE (b0, E1-000H) is set. The PMON Error Count registers for eight framers are updated by writing to the Chip ID/  
Global PMON Update register (E1-009H).  
When the chip is reset, the contents of the PMON Error Count registers are unknown until the first latching of performance data is performed.  
E1 PMON Framing Bit Error Count (069H, 0E9H, 169H, 1E9H, 269H, 2E9H, 369H, 3E9H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
FER[6]  
R
5
FER[5]  
R
4
FER[4]  
R
3
FER[3]  
R
2
FER[2]  
R
1
FER[1]  
R
0
FER[0]  
R
Reserved  
Default  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
These bits are valid when it is in the Basic Frame Sync. They represent the number of the basic frame alignment signal errors and update on the  
defined intervals. The basic frame alignment signal errors are defined in the WORDERR (b5, E1-000H) and the CNTNFAS (b4, E1-000H).  
191  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 PMON Far End Block Error Count LSB (06AH, 0EAH, 16AH, 1EAH, 26AH, 2EAH, 36AH, 3EAH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
FEBE[7]  
FEBE[6]  
FEBE[5]  
FEBE[4]  
FEBE[3]  
FEBE[2]  
FEBE[1]  
FEBE[0]  
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
Default  
E1 PMON Far End Block Error Count MSB (06BH, 0EBH, 16BH, 1EBH, 26BH, 2EBH, 36BH, 3EBH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
FEBE[9]  
FEBE[8]  
Reserved  
R
X
R
X
Default  
The FEBE[9:0] are valid when it is in the CRC Multi-Frame Sync. They represent the number of the Far End Block Errors (FEBE) and update on  
the defined intervals.  
E1 PMON CRC Error Count LSB (06CH, 0ECH, 16CH, 1ECH, 26CH, 2ECH, 36CH, 3ECH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
CRCE[7]  
CRCE[6]  
CRCE[5]  
CRCE[4]  
CRCE[3]  
CRCE[2]  
CRCE[1]  
CRCE[0]  
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
Default  
E1 PMON CRC Error Count MSB (06DH, 0EDH, 16DH, 1EDH, 26DH, 2EDH, 36DH, 3EDH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
CRCE[9]  
CRCE[8]  
Reserved  
R
X
R
X
Default  
The CRCE[9:0] are valid when it is in the CRC Multi-Frame Sync. They represent the number of the CRC errors and update on the defined  
intervals.  
192  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 PRGD Control (070H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
PDR[1]  
R/W  
0
6
PDR[0]  
R/W  
0
5
4
PS  
R/W  
0
3
TINV  
R/W  
0
2
RINV  
R/W  
0
1
0
MANSYNC  
R/W  
AUTOSYNC  
Reserved  
R/W  
1
Default  
0
PDR[1:0]:  
The PDR[1:0] define the function of the four PRGD Pattern Detector registers:  
PDR[1:0]  
00, 01  
10  
PRGD Pattern Detector Registers (#1 ~ #4)  
Pattern Receive  
Error Count  
Bit Count  
11  
(The #1 is the LSB, while the #4 is the MSB.)  
PS:  
= 0: a pseudo-random pattern is generated/detected by the PRGD.  
= 1: a repetitive pattern is generated/detected by the PRGD.  
This bit should be set first of all the PRGD registers.  
TINV:  
= 0: disable the inversion of the generated pattern before being transmitted.  
= 1: enable the inversion of the generated pattern before being transmitted.  
RINV:  
= 0: disable the inversion of the received pattern before being processed.  
= 1: enable the inversion of the received pattern before being processed.  
AUTOSYNC:  
= 0: disable automatically re-searching for the sync of the pattern when the PRGD pattern is out of synchronization.  
= 1: enable automatically re-searching for the sync of the pattern when the PRGD pattern is out of synchronization.  
MANSYNC:  
Trigger on the rising edge. A transition from logic 0 to logic 1 on this bit manually initiates a re-search for the sync of a pattern.  
Every time when the setting of the PRGD registers is changed or the detector data source changes, a manual sync operation is recommended to  
ensure that the detector works correctly.  
193  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 PRGD Interrupt Enable / Status (071H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
SYNCE  
R/W  
0
6
5
XFERE  
R/W  
0
4
3
SYNCI  
R
2
BEI  
R
1
XFERI  
R
0
OVR  
R
BEE  
R/W  
0
SYNCV  
R
X
Default  
X
X
X
X
SYNCE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the SYNCI is logic one.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the SYNCI is logic one.  
BEE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when bit error has been detected in the received pattern.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when each bit error is detected in the received pattern.  
XFERE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the the data in the PRGD pattern detector register is updated.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the the data in the PRGD pattern detector register is updated.  
SYNCV:  
= 0: the pattern is out of sync (the pattern detector has detected 10 or more bit errors in a hopping 48-bit window).  
= 1: the pattern is in sync (the pattern detector has observed at least 48 consecutive error-free bit-periods).  
SYNCI:  
= 0: there is no transition on the SYNCV.  
= 1: there is a transition (from 0 to 1 or from 1 to 0) on the SYNCV.  
This bit is cleared to 0 after the bit is read.  
BEI:  
= 0: no bit error is detected in the received pattern.  
= 1: at least one bit error has been detected in the received pattern.  
This bit is cleared to 0 after the bit is read.  
XFERI:  
= 0: the data in the PRGD pattern detector register is not updated.  
= 1: the data in the PRGD pattern detector register is updated.  
This bit is cleared to 0 after the bit is read.  
OVR:  
= 0: the PRGD pattern detector register is not overwritten.  
= 1: the PRGD pattern detector register is overwritten.  
This bit is cleared to 0 after the bit is read.  
194  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 PRGD Shift Register Length (072H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
PL[4]  
R/W  
0
3
PL[3]  
R/W  
0
2
PL[2]  
R/W  
0
1
PL[1]  
R/W  
0
0
PL[0]  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Default  
These bits determine the length of the valid data in the PRGD pattern insertion register. The length is equal to the value of PL[4:0] + 1.  
E1 PRGD Tap Bit Type Function Default (073H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PT[4]  
R/W  
0
PT[3]  
R/W  
0
PT[2]  
R/W  
0
PT[1]  
R/W  
0
PT[0]  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Default  
These bits determine the feedback tap position of the generated pseudo random pattern before it is transmitted. The feedback tap position is  
equal to the value of PT[4:0] + 1. In application, the PT is always less than the PL.  
E1 PRGD Error Insertion (074H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
EVENT  
R/W  
0
2
EIR[2]  
R/W  
0
1
EIR[1]  
R/W  
0
0
EIR[0]  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Default  
EVENT:  
A single bit error is generated when the state of this bit is changed from 0 to 1. To insert another bit error, this bit must be cleared to 0, and then  
set from 0 to 1 again.  
EIR[2:0]:  
The EIR[2:0] bits determine the bit error rate that will be inserted in the PRGD test pattern. If the bit error rate is changed from one non- zero  
value to another non-zero value, it is recommended to set the EIR[2:0] to ‘000’ first, then set the EIR[2:0] to the desired value.  
EIR[2:0]  
0 0 0  
0 0 1  
0 1 0  
0 1 1  
1 0 0  
1 0 1  
1 1 0  
1 1 1  
Bit error rate  
No error inserted  
No error inserted  
10-2  
10-3  
10-4  
10-5  
10-6  
10-7  
195  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 PRGD Pattern Insertion #1 (078H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PI[7]  
R/W  
0
PI[6]  
R/W  
0
PI[5]  
R/W  
0
PI[4]  
R/W  
0
PI[3]  
R/W  
0
PI[2]  
R/W  
0
PI[1]  
R/W  
0
PI[0]  
R/W  
0
Default  
E1 PRGD Pattern Insertion #2 (079H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
PI[15]  
R/W  
0
6
PI[14]  
R/W  
0
5
PI[13]  
R/W  
0
4
PI[12]  
R/W  
0
3
PI[11]  
R/W  
0
2
PI[10]  
R/W  
0
1
0
PI[9]  
R/W  
0
PI[8]  
R/W  
0
Default  
E1 PRGD Pattern Insertion #3 (07AH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
PI[23]  
R/W  
0
6
PI[22]  
R/W  
0
5
PI[21]  
R/W  
0
4
PI[20]  
R/W  
0
3
PI[19]  
R/W  
0
2
PI[18]  
R/W  
0
1
PI[17]  
R/W  
0
0
PI[16]  
R/W  
0
Default  
E1 PRGD Pattern Insertion #4 (07BH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
PI[31]  
R/W  
0
6
PI[30]  
R/W  
0
5
PI[29]  
R/W  
0
4
PI[28]  
R/W  
0
3
PI[27]  
R/W  
0
2
PI[26]  
R/W  
0
1
PI[25]  
R/W  
0
0
PI[24]  
R/W  
0
Default  
When a repetitive pattern is selected to transmit, the data in these registers are the repetitive pattern.  
When a pseudo random pattern is selected to transmit, the data in these registers should be set to FFFFFFFFH. They are the initial value for the  
pseudo random pattern.  
Writing to PI[31:24] updates the PRGD configuration.  
When a repetitive pattern is transmitted, the PI[31] bit is transmitted first, followed by the remaining bits in sequence down to PI[0]. The length of  
the valid data in these four registers is determined by the PL[4:0]. When the length is less than 31, the bits in higher PI are not used.  
196  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
E1 PRGD Pattern Detector #1 (07CH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
PD[7]  
R
6
PD[6]  
R
5
PD[5]  
R
4
PD[4]  
R
3
PD[3]  
R
2
PD[2]  
R
1
PD[1]  
R
0
PD[0]  
R
Default  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
E1 PRGD Pattern Detector #2 (07DH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
PD[15]  
R
6
PD[14]  
R
5
PD[13]  
R
4
PD[12]  
R
3
PD[11]  
R
2
PD[10]  
R
1
PD[9]  
R
0
PD[8]  
R
Default  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
E1 PRGD Pattern Detector #3 (07EH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
PD[23]  
R
6
PD[22]  
R
5
PD[21]  
R
4
PD[20]  
R
3
PD[19]  
R
2
PD[18]  
R
1
PD[17]  
R
0
PD[16]  
R
Default  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
E1 PRGD Pattern Detector #4 (07FH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
PD[31]  
R
6
PD[30]  
R
5
PD[29]  
R
4
PD[28]  
R
3
PD[27]  
R
2
PD[26]  
R
1
PD[25]  
R
0
PD[24]  
R
Default  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
When the PDR[1:0] (b7~6, E1-070H) are set to 00 or 01, the four PRGD pattern detector registers are configured as Pattern Receive registers.  
They reflect the content of the received pattern.  
When the PDR[1:0] (b7~6, E1-070H) are set to 10, the four PRGD pattern detector registers are configured as Error Counter registers. The value  
in these registers represents the number of the bit errors. The bit errors are not accumulated when the pattern is out of sync.  
When the PDR[1:0] (b7~6, E1-070H) are set to 11, the four PRGD pattern detector registers are configured as Bit Counter registers. The value in  
these registers represent the total received bit number.  
These registers can be configured to update every second automatically when the AUTOUPDATE (b0, E1-000H) is set to 1, or by writing to any  
of these four registers, or to the Revision / Chip ID / Global PMON register.  
197  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
5.2.2  
T1 / J1 MODE  
T1 / J1 Receive Line Options(000H, 080H, 100H, 180H, 200H, 280H, 300H, 380H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
FIFOBYP  
R/W  
6
5
IBCD_IDLE  
R/W  
4
3
2
1
0
UNF  
R/W  
0
AUTOYELLOW AUTORED  
AUTOOOF AUTOUPDATE  
Reserved  
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
Default  
0
0
FIFOBYP:  
This bit decides whether the received data should pass through or bypass the Receive Jitter Attenuation FIFO.  
= 0: The received data pass through the RJAT FIFO.  
= 1: The RJAT FIFO is bypassed. The delay is reduced by typically 24 bits.  
UNF:  
= 0: The Frame Processor operates normally.  
= 1: Frame searching is disabled, the RCRB holds its signaling frozen, and Auto_OOF function, if enabled, will consider OOF to be declared.  
IBCD_IDLE:  
This bit is valid in framed mode.  
= 0: compare the inband loopback activate/deactivate code with all received data stream, including the F-bit. However, the result of F-bit  
comparison is discarded.  
= 1: compare the inband loopback activate/deactivate code with the received data stream, excluding the F-bit.  
AUTOYELLOW:  
This bit decides whether to send the Yellow Alarm signal automatically.  
= 0: The automatic Yellow Alarm Transmission is disabled. It means that the Yellow Alarm can only be transmitted when the XYEL (b1, T1/J1-  
045H) is set to 1.  
= 1: The automatic Yellow Alarm Transmission is enabled. It means that the Yellow Alarm will be transmitted automatically when Red alarm is  
declared in the received data stream.  
AUTORED:  
This bit decides whether to start trunk conditioning (replacing data on RSDn/MRSD with the data stored in the data trunk conditioning registers in  
RPLC) automatically when Red Alarm is declared.  
= 0: The trunk conditioning is not activated automatically when Red Alarm is declared in the Alarm Detector block.  
= 1: The trunk conditioning will be initiated automatically when Red Alarm is declared in the Alarm Detector block.  
AUTOOOF:  
This bit decides whether to start trunk conditioning (replacing data on RSDn/MRSD with the data stored in the data trunk conditioning registers in  
RPLC) automatically in the duration of loss of SF/ESF frame.  
= 0: The trunk conditioning is not activated automatically when the INFR (b0, T1/J1-022H) is declared in the Frame Processor block.  
= 1: The trunk conditioning will be activated automatically when the INFR (b0, T1/J1-022H) is declared in the Frame Processor block.  
AUTOUPDATE:  
This bit decides whether the PMON and PRGD registers are automatically updated once every second.  
= 0: The PMON and PRGD registers are not automatically updated. They can only be updated by MCU operation.  
= 1: The PMON and PRGD registers will be automatically updated once every second.  
198  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 Receive Side System Interface Options(001H, 081H, 101H, 181H, 201H, 281H, 301H, 381H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
IMODE[1]  
R/W  
6
IMODE[0]  
R/W  
5
RSCKSEL  
R/W  
4
RSCCK2M  
R/W  
3
RSCCK8M  
R/W  
2
RSFSP  
R/W  
0
1
ALTIFP  
R/W  
0
0
IMTKC  
R/W  
0
Default  
1
1
0
0
0
IMODE[1:0]:  
These bits select the operation mode in the receive path.  
IMODE[1:0]  
Operation Mode In Receive Path  
Receive Clock Master Fractional T1/J1 mode  
Receive Clock Master Full T1/J1 mode  
Receive Clock Slave RSCK Reference mode  
Receive Clock Slave External Signaling mode  
0 0  
0 1  
1 0  
1 1  
“Receive Clock Master Full T1/J1” mode means that the received entire frame (193 bits) is clocked out from RSDn pin, and there are no gaps in  
the RSCKn clock pulse.  
“Receive Clock Master Fractional T1/J1” mode means that the RSCKn only clocks out on the selected channels, and RSCKn does not pulse  
during those un-selected channels. The selection of the channel is decided by the EXTRACT (b2, T1/J1-RPLC-Indirect Register-01-18 H).  
When Receive Clock Slave RSCK Reference Mode is selected, the RSCKn/RSSIGn pin will be used as RSCKn to output a 1.544 MHz jitter  
attenuated version of LRCKn or an 8KHz clock.  
When Receive Clock Slave External Signaling mode is selected, the RSCKn/RSSIGn pin is used as RSSIGn to output the extracted signaling  
data. Each channel’s signaling data is channel aligned with the RSDn data stream and located in lower nibble (b5b6b7b8) of the timeslot.  
RSCKSEL:  
When Receive Clock Slave RSCK Reference Mode is selected, this bit selects the frequency of the RSCKn.  
= 0: the RSCKn outputs an 8 KHz timing reference that is generated by dividing the jitter attenuated version of LRCKn.  
= 1: the RSCKn outputs a jitter attenuated version of the 1.544MHz receive line clock (LRCK).  
RSCCK2M, RSCCK8M:  
These bits determine the bit rate of the received data stream on the backplane. The 2.048 Mbit/s rate can only be supported when the backplane  
is configured in Receive Clock Slave mode. If the Receive Multiplexed mode is desired, all the RSCCK2M & RSCCK8M in eight framers must be set  
the same to select the 8.192 Mbit/s backplane bit rate. When the RSCCK2M, RSCCK8M selects the 8.192 Mbit/s, the IMODE[1:0] (b7~6, T1/J1-  
001H) must be set to 11.  
RSCCK2M, RSCCK8M  
Backplane Rate  
1.544M bit/s  
2.048M bit/s  
8.192M bit/s  
Reserved  
0 0  
1 0  
0 1  
1 1  
RSFSP,ALTIFP:  
RSFSP  
ALTIFP  
RSFSn Indication  
the RSFSn pin asserts on each F-bit.  
the RSFSn pin asserts on every second F-bit (i.e., the F-bit of even frame if there is no channel offset).  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
the signal on the RSFSn pin asserts on the first F-bit of every 12 frames (in SF format) or every 24 frames (in ESF format).  
-
In Receive Multiplexed mode, regardless of the setting in the RSFSP and the ALTRSFS, the MRSFS can only indicate each F-bit of SF/ESF of  
the selected first framer.  
199  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
IMTKC:  
This bit decides how to substitute the received data stream on RSDn and RSSIGn with contents in RPLC Data Trunk Conditioning Registers and  
RPLC Signaling Trunk Conditioning Registers. This bit affects the corresponding timeslot of the MRSD and MRSSIG even if the multiplexed  
backplane is enabled.  
= 0: The data and signaling signals are substituted on a per-timeslot basis in accordance with the control bits contained in the per-timeslot  
Payload Control Byte registers in the RPLC.  
= 1: the data on RSDn of all timeslots are replaced with the data contained in the Data Trunk Conditioning registers in RPLC, and the data on  
RSSIGn of all timeslots are replaced with the data contained in the Signaling Trunk Conditioning registers. To enable this function, the PCCE (b0, T1/  
J1-050H) of the RPLC must be set to logic 1.  
T1 / J1 Backplane Parity Configuration / Status(002H, 082H, 102H, 182H, 202H, 282H, 302H, 382H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
TPTYP  
R/W  
0
6
TPRTYE  
R/W  
5
TSDI  
R
4
3
PTY_EXTD  
R/W  
2
1
RPTYP  
R/W  
0
0
RPRTYE  
R/W  
TSSIGI  
R
X
Reserved  
Default  
0
X
0
0
TPTYP:  
= 0: even parity check is employed in the F-bit input from the TSDn/MTSD and TSSIGn/MTSSIG pin, which means a logic one is expected in the  
F-bit position when the number of ones in the previous SF/ESF is odd.  
= 1: odd parity check is employed in the F-bit input from the TSDn/MTSD and TSSIGn/MTSSIG pin, which means a logic one is expected in the F-  
bit position when the number of ones in the previous SF/ESF is even.  
TPRTYE:  
This bit is invalid in Receive Clock Master Fractional T1/J1 mode.  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when a parity error is detected on the TSDn/MTSD pin or a parity error is detected on the TSSIGn/  
MTSSIG pin.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when a parity error is detected on the TSDn/MTSD pin or a parity error is detected on the TSSIGn/MTSSIG  
pin.  
TSDI:  
= 0: indicate that no parity error is detected on the TSDn/MTSD pin.  
= 1: indicate that a parity error is detected on the TSDn/MTSD pin.  
This bit is cleared to 0 after the bit is read.  
TSSIGI:  
= 0: indicate that no parity error is detected on the TSSIGn/MTSSIG pin.  
= 1: indicate that a parity error is detected on the TSSIGn/MTSSIG pin.  
This bit is cleared to 0 after the bit is read.  
PTY_EXTD:  
= 0: the parity is calculated over the previous SF/ESF, excluding the F-bit on the TSDn/MTSD, TSSIGn/MTSSIG, RSDn/MRSD and RSSIGn/  
MRSSIG pin.  
= 1: the parity is calculated over the previous SF/ESF, including the F-bit on the TSDn/MTSD, TSSIGn/MTSSIG, RSDn/MRSD and RSSIGn/  
MRSSIG pin.  
RPTYP:  
This bit is invalid in Receive Clock Master Fractional T1/J1 mode and valid when the RPRTYE = 1.  
= 0: even parity check is employed in the F-bit output on the RSDn/MRSD and RSSIGn/MRSSIG pin, which means a logic one should be replaced  
in the F-bit when the number of ones in the previous SF/ESF is odd.  
= 1: odd parity check is employed in the F-bit output on the RSDn/MRSD and RSSIGn/MRSSIG pin, which means a logic one should be replaced  
in the F-bit when the number of ones in the previous SF/ESF is even.  
RPRTYE:  
This bit is invalid in Receive Clock Master Fractional T1/J1 mode.  
= 0: disable the parity on the RSDn/MRSD and RSSIGn/MRSSIG pin.  
= 1: enable the parity on the RSDn/MRSD and RSSIGn/MRSSIG pin.  
200  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 Receive Interface Configuration(003H, 083H, 103H, 183H, 203H, 283H, 303H, 383H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
MRBS  
R/W  
0
6
MRBC  
R/W  
0
5
TRI[1]  
R/W  
0
4
TRI[0]  
R/W  
0
3
RSCKRISE  
R/W  
2
LRCKFALL  
R/W  
1
0
RSCFSFALL RSCCKRISE  
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
Default  
0
0
MRBS:  
In Receive Multiplexed mode, this bit decides which bus the corresponding framer will use to output the received data.  
= 0: The first multiplexed bus (MRSD[1], MRSFS[1], MRSSIG[1]) is selected.  
= 1: The second multiplexed bus (MRSD[2], MRSFS[2], MRSSIG[2]) is selected.  
MRBC:  
This bit turns on or turn off the transmission of received data from the corresponding framer to the selected multiplexed receive bus. Users should  
complete the setting in the MRBS (b7, T1/J1-003H) before turn on this bit.  
= 0: The corresponding framer will not output its data stream on the multiplexed bus.  
= 1: The corresponding framer will output its data stream on the multiplexed bus.  
TRI[1:0]:  
These bits decide the output status of the RSDn/MRSD and RSSIGn/MRSSIG pins.  
TRI[1:0]  
0 0  
1 0  
Output Status on the RSDn/MRSD and RSSIGn/MRSSIG pin  
in high impedance  
Reserved  
0 1  
1 1  
Normal operation  
Reserved  
RSCKRISE:  
This bit selects the active edge of RSCKn to update the data on the corresponding RSDn and RSFSn.This bit is valid in Receive Clock Master  
mode.  
= 0: the falling edge is selected.  
= 1: the rising edge is selected.  
LRCKFALL:  
This bit selects the active edge of LRCKn to sample the data on the corresponding LRDn.  
= 0: the rising edge is selected.  
= 1: the falling edge is selected.  
RSCFSFALL:  
This bit selects the active edge of RSCCK/MRSCCK to sample the data on the corresponding RSCFS/MRSCFS. This bit is valid in Receive  
Clock Slave mode and Receive Multiplexed mode.  
= 0: the rising edge is selected.  
= 1: the falling edge is selected  
This bit in all eight framers must be set to the same value.  
RSCCKRISE:  
This bit selects the active edge of RSCCK/MRSCCK to update the data on the corresponding RSDn/MRSD, RSSIGn/MRSSIG and RSFSn/  
MRSFS. This bit is valid in Receive Clock Slave mode and Receive Multiplexed mode.  
= 0: the falling edge is selected.  
= 1: the rising edge is selected.  
In Receive Multiplexed mode, the RSCCKRISE of the eight framers must be set to the same value.  
201  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 Transmit Interface Configuration(004H, 084H, 104H, 184H, 204H, 284H, 304H, 384H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
FIFOBYP  
R/W  
6
TAISEN  
R/W  
0
5
4
3
2
1
TSDFALL  
R/W  
0
LTCKRISE  
R/W  
TSCCKBFALL TSFSRISE  
Reserved  
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
Default  
0
0
0
FIFOBYP:  
This bit decides whether the transmit data should pass through or bypass the Transmit Jitter Attenuation FIFO. The bit is valid in Clock Slave  
mode.  
= 0: the data to be transmitted pass through the TJAT FIFO.  
= 1: the TJAT FIFO is bypassed. The delay is reduced by typically 24 bits.  
TAISEN:  
This bit enables the line interface to generate an un-framed all-ones Alarm Indication Signal on the TLDn pin or the corresponding framer on the  
MTLD.  
= 0: normal operation.  
= 1: TLDn or the corresponding framer on the MTLD transmits all ones.  
TSCCKBFALL:  
This bit selects the active edge of TSCCKB/MTSCCKB to sample the data on the corresponding TSDn/MTSD, TSSIGn/MTSSIG and TSCFS/  
MTSCFS. This bit is valid in Transmit Clock Slave mode and Transmit Multiplexed mode.  
= 0: the rising edge is selected.  
= 1: the falling edge is selected.  
The TSCCKBFALL of the eight framers should be set to the same value.  
TSFSRISE:  
This bit is valid in Transmit Clock Slave TSFS Enabled mode and Transmit Clock Master mode.  
= 0: In Transmit Clock Slave TSFS Enabled mode, the signal on the TSFSn pin is updated on the falling edge of the TSCCKB. In Transmit Clock  
Master mode, the signal on the TSFSn pin is updated on the falling edge of the LTCKn.  
= 1: In Transmit Clock Slave TSFS Enabled mode, the signal on the TSFSn pin is updated on the rising edge of the TSCCKB. In Transmit Clock  
Master mode, the signal on the TSFSn pin is updated on the rising edge of the LTCKn.  
TSDFALL:  
This bit selects the active edge of LTCKn to sample the data on the corresponding TSDn in Transmit Clock Master mode.  
= 0: the TSDn is sampled on the rising edge of the LTCKn.  
= 1: the TSDn is sampled on the falling edge of the LTCKn.  
LTCKRISE:  
This bit selects the active edge of LTCKn to update the data on the corresponding LTDn.  
= 0: the falling edge is selected.  
= 1: the rising edge is selected.  
202  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 Transmit Side System Interface Options(005H, 085H, 105H, 185H, 205H, 285H, 305H, 385H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
EMODE[1]  
R/W  
6
EMODE[0]  
R/W  
5
FPINV  
R/W  
0
4
ABXXEN  
R/W  
3
RATE[1]  
R/W  
0
2
RATE[0]  
R/W  
0
1
TSCFSP  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Default  
1
1
0
0
EMODE[1:0]:  
EMODE[1:0]  
Operation Mode In Transmitter Path  
Reserved  
Transmit Clock Master mode  
Transmit Clock Slave TSFS Enable mode  
0 0  
0 1  
1 0  
1 1  
Transmit Clock Slave External Signaling mode  
In Transmit Multiplexed mode, these bits must be set to 11.  
FPINV:  
= 0: the positive pulse on the TSCFS/MTSCFS pin is valid.  
= 1: the negative pulse on the TSCFS/MTSCFS pin is valid.  
This bit of the eight framers should be set to the same value.  
ABXXEN:  
This bit is valid only in T1 ESF mode.  
= 0: the valid signaling on the TSSIGn/MTSSIG pin is in the lower four nibble of each channel (i.e. XXXXABCD).  
= 1: the valid signaling on the TSSIGn/MTSSIG pin is in the upper two-bit positions of the lower nibble of each channel (i.e. XXXXABXX). Thus,  
the ‘A’ bit will be inserted to the signaling bit of Frame 6 and 18, and the ‘B’ bit will be inserted to the signaling bit of Frame 12 and 24.  
RATE[1:0]:  
These bits determine the bit rate of the transmit data stream on the backplane. Note that if any of the eight framers selects the 8.192 Mbit/s  
backplane bit rate, the multiplxed bus will be enabled for the chip. When the RATE[1:0] selects the 2.048 Mbit/s or 8.192 Mbit/s, the EMODE[1] (b7,  
T1/J1-005H) must be set to 1 (i.e., in Transmit Clock Slave mode).  
RATE[1:0]  
0 0  
Backplane Rate  
1.544M bit/s  
2.048M bit/s  
Reserved  
0 1  
1 0  
1 1  
8.192M bit/s  
TSCFSP:  
= 0: indicate that the signal on the TSCFS pin asserts on each F-bit.  
= 1: indicate that the signal on the TSCFS pin asserts on the first F-bit of every 12 SFs or every 24 ESFs.  
This bit of the eight framers should be set to the same value.  
203  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 Transmit Framing and Bypass Options(006H, 086H, 106H, 186H, 206H, 286H, 306H, 386H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
FRESH  
R/W  
0
6
5
SIGAEN  
R/W  
0
4
3
FDIS  
R/W  
0
2
FBITBYP  
R/W  
1
CRCBYP  
R/W  
0
FDLBYP  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Reserved  
Default  
0
0
FRESH:  
= 0: normal operation.  
= 1: initiate the FIFO in the Frame Generator block.  
After initialization of the backplane interface, the user should write 1 into this bit and then clear it.  
SIGAEN:  
= 0: track the signaling input from the TSSIGn/MTSSIG pin for the signaling bit.  
= 1: take a snapshot of the 1st frame input from the TSSIGn/MTSSIG pin and lock it for the signaling bit of the whole SF/ESF.  
FDIS:  
This bit is valid when the UF (b6, T1/J1-046H) is logic 0.  
= 0: the Frame Generator is enabled to generate and insert the framing bits into the transmit data.  
= 1: the Frame Generator is bypassed. Data on TSDn/MTSD pin is transmitted transparently.  
FBITBYP:  
This bit is valid when the UF (b6, T1/J1-046H) and the FDIS (b3, T1/J1-006H) are logic 0.  
= 0: the frame synchronization bits in the output data stream are generated by the Frame Generator.  
= 1: the frame synchronization bits in the input data stream on the TSDn/MTSD pin will be output transparently.  
CRCBYP:  
This bit is valid when the UF (b6, T1/J1-046H) and the FDIS (b3, T1/J1-006H) are logic 0.  
= 0: the framing bit corresponding to the CRC-6 bit position in the output data stream are generated by the Frame Generator.  
= 1: the framing bit corresponding to the CRC-6 bit position in the input data stream on the TSDn/MTSD pin will be output transparently.  
FDLBYP:  
This bit is valid when the UF (b6, T1/J1-046H) and the FDIS (b3, T1/J1-006H) are logic 0.  
= 0: the framing bit corresponding to the data link bit position in the output data stream are generated by the Frame Generator.  
= 1: the framing bit corresponding to the data link bit position in the input data stream on the TSDn/MTSD pin will be output transparently.  
204  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 Transmit Timing Options(007H, 087H, 107H, 187H, 207H, 287H, 307H, 387H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
TJATREF_SEL[2] TJATREF_SEL[1] TJATREF_SEL[0] LTCK_SEL[2] LTCK_SEL[1] LTCK_SEL[0]  
Reserved  
R/W  
1
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
1
R/W  
0
R/W  
1
Default  
TJATREF_SEL[2:0]:  
The TJATREF_SEL[2:0] select the input reference clock for the TJAT DPLL.  
TJATREF_SEL[2:0]  
Input Reference Clock  
TSCCKA / 8  
TSCCKB  
000  
001  
010  
LRCK  
011  
TSCCKA  
100  
XCK / 24  
the others  
TSCCKB  
LTCK_SEL[2:0]:  
LTCK_SEL[2:0]  
Line Transmit Clock  
TSCCKA / 8  
TSCCKB  
000  
001  
010  
011  
100  
LRCK  
TSCCKA  
XCK / 24  
the others  
A smoothed clock output from the TJAT DPLL  
205  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 Interrupt Source #1(008H, 088H, 108H, 188H, 208H, 288H, 308H, 388H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
PMON  
R/W  
0
6
IBCD  
R/W  
0
5
FRMP  
R/W  
0
4
PRGD  
R/W  
0
3
ELSB  
R/W  
0
2
RHDLC#1  
R/W  
1
RBOM  
R/W  
0
0
ALMD  
R/W  
0
Default  
0
Bits in this register indicate which function block caused an interrupt signal on INT pin. Reading this register does not clear the interrupt  
indication. To clear the interrupt indication on INT pin, the corresponding interrupt status register must be read.  
T1 / J1 Interrupt Source #2(009H, 089H, 109H, 189H, 209H, 289H, 309H, 389H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
RHDLC#2  
R/W  
6
PRTY  
R/W  
0
5
TJAT  
R/W  
0
4
RJAT  
R/W  
0
3
THDLC#1  
R/W  
2
THDLC#2  
R/W  
1
0
RCRB  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Default  
0
0
0
Bits in this register indicate which function block caused an interrupt signal on INT pin.  
The PRTY bit indicates a pending parity error indication needs serving in the Backplane Parity Configuration and Status registers.  
Reading this register does not clear the interrupt indication. To clear the interrupt indication on INT pin, the corresponding interrupt status register  
must be read.  
206  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 Diagnostics (00AH, 08AH, 10AH, 18AH, 20AH, 28AH, 30AH, 38AH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
LINELB  
R/W  
0
3
2
DDLB  
R/W  
0
1
TXMFP  
R/W  
0
0
TXDIS  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Reserved  
Default  
LINELB:  
Line Loop back means that the transmit line interface data and clock (LTDn and LTCKn) are internal directly comes from the received line data and  
clock (LRDn and LRCKn). The loop back data stream can pass through the Receive Jitter Attenuator or bypass the Receive Jitter Attenuator (if the  
Receive Jitter Attenuator is configured to be bypassed)  
= 0: Line loop back is disabled.  
= 1: Line loop back is enabled.  
DDLB:  
Digital Loop back means that the received line data and clock (LRDn and LRCKn) are internal directly comes from the transmit line data and clock  
(LTDn and LTCKn) without the Receive Jitter Attenuator.  
= 0: Digital loop back is disabled.  
= 1: Digital loop back is enabled.  
TXMFP:  
This bit controls whether the mimic pattern is generated. The mimic pattern is a copy of the F-bit. The mimic pattern is generated in the 1st bit of  
each channel.  
= 0: the mimic pattern is not generated.  
= 1: the mimic pattern is generated.  
TXDIS:  
= 0: normal transmission.  
= 1: force the data to be transmitted on the TLDn pin to be all zeros.  
T1 / J1 Revision / Chip ID / Global PMON Update(00CH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
ID[4]  
R
3
ID[3]  
R
2
ID[2]  
R
1
ID[1]  
R
0
ID[0]  
R
TYPE[2]  
TYPE[1]  
TYPE[0]  
R
0
R
0
R
0
Default  
0
0
0
0
1
Writing to this register causes all Performance Monitor and PRGD Generator/Detector counters to be updated simultaneously.  
TYPE[2:0]:  
TYPE[2:0] are fixed to 000, representing the IDT82V2108 chip.  
ID[4:0]:  
ID[4:0] are fixed to 00011, representing the current version number of the IDT82V2108.  
207  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 Data Link Micro Select / Framer Reset(00DH, 08DH, 10DH, 18DH, 20DH, 28DH, 30DH, 38DH)  
Bit No.  
7
6
5
4
3
TXCISEL  
R/W  
2
1
0
RESET  
R/W  
0
BitName RHDLCSEL[1] RHDLCSEL[0] THDLCSEL[1] THDLCSEL[0]  
Type  
Default  
R/W  
X
R/W  
X
R/W  
X
R/W  
X
Reserved  
X
RHDLCSEL[1:0]:  
The RHDLCSEL[1:0] select one of the two HDLC Receivers to be accessed by the microprocessor in ESF format. When RHDLC #1 is selected,  
the HDLC link position is fixed in the DL of F-bit. When RHDLC #2 is selected, the microprocessor can access the HDLC #2 controller to assign the  
link to any one of 24 channels. These bits must be set before using the HDLC controller.  
RHDLCSEL[1:0]  
the HDLC Receiver  
RHDLC #1  
00  
01  
10  
11  
RHDLC #2  
Reserved  
THDLCSEL[1:0]:  
The THDLCSEL[1:0] select which one of the two HDLC Transmitters to be accessed by the microprocessor in ESF format. When THDLC #1 is  
selected, the HDLC link position is fixed in the DL of F-bit. When THDLC #2 is selected, the microprocessor can access the HDLC #2 controller to  
assign the link to any one of 24 channels. These bits must be set before using the HDLC controller.  
THDLCSEL[1:0]  
the HDLC Transmitter  
THDLC #1  
00  
01  
10  
11  
THDLC #2  
Reserved  
TXCISEL:  
The registers addressed from T1/J1-070H to T1/J1-071H are shared by the HDLC Receiver and HDLC Transmitter to decide the position of the  
extracted bit in the received data stream and the inserted bit in the transmitting data stream respectively. This bit is used to decide whether the Read/  
Write operation on the registers addressed from T1/J1-070H to T1/J1-071H is for the HDLC receiver or for the HDLC transmitter.  
= 0: the Read/Write operation on registers addressed from T1/J1-070H to T1/J1-071H is for HDLC receiver.  
= 1: Read/Write operation on registers addressed from T1/J1-070H to T1/J1-071H is for the HDLC transmitter.  
RESET:  
This bit implements a software reset for individual framer.  
= 0: normal operation.  
= 1: The corresponding framer is held in reset. However, this bit and the bits in this register can not be reset. Therefore, a logic 0 must be written  
to bring the framer out of reset. Holding the framer in a reset state effectively puts it into a low power standby mode. A hardware reset clears the  
RESET bit and the bits in this register.  
208  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 Interrupt ID(00EH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
INT[8]  
R
6
INT[7]  
R
5
INT[6]  
R
4
INT[5]  
R
3
INT[4]  
R
2
INT[3]  
R
1
INT[2]  
R
0
INT[1]  
R
Default  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
This register indicates which one of the eight framers caused the interrupt INT pin to logic low. When any one of the eight framers caused the  
interrupt, the corresponding bit in the INT[8:1] will be high.  
T1 / J1 Pattern Generator / Detector Positioning / Control (00FH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
RXPATGEN  
R/W  
1
UNF_GEN  
R/W  
0
UNF_DET  
R/W  
PRGDSEL[2] PRGDSEL[1] PRGDSEL[0] Nx56k_GEN Nx56k_DET  
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
Default  
0
0
0
The IDT82V2108 has only one Pattern Generator/Detector (PRGD) shared by all eight framers. At one time, only one framer can use this PRGD.  
This register selects which framer will use the PRGD and how the PRGD will be used.  
PRGDSEL[2:0]:  
PRGDSEL[2:0] select one of the eight framers to be tested by the PRGD block.  
PRGDSEL[2:0]  
Tested Framer  
Framer 1  
Framer 2  
Framer 3  
Framer 4  
Framer 5  
Framer 6  
Framer 7  
Framer 8  
000  
001  
010  
011  
100  
101  
110  
111  
Nx56k_GEN:  
This bit is invalid when the UNF_GEN (b1, T1/J1-00FH) is logic 1.  
= 0: eight bits are all replaced with the PRGD pattern when one channel is selected in the TPLC or RPLC.  
= 1: the 7 most significant bits are replaced with the PRGD pattern when one channel is selected in the TPLC or RPLC.  
Nx56k_DET:  
This bit is invalid when the UNF_DEL (b0, T1/J1-00FH) is logic 1.  
= 0: eight bits are all detected by the PRGD when one channel is selected in the TPLC or RPLC.  
= 1: the 7 most significant bits are detected by the PRGD when one channel is selected in the TPLC or RPLC.  
RXPATGEN:  
= 0: the pattern in PRGD is generated in the transmit path and is detected in the receive path.  
= 1: the pattern in PRGD is generated in the receive path and is detected in the transmit path.  
UNF_GEN:  
= 0: which channels of the selected path will be replaced by the PRGD pattern is specified in TPLC or RPLC.  
= 1: all 24 channels and the F-bit of the selected path will be replaced by the PRGD pattern.  
UNF_DET:  
= 0: which channels of the selected path will be detected by PRGD pattern is specified in TPLC or RPLC.  
= 1: all 24 channels and the F-bit of the selected path will be detected by PRGD pattern.  
209  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 RJAT Interrupt Status(010H, 090H, 110H, 190H, 210H, 290H, 310H, 390H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
OVRI  
R
0
UNDI  
R
Reserved  
Default  
X
X
OVRI:  
If data are still attempted to write into the FIFO when the FIFO is already full, the overwritten event will occur.  
= 0: the RJAT FIFO is not overwritten.  
= 1: the RJAT FIFO is overwritten.  
This bit is cleared to 0 when it is read.  
UNDI:  
If data are still attempted to read from the FIFO when the FIFO is already empty, the under-run event will occur.  
= 0: the RJAT FIFO is not under-run.  
= 1: the RJAT FIFO is under-run.  
This bit is cleared to 0 when it is read.  
T1 / J1 RJAT Reference Clock Divisor (N1) Control(011H, 091H, 111H, 191H, 211H, 291H, 311H, 391H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
N1[7]  
R/W  
0
6
N1[6]  
R/W  
0
5
N1[5]  
R/W  
1
4
N1[4]  
R/W  
0
3
N1[3]  
R/W  
1
2
N1[2]  
R/W  
1
1
N1[1]  
R/W  
1
0
N1[0]  
R/W  
1
Default  
These bits define a binary number. The (N1[7:0] + 1) is the divisor of the input reference clock, which is the ratio between the frequency of the  
input reference clock and the frequency applied to the phase discriminator input.  
Writing to this register will reset the DPLL in the RJAT.  
T1 / J1 RJAT Output Clock Divisor (N2) Control(012H, 092H, 112H, 192H, 212H, 292H, 312H, 392H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
N2[7]  
R/W  
0
6
N2[6]  
R/W  
0
5
N2[5]  
R/W  
1
4
N2[4]  
R/W  
0
3
N2[3]  
R/W  
1
2
N2[2]  
R/W  
1
1
N2[1]  
R/W  
1
0
N2[0]  
R/W  
1
Default  
These bits define a binary number. The (N2[7:0] + 1) is the divisor of the output smoothed clock, which is the ratio between the frequency of the  
output smoothed clock and the frequency applied to the phase discriminator input.  
Writing to this register will reset the DPLL in the RJAT.  
210  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 RJAT Configuration(013H, 093H, 113H, 193H, 213H, 293H, 313H, 393H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
CENT  
R/W  
0
3
UNDE  
R/W  
0
2
OVRE  
R/W  
0
1
0
LIMIT  
R/W  
1
Reserved  
Reserved  
Default  
CENT:  
The CENT allows the RJAT FIFO to self-center its read pointer, maintaining the pointer at least 4 UI away from the FIFO being empty or full.  
= 0: disable the self-center. Data are pass through uncorrupted when the FIFO is empty or full.  
= 1: enable the FIFO to self-center its read pointer when the FIFO is 4 UI away from being empty or full.  
A positive transition in this bit will execute a self-center action immediately.  
UNDE:  
This bit decides whether to generate an interrupt when the RJAT FIFO is under-run.  
= 0: No interrupt is generated when the RJAT FIFO is under-run.  
= 1: An interrupt on the INT pin is generated when the RJAT FIFO is under-run.  
OVRE:  
This bit decides whether to generate an interrupt when the RJAT FIFO is overwritten.  
= 0: No interrupt is generated when the RJAT FIFO is overwritten.  
= 1: An interrupt on the INT pin is generated when the RJAT FIFO is overwritten.  
LIMIT:  
= 0: disable the limitation of the jitter attenuation.  
= 1: enable the DPLL to limit the jitter attenuation by enabling the FIFO to increase or decrease the frequency of the output smoothed clock when  
the read pointer is 1 UI away from the FIFO being empty or full. This limitation of jitter attenuation ensures that no data is lost during high phase shift  
conditions.  
T1 / J1 TRSI Timeslot Offset(014H, 094H, 114H, 194H, 214H, 294H, 314H, 394H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
TSOFF[6]  
R/W  
5
TSOFF[5]  
R/W  
4
TSOFF[4]  
R/W  
3
TSOFF[3]  
R/W  
2
TSOFF[2]  
R/W  
1
TSOFF[1]  
R/W  
0
TSOFF[0]  
R/W  
Reserved  
Default  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
In T1/J1 Transmit Clock Slave External Signaling mode E1 rate, the content in the TSOFF[6:0] determines the channel offset between the signal  
on the TSCFS pin and the start of the corresponding frame transmitted on the TSDn & TSSIGn.  
In T1/J1 Transmit Clock Slave TSFS Enabled mode E1 rate, the content in the TSOFF[6:0] determine the channel offset between the signal on the  
TSCFS pin and the start of the corresponding frame transmitted on the TSDn.  
In Transmit Multiplexed mode, the content in the TSOFF[6:0] determine the channel offset between the signal on the MTSCFS pin and the start of  
the corresponding frame transmitted on the MTSD.  
Except for the above three modes, the channel offset is disabled. Thus, the TSOFF[6:0] must be logic 0.  
These bits define a binary number. The offset can be set from 0 to 127 channels.  
211  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 TRSI Bit Offset(015H, 095H, 115H, 195H, 215H, 295H, 315H, 395H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
MTBS  
R/W  
0
5
CMS  
R/W  
0
4
COFF  
R/W  
0
3
2
BOFF[2]  
R/W  
1
BOFF[1]  
R/W  
0
0
BOFF[0]  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Reserved  
Default  
0
MTBS:  
Valid in Transmit Multiplexed mode.  
= 0: the data of the current channel are taken from the first multiplexed bus (MTSD[1], MTSSIG[1]).  
= 1: the data of the current channel are taken from the second multiplexed bus (MTSD[2], MTSSIG[2]).  
CMS:  
= 0: the clock rate of the TSCCKB/MTSCCKB is the same as that of the backplane.  
= 1: the clock rate of the TSCCKB/MTSCCKB is twice that of the backplane.  
The CMS of the eight framers should be set to the same value.  
COFF:  
Valid when the CMS (b5, T1/J1-015H) is logic 1.  
= 0: select the first active edge of the TSCCKB/MTSCCKB to sample / update the data.  
= 1: select the second active edge of the TSCCKB/MTSCCKB to sample / update the data.  
In Transmit Clock Multiplexed mode, the COFF of the eight framers should be set to the same value.  
BOFF[2:0]:  
In T1/J1 Transmit Clock Slave External Signaling mode E1 rate, the content in the BOFF[2:0] determines the bit offset between the signal on the  
TSCFS pin and the start of the SF/ESF transmitted on the TSDn & TSSIGn.  
In T1/J1 Transmit Clock Slave TSFS Enabled mode E1 rate, the content in the BOFF[2:0] determines the bit offset between the signal on the  
TSCFS pin and the start of the SF/ESF transmitted on the TSDn.  
In Transmit Multiplexed mode, the content in the BOFF[2:0] determines the bit offset between the signal on the MTSCFS pin and the start of the  
SF/ESF transmitted on the MTSD & MTSSIG.  
Except for the above three modes, the bit offset is disabled. Thus, the BOFF[2:0] must be logic 0.  
These bits define a binary number. Refer to the Functional Description for details.  
212  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 TJAT Interrupt Status(018H, 098H, 118H, 198H, 218H, 298H, 318H, 398H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
OVRI  
R
0
UNDI  
R
Reserved  
Default  
X
X
OVRI:  
If data are still attempted to write into the FIFO when the FIFO is already full, the overwritten event will occur.  
= 0: the TJAT FIFO is not overwritten.  
= 1: the TJAT FIFO is overwritten.  
This bit is cleared to 0 when it is read.  
UNDI:  
If data are still attempted to read from the FIFO when the FIFO is already empty, the under-run event will occur.  
= 0: the TJAT FIFO is not under-run.  
= 1: the TJAT FIFO is under-run.  
This bit is cleared to 0 when it is read.  
T1 / J1 TJAT Reference Clock Divisor (N1) Control(019H, 099H, 119H, 199H, 219H, 299H, 319H, 399H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
N1[7]  
R/W  
0
6
N1[6]  
R/W  
0
5
N1[5]  
R/W  
1
4
N1[4]  
R/W  
0
3
N1[3]  
R/W  
1
2
N1[2]  
R/W  
1
1
N1[1]  
R/W  
1
0
N1[0]  
R/W  
1
Default  
These bits define a binary number. The (N1[7:0] + 1) is the divisor of the input reference clock, which is the ratio between the frequency of the  
input reference clock and the frequency applied to the phase discriminator input.  
Writing to this register will reset the DPLL in the TJAT.  
T1 / J1 TJAT Output Clock Divisor (N2) Control(01AH, 09AH, 11AH, 19AH, 21AH, 29AH, 31AH, 39AH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
N2[7]  
R/W  
0
6
N2[6]  
R/W  
0
5
N2[5]  
R/W  
1
4
N2[4]  
R/W  
0
3
N2[3]  
R/W  
1
2
N2[2]  
R/W  
1
1
N2[1]  
R/W  
1
0
N2[0]  
R/W  
1
Default  
These bits define a binary number. The (N2[7:0] + 1) is the divisor of the output smoothed clock, which is the ratio between the frequency of the  
output smoothed clock and the frequency applied to the phase discriminator input.  
Writing to this register will reset the DPLL in the TJAT.  
213  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 TJAT Configuration (01BH, 09BH, 11BH, 19BH, 21BH, 29BH, 31BH, 39BH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
CENT  
R/W  
0
3
UNDE  
R/W  
0
2
OVRE  
R/W  
0
1
0
LIMIT  
R/W  
1
Reserved  
Reserved  
Default  
CENT:  
The CENT allows the TJAT FIFO to self-center its read pointer, maintaining the pointer at least 4 UI away from the FIFO being empty or full.  
= 0: disable the self-center. Data are pass through uncorrupted when the FIFO is empty or full.  
= 1: enable the FIFO to self-center its read pointer when the FIFO is 4 UI away from being empty or full.  
A positive transition in this bit will execute a self-center action immediately.  
UNDE:  
This bit decides whether to generate an interrupt when the TJAT FIFO is under-run.  
= 0: No interrupt is generated when the TJAT FIFO is under-run.  
= 1: An interrupt on the INT pin is generated when the TJAT FIFO is under-run.  
OVRE:  
This bit decides whether to generate an interrupt when the TJAT FIFO is overwritten.  
= 0: No interrupt is generated when the TJAT FIFO is overwritten.  
= 1: An interrupt on the INT pin is generated when the TJAT FIFO is overwritten.  
LIMIT:  
= 0: disable the limitation of the jitter attenuation.  
= 1: enable the DPLL to limit the jitter attenuation by enabling the FIFO to increase or decrease the frequency of the output smoothed clock when  
the read pointer is 1 UI away from the FIFO being empty or full. This limitation of jitter attenuation ensures that no data is lost during high phase shift  
conditions.  
T1 / J1 ELSB Interrupt Enable / Status(01DH, 09DH, 11DH, 19DH, 21DH, 29DH, 31DH, 39DH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
SLIPE  
R/W  
0
1
SLIPD  
R
0
SLIPI  
R
Reserved  
Default  
X
X
SLIPE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when a slip occurs.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when a slip occurs.  
SLIPD:  
This bit is applicable when the SLIPI is logic 1.  
= 0: the latest slip is due to the Elastic Store Buffer being empty; a frame was duplicated.  
= 1: the latest slip is due to the Elastic Store Buffer being full; a frame was deleted.  
SLIPI:  
= 0: no slip occurs.  
= 1: a slip occurs.  
This bit is cleared to 0 after the bit is read.  
214  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 ELSB Idle Code (01EH, 09EH, 11EH, 19EH, 21EH, 29EH, 31EH, 39EH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
D7  
R/W  
1
6
D6  
R/W  
1
5
D5  
R/W  
1
4
D4  
R/W  
1
3
D3  
R/W  
1
2
D2  
R/W  
1
1
D1  
R/W  
1
0
D0  
R/W  
1
Default  
These bits set the idle code that will replace the data on the RSDn/MRSD automatically when it is out of SF/ESF sync. D7 is the first bit to be  
inserted.  
The writing of the idle code pattern is asynchronous with respect to the output data clock. One channel of idle code data will be corrupted if the  
register is written to when the framer is out of frame.  
T1 / J1 FRMP Configuration (020H, 0A0H, 120H, 1A0H, 220H, 2A0H, 320H, 3A0H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
M2O[1]  
R/W  
0
6
M20[0]  
R/W  
0
5
ESFFA  
R/W  
0
4
3
JYEL  
R/W  
0
2
1
0
ESF  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Default  
M20[1:0]:  
These bits select the SF/ESF frame loss criteria.  
= 00: 2 of 4 frame alignment bits in error.  
= 01: 2 of 5 frame alignment bits in error.  
= 10: 2 of 6 frame alignment bits in error.  
= 11: Reserved  
ESFFA:  
This bit selects the framing algorithm for ESF format.  
= 0: if four consecutive Frame Alignment Patterns are detected in the F-Bit in the received data stream without the mimic framing pattern, the  
ESF synchronization is acquired. However, if there are mimic framing patterns in the received data stream, the ESF In-frame is not declared.  
= 1: when 6 consecutive Frame Alignment Patterns are received error free and the CRC-6 checksum is also error free, the synchronization is  
acquired. In this condition, the existance of the mimic framing patterns is not considered.  
ESF:  
This bit selects the SF or ESF format in the Frame Processor block.  
= 0: SF format is selected.  
= 1: ESF format is selected.  
JYEL:  
This bit selects the T1 or J1 mode in the Frame Processor block.  
= 0: T1 mode is selected.  
= 1: J1 mode is selected.  
215  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 FRMP Interrupt Enable(021H, 0A1H, 121H, 1A1H, 221H, 2A1H, 321H, 3A1H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
COFAE  
R/W  
0
4
FERE  
R/W  
0
3
BEEE  
R/W  
0
2
SFEE  
R/W  
0
1
MFPE  
R/W  
0
0
INFRE  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Default  
COFAE:  
When the frame alignment pattern has been achieved and the position of the new frame alignment pattern differs from the previous one, this bit  
decides whether to generate an interrupt or not.  
= 0: Disables the interrupt when there is a shift on the framing signal position.  
=1: Enables the interrupt on INT pin when there is a shift on the framing signal position.  
FERE:  
= 0: No interrupt is generated when there is a framing bit error.  
= 1: An interrupt on INT pin is generated when a framing bit error is detected.  
BEEE:  
= 0: No interrupt is generated when there is a bit error event.  
= 1: An interrupt on INT pin is generated when a bit error event occurs. Here, the bit error event is defined as a framing bit error for SF formatted  
data and a CRC-6 error (the local calculated CRC-6 result is not the same as the received CRC-6 bits) for ESF formatted data.  
(In SF mode, this bit has the same function as the FERE.)  
SFEE:  
The Severe Framing Error is defined as 2 or more framing bit errors during the current super-frame of SF or ESF data.  
= 0: No interrupt is generated when there is a Severe Framing Error.  
= 1: An interrupt on INT pin is generated when Severe Framing Error event occurs.  
MFPE:  
Mimic Framing Pattern is defined as more than one framing alignment pattern existing simultaneously in the receiving data stream. This bit  
decides whether to generate an interrupt when Mimic Framing Pattern appears or disappears.  
= 0: No interrupt is generated when there is a transition of the status of Mimic Framing Pattern.  
= 1: An interrupt on INT pin is generated when there is a transition (exist to non-exist, or non-exist to exist) of the status of Mimic Framing Pattern.  
INFRE:  
This bit decides whether to generate an interrupt when the status of incoming data stream changes from in-frame to out-of-frame or from out-of-  
frame to in-frame.  
= 0: No interrupt is generated when there is a transition of Frame Synchronize Status.  
= 1: An interrupt on INT pin is generated when there is a transition of Framing Synchronize Status.  
216  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 FRMP Interrupt Status (022H, 0A2H, 122H, 1A2H, 222H, 2A2H, 322H, 3A2H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
COFAI  
R
6
FERI  
R
5
BEEI  
R
4
SFEI  
R
3
MFPI  
R
2
INFRI  
R
1
MFP  
R
0
INFR  
R
Default  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
COFAI:  
= 0: Indicates the framing signal position shift has not occurred.  
= 1: Indicates the occurrence of framing signal position shift, which means when the frame alignment pattern has been achieved, the position of  
the new alignment pattern differs from the previous one.  
This bit is cleared to 0 after it is read.  
FERI:  
= 0: Indicates that there is no framing bit error.  
= 1: Indicates the occurrence of a framing bit error.  
This bit is cleared to 0 after it is read.  
BEEI:  
This bit indicates the occurrence of a bit error event. The bit error event is defined as a framing bit error for SF format or a CRC-6 error (the local  
calculated CRC-6 result is not the same as the received CRC-6 bits) for ESF format.  
= 0: Indicates there is no bit error.  
= 1: Indicates the occurrence of a bit error.  
(For SF formatted data, this bit has the same function as FERI bit.)  
This bit is cleared to 0 after it is read  
SFEI:  
The Severe Framing Error is defined as 2 or more framing bit errors during the current super-frame of SF or ESF data.  
= 0: Indicates there is no severe framing error.  
= 1: Indicates the occurrence of severe framing error.  
This bit is cleared to 0 after it is read.  
MFPI:  
This bit indicates the transition of the status of the current mimic framing pattern.  
= 0: When the status of current mimic framing pattern is not changed.  
= 1: When there is a transition (exist to non-exist, or non-exist to exist) of the status of mimic framing pattern.  
This bit is cleared to 0 after it is read.  
INFRI:  
This bit indicates the transition of frame synchronization status.  
= 0: When the frame synchronization status is not changed.  
= 1: When the frame synchronization status of the receiving data stream changes from in-frame to out-of-frame or from out-of-frame to in-frame.  
MFP:  
This bit reflects the current status of mimic framing pattern.  
= 0: Indicates that the mimic framing pattern does not exist.  
= 1: Indicates the presence of more than one framing alignment patterns in the receiving data stream.  
Read operation will not change the status of this bit.  
INFR:  
This bit reflects the current status of frame synchronization.  
= 0: The received data stream is out-of-frame.  
= 1: The received data stream is in-frame.  
Read operation will not change the status of this bit.  
217  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 Clock Monitor (027H, 0A7H, 127H, 1A7H, 227H, 2A7H, 327H, 3A7H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
XCK  
R
3
2
1
0
LRCK  
R
TSCCKB  
TSCCKA  
RSCCK  
R
X
Reserved  
R
X
R
X
Default  
X
X
This register provides monitoring on the IDT82V2108 clocks. When a monitored clock signal makes a low to high transition, the corresponding bit  
in this register is set to 1, and this bit remains to be 1 until this register is read. After a read operation on this register, all the bits in this register will be  
cleared to 0. A lack of transitions of the monitored clock will be indicated by 0 in the corresponding bit, which means that the clock fails. This register  
should be read periodically to detect clock failures.  
XCK:  
= 0: after the bit is read.  
= 1: a low to high transition occurs on the XCK.  
TSCCKB:  
= 0: after the bit is read.  
= 1: a low to high transition occurs on the TSCCKB.  
TSCCKA:  
= 0: after the bit is read.  
= 1: a low to high transition occurs on the TSCCKA.  
RSCCK:  
= 0: after the bit is read.  
= 1: a low to high transition occurs on the RSCCK.  
LRCK:  
= 0: after the bit is read.  
= 1: a low to high transition occurs on the LRCK.  
218  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 RBOM Enable (02AH, 0AAH, 12AH, 1AAH, 22AH, 2AAH, 32AH, 3AAH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
BOCE  
R/W  
0
IDLE  
R/W  
0
AVC  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Default  
IDLE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when there is a transition from BOM to non-BOM in the received data stream.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when there is a transition from BOM to non-BOM in the received data stream.  
AVC:  
This bit selects the validation criteria used to acknowledge the Bit Oriented Message (BOM) in the received data stream, or to acknowledge the  
Yellow signal in T1/J1 ESF format.  
= 0: the BOM or the Yellow signal is acknowledged when the pattern is matched and the received code is identical 8 out of 10 times.  
= 1: the BOM or the Yellow signal is acknowledged when the pattern is matched and the received code is identical 4 out of 5 times.  
BOCE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when a valid BOM code is detected in the received data stream.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when a valid BOM code is detected in the received data stream.  
T1 / J1 RBOM Code Status(02BH, 0ABH, 12BH, 1ABH, 22BH, 2ABH, 32BH, 3ABH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
IDLEI  
R
6
BOCI  
R
5
4
3
2
1
0
BOC[5]  
BOC[4]  
BOC[3]  
BOC[2]  
BOC[1]  
BOC[0]  
R
1
R
1
R
1
R
1
R
1
R
1
Default  
0
0
IDLEI:  
= 0: no transition from Bit Oriented Message (BOM) to non-BOM in the received data stream.  
= 1: a transition from BOM to non-BOM in the received data stream.  
This bit is cleared to 0 after the register is read.  
BOCI:  
= 0: no Bit Oriented Message (BOM) is detected.  
= 1: BOM is detected in the received data stream.  
This bit is cleared to 0 after the register is read.  
BOC[5:0]:  
These bits directly reflect the content of the Bit Oriented Message (BOM) in the received data stream.  
All ones in the BOC[5:0] mean there is no BOM received.  
The BOC[5] corresponds to the MSB of the code while the BOC[0] corresponds to the LSB.  
219  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 ALMD Configuration(02CH, 0ACH, 12CH, 1ACH, 22CH, 2ACH, 32CH, 3ACH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
J1_YEL  
R/W  
0
4
3
2
1
0
ESF  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Reserved  
Default  
J1_YEL:  
This bit selects the T1 or J1 mode in the Alarm Detector block.  
= 0: T1 mode is selected in the ALMD block.  
= 1: J1 mode is selected in the ALMD block.  
ESF:  
This bit selects the SF or ESF format in the Alarm Detector block.  
= 0: SF format is selected.  
= 1: ESF format is selected.  
T1 / J1 ALMD Interrupt Enable(02DH, 0ADH, 12DH, 1ADH, 22DH, 2ADH, 32DH, 3ADH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
FASTD  
R/W  
0
3
2
YELE  
R/W  
0
1
REDE  
R/W  
0
0
AISE  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Reserved  
Default  
FASTD:  
= 0: the RED Alarm is cleared when the out of SF/ESF sync event has been absent for 16.6sec (±500ms); the AIS Alarm is cleared when the AIS  
signal has been absent for 16.8sec (±500ms).  
= 1: the RED Alarm is cleared when the out of SF/ESF sync event has been absent for 120ms; the AIS Alarm is cleared when the AIS signal has  
been absent for 180ms.  
YELE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the YELI (b5, T1/J1-02EH) is logic one.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the YELI (b5, T1/J1-02EH) is logic one.  
REDE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the REDI (b4, T1/J1-02EH) is logic one.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the REDI (b4, T1/J1-02EH) is logic one.  
AISE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the AISI (b3, T1/J1-02EH) is logic one.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the AISI (b3, T1/J1-02EH) is logic one.  
220  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 ALMD Interrupt Status(02EH, 0AEH, 12EH, 1AEH, 22EH, 2AEH, 32EH, 3AEH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
YELI  
R
4
REDI  
R
3
AISI  
R
2
YEL  
R
1
RED  
R
0
AIS  
R
Reserved  
Default  
0
0
0
0
0
0
YELI:  
= 0: there is no transition (from 1 to 0 or from 0 to 1) on the YEL (b2, T1/J1-02EH).  
= 1: there is a transition (from 1 to 0 or from 0 to 1) on the YEL (b2, T1/J1-02EH).  
This bit is clear to 0 after the register is read.  
REDI:  
= 0: there is no transition (from 1 to 0 or from 0 to 1) on the RED (b1, T1/J1-02EH).  
= 1: there is a transition (from 1 to 0 or from 0 to 1) on the RED (b1, T1/J1-02EH).  
This bit is clear to 0 after the register is read.  
AISI:  
= 0: there is no transition (from 1 to 0 or from 0 to 1) on the AIS (b0, T1/J1-02EH).  
= 1: there is a transition (from 1 to 0 or from 0 to 1) on the AIS (b0, T1/J1-02EH).  
This bit is clear to 0 after the register is read.  
YEL:  
= 0: the Yellow signal has been absent for 425ms (±50ms).  
= 1: the Yellow signal has been present for 425ms (±50ms).  
RED:  
= 0: the REDD (b2, T1/J1-02FH) has been logic 0 for 16.6sec (±500ms), or for 120ms if the FASTD (b4, T1/J1-02DH) is set.  
= 1: the REDD (b2, T1/J1-02FH) has been logic 1 for 2.55sec (±40ms).  
AIS:  
= 0: the AIS signal has been absent for 16.8sec (±500ms), or for 180ms if the FASTD (b4, T1/J1-02DH) is set.  
= 1: the AIS signal has been present for 1.5sec (±100ms).  
221  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 ALMD Alarm Detection Status(02FH, 0AFH, 12FH, 1AFH, 22FH, 2AFH, 32FH, 3AFH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
REDD  
R
1
YELD  
R
0
AISD  
R
Reserved  
Default  
X
X
X
REDD:  
= 0: no out of SF/ESF sync event has occurred in the latest 40ms period.  
= 1: one or more out of SF/ESF sync events have occurred in the latest 40ms period.  
YELD:  
= 0: In SF format, the Yellow signal is absent during the latest 40ms period; in ESF format, the Yellow signal is absent during the latest 4ms period.  
= 1: In SF format, the Yellow signal is present during the latest 40ms period; in ESF format, when the AVC (b1, T1/J1-02AH) is 0, the Yellow signal  
is present during the latest 40ms period, when the AVC (b1, T1/J1-02AH) is 1, the Yellow signal is present during the latest 20ms period.  
The Yellow signal is acknowledged differently in each format:  
- In T1 SF format: The Yellow signal occupies the 2nd bit of each channel. When the bit is logic 1 for 16 or fewer times during the 40ms period,  
the Yellow signal is present.  
- In J1 SF format: The Yellow signal occupies the F-bit of the 12th frame. However, when the bit is logic 0 for 2 or fewer times during the 40ms  
period, the Yellow signal is present.  
- In T1/J1 ESF format: The Yellow signal occupies the DL of the F-bit (refer to Table-4). The pattern is ‘FF00’ in T1 mode and ‘FFFF’ in J1 mode.  
When the AVC (b1, T1/J1-02AH) is logic 0, the Yellow signal is acknowledged if the pattern is matched in 8 out of 10 successive DL. When the AVC  
(b1, T1/J1-02AH) is logic 1, the Yellow signal is acknowledged if the pattern is matched in 4 out of 5 successive DL.  
AISD:  
= 0: the AIS signal is absent during the latest 60ms period.  
= 1: the AIS signal is present during the latest 60ms period.  
The AIS signal is acknowledged when the received data are out of SF/ESF synchronization for 60ms and the received logic 0 is less than 127  
times in the same period.  
222  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 TPLC Configuration (030H, 0B0H, 130H, 1B0H, 230H, 2B0H, 330H, 3B0H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PCCE  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Default  
PCCE:  
= 0: the per-channel functions in TPLC are disabled.  
= 1: the per-channel functions in TPLC are enabled.  
T1 / J1 TPLC mP Access Status (031H, 0B1H, 131H, 1B1H, 231H, 2B1H, 331H, 3B1H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
BUSY  
R
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reserved  
Default  
0
BUSY:  
= 0: no reading or writing operation on the indirect registers.  
= 1: an internal indirect register is being accessed, any new operation on the internal indirect register is not allowed.  
This bit goes low timed to an internal high-speed clock rising edge after the operation has been completed. The operation cycle is 650ns. No  
more operations to the indirect registers could be done until this bit is cleared.  
T1 / J1 TPLC Channel Indirect Address / Control (032H, 0B2H, 132H, 1B2H, 232H, 2B2H, 332H, 3B2H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
R/WB  
R/W  
0
6
A6  
R/W  
0
5
A5  
R/W  
0
4
A4  
R/W  
0
3
A3  
R/W  
0
2
A2  
R/W  
0
1
A1  
R/W  
0
0
A0  
R/W  
0
Default  
Writing to this register with a valid address and R/WB bit initiates an internal operation cycle to the indirect registers.  
R/WB:  
= 0: write the data to the specified indirect register.  
= 1: read the data from the specified indirect register.  
A[6:0]:  
Specify the address of the indirect registers (from 01H to 48H) for the microprocessor access.  
223  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 TPLC Channel Indirect Data Buffer (033H, 0B3H, 133H, 1B3H, 233H, 2B3H, 333H, 3B3H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
D7  
R/W  
0
6
D6  
R/W  
0
5
D5  
R/W  
0
4
D4  
R/W  
0
3
D3  
R/W  
0
2
D2  
R/W  
0
1
D1  
R/W  
0
0
D0  
R/W  
0
Default  
This register hold the value which will be read from or write into the indirect registers (from 01H to 48H). If data are to be written to the indirect  
registers, the byte to be written must be written into this register before the target indirect register’s address and R/WB=0 is written into the Address/  
Control register, initiating the access. If data are to be read from the indirect registers, only the target indirect register’s address and R/WB=1 is  
written into the Address/Control register, initiating the request. After 490 ns, this register will contain the requested data byte.  
TPLC Indirect Registers Map  
01H ~ 18H  
19H ~ 30H  
31H ~ 48H  
Per-Channel Control for Channel 1 ~ 24  
IDLE Code Byte for Channel 1 ~ 24  
Signaling Control Byte for Channel 1 ~ 24  
224  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 TPLC Per-Channel Control Registers(TPLC Indirect Registers 01H – 18H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
INVERT  
R/W  
X
6
IDLE_DS0  
R/W  
5
4
SIGNINV  
R/W  
3
TEST  
R/W  
X
2
LOOP  
R/W  
X
1
ZCS[1]  
R/W  
X
0
ZCS[0]  
R/W  
X
DMW  
R/W  
X
Default  
X
X
INVERT:  
This bit, together with the SIGNINV (b4, T1/J1-TPLC-indirect register - 01~18H), determines the bit inversion of the corresponding channel when  
input from the TSDn/MTSD pin.  
INVERT  
SIGNINV  
Bit Inversion  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
No bit inversion  
Invert the MSB of the corresponding channel  
Invert all the bits of the corresponding channel  
Invert all the bits except the MSB of the corresponding channel  
IDLE_DS0:  
= 0: disable the data in the corresponding channel to be replaced by the data set in the IDLE[7:0] when input from the TSDn/MTSD pin.  
= 1: enable the data in the corresponding channel to be replaced by the data set in the IDLE[7:0] when input from the TSDn/MTSD pin.  
DMW:  
= 0: disable the data in the corresponding channel to be replaced with a digital milliwatt pattern when input from the TSDn/MTSD pin.  
= 1: enable the data in the corresponding channel to be replaced with a digital milliwatt pattern when input from the TSDn/MTSD pin.  
SIGNINV:  
Refer to the INVERT (b7, T1/J1-TPLC-indirect register - 01~18H).  
TEST:  
= 0: disable the data in the corresponding channel to be tested by PRGD.  
= 1: enable the data in the corresponding channel to be extracted to PRGD for test (when the RXPATGEN [b2, T1/J1-00FH] is logic 1), or enable  
the test pattern from PRGD to replace the data in the corresponding channel for test (when the RXPATGEN [b2, T1/J1-00FH] is logic 0).  
All the timeslots that are extracted to the PRGD are concatenated and treated as a continuous stream in which pseudo random are searched for.  
Similarly, all timeslots set to be replaced with PRGD test pattern data are concatenated replaced by the PRBS.  
LOOP:  
= 0: disable the payload loopback.  
= 1: enable the payload loopback. When the Receive Clock Master modes are enabled, the Elastic Store is used to align the receive line data to  
the data to be transmitted. When Receive Clock Slave modes are enabled, the Elastic Store is unavailable to facilitate the payload loopbacks, and  
loopback functionality is provided only when the transmit path is also in Transmit Clock Slave mode, and the received clock and the clock to be  
transmitted and Common Frame Pulse are identical (RSCCK = TSCCKB, RSCFS = TSCFS).  
ZCS[1:0]:  
ZCS[1:0]  
0 0  
Per-Channel Zero Code Suppression  
No zero code suppression.  
0 1  
1 0  
Every bit 8 in the corresponding channel is forced to be logic one.  
GTE Zero Code Suppression – Every bit 8 (or bit 7 in signaling frames) is forced to be logic one when the bits in the  
corresponding channel are all zeros.  
1 1  
Bell Zero Code Suppression – Every bit 7 is forced to be logic one when the bits in the corresponding channel are all zeros.  
The priority of the TPLC operation on the TSDn/MTSD pin from high to low is:  
Extract data to PRGD for test; Zero Code Suppression; Payload loopback; Replace the data with the milliwatt pattern; Replace the data with the  
pattern generated in the PRGD; Replace the data with the value in the IDLE[7:0]; Invert the bit.  
225  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 TPLC IDLE Code Byte Registers(TPLC Indirect Registers 19H – 30H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
IDLE7  
R/W  
X
6
IDLE6  
R/W  
X
5
IDLE5  
R/W  
X
4
IDLE4  
R/W  
X
3
IDLE3  
R/W  
X
2
IDLE2  
R/W  
X
1
IDLE1  
R/W  
X
0
IDLE0  
R/W  
X
Default  
They contain the data that will replace the data input from the TSDn/MTSD pin when the corresponding IDLE_DS0 is logic 1. IDLE7 is the MSB.  
T1 / J1 TPLC Signaling Control Byte Registers(TPLC Indirect Registers 31H – 48H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
SIGC0  
R/W  
X
6
SIGC1  
R/W  
X
5
4
3
A
R/W  
X
2
B
R/W  
X
1
C
R/W  
X
0
D
R/W  
X
Reserved  
Default  
SIGC0:  
This bit is valid when the corresponding SIGC1 is logic 1.  
= 0: use the data input from the TSSIGn/MTSSIG pin as the signaling.  
= 1: use the data in the A, B, C, D as the signaling.  
SIGC1:  
= 0: disable replacing the signaling bit with the data input from the TSSIGn/MTSSIG pin or the data in the A, B, C, D.  
= 1: enable replacing the signaling bit with the data input from the TSSIGn/MTSSIG pin or the data in the A, B, C, D.  
A, B, C, D:  
They contain the data that can be used as signaling when the corresponding SIGC0 is logic 1. They are in the least significant nibble.  
226  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 THDLC #1, #2 Configuration(034H, 0B4H, 134H, 1B4H, 234H, 2B4H, 334H, 3B4H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
FLGSHARE  
R/W  
6
FIFOCLR  
R/W  
5
4
3
EOM  
R/W  
0
2
1
0
EN  
R/W  
0
ABT  
R/W  
0
CRC  
R/W  
1
Reserved  
Default  
1
0
Selection of the THDLC block (#1 or #2) whose registers are visible on the microprocessor interface is done via the THDLCSEL[1:0] (b5~4, T1/  
J1-00DH).  
FLGSHARE:  
= 0: the closing flag of the current HDLC and the opening flag of the next HDLC are separate.  
= 1: the closing flag of the current HDLC and the opening flag of the next HDLC are shared.  
FIFOCLR:  
= 0: normal operation.  
= 1: clear the FIFO.  
EOM:  
= 0: normal operation.  
= 1: a positive transition of this bit starts a packet transmission. Then if the CRC(b1, E1-050H) is set, the 16-bit FCS word is appended to the last  
data byte transmitted.  
ABT:  
= 0: normal operation.  
= 1: transmit the 7F abort sequence after the current setting in the Transmit Data register is transmitted, so that the FIFO is cleared and all data in  
the FIFO will be lost.  
Aborts are continuously sent and the FIFO is held in reset until this bit is reset to a logic 0. At least one Abort sequence will be sent when the ABT  
transitions from logic 0 to logic 1.  
CRC:  
= 0: do not append the CRC-16 frame check sequences (FCS) to the end of the HDLC data.  
= 1: append the FCS to the end of the HDLC data  
EN:  
= 0: disable the operation of the THDLC block and transmit all ones on the assigned data link.  
= 1: enable the operation of the THDLC block and flag sequences are sent until data are written into the THDLC Transmit Data register and the  
EOM is set to logic 1.  
227  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 THDLC #1, #2 Upper Transmit Threshold (035H, 0B5H, 135H, 1B5H, 235H, 2B5H, 335H, 3B5H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
UTHR[6]  
R/W  
5
UTHR[5]  
R/W  
4
UTHR[4]  
R/W  
3
UTHR[3]  
R/W  
2
UTHR[2]  
R/W  
1
UTHR[1]  
R/W  
0
UTHR[0]  
R/W  
Reserved  
Default  
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
Selection of the THDLC block (#1 or #2) whose registers are visible on the microprocessor interface is done via the THDLCSEL[1:0] (b5~4, T1/  
J1-00DH).  
UTHR[6:0]:  
These bits define the upper fill level of the FIFO. Once the fill level exceeds the UTHR[6:0] value, the data stored in the FIFO will start to transmit.  
The transmission will not stop until the last complete packet is transmitted and the THDLC FIFO fill level is below UTHR[6:0] + 1.  
It should be greater than the value of the LINT[6:0] unless both are equal to 00H.  
T1 / J1 THDLC #1, #2 Lower Interrupt Threshold(036H, 0B6H, 136H, 1B6H, 236H, 2B6H, 336H, 3B6H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
LINT[6]  
R/W  
0
5
LINT[5]  
R/W  
0
4
LINT[4]  
R/W  
0
3
LINT[3]  
R/W  
0
2
LINT[2]  
R/W  
1
1
LINT[1]  
R/W  
1
0
LINT[0]  
R/W  
1
Reserved  
Default  
Selection of the THDLC block (#1 or #2) whose registers are visible on the microprocessor interface is done via the THDLCSEL[1:0] (b5~4, T1/  
J1-00DH).  
LINT[6:0]:  
These bits define the fill level of the FIFO that can cause an interrupt. That is, when the fill level of the FIFO is below the LINT[6:0], an interrupt will  
be generated. It should be less than the value of the UTHR[6:0] unless both are equal to 00H.  
228  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 THDLC #1, #2 Interrupt Enable(037H, 0B7H, 137H, 1B7H, 237H, 2B7H, 337H, 3B7H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
FULLE  
R/W  
0
2
OVRE  
R/W  
0
1
UDRE  
R/W  
0
0
LFILLE  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Default  
Selection of the THDLC block (#1 or #2) whose registers are visible on the microprocessor interface is done via the THDLCSEL[1:0] (b5~4, T1/  
J1-00DH).  
FULLE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the FULLI (b3, T1/J1-038H) is logic 1.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the FULLI (b3, T1/J1-038H) is logic 1.  
OVRE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the OVRI (b2, T1/J1-038H) is logic 1.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the OVRI (b2, T1/J1-038H) is logic 1.  
UDRE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the UDRI (b1, T1/J1-038H) is logic 1.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the UDRI (b1, T1/J1-038H) is logic 1.  
LFILLE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the LFILLI (b0, T1/J1-038H) is logic 1.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the LFILLI (b0, T1/J1-038H) is logic 1.  
229  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 THDLC #1, #2 Interrupt Status / UDR Clear(038H, 0B8H, 138H, 1B8H, 238H, 2B8H, 338H, 3B8H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
FULL  
R
5
BLFILL  
R
4
3
FULLI  
R
2
OVRI  
R
1
UDRI  
R
0
LFILLI  
R
Reserved  
Reserved  
Default  
X
X
X
X
X
X
Selection of the THDLC block (#1 or #2) whose registers are visible on the microprocessor interface is done via the THDLCSEL[1:0] (b5~4, T1/  
J1-00DH).  
FULL:  
= 0: the THDLC FIFO is not full.  
= 1: the THDLC FIFO is full (128 bits).  
BLFILL:  
= 0: the data in the THDLC FIFO are not below the value of the LINT[6:0] (b6~0, T1/J1-036H).  
= 1: the data in the THDLC FIFO are empty or below the value of the LINT[6:0] (b6~0, T1/J1-036H).  
FULLI:  
= 0: there is no transition (from 0 to 1) on the FULL.  
= 1: there is a transition (from 0 to 1) on the FULL.  
This bit is clear to 0 after the bit is read.  
OVRI:  
The Over-Written is that the THDLC FIFO was already full when another data byte was written to the THDLC Transmit Data register.  
= 0: the THDLC FIFO is not overwritten.  
= 1: the THDLC FIFO is overwritten (more than 128 bits).  
This bit is clear to 0 after the bit is read.  
UDRI:  
The Under-Run is that the THDLC was in the process of transmitting a packet when it ran out of data to be transmitted.  
= 0: the THDLC FIFO is not under-run.  
= 1: the THDLC FIFO is under-run.  
This bit is clear to 0 after the bit is read.  
LFILLI:  
= 0: there is no transition (from 0 to 1) on the BLFILL.  
= 1: there is a transition (from 0 to 1) on the BLFILL.  
This bit is clear to 0 after the bit is read.  
230  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 THDLC #1, #2 Transmit Data(039H, 0B9H, 139H, 1B9H, 239H, 2B9H, 339H, 3B9H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
TD[7]  
R/W  
X
6
TD[6]  
R/W  
X
5
TD[5]  
R/W  
X
4
TD[4]  
R/W  
X
3
TD[3]  
R/W  
X
2
TD[2]  
R/W  
X
1
TD[1]  
R/W  
X
0
TD[0]  
R/W  
X
Default  
Selection of the THDLC block (#1 or #2) whose registers are visible on the microprocessor interface is done via the THDLCSEL[1:0] (b5~4, T1/  
J1-00DH).  
The content is the data to be transmitted. It is serially transmitted (TD[0] is the first).  
T1 / J1 IBCD Configuration (03CH, 0BCH, 13CH, 1BCH, 23CH, 2BCH, 33CH, 3BCH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
DSEL1  
R/W  
0
2
DSEL0  
R/W  
0
1
ASEL1  
R/W  
0
0
ASEL0  
R/W  
0
IBCD_ERR[1] IBCD_ERR[0]  
Reserved  
R/W  
0
R/W  
0
Default  
IBCD_ERR[1:0]:  
The IBCD_ERR[1:0] sets the error tolerance in the received activate/deactivate code within 39.8ms:  
IBCD_ERR[1:0]  
Error Tolerance  
0 bit  
0 0  
0 1  
1 0  
1 1  
200 bits  
20 bits  
2 bits  
DSEL[1:0]:  
The DSEL[1:0] define the length of the received loopback deactivate code, meanwhile, it define the valid code in the DACT[7:0] (b7~0, T1/J1-  
03FH):  
DSEL[1:0]  
0 0  
Deactivate Code Length & Valid Code In the DACT[7:0]  
5-bit length & the code in the DACT[7:3] is valid  
6-bit or 3-bit length & the code in the DACT[7:2] is valid  
7-bit length & the code in the DACT[7:1] is valid  
8-bit or 4-bit length & the code in the DACT[7:0] is valid  
0 1  
1 0  
1 1  
ASEL[1:0]:  
The ASEL[1:0] define the length of the received loopback activate code, meanwhile, it define the valid code in the ACT[7:0] (b7~0, T1/J1-03EH):  
ASEL[1:0]  
0 0  
Activate Code Length & Valid Code In the ACT[7:0]  
5-bit length & the code in the ACT[7:3] is valid  
6-bit or 3-bit length & the code in the ACT[7:2] is valid  
7-bit length & the code in the ACT[7:1] is valid  
8-bit or 4-bit length & the code in the ACT[7:0] is valid  
0 1  
1 0  
1 1  
231  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 IBCD Interrupt Enable / Status(03DH, 0BDH, 13DH, 1BDH, 23DH, 2BDH, 33DH, 3BDH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
LBAE  
R/W  
0
4
LBDE  
R/W  
0
3
LBAI  
R
2
LBDI  
R
1
LBA  
R
0
LBD  
R
LBACP  
LBDCP  
R
0
R
0
Default  
0
0
0
0
LBACP:  
= 0: no loopback activate code is present for 39.8ms.  
= 1: the loopback activate code is present for 39.8ms.  
LBDCP:  
= 0: no loopback deactivate code is present for 39.8ms.  
= 1: the loopback deactivate code is present for 39.8ms.  
LBAE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the loopback activate code status changes (i.e., the LBAI is logic one).  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the loopback activate code status changes (i.e., the LBAI is logic one).  
LBDE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the loopback deactivate code status changes (i.e., the LBDI is logic one).  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the loopback deactivate code status changes (i.e., the LBDI is logic one).  
LBAI:  
= 0: the loopback activate code status does not change.  
= 1: the loopback activate code status changes (i.e., there is a transition from 0 to 1 or from 1 to 0 on the LBA).  
This bit is cleared to 0 after the register is read.  
LBDI:  
= 0: the loopback deactivate code status does not change.  
= 1: the loopback deactivate code status changes (i.e., there is a transition from 0 to 1 or from 1 to 0 on the LBD).  
This bit is cleared to 0 after the register is read.  
LBA:  
= 0: no loopback activate code is present for 5.1s.  
= 1: the loopback activate code is present for 5.1s.  
LBD:  
= 0: no loopback deactivate code is present for 5.1s.  
= 1: the loopback deactivate code is present for 5.1s.  
232  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 IBCD Activate Code(03EH, 0BEH, 13EH, 1BEH, 23EH, 2BEH, 33EH, 3BEH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
ACT7  
R/W  
0
6
ACT6  
R/W  
0
5
ACT5  
R/W  
0
4
ACT4  
R/W  
0
3
ACT3  
R/W  
0
2
ACT2  
R/W  
0
1
ACT1  
R/W  
0
0
ACT0  
R/W  
0
Default  
The ACT[7:X] defines the content of the activate code. ‘X’ is 3, 2, 1 or 0 and depends on the length defined by the ASEL[1:0] (b1~0, T1/J1-03CH).  
The unused bits should be ignored. The ACT[7] is the MSB and compares with the first received code bit.  
T1 / J1 IBCD Deactivate Code(03FH, 0BFH, 13FH, 1BFH, 23FH, 2BFH, 33FH, 3BFH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
DACT7  
R/W  
0
6
DACT6  
R/W  
0
5
ADCT5  
R/W  
0
4
DACT4  
R/W  
0
3
DACT3  
R/W  
0
2
DACT2  
R/W  
0
1
DACT1  
R/W  
0
0
DACT0  
R/W  
0
Default  
The DACT[7:X] defines the content of the deactivate code. ‘X’ is 3, 2, 1 or 0 and depends on the length defined by the DSEL[1:0] (b3~2, T1/J1-  
03CH). The unused bits should be ignored. The DACT[7] is the MSB and compares with the first received code bit.  
T1 / J1 RCRB Configuration (COSS = 0) (040H, 0C0H, 140H, 1C0H, 240H, 2C0H, 340H, 3C0H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
COSS  
R/W  
0
5
4
3
2
1
0
PCCE  
R/W  
0
SIGE  
R/W  
0
ESF  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Reserved  
Reserved  
Default  
COSS:  
= 0: allow the RCRB registers to access the indirect registers.  
= 1: allow the RCRB registers to reflect the change of the signaling of its corresponding channel.  
SIGE:  
= 0: disable generation of an interrupt on the INT pin when there is signaling change in any one of the 24 channels.  
= 1: enable generation of an interrupt on the INT pin when there is signaling change in any one of the 24 channels.  
ESF:  
This bit selects the SF or ESF format in the Receive CAS/RBS Buffer block.  
= 0: SF format is selected.  
= 1: ESF format is selected.  
PCCE:  
= 0: the per-channel functions in RCRB are disabled.  
= 1: the per-channel functions in RCRB are enabled.  
233  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 RCRB Channel Indirect Status (COSS = 0) (041H, 0C1H, 141H, 1C1H, 241H, 2C1H, 341H, 3C1H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
BUSY  
R
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reserved  
Default  
0
BUSY:  
= 0: no reading or writing operation on the indirect registers is occurring.  
= 1: an internal indirect register is being accessed, any new operation on the internal indirect register is not allowed.  
This bit goes low timed to an internal high-speed clock rising edge after the operation has been completed. The operation cycle is 650ns. No  
more operations to the indirect registers could be done until this bit is cleared.  
T1 / J1 RCRB Channel Indirect Address / Control (COSS = 0) (042H, 0C2H, 142H, 1C2H, 242H, 2C2H, 342H, 3C2H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
R/WB  
R/W  
0
6
A6  
R/W  
0
5
A5  
R/W  
0
4
A4  
R/W  
0
3
A3  
R/W  
0
2
A2  
R/W  
0
1
A1  
R/W  
0
0
A0  
R/W  
0
Default  
R/WB:  
= 0: write the data to the specified indirect register.  
= 1: read the data from the specified indirect register.  
A[6:0]:  
Specifies the address of the indirect registers (from 20H to 57H) for the microprocessor access.  
T1 / J1 RCRB Channel Indirect Data Buffer (COSS = 0) (043H, 0C3H, 143H, 1C3H, 243H, 2C3H, 343H, 3C3H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
D7  
R/W  
X
6
D6  
R/W  
X
5
D5  
R/W  
X
4
D4  
R/W  
X
3
D3  
R/W  
X
2
D2  
R/W  
X
1
D1  
R/W  
X
0
D0  
R/W  
X
Default  
This register holds the value which will be read from or written to the indirect registers (from 20H to 57H). If data are to be written to the indirect  
registers, the byte to be written must be written into this register before the target indirect register’s address and R/WB=0 is written into the Address/  
Control register, initiating the access. If data are to be read from the indirect registers, only the target indirect register’s address and R/WB=1 is  
written into the Address/Control register, initiating the request. After 640 ns, this register will contain the requested data byte.  
234  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 RCRB Configuration (COSS = 1) (040H, 0C0H, 140H, 1C0H, 240H, 2C0H, 340H, 3C0H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
COSS  
R/W  
0
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reserved  
Reserved  
Default  
COSS:  
= 0: allow the RCRB registers to access the indirect registers.  
= 1: allow the RCRB registers to reflect the change of the signaling of its corresponding channel.  
T1 / J1 RCRB Signaling State Change Channels 17-24 (COSS = 1) (041H, 0C1H, 141H, 1C1H, 241H, 2C1H, 341H, 3C1H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
COSS[24]  
COSS[23]  
COSS[22]  
COSS[21]  
COSS[20]  
COSS[19]  
COSS[18]  
COSS[17]  
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
Default  
COSSn:  
= 0: the signaling in its corresponding channel is not changed.  
= 1: the signaling in its corresponding channel is changed.  
These bits are cleared to 0 after the register is read. COSS[24:17] correspond to channels 24 to 17.  
T1 / J1 RCRB Signaling State Change Channels 9-16 (COSS = 1) (042H, 0C2H, 142H, 1C2H, 242H, 2C2H, 342H, 3C2H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
COSS[16]  
COSS[15]  
COSS[14]  
COSS[13]  
COSS[12]  
COSS[11]  
COSS[10]  
COSS[9]  
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
Default  
COSSn:  
= 0: the signaling in its corresponding channel is not changed.  
= 1: the signaling in its corresponding channel is changed.  
These bits are cleared to 0 after the register is read. COSS[16:9] correspond to channels 16 to 9.  
T1 / J1 RCRB Signaling State Change Channels 1-8 (COSS = 1) (043H, 0C3H, 143H, 1C3H, 243H, 2C3H, 343H, 3C3H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
COSS[8]  
COSS[7]  
COSS[6]  
COSS[5]  
COSS[4]  
COSS[3]  
COSS[2]  
COSS[1]  
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
R
X
Default  
COSSn:  
= 0: the signaling in its corresponding channel is not changed.  
= 1: the signaling in its corresponding channel is changed.  
These bits are cleared to 0 after the register is read. COSS[8:1] correspond to channels 8 to 1.  
235  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
RCRB Indirect Registers Map  
Channel Signaling Data Register for Channel 1 ~ 24  
01H ~ 18H / 21H ~ 38H  
19H ~ 20H, 39H ~ 40H  
41H ~ 58H  
-
Per-Channel Configuration Register for Channel 1 ~ 24  
T1 / J1 RCRB Channel Signaling Data Registers (COSS = 0) (RCRB Indirect Registers 01H ~ 18H / 21H – 38H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
A
R
X
2
B
R
X
1
C
R
X
0
D
R
X
Reserved  
Default  
A, B, C, D:  
They contain the signaling of the corresponding channel.  
There is a maximum 2 ms delay between the transition of the COSS[n] bit (T1/J1-041H & T1/J1-042H & T1/J1-043H) and the updating of the A,  
B, C, D code in the corresponding indirect registers 21H ~ 38H. To avoid this 2ms delay, users can read the corresponding b3~0 in the indirect  
registers 01H ~ 18H first. If the value of these four bits are different from the previous A, B, C, D code, then the content of b3~0 in the 01H ~ 18H is  
the updated A, B, C, D code. If the conternt of the four bits is the same as the previous A, B, C, D code, then users should read the b3~0 in the 21H  
~ 38H to get the updated A, B, C, D code.  
In SF format, the C and D are the repetition of the A and B respectively.  
T1 / J1 RCRB Per-Channel Configuration Registers (COSS = 0) (RCRB Indirect Registers 41H – 58H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
DEB  
R/W  
X
Reserved  
Default  
DEB:  
= 0: disable signaling debounce.  
= 1: enable signaling debounce (valid only if the PCCE is logic 1). That is, the signaling is acknowledged only when 2 consecutive signaling bits of  
a channel are the same.  
236  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 FRMG Configuration (044H, 0C4H, 144H, 1C4H, 244H, 2C4H, 344H, 3C4H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
MTRK  
R/W  
0
6
J1_CRC  
R/W  
0
5
J1_YEL  
R/W  
0
4
3
2
1
GZCS[1]  
R/W  
0
GZCS[0]  
R/W  
ESF  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Default  
0
0
MTRK:  
Valid when the PCCE (b0, T1/J1-030H) is logic 1.  
= 0: normal operation.  
= 1: replace the data on all channels with the data set in the IDLE[7:0] (b7~0, T1/J1-TPLC-indirect registers-19~30H); replace the signaling on all  
channels with the data on the TSSIGn/MTSSIG pin or the data in the A, B, C, D (b3~0, T1/J1-TPLC-indirect registers-31~48H) according to the  
setting in the SIGC[1:0] (b7~6, T1/J1-TPLC-indirect registers-31~48H).  
J1_CRC:  
This bit selects the T1 or J1 CRC-6 algorithm when the ESF (b4, T1/J1-044H) is 1.  
= 0: the CRC-6 algorithm meets T1 standard.  
= 1: the CRC-6 algorithm meets J1 standard.  
J1_YEL:  
This bit selects the T1 or J1 Yellow alarm pattern to be transmitted.  
= 0: the Yellow alarm transition meets T1 standard.  
= 1: the Yellow alarm transition meets J1 standard.  
The Yellow alarm pattern is:  
- In T1 SF format: Transmit the logic 0 on the 2nd bit of each channel.  
- In T1 ESF format: Transmit the ‘FF00’ on each FDL link.  
- In J1 SF format: Transmit the logic 1 on the 12th F-bit.  
- In J1 ESF format: Transmit the ‘FFFF’ on each FDL link.  
The SF or ESF format is selected by the ESF (b4, T1/J1-044H).  
ESF:  
This bit selects the SF or ESF format in the Frame Generator block.  
= 0: the SF format is selected.  
= 1: the ESF format is selected.  
GZCS[1:0]:  
These bits select the Zero Code Suppression format to be used. They are logically ORed with the ZCS[1:0] (b1~0, T1/J1-TPLC-indirect registers-  
01~18H).  
GZCS[1:0]  
0 0  
Zero Code Suppression  
No zero code suppression.  
0 1  
GTE Zero Code Suppression – Every bit 8 (or bit 7 in signaling frames) is forced to be logic one when the bits in a channel are  
all zeros.  
1 0  
1 1  
Reserved.  
Bell Zero Code Suppression – Every bit 7 is forced to be logic one when the bits in a channel are all zeros.  
237  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 FRMG Alarm Transmit (045H, 0C5H, 145H, 1C5H, 245H, 2C5H, 345H, 3C5H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
XYEL  
R/W  
0
0
Reserved  
Reserved  
Default  
XYEL:  
= 0: disable generating Yellow alarm manually.  
= 1: enable generating Yellow alarm manually.  
T1 / J1 IBCG Control (046H, 0C6H, 146H, 1C6H, 246H, 2C6H, 346H, 3C6H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
EN  
R/W  
0
6
UF  
R/W  
0
5
4
3
2
1
CL1  
R/W  
0
0
CL0  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Default  
EN:  
= 0: disable transmiting the inband loopback code.  
= 1: enable transmiting the inband loopback code.  
UF:  
= 0: the Frame Generator block operates normally. It transmits the inband loopback code in framed mode, that is, only the 192 bits are replaced  
with the inband loopback while the F-bit is occupied by Frame Alignment Pattern, DL or CRC-6.  
= 1: disable the Frame Generator block, that is, disable to form the SF/ESF frame. It transmits the inband loopback code in un-framed mode, that  
is, all 193 bits are replaced with the inband loopback code.  
CL[1:0]:  
The CL[1:0] define the length of the loopback code to be transmitted, meanwhile, they define the valid code in the IBC[7:0] (b7~0, T1/J1-047H):  
CL[1:0]  
0 0  
0 1  
1 0  
1 1  
Loopback Code Length & valid code in the IBC[7:0]  
5-bit length & the code in the IBC[7:3] is valid  
6-bit or 3-bit length & the code in the IBC[7:2] is valid  
7-bit length & the code in the IBC[7:1] is valid  
8-bit or 4-bit length & the code in the IBC[7:0] is valid  
238  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 IBCG Loopback Code (047H, 0C7H, 147H, 1C7H, 247H, 2C7H, 347H, 3C7H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
IBC7  
R/W  
X
IBC6  
R/W  
X
IBC5  
R/W  
X
IBC4  
R/W  
X
IBC3  
R/W  
X
IBC2  
R/W  
X
IBC1  
R/W  
X
IBC0  
R/W  
X
Default  
The IBC[7:X] defines the content of the inband loopback code. ‘X’ is one of 3 to 0 which is depending on the length defined by the CL[1:0] (b1~0,  
T1/J1-046H). The IBC[7] is the MSB.  
T1 / J1 PMON Interrupt Enable / Status (049H, 0C9H, 149H, 1C9H, 249H, 2C9H, 349H, 3C9H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
XFER  
R
0
OVR  
R
INTE  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Default  
0
0
INTE:  
= 0: disabled the interrupt on the INT pin when the counter data has been transferred into the Error Count registers.  
= 1: enabled the interrupt on the INT pin when the counter data has been transferred into the Error Count registers.  
XFER:  
= 0: indicate that the counter data has not been transferred to the Error Count registers.  
= 1: indicate that the counter data has been transferred to the Error Count registers.  
This bit is clear to 0 after the bit is read.  
OVR:  
= 0: indicate that no overwritten on the Error Count registers has occurred.  
= 1: indicate that one of the Error Count registers is overwritten.  
This bit is clear to 0 after the bit is read.  
Registers 04A-04FH, 0CA-0CFH, 14A-14FH, 1CA-1CFH, 24A-24FH, 2CA-2CFH, 34A-34FH, 3CA-3CFH:  
The PMON Error Count registers for a single framer are updated as a group by writing to any of the PMON count registers or updated every 1  
second when the AUTOUPDATE (b0, T1/J1-000H) is set. The PMON Error Count registers for eight framers are updated by writing to the Chip ID/  
Global PMON Update register (T1/J1-00CH).  
When the chip is reset, the contents of the PMON Error Count registers are unknown until the first latching of performance data is performed.  
239  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 PMON BEE Count (LSB) (04AH, 0CAH, 14AH, 1CAH, 24AH, 2CAH, 34AH, 3CAH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
BEE7  
R
6
BEE6  
R
5
BEE5  
R
4
BEE4  
R
3
BEE3  
R
2
BEE2  
R
1
BEE1  
R
0
BEE0  
R
Default  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
T1 / J1 PMON BEE Count (MSB) (04BH, 0CBH, 14BH, 1CBH, 24BH, 2CBH, 34BH, 3CBH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
BEE11  
R
2
BEE10  
R
1
BEE9  
R
0
BEE8  
R
Reserved  
Default  
X
X
X
X
In the ESF format, the BEE[11:0] represent the number of the CRC-6 errors, that is, the differences between the received CRC-6 and the local  
calculated CRC-6  
In the SF format, the BEE[11:0] represent the number of the bit errors in the Frame Alignment Pattern.  
This register is updated on the defined intervals.  
T1 / J1 PMON FER Count (LSB) (04CH, 0CCH, 14CH, 1CCH, 24CH, 2CCH, 34CH, 3CCH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
FER7  
R
6
FER6  
R
5
FER5  
R
4
FER4  
R
3
FER3  
R
2
FER2  
R
1
FER1  
R
0
FER0  
R
Default  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
T1 / J1 PMON FER Count (MSB) (04DH, 0CDH, 14DH, 1CDH, 24DH, 2CDH, 34DH, 3CDH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
FER8  
R
Reserved  
Default  
X
The FER[8:0] represent the number of the bit errors in the Frame Alignment Pattern.  
This register is updated on the defined intervals.  
240  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 PMON OOF Count (04EH, 0CEH, 14EH, 1CEH, 24EH, 2CEH, 34EH, 3CEH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
OOF4  
R
3
OOF3  
R
2
OOF2  
R
1
OOF1  
R
0
OOF0  
R
Reserved  
Default  
X
X
X
X
X
The OOF[4:0] represent the number of the out of SF/ESF sync events and update on the defined intervals  
T1 / J1 PMON COFA Count(04FH, 0CFH, 14FH, 1CFH, 24FH, 2CFH, 34FH, 3CFH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
COFA2  
R
1
COFA1  
R
0
COFA0  
R
Reserved  
Default  
X
X
X
The COFA[2:0] represent the number of the changes of the Frame Alignment Pattern position and update on the defined intervals  
T1 / J1 RPLC Configuration (050H, 0D0H, 150H, 1D0H, 250H, 2D0H, 350H, 3D0H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PCCE  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Default  
PCCE:  
= 0: the per-channel functions in RPLC are disabled.  
= 1: the per-channel functions in RPLC are enabled.  
241  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 RPLCmP Access Status (051H, 0D1H, 151H, 1D1H, 251H, 2D1H, 351H, 3D1H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
BUSY  
R
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Reserved  
Default  
0
BUSY:  
= 0: no reading or writing operation on the indirect registers.  
= 1: an internal indirect register is being accessed, any new operation on the internal indirect register is not allowed.  
This bit goes low timed to an internal high-speed clock rising edge after the operation has been completed. The operation cycle is 640ns. No  
more operations to the indirect registers could be done until this bit is cleared.  
T1 / J1 RPLC Channel Indirect Address / Control (052H, 0D2H, 152H, 1D2H, 252H, 2D2H, 352H, 3D2H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
R/WB  
R/W  
0
6
A6  
R/W  
0
5
A5  
R/W  
0
4
A4  
R/W  
0
3
A3  
R/W  
0
2
A2  
R/W  
0
1
A1  
R/W  
0
0
A0  
R/W  
0
Default  
Writing to this register with a valid address and R/WB bit initiates an internal operation cycle to the indirect registers.  
R/WB:  
= 0: write the data to the specified indirect register.  
= 1: read the data from the specified indirect register.  
A[6:0]:  
Specify the address of the indirect registers (from 01H to 48H) for the microprocessor access.  
T1 / J1 RPLC Channel Indirect Data Buffer (053H, 0D3H, 153H, 1D3H, 253H, 2D3H, 353H, 3D3H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
D7  
R/W  
0
6
D6  
R/W  
0
5
D5  
R/W  
0
4
D4  
R/W  
0
3
D3  
R/W  
0
2
D2  
R/W  
0
1
D1  
R/W  
0
0
D0  
R/W  
0
Default  
This register holds the value which will be read from or written to the indirect registers (from 01H to 48H). If data are to be written to the indirect  
registers, the byte to be written must be written into this register before the target indirect register’s address and R/WB=0 is written into the Address/  
Control register, initiating the access. If data are to be read from the indirect registers, only the target indirect register’s address and R/WB=1 is  
written into the Address/Control register, initiating the request. After 640 ns, this register will contain the requested data byte.  
RPLC Indirect Registers Map  
01H ~ 18H  
19H ~ 30H  
31H ~ 48H  
Per-Channel Configuration for Channel 1 ~ 24  
Data Trunk Conditioning Code for Channel 1 ~ 24  
Signaling Trunk Conditioning for Channel 1 ~ 24  
242  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 RPLC Per-Channel Configuration Registers (RPLC Indirect Registers 01H – 18H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
INVERT  
R/W  
X
6
DTRKC  
R/W  
X
5
4
SIGNINV  
R/W  
3
TEST  
R/W  
X
2
EXTRACT  
R/W  
1
0
DMW  
R/W  
X
FIX  
R/W  
X
POL  
R/W  
X
Default  
X
X
INVERT:  
This bit, together with the SIGNINV (b4, T1/J1-RPLC-indirect register - 01~18H), determines the bit inversion of the corresponding channel when  
output from the RSDn/MRSD pin.  
INVERT  
SIGNINV  
Bit Inversion  
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
No bit inversion  
Invert the MSB of the corresponding channel  
Invert all the bits of the corresponding channel  
Invert all the bits except the MSB of the corresponding channel  
DTRKC:  
= 0: disable the data in the corresponding channel to be replaced by the data set in the DTRK[7:0] (b7~0, T1/J1-19~30H) when output on the  
RSDn/MRSD pin.  
= 1: enable the data in the corresponding channel to be replaced by the data set in the DTRK[7:0] (b7~0, T1/J1-19~30H) when output on the  
RSDn/MRSD pin.  
DMW:  
= 0: disable the data in the corresponding channel to be replaced with a digital milliwatt pattern when output on the RSDn/MRSD pin.  
= 1: enable the data in the corresponding channel to be replaced with a digital milliwatt pattern when output on the RSDn/MRSD pin.  
SIGNINV:  
Refer to the INVERT (b7, T1/J1-RPLC-indirect register - 01~18H)  
TEST:  
= 0: disable the data in the corresponding channel to be tested by PRGD.  
= 1: enable the data in the corresponding channel to be extracted to PRGD for test (when the RXPATGEN [b2, T1/J1-00FH] is logic 0), or enable  
the test pattern from PRGD to replace the data in the corresponding channel for test (when the RXPATGEN [b2, T1/J1-00FH] is logic 1).  
All the channels that are extracted to the PRGD are concatenated and treated as a continuous stream in which pseudo random are searched for.  
Similarly, all channels set to be replaced with PRGD test pattern data are concatenated replaced by the PRBS.  
EXTRACT:  
This bit is valid in Receive Clock Slave Fractional T1/J1 mode:  
= 0: RSCKn is held in its inactivated state.  
= 1: RSCKn is clocked for the corresponding channel.  
FIX:  
= 0: disable the signaling bit of the corresponding channel to be fixed with the value set by the POL when output on the RSDn/MRSD pin.  
= 1: enable the signaling bit of the corresponding channel to be fixed with the value set by the POL when output on the RSDn/MRSD pin.  
POL:  
Valid when the FIX is logic 1:  
= 0: fix the signaling bit of the corresponding channel to be logic 0.  
= 1: fix the signaling bit of the corresponding channel to be logic 1.  
The priority of the RPLC operation of the corresponding channel on the RSDn/MRSD pin from high to low is:  
Extract data to PRGD for test; Replace the data with the value in the DTRK[7:0]; Replace the data with the milliwatt pattern; Replace the data with  
the pattern generated in the PRGD; Invert the bits in the channel; Fix the signaling bit.  
243  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 RPLC Data Trunk Conditioning Code Byte Registers (RPLC Indirect Registers 19H – 30H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
DTRK7  
R/W  
X
6
DTRK6  
R/W  
X
5
DTRK5  
R/W  
X
4
DTRK4  
R/W  
X
3
DTRK3  
R/W  
X
2
DTRK2  
R/W  
X
1
DTRK1  
R/W  
X
0
DTRK0  
R/W  
X
Default  
These indirect registers contain the data that will replace the data output on the RSDn/MRSD pin when the corresponding DTRKC (b6, T1/J1-  
RPLC-indirect registers-01~18H) is logic 1. DTRK7 is the MSB.  
T1 / J1 RPLC Signaling Trunk Conditioning Byte Registers (RPLC Indirect Registers 31H – 48H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
STRKC  
R/W  
X
6
5
4
3
A
R/W  
X
2
B
R/W  
X
1
C
R/W  
X
0
D
R/W  
X
Reserved  
Default  
STRKC:  
= 0: disable the signaling of the corresponding channel to be replaced by the data set in the A, B, C, D (b3~0, T1/J1-RPLC-indirect registers-  
31~48H) when output on the RSSIGn/MRSSIG pin.  
= 1: enable the signaling of the corresponding channel to be replaced by the data set in the A, B, C, D (b3~0, T1/J1-RPLC-indirect registers-  
31~48H) when output on the RSSIGn/MRSSIG pin.  
A, B, C, D:  
These bits contain the data that will replace the data output on the RSSIGn/MRSSIG pin when the corresponding STRKC (b7, T1/J1-RPLC-  
indirect registers-31~48H) is logic 1. They are in the least significant nibble.  
244  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 RHDLC #1, #2 Configuration (054H, 0D4H, 154H, 1D4H, 254H, 2D4H, 354H, 3D4H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
2
MM  
R/W  
0
1
TR  
R/W  
0
0
EN  
R/W  
0
MEN  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Default  
Selection of the RHDLC block (#1 or #2) whose registers are visible on the microprocessor interface is done via the RHDLCSEL[1:0] (b7~6, T1/  
J1-00DH).  
MEN, MM:  
The MEN & MM define the address matching mode:  
MEN  
0
1
MM  
X
0
Address Matching Mode  
No address matching is needed. All the HDLC data are stored in the FIFO.  
The HDLC data are stored in the FIFO when the first byte is all ones or the same as the setting in the PA[7:0] (b7~0, T1/J1-  
058H) or the SA[7:0] (b7~0, T1/J1-059H).  
1
1
The HDLC data are stored in the FIFO when the most significant 6 bits in the first byte are all ones or the same as the  
setting in the PA[7:2] (b7~2, T1/J1-058H) or the SA[7:2] (b7~2, T1/J1-059H).  
TR:  
= 0: Normal operation.  
= 1: forces the RHDLC to immediately terminate the reception of the current data frame, empty the FIFO buffer, clear the interrupts and initiate a  
new HDLC searching.  
This bit is clear to 0 after a rising and falling edge occur on the internal clock or after the register is read.  
EN:  
= 0: disabled the operation of the RHDLC block and all the FIFO buffer and interrupts are cleared.  
= 1: enabled the operation of the RHDLC block and the HDLC opening flag will be searched immediately.  
If the EN is set from logic 1 to logic 0 and back to logic 1, the RHDLC will immediately terminate the reception of the current data frame, empty  
the FIFO buffer, clear the interrupts and initiate a new HDLC searching.  
245  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 RHDLC #1, #2 Interrupt Control (055H, 0D5H, 155H, 1D5H, 255H, 2D5H, 355H, 3D5H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
INTC[6]  
R/W  
0
5
INTC[5]  
R/W  
0
4
INTC[4]  
R/W  
0
3
INTC[3]  
R/W  
0
2
INTC[2]  
R/W  
0
1
INTC[1]  
R/W  
0
0
INTC[0]  
R/W  
0
INTE  
R/W  
0
Default  
Selection of the RHDLC block (#1 or #2) whose registers are visible on the microprocessor interface is done via the RHDLCSEL[1:0] (b7~6, T1/  
J1-00DH).  
INTE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when there is a transition from 0 to 1 on the INTR (b0, T1/J1-056H).  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when there is a transition from 0 to 1 on the INTR (b0, T1/J1-056H).  
INTC[6:0]:  
These bits set the interrupt set point of the FIFO buffer. Exceeding the set point will cause an interrupt, and the interrupt will persist until the FIFO  
is empty. The set point is decimal 128 when the INTC[6:0] is all zeros.  
The contents of this register should only be changed when the EN (b0, T1/J1-054H) is logic 0. This prevents any erroneous interrupt generation.  
246  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 RHDLC #1, #2 Status (056H, 0D6H, 156H, 1D6H, 256H, 2D6H, 356H, 3D6H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
FE  
R
6
OVR  
R
5
COLS  
R
4
PKIN  
R
3
PBS[2]  
R
2
PBS[1]  
R
1
PBS[0]  
R
0
INTR  
R
Default  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Selection of the RHDLC block (#1 or #2) whose registers are visible on the microprocessor interface is done via the RHDLCSEL[1:0] (b7~6, T1/  
J1-00DH).  
FE:  
= 0: the FIFO is loaded with data.  
= 1: the FIFO is empty.  
OVR:  
The overwritten condition occurs when data are written over unread data in the FIFO buffer. This bit is cleared to 0 after the register is read.  
= 0: no overwritten occurs.  
= 1: the FIFO is overwritten, and then the FIFO is reset , which cause the COLS and PKIN to be reset to logic 0.  
COLS:  
This bit reflects the HDLC link status change.  
= 0: normal operation.  
= 1: the first HDLC opening flag sequence (7E) activated the HDLC or the HDLC abort sequence (7F) deactivated the HDLC is detected.  
This bit is cleared to 0 after the bit is read, or after the OVR transitions to logic 1, or after the EN is cleared.  
PKIN:  
= 0: the last byte of a non-aborted packet is not written into the FIFO.  
= 1: the last byte of a non-aborted packet is written into the FIFO.  
This bit is cleared to 0 after the bit is read, or after the OVR transitions to logic 1.  
PBS[2:0]:  
The PBS[2:0] indicate the status of the last byte read from the FIFO.  
PBS[2:0]  
Status of the Data  
000  
001  
010  
011  
100  
Normal data  
A dummy byte to indicate the first HDLC opening flag sequence (7E) was detected, which means the HDLC link became active.  
A dummy byte to indicate the HDLC abort sequence (7F) was detected, which means the HDLC link became inactive.  
Reserved  
The last byte of a non-aborted HDLC packet was received. The HDLC packet is in an integer number of bytes and has no FCS  
error.  
101  
110  
111  
The last byte of a non-aborted HDLC packet was received and a non-integer number of bytes is in the packet.  
The last byte of a non-aborted HDLC packet was received. The HDLC packet is in an integer number of bytes and has FCS error.  
The last byte of a non-aborted HDLC packet was received. The HDLC packet is in a non-integer number of bytes and has FCS  
error.  
INTR:  
= 0: no interrupt sources in the HDLC Receiver block occurred.  
= 1: any one of the interrupt sources in the HDLC Receiver block occurred. The interrupt sources in the HDLC Receiver are: 1. Receiving the first  
7E opening flag sequence which activates the HDLC link; 2. A packet was received; 3. Change of link status; 4. Exceeding the set point of the FIFO  
which is defined in the INTC[6:0] (b6~0, T1/J1-055H); 5. Over-writting the FIFO.  
This bit is cleared to 0 after the bit is read.  
247  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 RHDLC #1, #2 Data (057H, 0D7H, 157H, 1D7H, 257H, 2D7H, 357H, 3D7H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
RD[7]  
R
6
RD[6]  
R
5
RD[5]  
R
4
RD[4]  
R
3
RD[3]  
R
2
RD[2]  
R
1
RD[1]  
R
0
RD[0]  
R
Default  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
Selection of the RHDLC block (#1 or #2) whose registers are visible on the microprocessor interface is done via the RHDLCSEL[1:0] (b7~6, T1/  
J1-00DH).  
RD[7:0]:  
These bits represent the bytes read from the FIFO. These bits should not be accessed at a rate greater than 1/15 of the XCK rate.  
The RD[0] corresponds to the first bit of the serial received data from the FIFO.  
T1 / J1 RHDLC #1, #2 Primary Address Match (058H, 0D8H, 158H, 1D8H, 258H, 2D8H, 358H, 3D8H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
PA[7]  
R/W  
1
6
PA[6]  
R/W  
1
5
PA[5]  
R/W  
1
4
PA[4]  
R/W  
1
3
PA[3]  
R/W  
1
2
PA[2]  
R/W  
1
1
PA[1]  
R/W  
1
0
PA[0]  
R/W  
1
Default  
Selection of the RHDLC block (#1 or #2) whose registers are visible on the microprocessor interface is done via the RHDLCSEL[1:0] (b7~6, T1/  
J1-00DH).  
PA[7:0]:  
These bits stipulate the primary address pattern.  
PA[0] compares to the first bit of the serial data.  
T1 / J1 RHDLC #1, #2 Second Address Match (059H, 0D9H, 159H, 1D9H, 259H, 2D9H, 359H, 3D9H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
SA[7]  
R/W  
1
6
SA[6]  
R/W  
1
5
SA[5]  
R/W  
1
4
SA[4]  
R/W  
1
3
SA[3]  
R/W  
1
2
SA[2]  
R/W  
1
1
SA[1]  
R/W  
1
0
SA[0]  
R/W  
1
Default  
Selection of the RHDLC block (#1 or #2) whose registers are visible on the microprocessor interface is done via the RHDLCSEL[1:0] (b7~6, T1/  
J1-00DH).  
SA[7:0]:  
These bits stipulate the secondary address pattern.  
SA[0] compares to the first bit of the serial data.  
248  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 TBOM Code (05DH, 0DDH, 15DH, 1DDH, 25DH, 2DDH, 35DH, 3DDH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
BOC[5]  
R/W  
1
4
BOC[4]  
R/W  
1
3
BOC[3]  
R/W  
1
2
BOC[2]  
R/W  
1
1
BOC[1]  
R/W  
1
0
BOC[0]  
R/W  
1
Reserved  
Default  
When the BOC[5:0] are written with any 6-bit code other than the ‘111111’, the code will be transmitted as the Bit Oriented Message (BOM),  
overwriting any HDLC packets currently being transmitted. The BOM pattern is ‘111111110BOC[0]BOC[1]BOC[2]BOC[3]BOC[4]BOC[5]0’, that is, the  
BOC[0] is transmitted first.  
249  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 PRGD Control (060H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
PDR[1]  
R/W  
0
6
PDR[0]  
R/W  
0
5
4
PS  
R/W  
0
3
TINV  
R/W  
0
2
RINV  
R/W  
0
1
0
MANSYNC  
R/W  
AUTOSYNC  
Reserved  
R/W  
1
Default  
0
PDR[1:0]:  
The PDR[1:0] define the function of the four PRGD Pattern Detector registers:  
PDR[1:0]  
00, 01  
10  
PRGD Pattern Detector Registers (#1 ~ #4)  
Pattern Receive  
Error Count  
Bit Count  
11  
(The #1 is the LSB, while the #4 is the MSB.)  
PS:  
= 0: a pseudo-random pattern is generated/detected by the PRGD.  
= 1: a repetitive pattern is generated/detected by the PRGD.  
This bit should be set first of all the PRGD registers.  
TINV:  
= 0: disable inverting the generated pattern before being transmitted.  
= 1: enable inverting the generated pattern before being transmitted.  
RINV:  
= 0: disable inverting the received pattern before being processed.  
= 1: enable inverting the received pattern before being processed.  
AUTOSYNC:  
= 0: disable automatic re-search for the sync of the pattern after the pattern is out of synchronization.  
= 1: enable automatic re-search for the sync of the pattern after the pattern is out of synchronization.  
MANSYNC:  
Trigger on the rising edge. A transition from logic 0 to logic 1 on this bit manually initiates a re-search for the sync of a pattern.  
Each time the value of the PRGD registers is changed or the detector data source changes, a manual sync operation is recommended to ensure  
that the detector works correctly.  
250  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 PRGD Interrupt Enable / Status (061H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
SYNCE  
R/W  
0
6
5
XFERE  
R/W  
0
4
3
SYNCI  
R
2
BEI  
R
1
XFERI  
R
0
OVR  
R
BEE  
R/W  
0
SYNCV  
R
X
Default  
X
X
X
X
SYNCE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the SYNCI is logic one.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the SYNCI is logic one.  
BEE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when at least one bit error has been detected in the received pattern.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when at least one bit error has been detected in the received pattern.  
XFERE:  
= 0: disable the interrupt on the INT pin when the the data in the PRGD pattern detector register is updated.  
= 1: enable the interrupt on the INT pin when the the data in the PRGD pattern detector register is updated.  
SYNCV:  
= 0: the pattern is out of sync (the pattern detector has detected 10 or more bit errors in a fixed 48-bit window).  
= 1: the pattern is in sync (the pattern detector has observed at least 48 consecutive error-free bit periods).  
SYNCI:  
= 0: there is no transition on the SYNCV.  
= 1: there is a transition (from 0 to 1 or from 1 to 0) on the SYNCV.  
This bit is cleared to 0 after the bit is read.  
BEI:  
= 0: no bit error is detected in the received pattern.  
= 1: at least one bit error has been detected in the received pattern.  
This bit is cleared to 0 after the bit is read.  
XFERI:  
= 0: the data in the PRGD pattern detector register is not updated.  
= 1: the data in the PRGD pattern detector register is updated.  
This bit is cleared to 0 after the bit is read.  
OVR:  
= 0: the PRGD pattern detector register is not overwritten.  
= 1: the PRGD pattern detector register is overwritten.  
This bit is cleared to 0 after the bit is read.  
251  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 PRGD Shift Register Length (062H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
PL[4]  
R/W  
0
3
PL[3]  
R/W  
0
2
PL[2]  
R/W  
0
1
PL[1]  
R/W  
0
0
PL[0]  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Default  
These bits determine the length of the valid data in the PRGD pattern insertion register. The length is equal to the value of PL[4:0] + 1.  
T1 / J1 PRGD Tap (063H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
PT[4]  
R/W  
0
3
PT[3]  
R/W  
0
2
PT[2]  
R/W  
0
1
PT[1]  
R/W  
0
0
PT[0]  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Default  
These bits determine the feedback tap position of the generated pseudo random pattern before it is transmitted. The feedback tap position is  
equal to the value of PT[4:0] + 1. In application, the PT is always less than the PL.  
T1 / J1 PRGD Error Insertion (064H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
3
EVENT  
R/W  
0
2
EIR[2]  
R/W  
0
1
EIR[1]  
R/W  
0
0
EIR[0]  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
Default  
EVENT:  
A single bit error is generated when the state of this bit is changed from 0 to 1. To insert another bit error, this bit must be cleared to 0, and then set  
from 0 to 1 again.  
EIR[2:0]:  
The EIR[2:0] bits determine the bit error rate that will be inserted in the PRGD test pattern. If the bit error rate is changed from one non- zero value  
to another non-zero value, it is recommended to set the EIR[2:0] to ‘000’ first, then set the EIR[2:0] to the desired value.  
EIR[2:0]  
0 0 0  
0 0 1  
0 1 0  
0 1 1  
1 0 0  
1 0 1  
1 1 0  
1 1 1  
Bit error rate  
No error inserted  
No error inserted  
10-2  
10-3  
10-4  
10-5  
10-6  
10-7  
252  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 PRGD Pattern Insertion #1 (068H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
PI[7]  
R/W  
0
6
PI[6]  
R/W  
0
5
PI[5]  
R/W  
0
4
PI[4]  
R/W  
0
3
PI[3]  
R/W  
0
2
PI[2]  
R/W  
0
1
PI[1]  
R/W  
0
0
PI[0]  
R/W  
0
Default  
T1 / J1 PRGD Pattern Insertion #2 (069H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
PI[15]  
R/W  
0
6
PI[14]  
R/W  
0
5
PI[13]  
R/W  
0
4
PI[12]  
R/W  
0
3
PI[11]  
R/W  
0
2
PI[10]  
R/W  
0
1
PI[9]  
R/W  
0
0
PI[8]  
R/W  
0
Default  
T1 / J1 PRGD Pattern Insertion #3 (06AH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
PI[23]  
R/W  
0
6
PI[22]  
R/W  
0
5
PI[21]  
R/W  
0
4
PI[20]  
R/W  
0
3
PI[19]  
R/W  
0
2
PI[18]  
R/W  
0
1
PI[17]  
R/W  
0
0
PI[16]  
R/W  
0
Default  
T1 / J1 PRGD Pattern Insertion #4 (06BH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
PI[31]  
R/W  
0
6
PI[30]  
R/W  
0
5
PI[29]  
R/W  
0
4
PI[28]  
R/W  
0
3
PI[27]  
R/W  
0
2
PI[26]  
R/W  
0
1
PI[25]  
R/W  
0
0
PI[24]  
R/W  
0
Default  
When a repetitive pattern is selected to transmit, the data in these registers are the repetitive pattern.  
When a pseudo random pattern is selected to transmit, the data in these registers should be set to FFFFFFFFH. They are the initial value for the  
pseudo random pattern.  
Writing to PI[31:24] updates the PRGD configuration.  
When a repetitive pattern is transmitted, the PI[31] is transmitted first, followed by the remaining bits in sequence down to PI[0]. The length of the  
valid data in these four registers is determined by the PL[4:0]. When the length is less than 31, the bits in higher PI are not used.  
253  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 PRGD Pattern Detector #1 (06CH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
PD[7]  
R
6
PD[6]  
R
5
PD[5]  
R
4
PD[4]  
R
3
PD[3]  
R
2
PD[2]  
R
1
PD[1]  
R
0
PD[0]  
R
Default  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
T1 / J1 PRGD Pattern Detector #2 (06DH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
PD[15]  
R
6
PD[14]  
R
5
PD[13]  
R
4
PD[12]  
R
3
PD[11]  
R
2
PD[10]  
R
1
PD[9]  
R
0
PD[8]  
R
Default  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
T1 / J1 PRGD Pattern Detector #3 (06EH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
PD[23]  
R
6
PD[22]  
R
5
PD[21]  
R
4
PD[20]  
R
3
PD[19]  
R
2
PD[18]  
R
1
PD[17]  
R
0
PD[16]  
R
Default  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
T1 / J1 PRGD Pattern Detector #4 (06FH)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
PD[31]  
R
6
PD[30]  
R
5
PD[29]  
R
4
PD[28]  
R
3
PD[27]  
R
2
PD[26]  
R
1
PD[25]  
R
0
PD[24]  
R
Default  
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
When the PDR[1:0] (b7~6, T1/J1-060H) are set to 00 or 01, the four PRGD pattern detector registers are configured as Pattern Receive registers.  
They reflect the content of the received pattern.  
When the PDR[1:0] (b7~6, T1/J1-060H) are set to 10, the four PRGD pattern detector registers are configured as Error Counter registers. The  
value in these registers represent the number of bit errors. The bit errors are not accumulated when the pattern is out of sync.  
When the PDR[1:0] (b7~6, T1/J1-060H) are set to 11, the four PRGD pattern detector registers are configured as Bit Counter registers. The value  
in these registers represent the total received bit number.  
These registers are updated each second automatically, or by writing to any of these four registers, or to the Revision / Chip ID / Global PMON  
register.  
254  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 RHDLC Receive Data Link 2 Control (TXCISEL = 0)(070H, 0F0H, 170H, 1F0H, 270H, 2F0H, 370H, 3F0H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
DL2_EVEN  
R/W  
6
DL2_ODD  
R/W  
5
4
DL2_TS[4]  
R/W  
3
DL2_TS[3]  
R/W  
2
DL2_TS[2]  
R/W  
1
DL2_TS[1]  
R/W  
0
DL2_TS[0]  
R/W  
Reserved  
Default  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
When the TXCISEL (b3, T1/J1-00DH) is 0, this register is used for the Receive HDLC #2.  
DL2_EVEN:  
= 0: the data is not extracted from the even frames.  
= 1: the data is extracted from the even frames.  
DL2_ODD:  
= 0: the data is not extracted from the odd frames.  
= 1: the data is extracted from the odd frames.  
DL2_TS[4:0]:  
These bits binary define one channel of even and/or odd frames to extract the data from. They are invalid when the DL2_EVEN and the DL2_ODD  
are both logic 0.  
T1 / J1 RHDLC Data Link 2 Bit Select (TXCISEL = 0) (071H, 0F1H, 171H, 1F1H, 271H, 2F1H, 371H, 3F1H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
DL2_BIT[7]  
R/W  
6
DL2_BIT[6]  
R/W  
5
DL2_BIT[5]  
R/W  
4
DL2_BIT[4]  
R/W  
3
DL2_BIT[3]  
R/W  
2
DL2_BIT[2]  
R/W  
1
DL2_BIT[1]  
R/W  
0
DL2_BIT[0]  
R/W  
Default  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
When the TXCISEL (b3, T1/J1-00DH) is 0, this register is used for the Receive HDLC #2.  
DL2_BITn:  
= 0: the data is not extracted from the corresponding bit.  
= 1: the data is extracted from the corresponding bit of the assigned channel.  
These bits are invalid when the DL2_EVEN and the DL2_ODD are both logic 0.  
The DL1_BIT[7] corresponds to the first bit (MSB) of the selected channel.  
255  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 THDLC Transmit Data Link 2 Control (TXCISEL = 1)(070H, 0F0H, 170H, 1F0H, 270H, 2F0H, 370H, 3F0H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
DL2_EVEN  
R/W  
6
DL2_ODD  
R/W  
5
4
DL2_TS[4]  
R/W  
3
DL2_TS[3]  
R/W  
2
DL2_TS[2]  
R/W  
1
DL2_TS[1]  
R/W  
0
DL2_TS[0]  
R/W  
Reserved  
Default  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
When the TXCISEL (b3, T1/J1-00DH) is 1, this register is used for the Transmit HDLC #2.  
DL2_EVEN:  
= 0: the data is not inserted to the even frames.  
= 1: the data is inserted to the even frames.  
DL2_ODD:  
= 0: the data is not inserted to the odd frames.  
= 1: the data is inserted to the odd frames.  
DL2_TS[4:0]:  
These bits binary define one channel of even and/or odd frames to insert the data to. They are invalid when the DL2_EVEN and the DL2_ODD are  
both logic 0.  
T1 / J1 THDLC Data Link 2 Bit Select (TXCISEL = 1) (071H, 0F1H, 171H, 1F1H, 271H, 2F1H, 371H, 3F1H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
DL2_BIT[7]  
R/W  
6
DL2_BIT[6]  
R/W  
5
DL2_BIT[5]  
R/W  
4
DL2_BIT[4]  
R/W  
3
DL2_BIT[3]  
R/W  
2
DL2_BIT[2]  
R/W  
1
DL2_BIT[1]  
R/W  
0
DL2_BIT[0]  
R/W  
Default  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
When the TXCISEL (b3, T1/J1-00DH) is 1, this register is used for the Transmit HDLC #2.  
DL2_BITn:  
= 0: the data is not inserted to the corresponding bit.  
= 1: the data is inserted to the corresponding bit of the assigned channel.  
These bits are invalid when the DL2_EVEN and the DL2_ODD are both logic 0.  
The DL1_BIT[0] corresponds to the first bit (MSB) of the selected channel.  
256  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 RESI Timeslot Offset (077H, 0F7H, 177H, 1F7H, 277H, 2F7H, 377H, 3F7H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
TSOFF[6]  
R/W  
5
TSOFF[5]  
R/W  
4
TSOFF[4]  
R/W  
3
TSOFF[3]  
R/W  
2
TSOFF[2]  
R/W  
1
TSOFF[1]  
R/W  
0
TSOFF[0]  
R/W  
Reserved  
Default  
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
In the Receive Clock Slave mode, when the data rate on the system side is 2.048M bit/s (the RSCCK2M [b4, T1/J1-001H] and RSCCK8M [b3,  
T1/J1-001H] are set to ‘10’), these bits determine the channel offset between the RSCFS and the start of the corresponding frame on the RSDn (and  
RSSIGn).  
In the Receive Multiplexed mode, these bits determine the channel offset between the MRSCFS and the start of the corresponding frame on the  
MRSD and MRSSIG.  
In the Receive Clock Slave mode, when the data rate on the system side is 1.544M bit/s, and in Receive Clock Master mode, the channel offset  
is disabled. Thus, the TSOFF must be set to 0.  
They define a binary number. The offset can be set from 0 to 127 channels.  
257  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
T1 / J1 RESI Timeslot Offset (078H, 0F8H, 178H, 1F8H, 278H, 2F8H, 378H, 3F8H)  
Bit No.  
BitName  
Type  
7
6
5
4
CMS  
R/W  
0
3
BOFF_EN  
R/W  
2
BOFF[2]  
R/W  
0
1
BOFF[1]  
R/W  
0
0
BOFF[0]  
R/W  
0
FPINV RSD_RSCFS_EDGE  
R/W  
0
Reserved  
R/W  
0
Default  
0
FPINV:  
= 0: The receive framing pulse RSCFS and RSFSn/MRSFS are active high.  
= 1: The receive framing pulse RSCFS and RSFSn/MRSFS are active low.  
When the bit indicates the RSCFS and MRSFS polarity, the bits of all eight framers must have the same value.  
RSD_RSCFS_EDGE:  
Valid when the CMS (b4, T1/J1-078H) is logic 1 and the setting in the RSCFSFALL (b1, T1/J1-003H) and that in the RSCCKRISE (b0, T1/J1-  
003H) are equal.  
= 0: select the second active edge of the RSCCK to update the signal on the RSDn, RSSIGn and RSFSn pins, or select the first active edge of  
the MRSCCK to update the signal on the MRSD, MRSSIG and MRSFS pins.  
= 1: select the first active edge of the RSCCK to update the signal on the RSDn, RSSIGn and RSFSn pins, or select the second active edge of  
the MRSCCK to update the signal on the MRSD, MRSSIG and MRSFS pins.  
(The signal on the RSCFS/MRSCFS pin is always sampled on the first active edge.)  
In Receive Multiplexed mode, the RSD_RSCFS_EDGE in all eight framers should be set to the same value.  
CMS:  
= 0: the bit rate of RSCCK/MRSCCK is the same as the bit rate of the backplane.  
= 1: the bit rate of RSCCK/MRSCCK is twice the bit rate of the backplane.  
The CMS in all eight framers should be set to the same value.  
BOFF_EN:  
Valid when the CMS (b4, T1/J1-078H) is 0.  
= 0: disable the bit offset.  
= 1: enable the bit offset.  
BOFF[2:0]:  
Valid when the CMS (b4, T1/J1-078H)is 0 and the BOFF_EN is logic 1.  
In Receive Clock Slave mode, when the data rate in the system side is 2.048M bit/s (the RSCCK2M [b4, T1/J1-001H] and RSCCK8M [b3, T1/J1-  
001H] are set to ‘10’), these bits determine the bit offset between the RSCFS and the start of the corresponding frame on the RSDn (and RSSIGn).  
In Receive Multiplexed mode, these bits determine the bit offset between the MRSCFS and the start of the corresponding frame on the MRSD and  
MRSSIG.  
In Receive Clock Slave mode, when the data rate in the system side is 1.544M bit/s, and in Receive Clock Master mode, the bit offset is disabled.  
These bits define a binary number. Programming of the Bit Offsets is consistent with the convention established by the Concentration Highway  
Interface (CHI) specification. Refer to the Functional Description for details.  
258  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Test Clock (TCK) input pins. Data are shifted into the registers via the  
Test Data Input (TDI) pin, and shifted out of the registers via the Test  
Data Output (TDO) pin. Both TDI and TDO are clocked at a rate deter-  
mined by TCK.  
The JTAG boundary scan registers includes BSR (Boundary Scan  
Register), IDR (Device Identification Register), BR (Bypass Register)  
and IR (Instruction Register). These will be described in the following  
pages. Refer to Figure - 83 for architecture.  
6
IEEE STD 1149.1 JTAG TEST  
ACCESS PORT  
The IDT82V2108 supports the digital Boundary Scan Specification as  
described in the IEEE 1149.1 standards.  
The boundary scan architecture consists of data and instruction reg-  
isters plus a Test Access Port (TAP) controller. Control of the TAP is  
achieved through signals applied to the Test Mode Select (TMS) and  
BSR (Boundary Scan Register)  
IDR (Device Identification Register)  
MUX  
TDI  
BR (Bypass Register)  
TDO  
IR (Instruction Register)  
Control<6:0>  
TMS  
TAP  
Select  
(Test Access Port)  
TRST  
Controller  
Output Enable  
TCK  
Figure - 83. JTAG Architecture  
259  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Table - 64. IR Code  
IR CODE INSTRUCTION  
COMMENTS  
000  
EXTEST  
The external test instruction allows testing of the interconnection to other devices. When the current instruction  
is the EXTEST instruction, the boundary scan register is placed between TDI and TDO. The signal on the input  
pins can be sampled by loading the boundary scan register using the Capture-DR state. The sampled values  
can then be viewed by shifting the boundary scan register using the Shift-DR state. The signal on the output  
pins can be controlled by loading patterns shifted in through input TDI into the boundary scan register using  
the Update-DR state.  
010  
SAMPLE /  
PRELOAD  
The SAMPLE/PRELOAD instruction is used to allow scanning of the boundary-scan register without causing  
interference to the normal operation of the on-chip system logic. Data received at system input pins is supplied  
without modification to the on-chip system logic; data from the on-chip system logic is driven without modification  
through the system output pins. SAMPLE allows a snapshot to be taken of the data flowing from the system  
pins to the on-chip system logic or vice versa, without interfering with the normal operation of the assembled  
board. PRELOAD allows an initial data pattern to be placed at the latched parallel outputs of boundary-scan  
register cells prior to selection of another boundary-scan test operation.  
001  
111  
100  
IDCODE  
BYPASS  
CLAMP  
The identification instruction is used to connect the identification register between TDI and TDO. The device’s  
identification code can then be shifted out using the Shift-DR state.  
The BYPASS instruction shifts data from input TDI to output TDO with one TCK clock period delay. The instruc-  
tion is used to bypass the device.  
This instruction allows the state of the signals driven from device pins to be determined from the boundary-scan  
register while the bypass register is selected as the serial path between TDI and TDO. The signals driven from  
the device pins will not change while the CLAMP instruction is selected.  
101  
011  
HIGHZ  
Use of the HIGHZ instruction places the device in a state in which all of its system logic outputs are placed in an  
inactive drive state (e.g., high impedance). In this state, and in-circuit test system may drive signals onto the con-  
nections normally driven by a device output without incurring the risk of damage to the device.  
(for manufactory test)  
260  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
6.2.2  
BYPASS REGISTER (BYR)  
6.1 JTAG INSTRUCTIONS AND INSTRUCTION  
REGISTER (IR)  
The IR (Instruction Register) with instruction decode block is used to  
select the test to be executed or the data register to be accessed or  
both.  
The instructions are shifted in LSB first to this 3-bit register. See  
Table - 64 for details of the codes and the instructions related.  
The BYR consists of a single bit. It can provide a serial path between  
the TDI input and TDO output, bypassing the BYR to reduce test access  
times.  
6.2.3  
BOUNDARY SCAN REGISTER (BSR)  
The scan chain uses 3 types of cells:  
• Input / Output cells: When used as input, the cells are able to  
sample and control the state of an external signal during BS tests. When  
used as output, the cells are able to control the state of an external  
signal during BS tests.  
• In/Out or Tri-state output cells: When configured as input, the cells  
are able to sample and control the state of an external signal. When  
configured as output, the cells are able to control the state of an external  
signal.  
• Control cell: This cell provides a signal for direction control of bi-  
directional or tri-state output pins during BS tests.  
The Boundary Scan sequence and the I/O Pad Cell type are  
illustrated in Table - 66:  
6.2 JTAG DATA REGISTER  
6.2.1  
DEVICE IDENTIFICATION REGISTER (IDR)  
The IDR can be set to define the Vision, the Part Number, the  
Manufacturer Identity and a fixed bit. The IDR is 32 bits long and is  
partitioned as in Table - 65. Data from the IDR is shifted out to the TDO  
LSB first.  
Table - 65. IDR  
BIT No.  
0
1~11  
12~27  
28~31  
COMMENTS  
Set to “1”  
Manufacturer Identity (033H)  
Part Number (04D0H)  
Version (2H)  
6.3 TEST ACCESS PORT CONTROLLER  
The TAP controller is a 16-state synchronous state machine. Figure -  
84 shows its state diagram. A description of each state follows. Note that  
the figure contains two main branches to access either the data or  
instruction registers. The value shown next to each state transition in this  
figure states the value present at TMS at each rising edge of TCK.  
Please refer to Table - 67 for details of the state description.  
Table - 66. Boundary Scan Sequence and the I/O Pad Cell Type  
Pin_name  
LRD[1]  
LRCK[1]  
LRD[2]  
LRCK[2]  
LRD[3]  
LRCK[3]  
LRD[4]  
LRCK[4]  
LTD[1]  
LTCK[1]  
LTD[2]  
LTCK[2]  
LTD[3]  
LTCK[3]  
LTD[4]  
LTCK[4]  
LTD[5]  
Cell Type  
Input  
Input  
Input  
Input  
Input  
Input  
Input  
Input  
Output  
Output  
Output  
Output  
Output  
Output  
Output  
Output  
Output  
Output  
Output  
Output  
Output  
BS *  
128  
127  
126  
125  
124  
123  
122  
121  
120  
119  
118  
117  
116  
115  
114  
113  
112  
111  
110  
109  
108  
Pin_name  
LTCK[7]  
LTD[8]  
LTCK[8]  
LRD[5]  
LRCK[5]  
LRD[6]  
LRCK[6]  
LRD[7]  
LRCK[7]  
LRD[8]  
LRCK[8]  
RST  
INT  
D[7:0]_EN  
D[0]  
D[1]  
D[2]  
D[3]  
D[4]  
D[5]  
Cell Type  
Output  
Output  
Output  
Input  
Input  
Input  
Input  
Input  
Input  
Input  
Input  
Input  
Output  
Control  
In/Out  
In/Out  
In/Out  
In/Out  
In/Out  
In/Out  
In/Out  
BS *  
107  
106  
105  
104  
103  
102  
101  
100  
99  
98  
97  
96  
95  
94  
93  
92  
91  
LTCK[5]  
LTD[6]  
LTCK[6]  
LTD[7]  
90  
89  
88  
87  
D[6]  
261  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Pin_name  
Cell Type  
Tri-state Output  
Control  
Output  
Tri-state Output  
Control  
Tri-state Output  
Control  
In/Out  
BS *  
37  
36  
35  
34  
33  
32  
31  
30  
29  
28  
27  
26  
25  
24  
23  
22  
21  
20  
19  
18  
17  
16  
15  
14  
13  
12  
11  
10  
9
Pin_name  
D[7]  
ALE  
A[0]  
A[1]  
A[2]  
A[3]  
A[4]  
A[5]  
A[6]  
A[7]  
A[8]  
A[9]  
A[10]  
CS  
WR  
RD  
Cell Type  
In/Out  
Input  
Input  
Input  
Input  
Input  
Input  
Input  
Input  
Input  
Input  
Input  
Input  
Input  
Input  
Input  
BS *  
86  
85  
84  
83  
82  
81  
80  
79  
78  
77  
76  
75  
74  
73  
72  
71  
70  
69  
68  
67  
66  
65  
64  
63  
62  
61  
60  
59  
58  
57  
56  
55  
54  
53  
52  
51  
50  
49  
48  
47  
46  
45  
44  
43  
42  
41  
40  
39  
38  
RSD[2]/MRSD[2]  
RSD[2]/MRSD[2]_EN  
RSFS[1]/MRSFS[1]  
RSCK[1]/RSSIG[1]/MRSSIG[1]  
RSCK[1]/RSSIG[1]/MRSSIG[1]_EN  
RSD[1]/MRSD[1]  
RSD[1]/MRSD[1]_EN  
TSSIG[8]/TSFS[8]  
TSSIG[8]/TSFS[8]_EN  
TSD[8]  
TSSIG[7]/TSFS[7]  
TSSIG[7]/TSFS[7]_EN  
TSD[7]  
TSSIG[6]/TSFS[6]  
TSSIG[6]/TSFS[6]_EN  
TSD[6]  
TSSIG[5]/TSFS[5]  
TSSIG[5]/TSFS[5]_EN  
TSD[5]  
TSSIG[4]/TSFS[4]  
TSSIG[4]/TSFS[4]_EN  
TSD[4]  
TSSIG[3]/TSFS[3]  
TSSIG[3]/TSFS[3]_EN  
TSD[3]  
TSFS[2]/TSSIG[2]/MTSSIG[2]  
TSFS[2]/TSSIG[2]/MTSSIG[2]_EN  
TSD[2]/MTSD[2]  
Control  
Input  
In/Out  
Control  
Input  
In/Out  
Control  
Input  
In/Out  
Control  
Input  
In/Out  
Control  
Input  
In/Out  
Control  
Input  
In/Out  
Control  
Input  
In/Out  
Control  
Input  
Input  
RSFS[8]  
Output  
Tri-state Output  
Control  
Tri-state Output  
Control  
Output  
Tri-state Output  
Control  
Tri-state Output  
Control  
Output  
Tri-state Output  
Control  
Tri-state Output  
Control  
Output  
Tri-state Output  
Control  
Tri-state Output  
Control  
Output  
Tri-state Output  
Control  
Tri-state Output  
Control  
Output  
Tri-state Output  
Control  
Tri-state Output  
Control  
RSCK[8]/RSSIG[8]  
RSCK[8]/RSSIG[8]_EN  
RSD[8]  
RSD[8]_EN  
RSFS[7]  
RSCK[7]/RSSIG[7]  
RSCK[7]/RSSIG[7]_EN  
RSD[7]  
RSD[7]_EN  
RSFS[6]  
RSCK[6]/RSSIG[6]  
RSCK[6]/RSSIG[6]_EN  
RSD[6]  
RSD[6]_EN  
RSFS[5]  
RSCK[5]/RSSIG[5]  
RSCK[5]/RSSIG[5]_EN  
RSD[5]  
RSD[5]_EN  
RSFS[4]  
RSCK[4]/RSSIG[4]  
RSCK[4]/RSSIG[4]_EN  
RSD[4]  
RSD[4]_EN  
RSFS[3]  
RSCK[3]/RSSIG[3]  
RSCK[3]/RSSIG[3]_EN  
RSD[3]  
RSD[3]_EN  
RSFS[2]/MRSFS[2]  
RSCK[2]/RSSIG[2]/MRSSIG[2]  
RSCK[2]/RSSIG[2]/MRSSIG[2]_EN  
TSFS[1]/TSSIG[1]/MTSSIG[1]  
TSFS[1]/TSSIG[1]/MTSSIG[1]_EN  
TSD[1]/MTSD[1]  
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
XCK  
RSCFS/MRSCFS  
RSCCK/MRSCCK  
TSCFS/MTSCFS  
TSCCKB/MTSCCKB  
TSCCKA  
Input  
Input  
Input  
Input  
Input  
Note: * BS means Boundary Scan Sequence  
Output  
Tri-state Output  
Control  
262  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
Table - 67. TAP Controller State Description  
STATE  
DESCRIPTION  
In this state, the test logic is disabled to continue normal operation of the device. During initialization, the device  
initializes the instruction register with the IDCODE instruction.  
Test Logic  
Reset  
Regardless of the original state of the controller, the controller enters the Test-Logic-Reset state when the TMS input  
is held high for at least 5 rising edges of TCK. The controller remains in this state while TMS is high.  
This is a controller state between scan operations. Once in this state, the controller remains in the state as long as  
TMS is held low. The instruction register and all test data registers retain their previous state. When TMS is high and a  
rising edge is applied to TCK, the controller moves to the Select-DR state.  
Run-Test/Idle  
This is a temporary controller state and the instruction does not change in this state. The test data register selected  
by the current instruction retains its previous state. If TMS is held low and a rising edge is applied to TCK when in this  
state, the controller moves into the Capture-DR state and a scan sequence for the selected test data register is initiated.  
If TMS is held high and a rising edge applied to TCK, the controller moves to the Select-IR-Scan state.  
In this state, the Boundary Scan Register captures input pin data if the current instruction is EXTEST or  
SAMPLE/PRELOAD. The instruction does not change in this state. The other test data registers, which do not have  
parallel input, are not changed. When the TAP controller is in this state and a rising edge is applied to TCK, the  
controller enters the Exit1-DR state if TMS is high or the Shift-DR state if TMS is low.  
Select-DR-Scan  
Capture-DR  
Shift-DR  
In this controller state, the test data register connected between TDI and TDO as a result of the current instruction  
shifts data on stage toward its serial output on each rising edge of TCK. The instruction does not change in this state.  
When the TAP controller is in this state and a rising edge is applied to TCK, the controller enters the Exit1-DR state if  
TMS is high or remains in the Shift-DR state if TMS is low.  
This is a temporary state. While in this state, if TMS is held high, a rising edge applied to TCK causes the controller  
to enter the Update-DR state, which terminates the scanning process. If TMS is held low and a rising edge is applied to  
TCK, the controller enters the Pause-DR state. The test data register selected by the current instruction retains its  
previous value and the instruction does not change during this state.  
Exit1-DR  
The pause state allows the test controller to temporarily halt the shifting of data through the test data register in the  
serial path between TDI and TDO. For example, this state could be used to allow the tester to reload its pin memory  
from disk during application of a long test sequence. The test data register selected by the current instruction retains its  
previous value and the instruction does not change during this state. The controller remains in this state as long as TMS  
is low. When TMS goes high and a rising edge is applied to TCK, the controller moves to the Exit2-DR state.  
This is a temporary state. While in this state, if TMS is held high, a rising edge applied to TCK causes the controller  
to enter the Update-DR state, which terminates the scanning process. If TMS is held low and a rising edge is applied to  
TCK, the controller enters the Shift-DR state. The test data register selected by the current instruction retains its  
previous value and the instruction does not change during this state.  
Pause-DR  
Exit2-DR  
The Boundary Scan Register is provided with a latched parallel output to prevent changes while data is shifted in  
response to the EXTEST and SAMPLE/PRELOAD instructions. When the TAP controller is in this state and the  
Boundary Scan Register is selected, data is latched into the parallel output of this register from the shift-register path on  
the falling edge of TCK. The data held at the latched parallel output changes only in this state. All shift-register stages in  
the test data register selected by the current instruction retain their previous value and the instruction does not change  
during this state.  
Update-DR  
This is a temporary controller state. The test data register selected by the current instruction retains its previous  
state. If TMS is held low and a rising edge is applied to TCK when in this state, the controller moves into the Capture-IR  
state, and a scan sequence for the instruction register is initiated. If TMS is held high and a rising edge is applied to  
TCK, the controller moves to the Test-Logic-Reset state. The instruction does not change during this state.  
In this controller state, the shift register contained in the instruction register loads a fixed value of ‘100’ on the rising  
edge of TCK. This supports fault-isolation of the board-level serial test data path. Data registers selected by the current  
instruction retain their value and the instruction does not change during this state. When the controller is in this state  
and a rising edge is applied to TCK, the controller enters the Exit1-IR state if TMS is held high, or the Shift-IR state if  
TMS is held low.  
Select-IR-Scan  
Capture-IR  
263  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
STATE  
DESCRIPTION  
In this state, the shift register contained in the instruction register is connected between TDI and TDO and shifts data one  
stage towards its serial output on each rising edge of TCK. The test data register selected by the current instruction retains its  
previous value and the instruction does not change during this state. When the controller is in this state and a rising edge is  
applied to TCK, the controller enters the Exit1-IR state if TMS is held high, or remains in the Shift-IR state if TMS is held low.  
This is a temporary state. While in this state, if TMS is held high, a rising edge applied to TCK causes the controller to  
enter the Update-IR state, which terminates the scanning process. If TMS is held low and a rising edge is applied to TCK, the  
controller enters the Pause-IR state. The test data register selected by the current instruction retains its previous value and  
the instruction does not change during this state.  
The pause state allows the test controller to temporarily halt the shifting of data through the instruction register. The test  
data register selected by the current instruction retains its previous value and the instruction does not change during this  
state. The controller remains in this state as long as TMS is low. When TMS goes high and a rising edge is applied to TCK,  
the controller moves to the Exit2-IR state.  
Shift-IR  
Exit1-IR  
Pause-IR  
Exit2-IR  
This is a temporary state. While in this state, if TMS is held high, a rising edge applied to TCK causes the controller to  
enter the Update-IR state, which terminates the scanning process. If TMS is held low and a rising edge is applied to TCK, the  
controller enters the Shift-IR state. The test data register selected by the current instruction retains its previous value and the  
instruction does not change during this state.  
The instruction shifted into the instruction register is latched into the parallel output from the shift-register path on the falling  
Update-IR edge of TCK. When the new instruction has been latched, it becomes the current instruction. The test data registers selected  
by the current instruction retain their previous value.  
1
Test-logic Reset  
0
0
1
1
1
Run Test/Idle  
Select-DR  
0
Select-IR  
0
1
1
Capture-DR  
0
Capture-IR  
0
0
0
Shift-DR  
1
Shift-IR  
1
1
1
Exit1-DR  
0
Exit1-IR  
0
0
0
Pause-DR  
1
Pause-IR  
1
0
0
Exit2-DR  
1
Exit2-IR  
1
Update-DR  
Update-IR  
0
0
1
1
Figure - 84. JTAG State Diagram  
264  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
7
PHYSICAL AND ELECTRICAL SPECIFICATIONS  
7.1 ABSOLUTE MAXIMUM RATINGS  
Min  
-65°C  
-0.3V  
VDD-0.3V  
-0.3V  
Max  
+150°C  
4.6V  
5.5V  
BIAS+0.3V  
230°C  
Storage temperature  
Voltage on VDD w.r.t. GND  
Voltage on BIAS w.r.t. GND  
Voltage on any pin  
Maximum lead temperature  
ESD Performance (HBM)  
ESD Performance (CDM)  
Latch-up current on any pin  
Maximum DC current on any pin  
Maximum lead temperature  
Maximum junction temperature  
during TBC seconds  
2000V  
1000V  
100ma  
7.2 OPERATING CONDITIONS  
@ TA = -40 to +85 °C, VDD = 3.3V ± 10%, VDD£BIAS£5.5V  
7.3 D.C. CHARACTERISTICS  
Parameter  
VDDC, VDDIO Core Power Supply  
BIAS  
IBIAS  
VIL  
Description  
Min  
2.97  
VDD  
0
Typ  
3.3  
5.0  
1
Max  
3.63  
5.5  
3
0.8  
Unit  
V
V
mA  
V
Test Conditions  
5V Tolerant Bias  
Current into 5V Bias  
Input Low Voltage  
VBIAS=5.5V  
VIH  
Input High Voltage  
2.0  
BIAS  
0.4  
V
V
V
V
V
V
uA  
uA  
uA  
mA  
VOL  
VOH  
VT+  
VT-  
VTH  
IILPU  
IIL  
Output Low Voltage  
Output High Voltage  
Reset Input High Voltage  
Reset Input Low Voltage  
Reset Input Hysteresis Voltage  
Input Low Current  
Input Low Current  
Input High Current  
Operating current  
VDD=min, IOL= 2mA, 3mA  
VDD=min, IOL= 3mA, 3mA  
2.4  
1.50  
0.83  
0.17  
-70  
1.75  
1.10  
0.65  
-330  
0
2.0  
1.33  
1.17  
-450  
+1  
VIL=GND  
VIL=GND  
VIH=VBIAS  
-1  
-10  
IIH  
IDDOP1  
0
160  
+10  
E1 mode, XCK=49.152MHz,  
TSCCKB=2.048MHz, output unloaded, Vdd=3.63V.  
E1 mode, XCK=49.152MHz,  
TSCCKB=8.192MHz, output unloaded. Vdd=3.63V.  
T1 mode, XCK=37.056MHz,  
TSCCKB=1.544MHz, output unloaded. Vdd=3.63V.  
IDDOP2  
IDDOP3  
Operating current  
Operating current  
170  
120  
mA  
mA  
265  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
7.4 CLOCK AND RESET TIMING  
The RST must be asserted for a minimum of 100 ns after XCLK is stable to ensure that the chip is completely reset.  
7.4.1  
CLOCK PARAMETERS E1 CONFIGURATION  
Min. Frequency (MHz)  
Max. Frequency (MHz)  
ppm  
TL min (ns)  
*
TH min (ns)*  
XCK  
LRCK  
MRSCCK  
TSCCKA  
RSCCK  
49.152  
2.0  
8.0  
2.0  
2.0  
2.0  
±50  
2.1  
8.4  
2.1  
2.1  
2.1  
100  
40  
100  
40  
100  
140  
140  
100  
140  
140  
TSCCKB  
7.4.2  
CLOCK PARAMETERS T1/J1 CONFIGURATION  
1
1
Min. Frequency(MHz)  
Max. Frequency(MHz)  
ppm  
±32 2  
TL min  
TH min  
XCK3  
37.056  
LRCK  
1.534  
8.00  
1.534  
1.50  
1.545  
8.40  
1.545  
2.0584  
2.104  
100  
40  
100  
140  
140  
100  
40  
100  
140  
140  
MRSCCK  
TSCCKA  
RSCCK  
TSCCKB  
1.50  
NOTE:  
1. The T L and T H are defined in the figure.  
TH  
TL  
clock in the  
above two  
tables  
2. An XCK input accuracy of ±100 ppm is only acceptable if an accurate line rate reference is provided. If TJAT is left to free-run without a reference, or referenced  
to a derivative of XCK, then XCK accuracy must be ±32 ppm. The accuracy of XCK affect the performance of TJAT/RJAT.  
3. An XCK input accuracy of ±100 ppm is only acceptable if an accurate line rate reference is provided. If TJAT is left to free-run without a reference, or referenced  
to a derivative of XCLK, then XCLK accuracy must be ±32 ppm. The accuracy of XCLK affect the performance of TJAT/DJAT.  
4. For T1 mode with 2.048Mb/s back-plane data rate only.  
266  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
7.5 MICROPROCESSOR READ ACCESS TIMING  
Symbol  
tSAR  
Parameter  
Min  
0
Max  
Units  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
ns  
Address to Valid Read Set-up Time  
Address to Valid Read Hold Time  
Address to Latch Set-up Time  
Address to Latch Hold Time  
Valid Latch Pulse Width  
tHAR  
tSALR  
tHALR  
tVL  
0
5
5
10  
0
tSLR  
Latch to Read Set-up Time  
Latch to Read Hold  
tHLR  
0
tZRD  
Valid Read Negated to Output Tri-state  
Valid Read to Valid Data Propagation Delay  
20  
tPRD  
E1  
T1  
E1  
T1  
E1  
T1  
E1  
T1  
130  
160  
145  
185  
tZINTH  
tVRD  
tW2R  
Valid Read Negated to INT Inactive  
Valid Read Width  
120  
150  
120  
150  
Valid interval from last write to next read  
tSAR  
tHAR  
A[9:0]  
ALE  
Valid  
Address  
tSALR  
tHALR  
tVL  
tVRD  
tSLR  
CS+RD  
tZINTH  
INT  
tPRD  
tZRD  
D[7:0]  
Vald Data  
CS+WR  
tW2R  
Figure - 85. Read Access Timing  
Notes:  
1. Output propagation delay time is the time from the V /2 point of the reference signal to the 1.4V point of the output.  
DD  
2. Maximum output propagation delays are measured with a 100pF load on the MPIF data bus D[7:0].  
3. All the set-up time or hold time are defined as the time between the V /2 point of the reference signal.  
DD  
4. In non-multiplexed mode, ALE can be held high, tSALR, tHALR, tV , tSLR and tHLR are not applicable.  
L
5. Parameter tHAR is not applicable when address latching is used. The interval of read accesses should > = 180 ns.  
267  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
7.6 MICROPROCESSOR WRITE ACCESS TIMING  
Symbol  
tSAW  
tSDW  
tSALW  
tHALW  
tVL  
Parameter  
Min  
5
MAX  
Units  
ns  
Address to Valid Write Set-up Time  
Data to Valid Write Set-up Time  
Address to Latch Set-up Time  
Address to Latch Hold Time  
Valid Latch Pulse Width  
0
ns  
ns  
5
5
ns  
5
ns  
tHLW  
Latch to Write Hold  
5
ns  
tHDW  
tHAW  
tW2W  
Data to Valid Write Hold Time  
Address to Valid Write Hold Time  
Write to write interval  
5
ns  
5
ns  
E1  
T1  
80  
100  
ns  
ns  
A[9:0]  
ALE  
Valid  
Address  
tSALW  
tHALW  
tHLW  
tHAW  
tVL  
tSAW  
CS+WR  
tW2W  
tSDW  
tHDW  
D[7:0]  
Vald Data  
Figure - 86. Write Access Timing  
Notes:  
1. Output propagation delay time is the time from the V /2 point of the reference signal to the V /2 point of the output.  
DD  
DD  
2. All the set-up time or hold time are defined as the time between the V /2 point of the reference signal.  
DD  
3. In non-multiplexed mode, ALE can be held high, tSALW, tHALW, tV , tSLW and tHLW are not applicable.  
4. Parameter tHAW and tSAW are not applicable when address latchLing is used.  
268  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
7.7 I/O TIMING CHARACTERISTICS  
7.7.1  
TRANSMIT SYSTEM INTERFACE TIMING  
Note that timing information can refer to the positive or negative edge of the reference clock. The active clock edge is selected by configuration  
flags.  
Symbol  
Tprop  
Ts  
Parameter  
Min  
0
15  
10  
Typ  
Max  
20  
Unit  
ns  
ns  
Propagation delay  
Set up time  
Hold time  
Thold  
ns  
TSCCKB  
Tprop  
TSFS[x]  
Thold  
Ts  
TSD[x]  
TSSIG[x]  
TSCFS  
Figure - 87. Transmit Interface Timing (Transmit System Common Clock #B)  
LTCK[x]  
Tprop  
TSFS[x]  
Ts  
Thold  
TSD[x]  
Figure - 88. Transmit Interface Timing (Line Transmit Clock)  
269  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
7.7.2  
RECEIVE SYSTEM INTERFACE TIMING  
Note that timing information can refer to the positive or negative edge of the reference clock. The active clock edge is selected by configuration  
flags.  
Symbol  
Tprop  
Ts  
Parameter  
Min  
0
10  
10  
Typ  
Max  
20  
Unit  
ns  
ns  
Propagation delay  
Set up time  
Hold time  
Thold  
ns  
RSCCK  
Tprop  
RSD[x]  
RSSIG[x]  
RSFS[x]  
Ts  
Thold  
RSCFP  
Figure - 89. Receive Interface Timing (Receive System Common Clock)  
RSCK[x]  
Tprop  
RSD[x]  
RSPS[x]  
Figure - 90. Receive Interface Timing (Receive System Clock)  
270  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
7.7.3  
RECEIVE & TRANSMIT LINE TIMING  
Note that timing information can refer to the positive or negative edge of the reference clock. The active clock edge is selected by configuration  
flags.  
7.7.3.1 Receive Line Interface Timing  
Symbol  
Ts  
Th  
Parameter  
Setup Time  
Hold Time  
Min  
10  
10  
Typ  
Max  
Unit  
ns  
ns  
LRCK[x]  
LRD[x]  
Ts  
Thold  
Figure - 91. Receive Line Interface Timing  
7.7.3.2 Transmit Line Interface Timing  
Symbol  
Tprop  
Parameter  
Propagation delay  
Min  
-10  
Typ  
Max  
10  
Unit  
ns  
TLCLK[x]  
Tprop  
TLD[x]  
Figure - 92. Transmit Line Interface Timing  
271  
INDUSTRIAL  
TEMPERATURE RANGES  
IDT82V2108 T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER  
ORDERING INFORMATION  
IDT  
XXXXXXX  
XX  
X
Device Type  
Package  
Process/Temperature Range  
BLANK  
Industrial (-40 °C to +85 °C)  
BB  
PX  
Plastic Ball Grid Array (PBGA, BB144)  
Plastic Quad Flat Pack (PQFP128)  
82V2108  
T1 / E1 / J1 Octal Framer  
Data Sheet Document History  
07/30/2002 pgs 48, 50, 199  
09/09/2002 pgs 32, 33, 123, 125, 190, 236  
01/15/2003 pgs 1, 272  
CORPORATEHEADQUARTERS  
forSALES:  
for Tech Support:  
2975StenderWay  
Santa Clara, CA 95054  
800-345-7015or408-727-6116  
fax:408-492-8674  
408-330-1552  
email:telecomhelp@idt.com  
www.idt.com*  
*To search for sales office near you, please click the sales button found on our home page or dial the 800# above and press 2.  
The IDT logo is a registered trademark of Integrated Device Technology, Inc.  
272  

相关型号:

IDT82V2108BB

T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER
IDT

IDT82V2108BBG

Framer, CMOS, PBGA144, PLASTIC, BGA-144
IDT

IDT82V2108PX

T1 / E1 / J1 OCTAL FRAMER
IDT

IDT82V2108PXG

Framer, CMOS, PQFP128, PLASTIC, QFP-128
IDT

IDT82V2108PXG8

Framer, CMOS, PQFP128, PLASTIC, QFP-128
IDT

IDT82V2604

INVERSE MULTIPLEXING FOR ATM IDT82V2604
IDT

IDT82V2604BB

INVERSE MULTIPLEXING FOR ATM IDT82V2604
IDT

IDT82V2608

INVERSE MULTIPLEXING FOR ATM
IDT

IDT82V2608BB

INVERSE MULTIPLEXING FOR ATM
IDT

IDT82V2608BBG

Support Circuit, 1-Func, PBGA208, GREEN, PLASTIC, BGA-208
IDT

IDT82V2616

INVERSE MULTIPLEXING FOR ATM
IDT

IDT82V2616BB

INVERSE MULTIPLEXING FOR ATM
IDT